]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/calc.texi
version 3.04
[gnu-emacs] / man / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc 2.02g Manual
7 @setchapternewpage odd
8 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
11 @c @texline foo
12 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
13 @c @infoline foo
14 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
15
16 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
17 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
18
19 @iftex
20 @macro texline{stuff}
21 \stuff\
22 @end macro
23 @alias infoline=comment
24 @tex
25 \gdef\exprsetup{\tex \let\t\ttfont \turnoffactive}
26 \gdef\expr{\exprsetup$\exprfinish}
27 \gdef\exprfinish#1{#1$\endgroup}
28 @end tex
29 @alias mathit=expr
30 @macro cpi{}
31 @math{@pi{}}
32 @end macro
33 @macro cpiover{den}
34 @math{@pi/\den\}
35 @end macro
36 @end iftex
37
38 @ifnottex
39 @alias texline=comment
40 @macro infoline{stuff}
41 \stuff\
42 @end macro
43 @alias expr=samp
44 @alias mathit=i
45 @macro cpi{}
46 @expr{pi}
47 @end macro
48 @macro cpiover{den}
49 @expr{pi/\den\}
50 @end macro
51 @end ifnottex
52
53
54 @tex
55 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
56 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
57 @end tex
58
59 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
60 @iftex
61 @finalout
62 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
63 @tex
64 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
65
66 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
67 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
68 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
69 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
70 @end tex
71 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
72 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
73 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
74 @ignore
75 @newcount@calcpageno
76 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
77 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
78 @ifx@turnoffactive@undefinedzzz@def@turnoffactive{}@fi
79 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
80 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
81 \r@ggedbottomtrue
82 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
83 @end ignore
84 @end iftex
85
86 @copying
87 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
88
89 Copyright (C) 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90
91 @quotation
92 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
93 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
94 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
95 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
96 Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
97 Texts as in (a) below.
98
99 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
100 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
101 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
102 @end quotation
103 @end copying
104
105 @dircategory Emacs
106 @direntry
107 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
108 @end direntry
109
110 @titlepage
111 @sp 6
112 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
113 @sp 4
114 @center GNU Emacs Calc Version 2.02g
115 @c [volume]
116 @sp 1
117 @center January 2002
118 @sp 5
119 @center Dave Gillespie
120 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
121 @page
122
123 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
124 Copyright @copyright{} 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
125 @insertcopying
126 @end titlepage
127
128 @c [begin]
129 @ifinfo
130 @node Top, , (dir), (dir)
131 @chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
132
133 @noindent
134 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
135 that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
136
137 This manual is divided into three major parts: ``Getting Started,''
138 the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial
139 introduces all the major aspects of Calculator use in an easy,
140 hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is a complete reference to
141 the features of the Calculator.
142
143 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
144 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
145 longer Info tutorial.)
146
147 @end ifinfo
148 @menu
149 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
150
151 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
152 * Interactive Tutorial::
153 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
154
155 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
156 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
157 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
158 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
159 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
160 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
161 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
162 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
163 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
164 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
165 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
166 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
167 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
168 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
169
170 * Installation:: Installing Calc as a part of GNU Emacs.
171 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
172
173 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
174
175 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
176 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
177 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
178 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
179 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
180 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
181 @end menu
182
183 @node Copying, Getting Started, Top, Top
184 @unnumbered GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
185 @center Version 1, February 1989
186
187 @display
188 Copyright @copyright{} 1989 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
189 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA
190
191 Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
192 of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
193 @end display
194
195 @unnumberedsec Preamble
196
197 The license agreements of most software companies try to keep users
198 at the mercy of those companies. By contrast, our General Public
199 License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
200 software---to make sure the software is free for all its users. The
201 General Public License applies to the Free Software Foundation's
202 software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it.
203 You can use it for your programs, too.
204
205 When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
206 price. Specifically, the General Public License is designed to make
207 sure that you have the freedom to give away or sell copies of free
208 software, that you receive source code or can get it if you want it,
209 that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free
210 programs; and that you know you can do these things.
211
212 To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
213 anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
214 These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
215 distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
216
217 For example, if you distribute copies of a such a program, whether
218 gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
219 you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
220 source code. And you must tell them their rights.
221
222 We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
223 (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
224 distribute and/or modify the software.
225
226 Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
227 that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
228 software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
229 want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
230 that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
231 authors' reputations.
232
233 The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
234 modification follow.
235
236 @iftex
237 @unnumberedsec TERMS AND CONDITIONS
238 @end iftex
239 @ifinfo
240 @center TERMS AND CONDITIONS
241 @end ifinfo
242
243 @enumerate
244 @item
245 This License Agreement applies to any program or other work which
246 contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be
247 distributed under the terms of this General Public License. The
248 ``Program'', below, refers to any such program or work, and a ``work based
249 on the Program'' means either the Program or any work containing the
250 Program or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications. Each
251 licensee is addressed as ``you''.
252
253 @item
254 You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's source
255 code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
256 appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and
257 disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this
258 General Public License and to the absence of any warranty; and give any
259 other recipients of the Program a copy of this General Public License
260 along with the Program. You may charge a fee for the physical act of
261 transferring a copy.
262
263 @item
264 You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of
265 it, and copy and distribute such modifications under the terms of Paragraph
266 1 above, provided that you also do the following:
267
268 @itemize @bullet
269 @item
270 cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that
271 you changed the files and the date of any change; and
272
273 @item
274 cause the whole of any work that you distribute or publish, that
275 in whole or in part contains the Program or any part thereof, either
276 with or without modifications, to be licensed at no charge to all
277 third parties under the terms of this General Public License (except
278 that you may choose to grant warranty protection to some or all
279 third parties, at your option).
280
281 @item
282 If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when
283 run, you must cause it, when started running for such interactive use
284 in the simplest and most usual way, to print or display an
285 announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a notice
286 that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide a
287 warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under these
288 conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this General
289 Public License.
290
291 @item
292 You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a
293 copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in
294 exchange for a fee.
295 @end itemize
296
297 Mere aggregation of another independent work with the Program (or its
298 derivative) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring
299 the other work under the scope of these terms.
300
301 @item
302 You may copy and distribute the Program (or a portion or derivative of
303 it, under Paragraph 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
304 Paragraphs 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
305
306 @itemize @bullet
307 @item
308 accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
309 source code, which must be distributed under the terms of
310 Paragraphs 1 and 2 above; or,
311
312 @item
313 accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
314 years, to give any third party free (except for a nominal charge
315 for the cost of distribution) a complete machine-readable copy of the
316 corresponding source code, to be distributed under the terms of
317 Paragraphs 1 and 2 above; or,
318
319 @item
320 accompany it with the information you received as to where the
321 corresponding source code may be obtained. (This alternative is
322 allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
323 received the program in object code or executable form alone.)
324 @end itemize
325
326 Source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making
327 modifications to it. For an executable file, complete source code means
328 all the source code for all modules it contains; but, as a special
329 exception, it need not include source code for modules which are standard
330 libraries that accompany the operating system on which the executable
331 file runs, or for standard header files or definitions files that
332 accompany that operating system.
333
334 @item
335 You may not copy, modify, sublicense, distribute or transfer the
336 Program except as expressly provided under this General Public License.
337 Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, distribute or transfer
338 the Program is void, and will automatically terminate your rights to use
339 the Program under this License. However, parties who have received
340 copies, or rights to use copies, from you under this General Public
341 License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties
342 remain in full compliance.
343
344 @item
345 By copying, distributing or modifying the Program (or any work based
346 on the Program) you indicate your acceptance of this license to do so,
347 and all its terms and conditions.
348
349 @item
350 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
351 Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original
352 licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to these
353 terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the
354 recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
355
356 @item
357 The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
358 of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
359 be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
360 address new problems or concerns.
361
362 Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
363 specifies a version number of the license which applies to it and ``any
364 later version'', you have the option of following the terms and conditions
365 either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
366 Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
367 the license, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
368 Foundation.
369
370 @item
371 If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
372 programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
373 to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
374 Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
375 make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
376 of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
377 of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
378
379 @iftex
380 @heading NO WARRANTY
381 @end iftex
382 @ifinfo
383 @center NO WARRANTY
384 @end ifinfo
385
386 @item
387 BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
388 FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
389 OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
390 PROVIDE THE PROGRAM ``AS IS'' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
391 OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
392 MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
393 TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
394 PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
395 REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
396
397 @item
398 IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL
399 ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
400 REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
401 INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
402 ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT
403 LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES
404 SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE
405 WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN
406 ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
407 @end enumerate
408
409 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Copying, Top
410 @chapter Getting Started
411 @noindent
412 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
413 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
414 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
415
416 @menu
417 * What is Calc::
418 * About This Manual::
419 * Notations Used in This Manual::
420 * Using Calc::
421 * Demonstration of Calc::
422 * History and Acknowledgements::
423 @end menu
424
425 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
426 @section What is Calc?
427
428 @noindent
429 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
430 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
431 series of calculators, its many features include:
432
433 @itemize @bullet
434 @item
435 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
436
437 @item
438 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
439
440 @item
441 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
442 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
443 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
444 and algebraic formulas.
445
446 @item
447 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
448
449 @item
450 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
451
452 @item
453 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
454
455 @item
456 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
457 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
458
459 @item
460 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
461
462 @item
463 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
464
465 @item
466 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
467 inside any editing buffer.
468
469 @item
470 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
471
472 @item
473 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
474 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
475 @end itemize
476
477 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
478 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
479 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
480 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
481 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
482 the program you can learn its additional features. In terms of efficiency,
483 scope and depth, Calc cannot replace a powerful tool like Mathematica.
484 But Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and availability
485 of the source code. And, of course, it's free!
486
487 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
488 @section About This Manual
489
490 @noindent
491 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
492 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices, and as
493 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
494 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
495 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
496 regularly.
497
498 @ifinfo
499 The manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
500 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial (chapter 2),
501 and the Calc reference manual (the remaining chapters and appendices).
502 @end ifinfo
503 @iftex
504 The manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
505 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial (chapter 2),
506 and the Calc reference manual (the remaining chapters and appendices).
507 @c [when-split]
508 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
509 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
510 @c chapter.
511 @end iftex
512
513 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
514 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
515 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
516 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
517 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
518
519 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
520 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
521 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
522 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
523 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
524 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
525 to use its features.
526
527 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
528 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
529 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
530 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
531 need to know.
532
533 @cindex Marginal notes
534 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
535 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
536 variables also have their own indices.
537 @texline Each
538 @infoline In the printed manual, each
539 paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
540 in the margin with its index entry.
541
542 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
543 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by
544 pressing the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window,
545 you can press @kbd{M-# i} to read the manual on-line. Also, you
546 can jump directly to the Tutorial by pressing @kbd{h t} or @kbd{M-# t},
547 or to the Summary by pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{M-# s}. Within Calc,
548 you can also go to the part of the manual describing any Calc key,
549 function, or variable using @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v},
550 respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
551
552 Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
553 Foundation.
554
555 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
556 @section Notations Used in This Manual
557
558 @noindent
559 This section describes the various notations that are used
560 throughout the Calc manual.
561
562 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
563 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
564 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
565 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
566 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
567 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
568 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
569 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
570 regularly using Emacs.
571
572 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
573 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
574 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
575 also press @key{ESC} or @key{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
576 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
577
578 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
579 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
580 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
581
582 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
583 or @kbd{M-# k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
584 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{M-# k} key sequence,
585 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
586
587 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
588 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
589 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
590 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
591 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
592
593 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
594 [@code{sincos}].
595
596 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
597 @section A Demonstration of Calc
598
599 @noindent
600 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
601 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
602 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
603 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
604 Tutorial.
605
606 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
607 does this), and type @kbd{M-# c} (or @kbd{@key{ESC} # c}) to start the
608 Calculator. (@xref{Starting Calc}, if this doesn't work for you.)
609
610 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
611 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
612 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
613 Delete, and Space keys.
614
615 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
616 then the command to operate on the numbers.
617
618 @noindent
619 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
620 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
621 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
622
623 @noindent
624 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
625 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
626 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
627
628 @noindent
629 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
630
631 @noindent
632 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
633 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
634
635 @noindent
636 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
637
638 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
639 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
640 use the apostrophe key.
641
642 @noindent
643 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
644 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
645 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
646
647 @noindent
648 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
649 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
650 @infoline `pi' squared.
651 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
652
653 @noindent
654 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
655 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
656
657 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
658 @w{@kbd{M-# k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
659 the next section.)
660
661 @noindent
662 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
663 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
664
665 @noindent
666 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @t{y^x}.
667
668 @noindent
669 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
670
671 @noindent
672 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
673
674 @noindent
675 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
676 the Keypad Calculator off.
677
678 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{M-# x} if necessary to exit Calc.
679 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
680 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
681 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
682 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{M-# i}}, or just
683 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{M-# g} to
684 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
685
686 @example
687 @group
688 1.23 1.97
689 1.6 2
690 1.19 1.08
691 @end group
692 @end example
693
694 @noindent
695 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
696 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
697
698 @noindent
699 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
700 the product of the numbers.
701
702 @noindent
703 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
704 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
705 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{M-# r}.
706
707 @noindent
708 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
709 @texline @math{3\times2}
710 @infoline 3x2
711 matrix into a
712 @texline @math{2\times3}
713 @infoline 2x3
714 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
715 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
716 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
717 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{M-# :}.)
718
719 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
720 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
721 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
722
723 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
724 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
725 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
726 many weeks have passed since then.
727
728 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
729 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
730 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
731 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
732 between @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
733 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
734
735 @noindent
736 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
737 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, and @kbd{d T}
738 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system.
739 Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
740
741 @noindent
742 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
743 (That's a letter @kbd{l}, not a numeral @kbd{1}.)
744
745 @iftex
746 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
747 manual. Type @kbd{M-# c} to return to Calc after each of these
748 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
749 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
750 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
751 @end iftex
752 @ifinfo
753 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
754 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{M-# c}, to
755 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
756 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
757 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
758 @end ifinfo
759
760 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
761 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{M-# c} again.
762
763 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgements, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
764 @section Using Calc
765
766 @noindent
767 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
768 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
769 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
770
771 @menu
772 * Starting Calc::
773 * The Standard Interface::
774 * Quick Mode Overview::
775 * Keypad Mode Overview::
776 * Standalone Operation::
777 * Embedded Mode Overview::
778 * Other M-# Commands::
779 @end menu
780
781 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
782 @subsection Starting Calc
783
784 @noindent
785 On most systems, you can type @kbd{M-#} to start the Calculator.
786 The notation @kbd{M-#} is short for Meta-@kbd{#}. On most
787 keyboards this means holding down the Meta (or Alt) and
788 Shift keys while typing @kbd{3}.
789
790 @cindex META key
791 Once again, if you don't have a Meta key on your keyboard you can type
792 @key{ESC} first, then @kbd{#}, to accomplish the same thing. If you
793 don't even have an @key{ESC} key, you can fake it by holding down
794 Control or @key{CTRL} while typing a left square bracket
795 (that's @kbd{C-[} in Emacs notation).
796
797 @kbd{M-#} is a @dfn{prefix key}; when you press it, Emacs waits for
798 you to press a second key to complete the command. In this case,
799 you will follow @kbd{M-#} with a letter (upper- or lower-case, it
800 doesn't matter for @kbd{M-#}) that says which Calc interface you
801 want to use.
802
803 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{M-# c}. To get
804 Keypad mode, type @kbd{M-# k}. Type @kbd{M-# ?} to get a brief
805 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
806 a complete list.
807
808 To ease typing, @kbd{M-# M-#} (or @kbd{M-# #} if that's easier)
809 also works to start Calc. It starts the same interface (either
810 @kbd{M-# c} or @w{@kbd{M-# k}}) that you last used, selecting the
811 @kbd{M-# c} interface by default. (If your installation has
812 a special function key set up to act like @kbd{M-#}, hitting that
813 function key twice is just like hitting @kbd{M-# M-#}.)
814
815 If @kbd{M-#} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
816 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
817 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
818 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
819 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
820
821 The same commands (like @kbd{M-# c} or @kbd{M-# M-#}) that start
822 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
823
824 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
825 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
826
827 @noindent
828 @cindex Standard user interface
829 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
830 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{M-# c}
831 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
832 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
833
834 @smallexample
835 @group
836
837 ...
838 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
839 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calc Mode v2.00...
840 2: 17.3 | 17.3
841 1: -5 | 3
842 . | 2
843 | 4
844 | * 8
845 | ->-5
846 |
847 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%%-Emacs: *Calc Trail*
848 @end group
849 @end smallexample
850
851 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
852 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
853 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
854 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
855 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
856 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
857 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
858 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
859 you do.
860
861 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
862 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
863 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
864 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
865 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
866
867 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
868 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
869 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
870
871 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
872 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
873 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
874 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
875 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
876 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
877 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
878
879 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
880 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
881 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
882 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
883 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
884 as Calc commands.
885
886 When you quit by pressing @kbd{M-# c} a second time, the Calculator
887 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
888 hidden. When you press @kbd{M-# c} once again you will get the
889 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
890 Calculator.
891
892 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
893 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{M-# c} will give you
894 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
895 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
896 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
897 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
898 always treat @kbd{M-# M-#} the same as @kbd{M-# c}.
899
900 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
901
902 If you type @kbd{M-# b} first and then @kbd{M-# c}, you get a
903 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
904 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
905 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{M-# c} again to quit,
906 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{M-# b} key
907 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
908 normal partial-screen mode.
909
910 Finally, @kbd{M-# o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{M-# c}
911 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
912 editing before remains selected instead. @kbd{M-# o} is a handy
913 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; type
914 @kbd{M-# c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
915
916 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
917 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
918
919 @noindent
920 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
921 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{M-# q}
922 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
923
924 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
925 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
926 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
927 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
928 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{M-# q}
929 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
930 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
931 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
932
933 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
934 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{M-# c}) to change the mode settings.
935
936 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
937 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
938
939 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
940 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
941
942 @noindent
943 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
944 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
945 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
946 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
947
948 Type @kbd{M-# k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
949 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
950 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
951 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
952
953 @tex
954 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
955 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
956 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
957 \medskip
958 @end tex
959 @smallexample
960 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
961 |2: 17.3
962 |1: -5
963 | .
964 |--%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
965 |----+-----Calc 2.00-----+----1
966 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
967 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
968 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
969 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
970 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
971 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
972 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
973 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
974 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
975 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
976 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
977 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
978 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
979 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
980 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
981 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
982 @end smallexample
983
984 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
985 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
986 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
987 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
988 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
989 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
990
991 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
992 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
993 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
994 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
995 the stack).
996
997 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
998 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
999 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
1000 numbers.
1001
1002 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
1003 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
1004 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
1005 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
1006 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
1007
1008 If you press @kbd{M-# b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
1009 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
1010 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
1011
1012 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
1013 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
1014
1015 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
1016 @subsection Standalone Operation
1017
1018 @noindent
1019 @cindex Standalone Operation
1020 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
1021 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
1022 can give the commands:
1023
1024 @example
1025 emacs -f full-calc
1026 @end example
1027
1028 @noindent
1029 or
1030
1031 @example
1032 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
1033 @end example
1034
1035 @noindent
1036 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{M-# b M-# c}) or
1037 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{M-# b M-# k}).
1038 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
1039 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
1040 itself.
1041
1042 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other M-# Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
1043 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
1044
1045 @noindent
1046 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
1047 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
1048 document like this:
1049
1050 @smallexample
1051 @group
1052 The derivative of
1053
1054 ln(ln(x))
1055
1056 is
1057 @end group
1058 @end smallexample
1059
1060 @noindent
1061 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
1062 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
1063 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
1064 you want the result to be:
1065
1066 @smallexample
1067 @group
1068 The derivative of
1069
1070 ln(ln(x))
1071
1072 is
1073
1074 ln(ln(x))
1075 @end group
1076 @end smallexample
1077
1078 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{M-# e}.
1079 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to
1080 tell how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly)
1081 onto the Calc stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the
1082 editing buffer, but the buffer's mode line will change to look
1083 like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like @samp{12 Deg}
1084 and so on). Even though you are still in your editing buffer,
1085 the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
1086 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take
1087 the derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
1088
1089 @smallexample
1090 @group
1091 The derivative of
1092
1093 ln(ln(x))
1094
1095 is
1096
1097 1 / ln(x) x
1098 @end group
1099 @end smallexample
1100
1101 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
1102 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 @group
1106 The derivative of
1107
1108 ln(ln(x))
1109
1110 is
1111 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
1112 % [calc-mode: language: big]
1113
1114 1
1115 -------
1116 ln(x) x
1117 @end group
1118 @end smallexample
1119
1120 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
1121 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
1122 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{}.
1123 (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want to move
1124 these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them out
1125 of the way.)
1126
1127 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
1128 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 @group
1132 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
1133 % [calc-mode: language: big]
1134 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
1135
1136 1
1137 ------- (1)
1138 ln(x) x
1139 @end group
1140 @end smallexample
1141
1142 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{M-# e} again. The mode line
1143 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before. (If you have
1144 actually been trying this as you read along, you'll want to press
1145 @kbd{M-# 0} [with the digit zero] now to reset the modes you changed.)
1146
1147 The related command @kbd{M-# w} operates on a single word, which
1148 generally means a single number, inside text. It uses any
1149 non-numeric characters rather than blank lines to delimit the
1150 formula it reads. Here's an example of its use:
1151
1152 @smallexample
1153 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
1154 @end smallexample
1155
1156 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{M-# w} to enable
1157 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
1158 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
1159 then @w{@kbd{M-# w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
1160
1161 @smallexample
1162 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
1163 @end smallexample
1164
1165 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1166 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
1167
1168 @node Other M-# Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
1169 @subsection Other @kbd{M-#} Commands
1170
1171 @noindent
1172 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{M-# g} and @kbd{M-# r},
1173 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
1174 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
1175 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
1176 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
1177
1178 The @kbd{M-# g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
1179 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
1180 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
1181 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
1182 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
1183 @kbd{C-u M-# g} interprets the region as a single number or
1184 formula.
1185
1186 The @kbd{M-# r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1187 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1188 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1189
1190 Complementary to these is @kbd{M-# y}, which ``yanks'' the
1191 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1192 If you type @w{@kbd{M-# y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1193 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{M-# y} while
1194 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1195 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1196 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1197 is something on the Calc stack.
1198
1199 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{M-#} commands.
1200 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1201 following @kbd{M-#}.
1202
1203 @noindent
1204 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1205
1206 @table @kbd
1207 @item #
1208 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1209
1210 @item C
1211 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1212 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1213 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1214
1215 @item O
1216 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1217 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1218 move it out of that window.
1219
1220 @item B
1221 Control whether @kbd{M-# c} and @kbd{M-# k} use the full screen.
1222
1223 @item Q
1224 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1225
1226 @item K
1227 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1228
1229 @item E
1230 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1231
1232 @item J
1233 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1234
1235 @item W
1236 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1237
1238 @item Z
1239 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1240
1241 @item X
1242 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1243 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1244 @end table
1245 @iftex
1246 @sp 2
1247 @end iftex
1248
1249 @noindent
1250 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1251
1252 @table @kbd
1253 @item G
1254 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1255
1256 @item R
1257 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1258
1259 @item :
1260 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1261
1262 @item _
1263 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1264
1265 @item Y
1266 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1267 @end table
1268 @iftex
1269 @sp 2
1270 @end iftex
1271
1272 @noindent
1273 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1274
1275 @table @kbd
1276 @item A
1277 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1278 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1279 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1280
1281 @item D
1282 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1283 the duplicate.
1284
1285 @item F
1286 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1287
1288 @item N
1289 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1290
1291 @item P
1292 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1293
1294 @item U
1295 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1296
1297 @item `
1298 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1299 @end table
1300 @iftex
1301 @sp 2
1302 @end iftex
1303
1304 @noindent
1305 Miscellaneous commands:
1306
1307 @table @kbd
1308 @item I
1309 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1310 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1311
1312 @item T
1313 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1314
1315 @item S
1316 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1317
1318 @item L
1319 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1320 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1321
1322 @item M
1323 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1324 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1325
1326 @item 0
1327 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1328 its default state: Empty stack, and default mode settings.
1329 With any prefix argument, reset everything but the stack.
1330 @end table
1331
1332 @node History and Acknowledgements, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1333 @section History and Acknowledgements
1334
1335 @noindent
1336 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1337 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1338 the value of
1339 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1340 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1341 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1342 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1343 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1344 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1345 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1346 all.
1347
1348 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1349 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1350 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1351 got too far out of hand.
1352
1353 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1354 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1355 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1356
1357 Emacs Lisp doesn't have built-in floating point math, so it had to be
1358 simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers will only comfortably
1359 fit six decimal digits or so---not enough for a decent calculator. So
1360 I had to write my own high-precision integer code as well, and once I had
1361 this I figured that arbitrary-size integers were just as easy as large
1362 integers. Arbitrary floating-point precision was the logical next step.
1363 Also, since the large integer arithmetic was there anyway it seemed only
1364 fair to give the user direct access to it, which in turn made it practical
1365 to support fractions as well as floats. All these features inspired me
1366 to look around for other data types that might be worth having.
1367
1368 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1369 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1370 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I decided
1371 that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once things had
1372 gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at serious algebra
1373 systems like Mathematica, Macsyma, and Maple for further ideas. Since
1374 these systems did far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided
1375 to focus on rewrite rules and other programming features so that users
1376 could implement what they needed for themselves.
1377
1378 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1379 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1380 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1381
1382 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1383 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1384 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1385
1386 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1387 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1388 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1389 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1390 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1391 algebra system for microcomputers.
1392
1393 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1394 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1395 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1396 rules, and many other algebra features;
1397 @texline Fran\c cois
1398 @infoline Francois
1399 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1400 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1401 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1402 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1403 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1404 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1405 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Robert
1406 J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises; and Juha
1407 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1408 parts. Bob Weiner helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port.
1409
1410 @cindex Bibliography
1411 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1412 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1413 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1414 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1415 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1416 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1417 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for
1418 the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham, Knuth,
1419 and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the @emph{CRC
1420 Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and Abramowitz and
1421 Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical Functions}. I
1422 consulted the user's manuals for the HP-28 and HP-48 calculators, as
1423 well as for the programs Mathematica, SMP, Macsyma, Maple, MathCAD,
1424 Gnuplot, and others. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written
1425 without the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil
1426 Lewis and Dan LaLiberte.
1427
1428 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1429 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1430 finished in two weeks.
1431
1432 @c [tutorial]
1433
1434 @ifinfo
1435 @c This node is accessed by the `M-# t' command.
1436 @node Interactive Tutorial, , , Top
1437 @chapter Tutorial
1438
1439 @noindent
1440 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1441
1442 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1443 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1444 for this).
1445
1446 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1447 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1448 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1449 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1450
1451 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1452 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1453 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1454 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1455 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1456
1457 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1458
1459 Press @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1460
1461 @menu
1462 * Tutorial::
1463 @end menu
1464 @end ifinfo
1465
1466 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1467 @chapter Tutorial
1468
1469 @noindent
1470 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1471 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1472 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1473 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1474 @c [not-split]
1475 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1476 @c [when-split]
1477 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1478
1479 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1480 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1481 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1482 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1483 the Embedded mode interface.
1484
1485 @ifinfo
1486 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1487 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. (If you
1488 have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead.) Press
1489 @kbd{M-# c} to turn Calc on or to switch into the Calc window, and
1490 press @kbd{M-# i} to start the Info system or to switch into its window.
1491 Or, you may prefer to use the tutorial in printed form.
1492 @end ifinfo
1493 @iftex
1494 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1495 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. (If you
1496 have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead.) Press
1497 @kbd{M-# c} to turn Calc on or to switch into the Calc window, and
1498 press @kbd{M-# i} to start the Info system or to switch into its window.
1499 @end iftex
1500
1501 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1502 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1503 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1504 general areas.
1505
1506 @ifinfo
1507 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1508 it as you learn Calc. @xref{Installation}, to see how to make a printed
1509 summary. @xref{Summary}.
1510 @end ifinfo
1511 @iftex
1512 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1513 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1514 Calc.
1515 @end iftex
1516
1517 @menu
1518 * Basic Tutorial::
1519 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1520 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1521 * Types Tutorial::
1522 * Algebra Tutorial::
1523 * Programming Tutorial::
1524
1525 * Answers to Exercises::
1526 @end menu
1527
1528 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1529 @section Basic Tutorial
1530
1531 @noindent
1532 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1533 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1534 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1535
1536 @menu
1537 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1538 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1539 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1540 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1541 @end menu
1542
1543 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1544 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1545
1546 @cindex RPN notation
1547 @ifinfo
1548 @noindent
1549 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1550 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1551 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1552 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1553 @end ifinfo
1554 @tex
1555 \noindent
1556 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1557 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1558 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1559 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1560 @end tex
1561
1562 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1563 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1564 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1565 from the top of the stack.
1566
1567 @cindex Operators
1568 @cindex Operands
1569 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1570 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1571 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1572 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1573 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1574 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1575
1576 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1577 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1578 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1579 you wish; type @kbd{M-# c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1580 @kbd{M-# c} again or @kbd{M-# o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1581 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1582 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1583 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1584 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1585
1586 @smallexample
1587 @group
1588 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1589 . 1: 3 .
1590 .
1591
1592 M-# c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1593 @end group
1594 @end smallexample
1595
1596 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1597 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1598 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1599 less distracting in regular use.
1600
1601 @cindex Stack levels
1602 @cindex Levels of stack
1603 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1604 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1605 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1606 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1607 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1608 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1609 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1610
1611 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1612 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1613 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1614 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1615 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1616 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1617 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1618 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1619 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1620 if you are interested.
1621
1622 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1623 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1624 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1625 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1626 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1627
1628 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1629 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1630
1631 @smallexample
1632 @group
1633 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1634 . 1: 3 .
1635 .
1636
1637 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1638 @end group
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @noindent
1642 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1643 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1644 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1645
1646 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1647 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1648 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1649 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1650 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1651 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1652 return to where you were.)
1653
1654 @noindent
1655 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1656 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1657 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1658 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1659
1660 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1661 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.4) + {5\over4}}
1662 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1663 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1664
1665 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1666 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1667 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1668 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1669 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1670 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1671 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1672 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1673 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1674
1675 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1676 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1677 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1678
1679 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1680 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1681 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1682 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1683 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1684
1685 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1686 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1687 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1688
1689 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1690 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1691 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1692
1693 @smallexample
1694 @group
1695 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1696 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1697 . .
1698
1699 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1700 @end group
1701 @end smallexample
1702
1703 @noindent
1704 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1705 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1706
1707 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1708 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1709 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1710
1711 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1712 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1713 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1714 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1715 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1716
1717 @smallexample
1718 @group
1719 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1720 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1721 . .
1722
1723 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1724 @end group
1725 @end smallexample
1726
1727 @noindent
1728 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1729
1730 @smallexample
1731 @group
1732 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1733 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1734 . 1: 3 .
1735 .
1736
1737 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1738 @end group
1739 @end smallexample
1740
1741 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1742 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1743 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1744
1745 @smallexample
1746 @group
1747 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1748 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1749 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1750 . . .
1751
1752 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1753 @end group
1754 @end smallexample
1755
1756 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1757 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1758 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1759 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1760
1761 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1762 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1763 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1764 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1765
1766 @smallexample
1767 @group
1768 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1769 . . 1: 16 . .
1770 .
1771
1772 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1773 @end group
1774 @end smallexample
1775
1776 @noindent
1777 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1778 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1779
1780 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1781 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1782 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1783 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1784 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1785
1786 @smallexample
1787 @group
1788 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1789 . 1: 4 .
1790 .
1791
1792 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1793 @end group
1794 @end smallexample
1795
1796 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1797 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1798 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1799 prefix for you:
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 @group
1803 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1804 . 1: 4 .
1805 .
1806
1807 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1808 @end group
1809 @end smallexample
1810
1811 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1812
1813 @smallexample
1814 @group
1815 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1816 . . .
1817
1818 4 @key{RET} n Q
1819 @end group
1820 @end smallexample
1821
1822 @noindent
1823 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1824 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1825 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1826 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1827
1828 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1829 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1830 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1831 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1832 complex result.)
1833
1834 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1835 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1836
1837 @smallexample
1838 @group
1839 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1840 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1841 . .
1842
1843 ( 2 , 3 )
1844 @end group
1845 @end smallexample
1846
1847 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1848 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1849
1850 @smallexample
1851 @group
1852 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1853 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1854 . 1: 3 . .
1855 .
1856 (error)
1857 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1858 @end group
1859 @end smallexample
1860
1861 @noindent
1862 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1863 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1864
1865 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1866 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1867
1868 @smallexample
1869 @group
1870 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1871 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1872 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1873 . . .
1874
1875 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1876 @end group
1877 @end smallexample
1878
1879 @noindent
1880 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1881 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1882 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1883 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1884
1885 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1886 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1887 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1888 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1889 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1890
1891 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1892 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1893 the tutorial.
1894
1895 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1896 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1897 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1898 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1899 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1900 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1901 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1902
1903 @smallexample
1904 @group
1905 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1906 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1907 . 1: 30 1: 30
1908 . .
1909
1910 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1911 @end group
1912 @end smallexample
1913
1914 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1915 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1916 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1917 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1918 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1919
1920 @smallexample
1921 @group
1922 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1923 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1924 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1925 . . 1: 20
1926 .
1927
1928 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1929 @end group
1930 @end smallexample
1931
1932 @cindex Clearing the stack
1933 @cindex Emptying the stack
1934 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1935 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1936 entire stack.)
1937
1938 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1939 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1940
1941 @noindent
1942 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1943 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1944 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1945 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1946
1947 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1948 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1949 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1950 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1951 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1952 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1953 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1954
1955 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1956 The result should be the number 9.
1957
1958 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1959 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1960 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1961 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1962 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1963
1964 @example
1965 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1966 @end example
1967
1968 @noindent
1969 is equivalent to
1970
1971 @example
1972 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1973 @end example
1974
1975 @noindent
1976 or, in large mathematical notation,
1977
1978 @ifinfo
1979 @example
1980 @group
1981 3 * 4 * 5
1982 2 + --------- - 9
1983 8
1984 6 * 7
1985 @end group
1986 @end example
1987 @end ifinfo
1988 @tex
1989 \turnoffactive
1990 \beforedisplay
1991 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1992 \afterdisplay
1993 @end tex
1994
1995 @noindent
1996 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1997
1998 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1999 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
2000 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
2001 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
2002
2003 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
2004 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
2005 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
2006 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
2007
2008 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
2009 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
2010 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
2011 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
2012 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
2013
2014 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
2015
2016 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
2017 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
2018 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
2019 an algebraic entry.
2020
2021 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
2022 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
2023 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
2024 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
2025 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
2026
2027 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
2028 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
2029
2030 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
2031 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
2032 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
2033 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
2034 rule to use!
2035
2036 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
2037 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
2038 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
2039
2040 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
2041
2042 @smallexample
2043 @group
2044 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
2045 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
2046 . .
2047
2048 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
2049 @end group
2050 @end smallexample
2051
2052 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
2053 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
2054 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
2055
2056 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
2057 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
2058 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
2059 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
2060 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
2061 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
2062 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
2063
2064 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
2065
2066 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
2067 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
2068 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
2069 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
2070 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
2071 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
2072 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
2073 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
2074 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
2075 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
2076 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
2077 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
2078 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
2079
2080 @smallexample
2081 @group
2082 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
2083 . . .
2084
2085 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
2086 @end group
2087 @end smallexample
2088
2089 @noindent
2090 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
2091 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
2092
2093 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
2094 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
2095 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
2096 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2097
2098 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
2099 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
2100
2101 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
2102 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
2103 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
2104 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
2105 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
2106 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
2107 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
2108
2109 @smallexample
2110 @group
2111 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
2112 . . .
2113
2114 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
2115 @end group
2116 @end smallexample
2117
2118 @noindent
2119 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
2120 variables by the values that were stored in them.
2121
2122 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
2123 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
2124 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
2125
2126 @smallexample
2127 @group
2128 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
2129 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
2130 . 1: 2 .
2131 .
2132
2133 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
2134 @end group
2135 @end smallexample
2136
2137 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
2138 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
2139 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
2140 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
2141 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
2142 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
2143
2144 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
2145 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
2146
2147 @smallexample
2148 @group
2149 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 34 + 2 b
2150 . .
2151
2152 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
2153 @end group
2154 @end smallexample
2155
2156 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
2157 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
2158
2159 @smallexample
2160 @group
2161 1: 2 + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3)
2162 .
2163
2164 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
2165 @end group
2166 @end smallexample
2167
2168 @noindent
2169 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
2170 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
2171 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
2172 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
2173 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
2174 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
2175 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
2176 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
2177 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
2178 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
2179 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
2180 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
2181 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2182 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2183
2184 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2185 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2186 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2187 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2188 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2189
2190 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2191 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2192 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2193
2194 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2195 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2196 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2197 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2198 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2199 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2200 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2201 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2202
2203 @smallexample
2204 @group
2205 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2206 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2207 . .
2208
2209 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2210 @end group
2211 @end smallexample
2212
2213 @noindent
2214 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2215 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2216 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2217 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2218 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2219
2220 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2221
2222 @smallexample
2223 @group
2224 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2225 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2226 .
2227
2228 s u a @key{RET}
2229 @end group
2230 @end smallexample
2231
2232 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2233 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2234
2235 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2236 @subsection Undo and Redo
2237
2238 @noindent
2239 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2240 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2241 and restart Calc (@kbd{M-# M-# M-# M-#}) to make sure things start off
2242 with a clean slate. Now:
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 @group
2246 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2247 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2248 . .
2249
2250 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2251 @end group
2252 @end smallexample
2253
2254 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2255 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2256 above example, you could type:
2257
2258 @smallexample
2259 @group
2260 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2261 . 1: 3 .
2262 .
2263 (error)
2264 U U U U
2265 @end group
2266 @end smallexample
2267
2268 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2269 mistakenly.
2270
2271 @smallexample
2272 @group
2273 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2274 . 1: 3 . .
2275 .
2276 (error)
2277 D D D D
2278 @end group
2279 @end smallexample
2280
2281 @noindent
2282 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2283 by something other than an undo command.
2284
2285 @cindex Time travel
2286 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2287 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2288 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2289 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2290 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2291 was an earlier undo command.
2292
2293 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2294 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2295 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2296 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2297
2298 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2299 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2300 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2301 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2302 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2303 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2304 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2305 stack.
2306
2307 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2308 went into the trail.
2309
2310 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2311 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2312 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2313 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2314 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2315 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2316 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2317 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2318
2319 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2320 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2321 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2322 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2323 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2324
2325 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2326 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2327 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2328 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2329 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2330 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2331 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2332 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2333 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2334 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2335 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2336
2337 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2338
2339 @smallexample
2340 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2341 @end smallexample
2342
2343 @noindent
2344 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2345 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2346 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2347 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2348 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2349 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2350 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2351
2352 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2353 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2354 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2355 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2356 the prefix.
2357
2358 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2359 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2360 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2361 to edit a stack entry.
2362
2363 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2364 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2365 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2366 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2367 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2368 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2369 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2370 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2371
2372 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2373 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2374
2375 @noindent
2376 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2377 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2378 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2379 try some of the most common ones here.
2380
2381 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2382 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2383
2384 @smallexample
2385 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2386 @end smallexample
2387
2388 @noindent
2389 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2390 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2391 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2392 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2393 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2394 leading and trailing zeros.
2395
2396 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2397 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2398 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2399
2400 @smallexample
2401 @group
2402 1: 0.142857142857
2403 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2404 .
2405 @end group
2406 @end smallexample
2407
2408 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2409 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2410 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2411 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2412
2413 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2414 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2415
2416 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2417 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2418 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2419 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2420 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2421 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2422 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2423
2424 @smallexample
2425 @group
2426 1: 0.142857142857
2427 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2428 3: 1.14285714286
2429 .
2430 @end group
2431 @end smallexample
2432
2433 @noindent
2434 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2435 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2436
2437 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2438 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2439 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2440 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2441 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2442 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2443 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2444 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2445 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2446 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2447 arithmetic.
2448
2449 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2450 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2451 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2452
2453 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2454
2455 @smallexample
2456 @group
2457 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2458 . 1: 10000 .
2459 .
2460
2461 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2462 @end group
2463 @end smallexample
2464
2465 @noindent
2466 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2467 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2468 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2469 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2470 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2471
2472 @smallexample
2473 @group
2474 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2475 . 1: 10000. .
2476 .
2477
2478 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2479 @end group
2480 @end smallexample
2481
2482 @cindex Round-off errors
2483 @noindent
2484 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2485 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2486 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2487 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2488 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2489 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2490 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2491 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2492 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2493 out:
2494
2495 @smallexample
2496 @group
2497 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2498 . 1: 10000. .
2499 .
2500
2501 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2502 @end group
2503 @end smallexample
2504
2505 @noindent
2506 @cindex Guard digits
2507 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2508 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2509 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2510 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2511 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2512 last place.
2513
2514 @cindex Guard digits
2515 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2516 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2517 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2518 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2519 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2520 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2521 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2522
2523 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2524 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2525 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2526 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2527 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2528 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2529 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2530 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2531 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2532 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2533 numbers shown here:
2534
2535 @smallexample
2536 @group
2537 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2538 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2539 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2540 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2541 . . . . .
2542
2543 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2544 @end group
2545 @end smallexample
2546
2547 @noindent
2548 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2549 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2550 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2551 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2552 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2553 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2554
2555 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2556 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2557 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2558 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2559
2560 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2561 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2562 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2563 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2564 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2565
2566 @smallexample
2567 @group
2568 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2569 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2570 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2571 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2572 . . . . .
2573
2574 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2575 @end group
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2580 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2581 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2582 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2583 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2584 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2585 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2586
2587 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2588 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2589 displayed exactly.
2590
2591 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2592 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2593 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2594
2595 @example
2596 2417851639229258349412352
2597 @end example
2598
2599 @noindent
2600 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2601
2602 @example
2603 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2604 @end example
2605
2606 @noindent
2607 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2608 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2609 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2610
2611 @example
2612 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2613 @end example
2614
2615 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2616 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2617 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2618
2619 @example
2620 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2621 @end example
2622
2623 @noindent
2624 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2625 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2626
2627 @example
2628 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2629 @end example
2630
2631 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2632 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2633
2634 @example
2635 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2636 @end example
2637
2638 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2639 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2640 restore the default precision.
2641
2642 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2643 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2644 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2645 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2646
2647 @example
2648 16#200000000000000000000
2649 @end example
2650
2651 @noindent
2652 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2653 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2654 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2655 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2656 form:
2657
2658 @example
2659 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2660 @end example
2661
2662 @noindent
2663 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2664 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2665 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2666 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2667 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2668 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2669
2670 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2671 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2672 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2673 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2674 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2675
2676 @example
2677 2#101,1111,1110
2678 @end example
2679
2680 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2681 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2682 other radix.
2683
2684 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2685
2686 @example
2687 1,534
2688 @end example
2689
2690 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2691 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2692 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2693 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2694
2695 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2696 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2697 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2698 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2699 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2700 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2701 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2702 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2703 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2704
2705 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2706 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2707 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2708 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2709 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2710 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2711 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2712 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2713
2714 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2715 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2716 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2717 the way they are actually computed.
2718
2719 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2720 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2721 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2722 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2723
2724 @smallexample
2725 @group
2726 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2727 . . . .
2728
2729 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2730 @end group
2731 @end smallexample
2732
2733 @noindent
2734 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2735 of 45 degrees is
2736 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2737 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2738 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2739 roundoff error because the representation of
2740 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2741 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2742 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2743 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2744 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2745
2746 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2747 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2748 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2749 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2750 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2751
2752 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2753 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2754 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2755 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2756 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2757
2758 @smallexample
2759 @group
2760 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2761 . . .
2762
2763 P 4 / m r S
2764 @end group
2765 @end smallexample
2766
2767 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2768 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2769
2770 @smallexample
2771 @group
2772 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2773 . . .
2774
2775 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2776 @end group
2777 @end smallexample
2778
2779 @noindent
2780 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2781 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2782 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2783 first in radians, then in degrees.
2784
2785 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2786 and vice-versa.
2787
2788 @smallexample
2789 @group
2790 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2791 . . .
2792
2793 45 c r c d
2794 @end group
2795 @end smallexample
2796
2797 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2798 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2799 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2800 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2801 number, instead.
2802
2803 @smallexample
2804 @group
2805 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2806 1: 9 . .
2807 .
2808
2809 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2810 @end group
2811 @end smallexample
2812
2813 @noindent
2814 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2815 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2816
2817 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2818 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2819 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2820 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2821 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2822 what to do when dividing two integers.
2823
2824 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2825 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2826 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2827 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2828 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2829
2830 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2831 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2832 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2833 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2834 recompute for you.
2835
2836 @smallexample
2837 @group
2838 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2839 . . .
2840
2841 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2842 @end group
2843 @end smallexample
2844
2845 @noindent
2846 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2847 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2848 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2849 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2850 might affect their values.
2851
2852 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2853 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2854
2855 @noindent
2856 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2857 available in the Calculator.
2858
2859 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2860 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2861 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2862 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2863
2864 @smallexample
2865 @group
2866 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2867 . . . . .
2868
2869 5 & & n n
2870 @end group
2871 @end smallexample
2872
2873 @cindex Binary operators
2874 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2875 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2876 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2877 a negative prefix.
2878
2879 @smallexample
2880 @group
2881 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2882 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2883 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2884 . . 1: 10 .
2885 .
2886
2887 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2888 @end group
2889 @end smallexample
2890
2891 @cindex Unary operators
2892 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2893 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2894
2895 @smallexample
2896 @group
2897 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2898 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2899 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2900 . . .
2901
2902 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2903 @end group
2904 @end smallexample
2905
2906 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2907 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2908 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2909 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2910 integer.
2911
2912 @smallexample
2913 @group
2914 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2915 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2916 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2917 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2918 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2919 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2920 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2921 . . .
2922
2923 M-7 F U M-7 R
2924 @end group
2925 @end smallexample
2926
2927 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2928 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2929 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2930 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2931 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2932
2933 @smallexample
2934 @group
2935 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2936 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2937 . .
2938
2939 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2940 @end group
2941 @end smallexample
2942
2943 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2944
2945 @smallexample
2946 @group
2947 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2948 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2949 . .
2950
2951 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2952 @end group
2953 @end smallexample
2954
2955 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2956 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2957 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2958 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2959 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2960
2961 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2962 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2963 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2964 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2965 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2966
2967 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2968 identity
2969 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2970 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2971 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2972 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 @group
2976 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2977 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2978 . . . .
2979
2980 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2981 @end group
2982 @end smallexample
2983
2984 @noindent
2985 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2986 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2987
2988 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2989 of squares, command.
2990
2991 Another identity is
2992 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2993 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2994 @smallexample
2995 @group
2996
2997 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2998 1: 0.43837 . .
2999 .
3000
3001 U / I T
3002 @end group
3003 @end smallexample
3004
3005 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
3006 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
3007 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
3008 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
3009
3010 @smallexample
3011 @group
3012 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
3013 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
3014 . .
3015
3016 U U M-2 n / I T
3017 @end group
3018 @end smallexample
3019
3020 @noindent
3021 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
3022 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
3023 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
3024 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
3025 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
3026 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
3027 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
3028
3029 @smallexample
3030 @group
3031 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
3032 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
3033 . 1: 0.43837 .
3034 .
3035
3036 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
3037 @end group
3038 @end smallexample
3039
3040 @noindent
3041 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
3042 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
3043
3044 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
3045 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
3046 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
3047 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
3048 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
3049 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
3050 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
3051 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
3052
3053 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
3054 except that it is the @emph{difference}
3055 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
3056 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
3057 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
3058
3059 @smallexample
3060 @group
3061 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
3062 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
3063 . . . . .
3064
3065 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
3066 @end group
3067 @end smallexample
3068
3069 @noindent
3070 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
3071 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
3072 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
3073 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
3074 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
3075 error.
3076
3077 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
3078 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
3079 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
3080 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
3081
3082 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
3083 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
3084
3085 @cindex Common logarithm
3086 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
3087 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
3088 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
3089 prefix.
3090
3091 @smallexample
3092 @group
3093 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
3094 . . . .
3095
3096 1000 L U H L
3097 @end group
3098 @end smallexample
3099
3100 @noindent
3101 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
3102 and compute a common logarithm instead.
3103
3104 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
3105 value of @var{b}.
3106
3107 @smallexample
3108 @group
3109 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
3110 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
3111 . .
3112
3113 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
3114 @end group
3115 @end smallexample
3116
3117 @noindent
3118 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
3119 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
3120 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
3121 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
3122 onto the stack.
3123
3124 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
3125 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
3126 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
3127 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
3128 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
3129 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
3130 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
3131 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
3132 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
3133 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
3134
3135 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
3136 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
3137 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3138
3139 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
3140 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
3141 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
3142
3143 @smallexample
3144 @group
3145 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
3146 . . . .
3147
3148 100 ! U c f !
3149 @end group
3150 @end smallexample
3151
3152 @noindent
3153 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
3154 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
3155 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
3156 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
3157 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
3158 in this case).
3159
3160 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
3161 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
3162 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
3163 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
3164 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
3165
3166 @smallexample
3167 @group
3168 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
3169 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
3170 1: 5. 1: 120.
3171 . .
3172
3173 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
3174 @end group
3175 @end smallexample
3176
3177 @noindent
3178 Here we verify the identity
3179 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
3180 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
3181
3182 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3183 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3184 is defined by
3185 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3186 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3187 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3188 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3189 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3190 large intermediate values.
3191
3192 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3193 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3194 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3195
3196 @smallexample
3197 @group
3198 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3199 1: 20 . .
3200 .
3201
3202 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3203 @end group
3204 @end smallexample
3205
3206 @noindent
3207 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{v u} to ``unpack''
3208 this vector into 8 separate stack entries, then @kbd{M-8 *} to
3209 multiply them back together. The result is the original number,
3210 30045015.
3211
3212 @cindex Hash tables
3213 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3214 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3215 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3216
3217 @smallexample
3218 @group
3219 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3220 . . .
3221
3222 10000 k n I k n
3223 @end group
3224 @end smallexample
3225
3226 @noindent
3227 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3228 10000.
3229
3230 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3231 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3232 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3233 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3234
3235 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3236 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3237 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3238
3239 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3240 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3241
3242 @noindent
3243 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3244 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3245 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3246 a vector as a list of objects.
3247
3248 @menu
3249 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3250 * Matrix Tutorial::
3251 * List Tutorial::
3252 @end menu
3253
3254 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3255 @subsection Vector Analysis
3256
3257 @noindent
3258 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3259 elements, taken pairwise.
3260
3261 @smallexample
3262 @group
3263 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3264 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3265 .
3266
3267 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3268 @end group
3269 @end smallexample
3270
3271 @noindent
3272 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3273 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3274 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3275 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3276
3277 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3278 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3279 of the vectors.
3280
3281 @smallexample
3282 @group
3283 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3284 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3285 .
3286
3287 r 1 r 2 *
3288 @end group
3289 @end smallexample
3290
3291 @cindex Dot product
3292 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3293 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3294 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3295 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3296 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3297 vector.
3298
3299 @smallexample
3300 @group
3301 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3302 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3303 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3304 . .
3305
3306 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3307 @end group
3308 @end smallexample
3309
3310 @noindent
3311 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3312 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3313 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3314 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3315 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3316 is about 56 degrees.
3317
3318 @cindex Cross product
3319 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3320 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3321 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3322 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3323 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3324 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3325 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3326
3327 @smallexample
3328 @group
3329 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3330 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3331 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3332 .
3333
3334 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3335 @end group
3336 @end smallexample
3337
3338 @noindent
3339 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3340 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3341 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3342 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3343
3344 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3345 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3346 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3347 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3348 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3349 prefix keys have this property.)
3350
3351 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3352 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3353 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3354
3355 @smallexample
3356 @group
3357 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3358 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3359 . .
3360
3361 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3362 @end group
3363 @end smallexample
3364
3365 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3366 @cindex Unit vectors
3367 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3368 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3369 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3370 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3371
3372 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3373 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3374 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3375 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3376 Find the average position of the particle.
3377 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3378
3379 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3380 @subsection Matrices
3381
3382 @noindent
3383 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3384 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3385 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3386 both methods here:
3387
3388 @smallexample
3389 @group
3390 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3391 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3392 . .
3393
3394 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3395 @end group
3396 @end smallexample
3397
3398 @noindent
3399 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3400
3401 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3402 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3403 the second example.
3404
3405 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3406 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3407 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3408 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3409 of the right matrix.
3410
3411 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3412 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3413
3414 @smallexample
3415 @group
3416 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3417 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3418 .
3419
3420 @key{RET} *
3421 @end group
3422 @end smallexample
3423
3424 @noindent
3425 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3426 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3427 been left in symbolic form.
3428
3429 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3430
3431 @smallexample
3432 @group
3433 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3434 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3435 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3436 [ 2, 5 ] .
3437 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3438 .
3439
3440 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3441 @end group
3442 @end smallexample
3443
3444 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3445 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3446 matrix, as happened here!
3447
3448 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3449 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3450 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3451 as a row or column as appropriate.
3452
3453 @smallexample
3454 @group
3455 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3456 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3457 1: [1, 2, 3]
3458 .
3459
3460 r 4 r 1 *
3461 @end group
3462 @end smallexample
3463
3464 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3465 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3466 vector.
3467
3468 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3469 of the above
3470 @texline @math{2\times3}
3471 @infoline 2x3
3472 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3473 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3474 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3475
3476 @cindex Identity matrix
3477 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3478 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3479 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3480 the original matrix.
3481
3482 @smallexample
3483 @group
3484 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3485 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3486 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3487 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3488 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3489 .
3490
3491 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3492 @end group
3493 @end smallexample
3494
3495 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3496 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3497 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3498 inverse of a matrix.
3499
3500 @smallexample
3501 @group
3502 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3503 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3504 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3505 . .
3506
3507 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3508 @end group
3509 @end smallexample
3510
3511 @noindent
3512 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3513 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3514 our matrix to make it square.
3515
3516 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3517
3518 @smallexample
3519 @group
3520 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3521 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3522 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3523 . .
3524
3525 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3526 @end group
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3530 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3531 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3532 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3533
3534 @ifinfo
3535 @group
3536 @example
3537 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3538 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3539 7a + 6b = 3
3540 @end example
3541 @end group
3542 @end ifinfo
3543 @tex
3544 \turnoffactive
3545 \beforedisplayh
3546 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3547 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3548 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3549 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3550 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3551 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3552 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3553 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3554 $$
3555 \afterdisplayh
3556 @end tex
3557
3558 @noindent
3559 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3560
3561 @ifinfo
3562 @group
3563 @example
3564 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3565 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3566 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3567 @end example
3568 @end group
3569 @end ifinfo
3570 @tex
3571 \turnoffactive
3572 \beforedisplay
3573 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3574 \times
3575 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3576 $$
3577 \afterdisplay
3578 @end tex
3579
3580 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3581 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3582
3583 @smallexample
3584 @group
3585 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3586 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3587 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3588 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3589 .
3590
3591 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3592 @end group
3593 @end smallexample
3594
3595 @noindent
3596 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3597 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3598 inverse.)
3599
3600 Let's verify this solution:
3601
3602 @smallexample
3603 @group
3604 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3605 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3606 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3607 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3608 .
3609
3610 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3611 @end group
3612 @end smallexample
3613
3614 @noindent
3615 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3616 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3617 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3618 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3619 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3620 vectors, use explicit
3621 @texline @math{N\times1}
3622 @infoline Nx1
3623 or
3624 @texline @math{1\times N}
3625 @infoline 1xN
3626 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3627 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3628
3629 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3630 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3631 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3632 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3633
3634 @ifinfo
3635 @group
3636 @example
3637 x + a y = 6
3638 x + b y = 10
3639 @end example
3640 @end group
3641 @end ifinfo
3642 @tex
3643 \turnoffactive
3644 \beforedisplay
3645 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3646 x &+ b y = 10}
3647 $$
3648 \afterdisplay
3649 @end tex
3650
3651 @noindent
3652 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3653
3654 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3655 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3656 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3657 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3658 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3659 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3660 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3661 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3662 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3663 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3664 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3665 @ifinfo
3666 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3667 @end ifinfo
3668 @tex
3669 \turnoffactive
3670 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3671 @end tex
3672 Now
3673 @texline @math{A^T A}
3674 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3675 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3676 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3677 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3678 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3679 system:
3680
3681 @ifinfo
3682 @group
3683 @example
3684 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3685 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3686 7a + 6b = 3
3687 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3688 @end example
3689 @end group
3690 @end ifinfo
3691 @tex
3692 \turnoffactive
3693 \beforedisplayh
3694 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3695 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3696 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3697 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3698 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3699 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3700 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3701 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3702 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3703 $$
3704 \afterdisplayh
3705 @end tex
3706
3707 @noindent
3708 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3709
3710 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3711 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3712
3713 @noindent
3714 @cindex Lists
3715 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3716 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3717 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3718 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3719 number.
3720
3721 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3722
3723 @smallexample
3724 @group
3725 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3726 2: 20 . 2: 20
3727 1: 30 1: 30
3728 . .
3729
3730 M-3 v p v u
3731 @end group
3732 @end smallexample
3733
3734 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3735 of many copies of a given value:
3736
3737 @smallexample
3738 @group
3739 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3740 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3741 . .
3742
3743 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3744 @end group
3745 @end smallexample
3746
3747 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3748 @dfn{map} command.
3749
3750 @smallexample
3751 @group
3752 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3753 . . .
3754
3755 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3756 @end group
3757 @end smallexample
3758
3759 @noindent
3760 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3761 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3762 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3763 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3764 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3765 of each element.
3766
3767 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3768 from
3769 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3770 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3771 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3772
3773 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3774 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3775 elements in the vector:
3776
3777 @smallexample
3778 @group
3779 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3780 . . .
3781
3782 123123 k f V R *
3783 @end group
3784 @end smallexample
3785
3786 @noindent
3787 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3788 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3789
3790 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3791 reduction:
3792
3793 @smallexample
3794 @group
3795 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3796 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3797 .
3798
3799 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3800 @end group
3801 @end smallexample
3802
3803 @noindent
3804 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3805 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3806 for the dot product as before.
3807
3808 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3809 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3810 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3811
3812 @smallexample
3813 @group
3814 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3815 . .
3816
3817 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3818 @end group
3819 @end smallexample
3820
3821 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3822 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3823 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3824 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3825 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3826 vector size).
3827
3828 @smallexample
3829 @group
3830 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3831 . .
3832
3833 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3834 @end group
3835 @end smallexample
3836
3837 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3838 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3839 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3840
3841 @smallexample
3842 @group
3843 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3844 . .
3845
3846 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3847 @end group
3848 @end smallexample
3849
3850 @noindent
3851 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3852 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3853 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3854 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3855 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3856 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3857 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3858
3859 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3860 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3861 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3862
3863 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3864 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3865 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3866 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3867 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3868 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3869 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3870 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3871 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3872 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3873
3874 @smallexample
3875 x y
3876 --- ---
3877 1.34 0.234
3878 1.41 0.298
3879 1.49 0.402
3880 1.56 0.412
3881 1.64 0.466
3882 1.73 0.473
3883 1.82 0.601
3884 1.91 0.519
3885 2.01 0.603
3886 2.11 0.637
3887 2.22 0.645
3888 2.33 0.705
3889 2.45 0.917
3890 2.58 1.009
3891 2.71 0.971
3892 2.85 1.062
3893 3.00 1.148
3894 3.15 1.157
3895 3.32 1.354
3896 @end smallexample
3897
3898 @noindent
3899 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3900 easiest to press @kbd{M-# i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3901 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3902 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3903
3904 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3905 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3906 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3907 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3908 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3909 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{M-# r}. This command
3910 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3911 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3912
3913 @smallexample
3914 @group
3915 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3916 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3917 @dots{}
3918 @end group
3919 @end smallexample
3920
3921 @noindent
3922 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3923 large matrix.)
3924
3925 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3926 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3927 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3928 of row vectors on the stack.
3929
3930 @smallexample
3931 @group
3932 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3933 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3934 . .
3935
3936 v t v u
3937 @end group
3938 @end smallexample
3939
3940 @noindent
3941 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3942
3943 @smallexample
3944 @group
3945 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3946 .
3947
3948 t 2 t 1
3949 @end group
3950 @end smallexample
3951
3952 @noindent
3953 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3954 stored value from the stack.)
3955
3956 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3957
3958 @ifinfo
3959 @example
3960 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3961 @end example
3962 @end ifinfo
3963 @tex
3964 \turnoffactive
3965 \beforedisplay
3966 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3967 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3968 \afterdisplay
3969 @end tex
3970
3971 @noindent
3972 where
3973 @texline @math{\sum x}
3974 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3975 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3976 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3977 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3978 this formula uses.
3979
3980 @smallexample
3981 @group
3982 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3983 . .
3984
3985 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3986
3987 @end group
3988 @end smallexample
3989 @noindent
3990 @smallexample
3991 @group
3992 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3993 . .
3994
3995 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3996 @end group
3997 @end smallexample
3998
3999 @ifinfo
4000 @noindent
4001 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
4002 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
4003 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
4004 @end ifinfo
4005 @tex
4006 \turnoffactive
4007 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
4008 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
4009 $\sum x y$.)
4010 @end tex
4011
4012 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
4013 the length of either of our lists.
4014
4015 @smallexample
4016 @group
4017 1: 19
4018 .
4019
4020 r 1 v l t 7
4021 @end group
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 @noindent
4025 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
4026
4027 Now we grind through the formula:
4028
4029 @smallexample
4030 @group
4031 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
4032 . 1: 566.70919 .
4033 .
4034
4035 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
4036
4037 @end group
4038 @end smallexample
4039 @noindent
4040 @smallexample
4041 @group
4042 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
4043 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
4044 . 1: 1733.0569 .
4045 .
4046
4047 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
4048 @end group
4049 @end smallexample
4050
4051 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
4052 be found with the simple formula,
4053
4054 @ifinfo
4055 @example
4056 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
4057 @end example
4058 @end ifinfo
4059 @tex
4060 \turnoffactive
4061 \beforedisplay
4062 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
4063 \afterdisplay
4064 \vskip10pt
4065 @end tex
4066
4067 @smallexample
4068 @group
4069 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
4070 . 1: 21.70658 . .
4071 .
4072
4073 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
4074 @end group
4075 @end smallexample
4076
4077 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
4078 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
4079 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
4080 and compare it with the original data.
4081
4082 @smallexample
4083 @group
4084 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
4085 . .
4086
4087 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
4088 @end group
4089 @end smallexample
4090
4091 @noindent
4092 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
4093 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
4094 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
4095 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
4096
4097 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
4098 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
4099
4100 @smallexample
4101 @group
4102 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
4103 . . .
4104
4105 r 2 - V M A V R X
4106 @end group
4107 @end smallexample
4108
4109 @noindent
4110 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
4111 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
4112 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
4113 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
4114 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
4115 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
4116 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
4117 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
4118 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
4119
4120 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
4121 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
4122 GNUPLOT 3.0, the following instructions will work regardless of the
4123 kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
4124 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
4125
4126 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
4127 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
4128 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
4129 plotting of data.
4130
4131 @smallexample
4132 @group
4133 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
4134 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
4135 .
4136
4137 r 1 r 2 g f
4138 @end group
4139 @end smallexample
4140
4141 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
4142 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
4143 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
4144 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
4145 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
4146 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
4147
4148 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
4149 @ifinfo
4150 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
4151 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
4152 replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
4153 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
4154 @end ifinfo
4155
4156 @smallexample
4157 @group
4158 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
4159 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
4160 .
4161
4162 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
4163 @end group
4164 @end smallexample
4165
4166 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
4167 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
4168 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
4169
4170 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
4171 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
4172 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
4173 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
4174 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
4175 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4176
4177 @cindex Geometric mean
4178 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
4179 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{M-# g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
4180 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
4181 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
4182 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
4183 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
4184
4185 @example
4186 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
4187 15 14 7.5
4188 2.5
4189 @end example
4190
4191 @noindent
4192 The @kbd{M-# g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4193 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4194 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4195
4196 @ifinfo
4197 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4198 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4199 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4200 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4201 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4202 for @expr{n=6}.
4203 @end ifinfo
4204 @tex
4205 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4206 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4207 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4208 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4209 for \cite{n=6}.
4210 @end tex
4211
4212 @smallexample
4213 @group
4214 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4215 . .
4216
4217 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4218
4219 @end group
4220 @end smallexample
4221 @noindent
4222 @smallexample
4223 @group
4224 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4225 . .
4226
4227 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4228 @end group
4229 @end smallexample
4230
4231 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4232 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4233 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4234 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4235 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4236
4237 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4238 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4239 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4240 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4241 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4242 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4243
4244 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4245 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4246 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4247 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4248 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4249 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4250 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4251 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4252 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4253 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4254 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4255 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4256 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4257 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4258 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4259
4260 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4261 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4262 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4263 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4264
4265 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4266 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4267 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4268 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4269 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4270 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4271
4272 @cindex Divisor functions
4273 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4274 @tex
4275 $\sigma_k(n)$
4276 @end tex
4277 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4278 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4279 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4280 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4281 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4282
4283 @cindex Square-free numbers
4284 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4285 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4286 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4287 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4288 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4289 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4290 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4291 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4292
4293 @cindex Triangular lists
4294 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4295 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4296 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4297
4298 @smallexample
4299 @group
4300 1: [ [1],
4301 [1, 2],
4302 [1, 2, 3],
4303 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4304 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4305 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4306 @end group
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309 @noindent
4310 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4311
4312 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4313
4314 @smallexample
4315 @group
4316 1: [ [0],
4317 [1, 2],
4318 [3, 4, 5],
4319 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4320 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4321 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4322 @end group
4323 @end smallexample
4324
4325 @noindent
4326 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4327
4328 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4329 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4330 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4331 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4332 @infoline @expr{J1}
4333 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4334 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4335 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4336 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4337 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4338 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4339 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4340
4341 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4342 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4343 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4344 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4345 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4346 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4347 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4348 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4349 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4350 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4351 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4352
4353 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4354 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4355 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4356
4357 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4358 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4359 @texline @math{2\times2}
4360 @infoline 2x2
4361 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4362 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4363 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4364 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4365 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4366 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4367 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4368 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4369 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4370 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4371
4372 @cindex Matchstick problem
4373 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4374 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4375 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4376 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4377 a line turns out to be
4378 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4379 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4380 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4381 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4382 one turns out to be
4383 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4384 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4385 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4386 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4387
4388 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4389 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4390 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4391 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4392 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4393 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4394 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4395 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4396 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4397 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4398 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4399 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4400 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4401 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4402 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4403 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4404 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4405 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4406
4407 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4408 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4409 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4410 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4411 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4412 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4413 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4414 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4415 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4416 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4417 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4418 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4419
4420 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4421 @section Types Tutorial
4422
4423 @noindent
4424 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4425 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4426
4427 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4428 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4429 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4430 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4431 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4432
4433 @smallexample
4434 @group
4435 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4436 . 1: 49 . . .
4437 .
4438
4439 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4440 @end group
4441 @end smallexample
4442
4443 @noindent
4444 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4445 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4446 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4447 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4448 fraction beginning with 49.
4449
4450 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4451 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4452
4453 @smallexample
4454 @group
4455 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4456 . .
4457
4458 c f c F
4459 @end group
4460 @end smallexample
4461
4462 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4463 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4464 same, to within the current precision.
4465
4466 @smallexample
4467 @group
4468 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4469 . . . .
4470
4471 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4472 @end group
4473 @end smallexample
4474
4475 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4476 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4477 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4478 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4479
4480 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4481
4482 @smallexample
4483 @group
4484 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4485 . . . . .
4486
4487 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4488 @end group
4489 @end smallexample
4490
4491 @noindent
4492 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4493 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4494 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4495 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4496
4497 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4498 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4499 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4500 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4501 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4502 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4503 algebraic entry.
4504
4505 @smallexample
4506 @group
4507 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4508 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4509 . . . .
4510
4511 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4512 @end group
4513 @end smallexample
4514
4515 @noindent
4516 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4517 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4518 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4519 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4520 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4521 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4522 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4523 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4524 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4525 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4526 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4527 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4528 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4529
4530 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4531 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4532 to turn on Infinite mode.
4533
4534 @smallexample
4535 @group
4536 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4537 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4538 1: 0 . . .
4539 .
4540
4541 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4542 @end group
4543 @end smallexample
4544
4545 @noindent
4546 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4547 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4548 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4549 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4550 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4551 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4552 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4553 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4554 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4555 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4556 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4557 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4558 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4559 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4560 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4561 that matter, with anything else.
4562
4563 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4564 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4565 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4566 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4567 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4568
4569 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4570 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4571 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4572 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4573
4574 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4575 seconds.
4576
4577 @smallexample
4578 @group
4579 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4580 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4581 .
4582
4583 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4584 @end group
4585 @end smallexample
4586
4587 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4588 seconds.
4589
4590 @smallexample
4591 @group
4592 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4593 . . . .
4594
4595 0.5 I T c h S
4596 @end group
4597 @end smallexample
4598
4599 @noindent
4600 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4601 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4602 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4603
4604 @cindex Beatles
4605 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4606 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4607 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4608 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4609 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4610
4611 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4612 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4613 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4614
4615 @smallexample
4616 @group
4617 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4618 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4619 .
4620
4621 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4622 @end group
4623 @end smallexample
4624
4625 @noindent
4626 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4627 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4628 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4629 date form.
4630
4631 @smallexample
4632 @group
4633 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4634 . .
4635
4636 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4637 @end group
4638 @end smallexample
4639
4640 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4641 @noindent
4642 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4643 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4644 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4645 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4646 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4647 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4648
4649 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4650 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4651
4652 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4653 between now and the year 10001 A.D.? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4654
4655 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4656 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4657 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4658 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4659 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4660 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4661 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4662 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4663
4664 @smallexample
4665 @group
4666 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4667 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4668 .
4669
4670 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4671 @end group
4672 @end smallexample
4673
4674 @noindent
4675 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4676 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4677 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4678
4679 @cindex Torus, volume of
4680 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4681 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4682 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4683 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4684 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4685 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4686 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4687 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4688
4689 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4690 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4691 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4692 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4693 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4694
4695 @smallexample
4696 @group
4697 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4698 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4699 .
4700
4701 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4702 @end group
4703 @end smallexample
4704
4705 @noindent
4706 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4707 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4708
4709 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4710 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4711 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4712 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4713 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4714 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4715 the other.
4716
4717 @smallexample
4718 @group
4719 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4720 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4721 .
4722
4723 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4724 @end group
4725 @end smallexample
4726
4727 @noindent
4728 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4729 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4730 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4731 or both endpoints.
4732
4733 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4734 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4735 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4736 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4737 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4738
4739 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4740 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4741 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4742 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4743 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4744
4745 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4746 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4747 or 24 hours.
4748
4749 @smallexample
4750 @group
4751 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4752 . . . .
4753
4754 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4755 @end group
4756 @end smallexample
4757
4758 @noindent
4759 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4760 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4761 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4762 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4763 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4764
4765 @smallexample
4766 @group
4767 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4768 . . . .
4769
4770 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4771 @end group
4772 @end smallexample
4773
4774 @noindent
4775 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4776 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4777 that arises in the second one.
4778
4779 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4780 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4781 says that
4782 @texline @w{@math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}}
4783 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4784 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4785 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4786 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4787 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4788 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4789 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4790
4791 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4792 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4793 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4794 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4795
4796 @smallexample
4797 @group
4798 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4799 . .
4800
4801 x time @key{RET} n
4802 @end group
4803 @end smallexample
4804
4805 @noindent
4806 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4807
4808 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4809 is about
4810 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4811 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4812 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4813 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4814
4815 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4816 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4817 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4818 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4819 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4820 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4821
4822 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4823 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4824 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4825 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4826 like centimeters and inches.
4827
4828 @smallexample
4829 @group
4830 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4831 . . . .
4832
4833 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4834 @end group
4835 @end smallexample
4836
4837 @noindent
4838 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4839 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4840 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4841 which in this case means meters.
4842
4843 @smallexample
4844 @group
4845 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4846 . . . .
4847
4848 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4849
4850 @end group
4851 @end smallexample
4852 @noindent
4853 @smallexample
4854 @group
4855 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4856 . . .
4857
4858 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4859 @end group
4860 @end smallexample
4861
4862 @noindent
4863 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4864 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4865 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4866 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4867 being interpreted as unit names.
4868
4869 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4870 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4871 as its standard unit of length.
4872
4873 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4874
4875 @smallexample
4876 @group
4877 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4878 . . . .
4879
4880 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4881 @end group
4882 @end smallexample
4883
4884 @noindent
4885 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4886 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4887 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4888
4889 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4890 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4891 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4892 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4893 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4894 for them.
4895
4896 @smallexample
4897 @group
4898 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -20:3 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4899 . . . .
4900
4901 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET} c f
4902 @end group
4903 @end smallexample
4904
4905 @noindent
4906 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4907 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4908 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius. Since
4909 this comes out as an exact fraction, we then convert to floating-point
4910 for easier comparison with the other result.
4911
4912 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4913 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4914 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4915 numbers are in which units:
4916
4917 @smallexample
4918 @group
4919 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4920 . . .
4921
4922 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4923 @end group
4924 @end smallexample
4925
4926 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4927 @w{@kbd{M-# c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4928 at the units table.
4929
4930 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4931 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4932
4933 @cindex Speed of light
4934 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4935 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4936 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4937 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4938 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4939
4940 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4941 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4942 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4943 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4944 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4945
4946 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4947 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4948
4949 @noindent
4950 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4951 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4952 formulas.
4953
4954 @menu
4955 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4956 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4957 @end menu
4958
4959 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4960 @subsection Basic Algebra
4961
4962 @noindent
4963 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4964 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4965 formulas as regular data objects.
4966
4967 @smallexample
4968 @group
4969 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (6 - 2 x^2) (3 x^2 + y)
4970 . . .
4971
4972 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4973 @end group
4974 @end smallexample
4975
4976 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4977 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4978 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4979
4980 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4981 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4982
4983 @smallexample
4984 @group
4985 1: 18 x^2 + 6 y - 6 x^4 - 2 x^2 y 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4986 . .
4987
4988 a x a c x @key{RET}
4989 @end group
4990 @end smallexample
4991
4992 @noindent
4993 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4994 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4995
4996 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4997 is one-half.
4998
4999 @smallexample
5000 @group
5001 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
5002 . .
5003
5004 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
5005 @end group
5006 @end smallexample
5007
5008 @noindent
5009 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
5010 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
5011 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
5012 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
5013 back to its original value, if any.
5014
5015 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
5016 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
5017 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
5018 properly.)
5019
5020 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
5021 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
5022 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
5023 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
5024 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
5025 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
5026 the function has a local maximum there.
5027
5028 @smallexample
5029 @group
5030 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
5031 . .
5032
5033 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
5034 @end group
5035 @end smallexample
5036
5037 @noindent
5038 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
5039 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
5040
5041 @smallexample
5042 @group
5043 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 x / x - 24 x^3 / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
5044 . . .
5045
5046 ' x @key{RET} / a x a s
5047
5048 @end group
5049 @end smallexample
5050 @noindent
5051 @smallexample
5052 @group
5053 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023
5054 . .
5055
5056 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
5057 @end group
5058 @end smallexample
5059
5060 @noindent
5061 Notice the use of @kbd{a s} to ``simplify'' the formula. When the
5062 default algebraic simplifications don't do enough, you can use
5063 @kbd{a s} to tell Calc to spend more time on the job.
5064
5065 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
5066
5067 @smallexample
5068 @group
5069 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
5070 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
5071 . .
5072
5073 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
5074 @end group
5075 @end smallexample
5076
5077 @noindent
5078 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
5079 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
5080 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
5081 to delete the @samp{x}.)
5082
5083 @smallexample
5084 @group
5085 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
5086 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
5087 . .
5088
5089 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
5090 @end group
5091 @end smallexample
5092
5093 @noindent
5094 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
5095 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
5096 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
5097
5098 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
5099 @expr{34 - 24 x^2 = 0} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
5100 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
5101 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
5102 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
5103 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
5104 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
5105
5106 @smallexample
5107 @group
5108 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
5109 . . .
5110
5111 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
5112 @end group
5113 @end smallexample
5114
5115 @noindent
5116 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
5117 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
5118 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
5119 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
5120 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
5121
5122 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
5123 into the original formula.
5124
5125 @smallexample
5126 @group
5127 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
5128 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
5129 .
5130
5131 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
5132 @end group
5133 @end smallexample
5134
5135 @noindent
5136 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
5137 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
5138 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
5139
5140 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
5141 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
5142
5143 @smallexample
5144 @group
5145 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
5146 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
5147 .
5148
5149 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
5150 @end group
5151 @end smallexample
5152
5153 @noindent
5154 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
5155 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
5156 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
5157 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
5158 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
5159 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
5160 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
5161 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
5162 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
5163 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
5164
5165 If there had been several different values, we could have used
5166 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
5167
5168 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
5169 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
5170 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
5171 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
5172 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
5173 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
5174 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
5175 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
5176
5177 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
5178 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
5179 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
5180 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
5181 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
5182 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5183
5184 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
5185 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
5186 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
5187 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
5188
5189 @smallexample
5190 @group
5191 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
5192 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
5193 . .
5194
5195 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5196 @end group
5197 @end smallexample
5198
5199 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5200
5201 @smallexample
5202 @group
5203 3
5204 2: 34 x - 24 x
5205
5206 ____ ____
5207 V 51 V 51
5208 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5209 6 -6
5210
5211 .
5212
5213 d B
5214 @end group
5215 @end smallexample
5216
5217 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5218 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5219 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, and @TeX{} mode.
5220
5221 @smallexample
5222 @group
5223 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5224 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5225 . .
5226
5227 d C d F
5228
5229 @end group
5230 @end smallexample
5231 @noindent
5232 @smallexample
5233 @group
5234 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5235 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5236 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5237 .
5238
5239 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5240 @end group
5241 @end smallexample
5242
5243 @noindent
5244 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5245 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5246 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5247 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5248
5249 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5250 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5251 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5252 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5253 correct.
5254
5255 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5256 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5257 are shown in normal mode.)
5258
5259 @cindex Area under a curve
5260 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5261 This is simply the integral of the function:
5262
5263 @smallexample
5264 @group
5265 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5266 . .
5267
5268 r 1 a i x
5269 @end group
5270 @end smallexample
5271
5272 @noindent
5273 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5274 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5275
5276 @smallexample
5277 @group
5278 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5279 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5280
5281 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5282 @end group
5283 @end smallexample
5284
5285 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5286 of
5287 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5288 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5289 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5290 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5291 3}. (@bullet{})
5292
5293 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5294 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5295 under the curve
5296 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5297 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5298 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5299 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5300 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5301 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5302
5303 @cindex Integration, numerical
5304 @cindex Numerical integration
5305 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5306 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5307 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5308 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5309
5310 @smallexample
5311 @group
5312 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5313 2: 1 .
5314 1: 0.1
5315 .
5316
5317 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5318 @end group
5319 @end smallexample
5320
5321 @noindent
5322 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5323 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5324
5325 @smallexample
5326 @group
5327 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5328 1: sin(x) ln(x) .
5329 .
5330
5331 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5332
5333 @end group
5334 @end smallexample
5335 @noindent
5336 @smallexample
5337 @group
5338 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5339 . .
5340
5341 V R + 0.1 *
5342 @end group
5343 @end smallexample
5344
5345 @noindent
5346 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5347 to Radians mode?)
5348
5349 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5350 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5351 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5352 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5353 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5354 is the same for every box.)
5355
5356 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5357 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5358
5359 @smallexample
5360 @group
5361 1: sin(x) ln(x) 1: 0.84147 x - 0.84147 + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5362 . .
5363
5364 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5365 @end group
5366 @end smallexample
5367
5368 @noindent
5369 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5370 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5371 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5372
5373 @smallexample
5374 @group
5375 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5376 . . .
5377
5378 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5379 @end group
5380 @end smallexample
5381
5382 @noindent
5383 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5384 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5385 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5386 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5387 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5388 of @expr{x=1}.)
5389
5390 @cindex Simpson's rule
5391 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5392 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5393 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5394 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5395 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5396 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5397 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5398 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5399 down to the formula,
5400
5401 @ifinfo
5402 @example
5403 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5404 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5405 @end example
5406 @end ifinfo
5407 @tex
5408 \turnoffactive
5409 \beforedisplay
5410 $$ \displaylines{
5411 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5412 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5413 } $$
5414 \afterdisplay
5415 @end tex
5416
5417 @noindent
5418 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5419 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5420 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5421 method:
5422
5423 @ifinfo
5424 @example
5425 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5426 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5427 @end example
5428 @end ifinfo
5429 @tex
5430 \turnoffactive
5431 \beforedisplay
5432 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5433 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5434 \afterdisplay
5435 @end tex
5436
5437 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5438 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5439 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5440 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5441 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5442
5443 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5444 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5445 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5446 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5447
5448 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5449 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5450 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5451 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5452 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5453 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5454 details and examples.
5455
5456 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5457 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5458
5459 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5460 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5461
5462 @noindent
5463 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5464 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5465 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5466 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5467
5468 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5469
5470 @smallexample
5471 @group
5472 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x)
5473 .
5474
5475 ' 1/cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) @key{RET} s 1
5476 @end group
5477 @end smallexample
5478
5479 @noindent
5480 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably replace the
5481 @samp{tan} with a @samp{sin/cos} first, then combine over a common
5482 denominator. There is no Calc command to do the former; the @kbd{a n}
5483 algebra command will do the latter but we'll do both with rewrite
5484 rules just for practice.
5485
5486 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5487
5488 @smallexample
5489 @group
5490 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x)
5491 .
5492
5493 a r tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a) @key{RET}
5494 @end group
5495 @end smallexample
5496
5497 @noindent
5498 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5499 by itself the formula @samp{tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a)} doesn't do anything,
5500 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5501 it as a rewrite rule.)
5502
5503 The lefthand side, @samp{tan(a)}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5504 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5505 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5506 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5507 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5508 the actual variable @samp{x}.
5509
5510 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5511 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5512 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5513 @samp{sin(x) / cos(x)}. Calc's normal algebraic simplifications then
5514 mix this in with the rest of the original formula.
5515
5516 To merge over a common denominator, we can use another simple rule:
5517
5518 @smallexample
5519 @group
5520 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5521 .
5522
5523 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5524 @end group
5525 @end smallexample
5526
5527 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5528 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5529 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5530 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5531 denominators.
5532
5533 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5534 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5535 the subformula @samp{cos(x)}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5536 @samp{x}.
5537
5538 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5539 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5540 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5541 @samp{a = 1}, @samp{b = -sin(x)^2}, and @samp{x = cos(x)}.
5542
5543 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5544 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5545 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5546 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5547 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5548 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5549
5550 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5551 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}, but of course we must first rearrange
5552 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5553 would be @samp{@w{1 - sin(x)^2} := cos(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5554 that the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2} will also work. The
5555 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5556 situations, too.
5557
5558 @smallexample
5559 @group
5560 1: (1 + cos(x)^2 - 1) / cos(x) 1: cos(x)
5561 . .
5562
5563 a r sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} a s
5564 @end group
5565 @end smallexample
5566
5567 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5568 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5569 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5570 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5571 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5572 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5573 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5574 having to retype it.
5575
5576 @smallexample
5577 @group
5578 ' tan(x) := sin(x)/cos(x) @key{RET} s t tsc @key{RET}
5579 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5580 ' sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} s t sinsqr @key{RET}
5581
5582 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5583 . .
5584
5585 r 1 a r tsc @key{RET} a r merge @key{RET} a r sinsqr @key{RET} a s
5586 @end group
5587 @end smallexample
5588
5589 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5590 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5591 the edited value back into the variable.
5592 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5593
5594 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5595 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5596 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5597 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5598 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5599 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5600 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5601 entering them on the fly.
5602
5603 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5604 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5605 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying both
5606 sides by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5607 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5608 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5609
5610 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5611 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5612
5613 @smallexample
5614 @group
5615 1: [tsc, merge, sinsqr] 1: [tan(x) := sin(x) / cos(x), ... ]
5616 . .
5617
5618 ' [tsc,merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5619
5620 @end group
5621 @end smallexample
5622 @noindent
5623 @smallexample
5624 @group
5625 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5626 . .
5627
5628 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET} a s
5629 @end group
5630 @end smallexample
5631
5632 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5633 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5634 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5635 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5636 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5637 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5638
5639 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5640 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5641 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5642 only one rewrite at a time.
5643
5644 @smallexample
5645 @group
5646 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x) 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5647 . .
5648
5649 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5650 @end group
5651 @end smallexample
5652
5653 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5654 of rewrites that occur.
5655
5656 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5657 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5658
5659 @smallexample
5660 @group
5661 1: exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i)
5662 .
5663
5664 ' exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i) @key{RET}
5665
5666 @end group
5667 @end smallexample
5668 @noindent
5669 @smallexample
5670 @group
5671 1: 1 + exp(3 pi i) + 1
5672 .
5673
5674 a r exp(k pi i) := 1 :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5675 @end group
5676 @end smallexample
5677
5678 @noindent
5679 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5680 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5681
5682 An interesting point is that the variables @samp{pi} and @samp{i}
5683 were matched literally rather than acting as meta-variables.
5684 This is because they are special-constant variables. The special
5685 constants @samp{e}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5686 A common error with rewrite
5687 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5688 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5689 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5690
5691 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5692 @ignore
5693 @starindex
5694 @end ignore
5695 @tindex fib
5696 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5697 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5698 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5699 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5700 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5701
5702 @smallexample
5703 @group
5704 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5705
5706 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5707 . .
5708
5709 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5710 @end group
5711 @end smallexample
5712
5713 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5714 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5715 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5716 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5717 be used preferentially.
5718
5719 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5720 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5721 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5722 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5723 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5724 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5725 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5726
5727 @smallexample
5728 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5729 @end smallexample
5730
5731 @noindent
5732 Now:
5733
5734 @smallexample
5735 @group
5736 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: 8 + fib(x) + fib(0)
5737 . .
5738
5739 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5740 @end group
5741 @end smallexample
5742
5743 @noindent
5744 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5745 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5746 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5747 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5748 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5749
5750 @smallexample
5751 @group
5752 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5753 . .
5754
5755 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5756 @end group
5757 @end smallexample
5758
5759 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5760 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5761 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5762
5763 @smallexample
5764 @group
5765 fib(6) =
5766 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5767 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5768 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5769 @end group
5770 @end smallexample
5771
5772 @noindent
5773 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5774 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5775 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5776 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5777 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5778 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5779
5780 @smallexample
5781 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5782 @end smallexample
5783
5784 @noindent
5785 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5786 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5787 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5788 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5789 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5790 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5791
5792 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5793 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5794
5795 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5796 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5797 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5798 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5799 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5800
5801 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5802 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5803 un-store the variable.
5804
5805 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5806 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5807 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5808 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5809 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5810 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5811 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5812 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5813 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5814
5815 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5816 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5817 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5818 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5819
5820 @example
5821 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5822 @end example
5823
5824 @noindent
5825 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5826 to 1.''
5827
5828 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5829 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5830 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5831 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5832 and one for @samp{b}.
5833
5834 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5835 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5836 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5837 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5838
5839 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5840 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5841 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5842 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5843 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5844 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5845 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5846 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5847 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5848 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5849 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5850 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5851 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5852 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5853
5854 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5855 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5856 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5857 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5858 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5859 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5860
5861 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5862 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5863 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5864
5865 @ifinfo
5866 @example
5867 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5868 @end example
5869 @end ifinfo
5870 @tex
5871 \turnoffactive
5872 \beforedisplay
5873 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5874 \afterdisplay
5875 @end tex
5876
5877 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5878 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5879 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5880 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5881 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5882
5883 @ifinfo
5884 @example
5885 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5886 @end example
5887 @end ifinfo
5888 @tex
5889 \turnoffactive
5890 \beforedisplay
5891 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5892 \afterdisplay
5893 @end tex
5894
5895 @noindent
5896 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5897 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5898
5899 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5900 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5901 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5902 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5903 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5904 rearranged or if @kbd{a s} needs to be typed after rewriting. (This one
5905 is rather tricky; the solution at the end of this chapter uses 6 rewrite
5906 rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)} condition tests whether @samp{x} is
5907 a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5908
5909 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5910 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5911 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5912
5913 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5914
5915 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5916 @section Programming Tutorial
5917
5918 @noindent
5919 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5920 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5921 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5922 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5923 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5924 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5925
5926 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5927 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5928 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5929 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5930 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5931
5932 @smallexample
5933 @group
5934 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6
5935 . .
5936
5937 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5938 @end group
5939 @end smallexample
5940
5941 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5942 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5943 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5944 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5945 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5946 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5947 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5948 arguments?''
5949
5950 @smallexample
5951 @group
5952 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5953 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5954 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5955 .
5956
5957 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5958 @end group
5959 @end smallexample
5960
5961 @noindent
5962 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5963 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5964 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5965 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5966 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5967 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5968 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5969
5970 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5971 @ignore
5972 @starindex
5973 @end ignore
5974 @tindex Si
5975 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5976 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5977 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5978 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5979 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5980 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5981 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5982 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5983 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5984 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5985 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5986 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5987 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5988 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5989 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5990 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5991
5992 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5993 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5994 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5995 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5996 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5997
5998 @smallexample
5999 @group
6000 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
6001 . .
6002
6003 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
6004
6005 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 pi n1
6006 . .
6007
6008 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
6009 @end group
6010 @end smallexample
6011
6012 @noindent
6013 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
6014 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
6015 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
6016 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
6017 re-execute the same keystrokes.
6018
6019 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
6020
6021 @smallexample
6022 @group
6023 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
6024 . .
6025
6026 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
6027 @end group
6028 @end smallexample
6029
6030 @noindent
6031 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
6032 @kbd{z} to call it up.
6033
6034 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
6035
6036 @smallexample
6037 @group
6038 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
6039 . . . .
6040
6041 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
6042 @end group
6043 @end smallexample
6044
6045 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
6046 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
6047 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
6048
6049 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
6050 the following functions:
6051
6052 @enumerate
6053 @item
6054 Compute
6055 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
6056 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
6057 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
6058
6059 @item
6060 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
6061 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
6062
6063 @item
6064 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
6065 the stack.
6066 @end enumerate
6067 @noindent
6068 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
6069
6070 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
6071 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
6072 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
6073
6074 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
6075 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
6076 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
6077
6078 @smallexample
6079 @group
6080 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
6081 . 1: 4 .
6082 .
6083
6084 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
6085 @end group
6086 @end smallexample
6087
6088 @noindent
6089 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
6090 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
6091 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
6092 executes the body of the loop that many times.
6093
6094 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
6095 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
6096
6097 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
6098 Here's another example:
6099
6100 @smallexample
6101 @group
6102 3: 1 2: 10946
6103 2: 1 1: 17711
6104 1: 20 .
6105 .
6106
6107 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
6108 @end group
6109 @end smallexample
6110
6111 @noindent
6112 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
6113 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
6114 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
6115 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
6116
6117 @cindex Golden ratio
6118 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
6119 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
6120 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
6121 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
6122 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
6123 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
6124 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
6125 @infoline @expr{phi},
6126 the ``golden ratio,'' is
6127 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
6128 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
6129 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
6130 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
6131
6132 @smallexample
6133 @group
6134 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
6135 . . . .
6136
6137 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
6138 @end group
6139 @end smallexample
6140
6141 @cindex Continued fractions
6142 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
6143 representation of
6144 @texline @math{\phi}
6145 @infoline @expr{phi}
6146 is
6147 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
6148 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
6149 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
6150 and then replacing the innermost
6151 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
6152 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
6153 by 1. Approximate
6154 @texline @math{\phi}
6155 @infoline @expr{phi}
6156 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
6157 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
6158
6159 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
6160 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
6161 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
6162 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
6163 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
6164 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
6165 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
6166
6167 @cindex Harmonic numbers
6168 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
6169 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
6170 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
6171
6172 @smallexample
6173 @group
6174 3: 0 1: 3.597739
6175 2: 1 .
6176 1: 20
6177 .
6178
6179 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
6180 @end group
6181 @end smallexample
6182
6183 @noindent
6184 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
6185 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
6186 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
6187 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
6188 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
6189 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
6190 uses a step of one.
6191
6192 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
6193 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
6194 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
6195
6196 @smallexample
6197 @group
6198 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
6199 . 1: 20 .
6200 .
6201
6202 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
6203 @end group
6204 @end smallexample
6205
6206 @noindent
6207 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
6208 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
6209
6210 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6211 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6212 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6213 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6214 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6215 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6216 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6217
6218 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6219 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6220 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6221
6222 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6223 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6224 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6225 fix, though:
6226
6227 @smallexample
6228 @group
6229 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6230 . . 2: 3.597739
6231 1: 0.6667
6232 .
6233
6234 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6235 @end group
6236 @end smallexample
6237
6238 @noindent
6239 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6240 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6241 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6242 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6243 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6244 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6245 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6246 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6247 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6248
6249 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6250 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6251 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6252 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6253 by the formula
6254 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6255 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6256 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6257 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6258 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6259 numbers are very large fractions.)
6260
6261 @smallexample
6262 @group
6263 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6264 . .
6265
6266 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6267 @end group
6268 @end smallexample
6269
6270 @noindent
6271 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6272 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6273 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6274 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6275 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6276 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6277 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6278
6279 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6280
6281 @smallexample
6282 @group
6283 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6284 2: 5:66 . . . .
6285 1: 0.0757575
6286 .
6287
6288 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6289 @end group
6290 @end smallexample
6291
6292 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6293 Bernoulli numbers.
6294
6295 @smallexample
6296 @group
6297 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6298 2: 2 .
6299 1: 30
6300 .
6301
6302 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6303 @end group
6304 @end smallexample
6305
6306 @noindent
6307 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6308 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6309 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6310 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6311 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6312 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6313 sequence of keystrokes.)
6314
6315 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6316 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6317 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6318 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6319 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6320
6321 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6322 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6323 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6324 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6325
6326 @smallexample
6327 @group
6328 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6329 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6330
6331 1 ;; calc digits
6332 RET ;; calc-enter
6333 2 ;; calc digits
6334 + ;; calc-plus
6335
6336 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6337 @end group
6338 @end smallexample
6339
6340 @noindent
6341 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6342 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6343 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6344 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6345 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6346 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6347 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6348 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6349 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6350 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6351
6352 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6353 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6354 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6355 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6356 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6357
6358 @smallexample
6359 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6360 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6361 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6362 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6363 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6364 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6365 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6366 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6367 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6368 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6369 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6370 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6371 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6372 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6373 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6374 @end smallexample
6375
6376 @noindent
6377 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6378
6379 @smallexample
6380 @group
6381 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6382 . .
6383
6384 20 z h
6385 @end group
6386 @end smallexample
6387
6388 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6389 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6390 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6391 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6392 command on the @kbd{M-# m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6393 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6394 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{M-# m} at the other.
6395
6396 @example
6397 @group
6398 Z ` 0 t 1
6399 1 TAB
6400 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6401 r 1
6402 Z '
6403 @end group
6404 @end example
6405
6406 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6407 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6408 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6409 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6410 this formula over and over:
6411
6412 @ifinfo
6413 @example
6414 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6415 @end example
6416 @end ifinfo
6417 @tex
6418 \beforedisplay
6419 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f'(x)} $$
6420 \afterdisplay
6421 @end tex
6422
6423 @noindent
6424 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6425 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6426 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6427 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6428 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6429 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6430 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6431 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6432 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6433 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6434 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6435 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6436 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6437 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6438
6439 @cindex Digamma function
6440 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6441 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6442 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6443 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6444 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6445 is defined as the derivative of
6446 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6447 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6448 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6449
6450 @ifinfo
6451 @example
6452 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6453 @end example
6454 @end ifinfo
6455 @tex
6456 \beforedisplay
6457 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6458 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6459 $$
6460 \afterdisplay
6461 @end tex
6462
6463 @noindent
6464 where
6465 @texline @math{\sum}
6466 @infoline @expr{sum}
6467 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6468 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6469 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6470 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6471 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6472 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6473 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6474 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6475 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6476 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6477 Fortunately, we can compute
6478 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6479 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6480 from
6481 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6482 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6483 using the recurrence
6484 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6485 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6486 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6487 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6488 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6489 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6490 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6491 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6492 to compute
6493 @texline @math{\gamma}
6494 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6495 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6496 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6497 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6498
6499 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6500 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6501 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6502 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6503 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6504 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6505 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6506 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6507 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6508
6509 @cindex Recursion
6510 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6511 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6512
6513 @ifinfo
6514 @example
6515 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6516 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6517 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6518 @end example
6519 @end ifinfo
6520 @tex
6521 \turnoffactive
6522 \beforedisplay
6523 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6524 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6525 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6526 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6527 $$
6528 \afterdisplay
6529 \vskip5pt
6530 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6531 @end tex
6532
6533 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6534 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6535 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6536 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6537 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6538 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6539 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6540 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6541 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6542 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6543 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6544 or @kbd{M-# m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6545 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6546 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6547 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6548 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6549 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6550 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6551
6552 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6553 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6554 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6555 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6556 program can:
6557
6558 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6559 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6560 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6561 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6562
6563 @example
6564
6565 @end example
6566 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6567 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6568 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6569 @c [not-split]
6570 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6571 @c [when-split]
6572 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6573
6574 @page
6575 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6576 @section Answers to Exercises
6577
6578 @noindent
6579 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6580
6581 @menu
6582 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6583 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6584 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6585 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6586 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6587 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6588 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6589 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6590 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6591 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6592 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6593 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6594 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6595 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6596 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6597 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6598 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6599 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6600 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6601 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6602 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6603 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6604 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6605 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6606 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6607 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6608 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6609 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6610 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6611 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6612 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6613 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6614 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6615 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6616 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6617 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6618 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6619 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6620 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6621 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6622 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6623 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6624 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6625 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6626 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6627 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6628 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6629 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6630 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6631 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6632 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6633 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6634 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6635 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6636 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6637 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6638 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6639 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6640 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6641 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6642 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6643 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6644 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6645 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6646 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6647 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6648 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6649 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6650 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6651 @end menu
6652
6653 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6654 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6655 @tex
6656 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6657 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6658 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6659 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6660 @end tex
6661
6662 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6663 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6664
6665 @noindent
6666 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6667
6668 The result is
6669 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6670 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6671
6672 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6673 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6674
6675 @noindent
6676 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6677 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6678
6679 After computing the intermediate term
6680 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6681 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6682 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6683 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6684 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6685
6686 @smallexample
6687 @group
6688 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6689 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6690 . 1: 9.5 .
6691 .
6692
6693 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6694
6695 @end group
6696 @end smallexample
6697 @noindent
6698 @smallexample
6699 @group
6700 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6701 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6702 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6703 1: 4 .
6704 .
6705
6706 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6707 @end group
6708 @end smallexample
6709
6710 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6711 with the third term.
6712
6713 @smallexample
6714 @group
6715 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6716 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6717 . 1: 4 .
6718 .
6719
6720 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6721 @end group
6722 @end smallexample
6723
6724 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6725 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6726 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6727 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6728
6729 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6730 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6731
6732 @noindent
6733 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6734
6735 @smallexample
6736 @group
6737 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6738 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6739 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6740 . . 1: 1 . .
6741 .
6742
6743 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6744 @end group
6745 @end smallexample
6746
6747 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6748
6749 @smallexample
6750 @group
6751 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6752 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6753 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6754 . . . . .
6755
6756 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6757 @end group
6758 @end smallexample
6759
6760 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6761 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6762
6763 @noindent
6764 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6765 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6766
6767 @smallexample
6768 @group
6769 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6770 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6771 . . .
6772
6773 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6774 @end group
6775 @end smallexample
6776
6777 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6778 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6779 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6780 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6781 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6782
6783 @smallexample
6784 @group
6785 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6786 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6787 . . .
6788
6789 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6790 @end group
6791 @end smallexample
6792
6793 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6794 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6795 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6796 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6797
6798 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6799 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6800
6801 @noindent
6802 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6803
6804 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6805 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6806
6807 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6808 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6809 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6810
6811 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6812 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6813
6814 @noindent
6815 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6816 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6817 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6818 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6819
6820 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6821 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6822
6823 @noindent
6824 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6825 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6826 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6827 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6828 times anything is zero.''
6829
6830 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6831 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6832 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6833 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6834 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6835 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6836
6837 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6838 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6839
6840 @noindent
6841 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6842 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6843 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6844 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6845 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6846 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6847
6848 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6849 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6850 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6851 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6852 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6853 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6854 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6855 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6856 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6857 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6858 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6859
6860 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6861 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6862 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6863 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6864 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6865 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6866 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6867 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6868 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6869 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6870
6871 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6872 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6873 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6874 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6875 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6876 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6877 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6878 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6879 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6880 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6881
6882 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6883 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6884 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6885 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6886 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6887 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6888 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6889 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6890 in decimal display mode.
6891
6892 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6893 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6894 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6895 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6896
6897 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6898 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6899
6900 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6901 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6902 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6903 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6904 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6905 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6906 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6907 way to enter this number.
6908
6909 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6910 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6911 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6912 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6913 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6914 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6915 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6916
6917 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6918 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6919
6920 @noindent
6921 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6922
6923 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6924 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6925 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6926 their inputs.
6927
6928 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6929 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6930 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6931 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6932 determining facts like this.
6933
6934 @smallexample
6935 @group
6936 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6937 . .
6938
6939 45 S 2 ^
6940
6941 @end group
6942 @end smallexample
6943 @noindent
6944 @smallexample
6945 @group
6946 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6947 . . .
6948
6949 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6950 @end group
6951 @end smallexample
6952
6953 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6954 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6955 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6956 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6957 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6958
6959 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6960 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6961
6962 @noindent
6963 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6964 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6965 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6966 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6967 of time.
6968
6969 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6970 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6971 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6972 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6973 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6974 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6975
6976 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6977 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6978 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6979
6980 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6981 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6982
6983 @noindent
6984 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6985 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6986 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6987 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6988 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6989 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6990 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6991 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6992
6993 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6994 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6995 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6996 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6997 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6998 format.
6999
7000 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7001 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
7002
7003 @noindent
7004 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
7005 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
7006
7007 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
7008 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
7009 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
7010 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
7011
7012 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7013 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
7014
7015 @noindent
7016 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
7017 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
7018
7019 @smallexample
7020 @group
7021 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
7022 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
7023 .
7024
7025 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
7026 @end group
7027 @end smallexample
7028
7029 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
7030 indeed have unit length.
7031
7032 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7033 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
7034
7035 @noindent
7036 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
7037 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
7038 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
7039 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
7040
7041 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7042 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
7043
7044 @noindent
7045 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
7046 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
7047
7048 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7049 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
7050
7051 @ifinfo
7052 @example
7053 @group
7054 x + a y = 6
7055 x + b y = 10
7056 @end group
7057 @end example
7058 @end ifinfo
7059 @tex
7060 \turnoffactive
7061 \beforedisplay
7062 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
7063 x &+ b y = 10}
7064 $$
7065 \afterdisplay
7066 @end tex
7067
7068 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
7069 matrix as usual.
7070
7071 @smallexample
7072 @group
7073 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [6 - 4 a / (b - a), 4 / (b - a) ]
7074 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
7075 [ 1, b ] ]
7076 .
7077
7078 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
7079 @end group
7080 @end smallexample
7081
7082 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
7083 mode:
7084
7085 @smallexample
7086 @group
7087 4 a 4
7088 1: [6 - -----, -----]
7089 b - a b - a
7090 @end group
7091 @end smallexample
7092
7093 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
7094
7095 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7096 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
7097
7098 @noindent
7099 To solve
7100 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
7101 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
7102 first we compute
7103 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
7104 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
7105 and
7106 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
7107 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
7108 now, we have a system
7109 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
7110 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
7111 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
7112
7113 @ifinfo
7114 @example
7115 @group
7116 a + 2b + 3c = 6
7117 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
7118 7a + 6b = 3
7119 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
7120 @end group
7121 @end example
7122 @end ifinfo
7123 @tex
7124 \turnoffactive
7125 \beforedisplayh
7126 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
7127 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
7128 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
7129 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
7130 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
7131 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
7132 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
7133 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
7134 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
7135 $$
7136 \afterdisplayh
7137 @end tex
7138
7139 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
7140 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
7141 @texline @math{B'}
7142 @infoline @expr{B2}
7143 vector.
7144
7145 @smallexample
7146 @group
7147 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
7148 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
7149 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
7150 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
7151 . .
7152
7153 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
7154 @end group
7155 @end smallexample
7156
7157 @noindent
7158 Now we compute the matrix
7159 @texline @math{A'}
7160 @infoline @expr{A2}
7161 and divide.
7162
7163 @smallexample
7164 @group
7165 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
7166 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
7167 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
7168 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
7169 .
7170
7171 r 7 v t r 7 * /
7172 @end group
7173 @end smallexample
7174
7175 @noindent
7176 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
7177 round-off error.)
7178
7179 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
7180 @texline @math{3\times3}
7181 @infoline 3x3
7182 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
7183 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
7184 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
7185 answer since the
7186 @texline @math{4\times3}
7187 @infoline 4x3
7188 system would be equivalent to the original
7189 @texline @math{3\times3}
7190 @infoline 3x3
7191 system.)
7192
7193 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
7194 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
7195 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
7196
7197 @smallexample
7198 @group
7199 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
7200 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
7201 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
7202 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
7203 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
7204 .
7205
7206 r 7 @key{TAB} *
7207 @end group
7208 @end smallexample
7209
7210 @noindent
7211 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
7212 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
7213
7214 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7215 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7216
7217 @noindent
7218 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7219 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7220 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7221 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7222
7223 @smallexample
7224 @group
7225 2: 2 2: 2
7226 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7227 . .
7228
7229 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7230 @end group
7231 @end smallexample
7232
7233 @noindent
7234 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7235 vector.
7236
7237 @smallexample
7238 @group
7239 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7240 .
7241
7242 V M ^
7243 @end group
7244 @end smallexample
7245
7246 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7247 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7248
7249 @noindent
7250 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7251 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7252
7253 @ifinfo
7254 @example
7255 m*x + b*1 = y
7256 @end example
7257 @end ifinfo
7258 @tex
7259 \turnoffactive
7260 \beforedisplay
7261 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7262 \afterdisplay
7263 @end tex
7264
7265 Thus we want a
7266 @texline @math{19\times2}
7267 @infoline 19x2
7268 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7269 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7270 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7271
7272 @smallexample
7273 @group
7274 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7275 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7276 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7277 @dots{}
7278
7279 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7280 @end group
7281 @end smallexample
7282
7283 @noindent
7284 Now we compute
7285 @texline @math{A^T y}
7286 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7287 and
7288 @texline @math{A^T A}
7289 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7290 and divide.
7291
7292 @smallexample
7293 @group
7294 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7295 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7296 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7297 .
7298
7299 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7300 @end group
7301 @end smallexample
7302
7303 @noindent
7304 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7305
7306 @smallexample
7307 @group
7308 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7309 .
7310
7311 /
7312 @end group
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 Since we were solving equations of the form
7316 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7317 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7318 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7319 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7320 @kbd{V R}!
7321
7322 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7323 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7324 arithmetic functions!
7325
7326 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7327 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7328 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7329
7330 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7331 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7332
7333 @noindent
7334 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7335 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7336 and type @w{@kbd{M-# g}}.
7337
7338 @smallexample
7339 @group
7340 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7341 .
7342 @end group
7343 @end smallexample
7344
7345 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7346 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7347
7348 @smallexample
7349 @group
7350 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7351 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7352 . .
7353
7354 @key{RET} V R *
7355
7356 @end group
7357 @end smallexample
7358 @noindent
7359 @smallexample
7360 @group
7361 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7362 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7363 . .
7364
7365 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7366 @end group
7367 @end smallexample
7368
7369 @noindent
7370 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7371 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7372 then raise the number to that power.)
7373
7374 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7375 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7376
7377 @noindent
7378 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7379 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7380 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7381 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7382
7383 @smallexample
7384 @group
7385 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7386 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7387 . .
7388
7389 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7390 @end group
7391 @end smallexample
7392
7393 @noindent
7394 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7395
7396 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7397 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7398
7399 @smallexample
7400 @group
7401 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7402 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7403 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7404 .
7405
7406 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7407 @end group
7408 @end smallexample
7409
7410 @noindent
7411 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7412 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7413
7414 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7415 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7416
7417 @noindent
7418 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7419 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7420 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7421 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7422
7423 @smallexample
7424 @group
7425 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7426 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7427 . .
7428
7429 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7430
7431 @end group
7432 @end smallexample
7433 @noindent
7434 @smallexample
7435 @group
7436 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7437 . . .
7438
7439 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7440 @end group
7441 @end smallexample
7442
7443 @noindent
7444 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7445 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7446 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7447 the job is pretty straightforward.
7448
7449 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7450 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7451 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7452 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7453 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7454
7455 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7456 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7457
7458 @noindent
7459 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7460 to get a list of lists of integers!
7461
7462 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7463 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7464
7465 @noindent
7466 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7467 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7468
7469 @smallexample
7470 @group
7471 1: [ [0],
7472 [0, 1],
7473 [0, 1, 2],
7474 @dots{}
7475
7476 1 -
7477 @end group
7478 @end smallexample
7479
7480 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7481 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7482 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7483 can be computed directly by the formula
7484 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7485 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7486
7487 @smallexample
7488 @group
7489 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7490 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7491 . .
7492
7493 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7494 @end group
7495 @end smallexample
7496
7497 @noindent
7498 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7499 result:
7500
7501 @smallexample
7502 @group
7503 1: [ [0],
7504 [1, 2],
7505 [3, 4, 5],
7506 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7507 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7508 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7509 .
7510
7511 V M +
7512 @end group
7513 @end smallexample
7514
7515 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7516 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7517 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7518 triangular list.
7519
7520 @smallexample
7521 @group
7522 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7523 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7524 . .
7525
7526 @key{RET} V M V R +
7527 @end group
7528 @end smallexample
7529
7530 @noindent
7531 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7532 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7533 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7534
7535 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7536 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7537
7538 @noindent
7539 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7540
7541 @smallexample
7542 @group
7543 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7544 . . .
7545
7546 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7547 @end group
7548 @end smallexample
7549
7550 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7551
7552 @smallexample
7553 @group
7554 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7555 .
7556
7557 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7558 @end group
7559 @end smallexample
7560
7561 @noindent
7562 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7563
7564 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7565 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7566
7567 @smallexample
7568 @group
7569 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7570 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7571 . .
7572
7573 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7574 @end group
7575 @end smallexample
7576
7577 @noindent
7578 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7579 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7580 @texline @math{\sin x}
7581 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7582 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7583
7584 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7585 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7586 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7587
7588 @smallexample
7589 @group
7590 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7591 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7592 .
7593
7594 r 1 V M * V R +
7595 @end group
7596 @end smallexample
7597
7598 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7599 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7600 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7601 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7602 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7603 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7604
7605 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7606 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7607 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7608
7609 @smallexample
7610 @group
7611 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7612 1: [0 .. 5] .
7613 .
7614
7615 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7616 @end group
7617 @end smallexample
7618
7619 @noindent
7620 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7621 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7622 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7623
7624 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7625 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7626
7627 @noindent
7628 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7629
7630 @smallexample
7631 @group
7632 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7633 . 2: 10
7634 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7635 .
7636
7637 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7638
7639 @end group
7640 @end smallexample
7641 @noindent
7642 @smallexample
7643 @group
7644 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7645 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7646 .
7647
7648 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7649 @end group
7650 @end smallexample
7651
7652 @noindent
7653 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7654
7655 @smallexample
7656 @group
7657 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7658 .
7659
7660 10 V M % s 2
7661 @end group
7662 @end smallexample
7663
7664 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7665 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7666 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7667 the right of it are nines.
7668
7669 @smallexample
7670 @group
7671 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7672 . .
7673
7674 9 V M a = v v
7675
7676 @end group
7677 @end smallexample
7678 @noindent
7679 @smallexample
7680 @group
7681 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7682 . .
7683
7684 V U * v v 1 |
7685 @end group
7686 @end smallexample
7687
7688 @noindent
7689 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7690 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7691 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7692 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7693 rightmost digit.
7694
7695 @smallexample
7696 @group
7697 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7698 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7699 .
7700
7701 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7702 @end group
7703 @end smallexample
7704
7705 @noindent
7706 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7707 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7708 digits that generated them.
7709
7710 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7711
7712 @smallexample
7713 @group
7714 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7715 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7716 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7717 .
7718
7719 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7720
7721 @end group
7722 @end smallexample
7723 @noindent
7724 @smallexample
7725 @group
7726 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7727 . .
7728
7729 V M * V R +
7730 @end group
7731 @end smallexample
7732
7733 @noindent
7734 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7735 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7736
7737 @smallexample
7738 @group
7739 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7740 . .
7741
7742 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7743 @end group
7744 @end smallexample
7745
7746 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7747 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7748
7749 @noindent
7750 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7751 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7752 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7753 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7754
7755 Here's a more correct method:
7756
7757 @smallexample
7758 @group
7759 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7760 . 1: 7
7761 .
7762
7763 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7764
7765 @end group
7766 @end smallexample
7767 @noindent
7768 @smallexample
7769 @group
7770 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7771 . .
7772
7773 V M a = V R *
7774 @end group
7775 @end smallexample
7776
7777 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7778 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7779
7780 @noindent
7781 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7782 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7783 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7784
7785 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7786 commands.
7787
7788 @smallexample
7789 @group
7790 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7791 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7792 . .
7793
7794 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7795
7796 @end group
7797 @end smallexample
7798 @noindent
7799 @smallexample
7800 @group
7801 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7802 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7803 . .
7804
7805 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7806 @end group
7807 @end smallexample
7808
7809 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7810 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7811
7812 @smallexample
7813 @group
7814 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7815 . . .
7816
7817 + 1 V M a < V R +
7818 @end group
7819 @end smallexample
7820
7821 @noindent
7822 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7823
7824 @smallexample
7825 @group
7826 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7827 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7828
7829 100 / 4 * P /
7830 @end group
7831 @end smallexample
7832
7833 @noindent
7834 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7835 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7836 not very efficient!
7837
7838 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7839 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7840
7841 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7842 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7843
7844 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7845 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7846
7847 @noindent
7848 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7849 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7850 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7851 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7852 @texline @math{\theta},
7853 @infoline @expr{theta},
7854 and see if @expr{x} and
7855 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7856 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7857 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7858 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7859 numbers surround an integer.
7860
7861 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7862 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7863 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7864 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7865 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7866
7867 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7868 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7869 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7870 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7871 Pick random @expr{x} and
7872 @texline @math{\theta},
7873 @infoline @expr{theta},
7874 compute
7875 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7876 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7877 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7878
7879 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7880 commands.
7881
7882 @smallexample
7883 @group
7884 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7885 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7886 .
7887
7888 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7889 @end group
7890 @end smallexample
7891
7892 @noindent
7893 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7894
7895 @smallexample
7896 @group
7897 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7898 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7899 .
7900
7901 m d V M C +
7902
7903 @end group
7904 @end smallexample
7905 @noindent
7906 @smallexample
7907 @group
7908 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7909 . . .
7910
7911 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7912 @end group
7913 @end smallexample
7914
7915 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7916 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7917 a random integer.
7918
7919 @smallexample
7920 @group
7921 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7922 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7923 . .
7924
7925 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7926
7927 @end group
7928 @end smallexample
7929 @noindent
7930 @smallexample
7931 @group
7932 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7933 . . .
7934
7935 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7936
7937 @end group
7938 @end smallexample
7939 @noindent
7940 @smallexample
7941 @group
7942 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7943 . .
7944
7945 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7946 @end group
7947 @end smallexample
7948
7949 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7950 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7951
7952 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7953 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7954
7955 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7956 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7957
7958 @noindent
7959 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7960
7961 @smallexample
7962 @group
7963 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7964 .
7965
7966 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7967 @end group
7968 @end smallexample
7969
7970 @noindent
7971 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7972 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7973 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7974 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7975
7976 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7977 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7978 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7979 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7980
7981 @smallexample
7982 @group
7983 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7984 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7985 . .
7986
7987 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7988
7989 @end group
7990 @end smallexample
7991 @noindent
7992 @smallexample
7993 @group
7994 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7995 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7996 .
7997
7998 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7999 @end group
8000 @end smallexample
8001
8002 @noindent
8003 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
8004 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
8005 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
8006 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
8007 plus its second argument.
8008
8009 @smallexample
8010 @group
8011 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
8012 . .
8013
8014 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
8015 @end group
8016 @end smallexample
8017
8018 @noindent
8019 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
8020 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
8021 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
8022
8023 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
8024 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
8025 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
8026 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
8027 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
8028 the operations are faster.
8029
8030 @smallexample
8031 @group
8032 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
8033 . .
8034
8035 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
8036 @end group
8037 @end smallexample
8038
8039 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
8040 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
8041 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
8042 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
8043
8044 @ifinfo
8045 @example
8046 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
8047 @end example
8048 @end ifinfo
8049 @tex
8050 \turnoffactive
8051 \beforedisplay
8052 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
8053 \afterdisplay
8054 @end tex
8055
8056 @noindent
8057 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
8058 the distributive law yields
8059
8060 @ifinfo
8061 @example
8062 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
8063 @end example
8064 @end ifinfo
8065 @tex
8066 \turnoffactive
8067 \beforedisplay
8068 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
8069 \afterdisplay
8070 @end tex
8071
8072 @noindent
8073 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
8074 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
8075 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
8076 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
8077
8078 @ifinfo
8079 @example
8080 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
8081 @end example
8082 @end ifinfo
8083 @tex
8084 \turnoffactive
8085 \beforedisplay
8086 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n' $$
8087 \afterdisplay
8088 @end tex
8089
8090 @noindent
8091 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
8092 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
8093
8094 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
8095 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
8096 modulo some value @var{m}.
8097
8098 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8099 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
8100
8101 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
8102 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
8103 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
8104
8105 @smallexample
8106 @group
8107 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
8108 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
8109 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
8110 ...
8111
8112 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
8113 @end group
8114 @end smallexample
8115
8116 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
8117 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
8118 before nesting even begins.
8119
8120 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
8121 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
8122 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
8123
8124 @smallexample
8125 @group
8126 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
8127 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
8128 .
8129
8130 v t v u g f
8131 @end group
8132 @end smallexample
8133
8134 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
8135 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
8136 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
8137
8138 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
8139 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
8140 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
8141 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
8142
8143 @smallexample
8144 @group
8145 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
8146 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
8147 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
8148 ...
8149
8150 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
8151 @end group
8152 @end smallexample
8153
8154 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
8155
8156 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
8157 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
8158 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
8159 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
8160 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
8161 Schwartz.)
8162
8163 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8164 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
8165
8166 @noindent
8167 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
8168 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
8169
8170 @smallexample
8171 @group
8172 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
8173 . . .
8174
8175 2 ^ P / c F
8176 @end group
8177 @end smallexample
8178
8179 @noindent
8180 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
8181 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
8182 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
8183 irrational number to within 12 digits.
8184
8185 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
8186 precision slightly and try again:
8187
8188 @smallexample
8189 @group
8190 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
8191 . .
8192
8193 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
8194 @end group
8195 @end smallexample
8196
8197 @noindent
8198 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
8199 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
8200 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
8201 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
8202
8203 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
8204 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
8205 to the current precision before they begin.
8206
8207 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8208 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
8209
8210 @noindent
8211 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
8212 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
8213
8214 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
8215 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
8216 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are as just as big.
8217 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8218 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8219 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8220
8221 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8222 the input is infinite.
8223
8224 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8225 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8226 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8227 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8228 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8229
8230 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8231 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8232 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8233 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8234
8235 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8236 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8237
8238 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8239 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8240 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8241 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8242
8243 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8244 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8245
8246 @noindent
8247 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8248 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8249 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8250 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8251 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8252 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8253
8254 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8255 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8256 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8257 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8258
8259 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8260 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8261 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8262 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8263 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8264
8265 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8266 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8267
8268 @smallexample
8269 @group
8270 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8271 1: 17 .
8272 .
8273
8274 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8275 @end group
8276 @end smallexample
8277
8278 @noindent
8279 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8280
8281 @smallexample
8282 @group
8283 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8284 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8285 .
8286
8287 20" + 17 *
8288 @end group
8289 @end smallexample
8290
8291 @noindent
8292 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8293
8294 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8295 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8296
8297 @noindent
8298 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8299 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8300 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8301
8302 @smallexample
8303 @group
8304 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8305 . . .
8306
8307 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8308 @end group
8309 @end smallexample
8310
8311 @noindent
8312 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8313
8314 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8315 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8316 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8317 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8318 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8319
8320 @smallexample
8321 @group
8322 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8323 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8324 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8325 .
8326
8327 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8328 @end group
8329 @end smallexample
8330
8331 @noindent
8332 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8333
8334 @smallexample
8335 @group
8336 1: 242
8337 .
8338
8339 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8340 @end group
8341 @end smallexample
8342
8343 @noindent
8344 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8345
8346 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8347 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8348
8349 @noindent
8350 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8351 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8352 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8353 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8354 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8355 don't know the leap year rule.
8356
8357 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8358 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8359 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8360 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8361 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8362
8363 @smallexample
8364 @group
8365 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8366 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8367 .
8368
8369 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8370
8371 @end group
8372 @end smallexample
8373 @noindent
8374 @smallexample
8375 @group
8376 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8377 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8378 1: 1991 . .
8379 .
8380
8381 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8382 @end group
8383 @end smallexample
8384
8385 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8386 @noindent
8387 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8388 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8389 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8390 background information in that regard.)
8391
8392 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8393 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8394
8395 @noindent
8396 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8397 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8398
8399 @smallexample
8400 @group
8401 1: 1. 2: 1.
8402 . 1: 0.2
8403 .
8404
8405 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8406 @end group
8407 @end smallexample
8408
8409 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8410
8411 @smallexample
8412 @group
8413 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8414 . . .
8415
8416 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8417 @end group
8418 @end smallexample
8419
8420 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8421 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8422
8423 @smallexample
8424 @group
8425 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8426 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8427 1: 706.21 .
8428 .
8429
8430 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8431 @end group
8432 @end smallexample
8433
8434 @noindent
8435 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8436
8437 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8438 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8439
8440 @noindent
8441 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8442 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8443 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8444 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8445 but with no upper bound.
8446
8447 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8448
8449 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8450 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8451 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8452 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8453
8454 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8455 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8456 as a possible value.
8457
8458 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8459 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8460 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8461 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8462 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8463 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8464 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8465 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8466 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8467 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8468
8469 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8470 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8471
8472 @smallexample
8473 @group
8474 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8475 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8476 . .
8477
8478 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8479 @end group
8480 @end smallexample
8481
8482 @noindent
8483 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8484 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8485 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8486
8487 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8488 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8489 for different numbers.
8490
8491 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8492
8493 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8494 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8495
8496 @noindent
8497 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8498
8499 @smallexample
8500 @group
8501 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8502 . 811749612 .
8503 .
8504
8505 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8506 @end group
8507 @end smallexample
8508
8509 @noindent
8510 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8511 must not be prime.
8512
8513 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8514 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8515 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8516 use this method to test the second number.
8517
8518 @smallexample
8519 @group
8520 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8521 1: 15485863 .
8522 .
8523
8524 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8525 @end group
8526 @end smallexample
8527
8528 @noindent
8529 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8530 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8531
8532 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8533 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8534 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8535
8536 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8537 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8538 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8539 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8540
8541 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8542 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8543
8544 @noindent
8545 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8546 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8547 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8548
8549 @smallexample
8550 @group
8551 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8552 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8553 .
8554
8555 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8556
8557 @end group
8558 @end smallexample
8559 @noindent
8560 @smallexample
8561 @group
8562 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8563 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8564 .
8565
8566 x time @key{RET} +
8567 @end group
8568 @end smallexample
8569
8570 @noindent
8571 It will be just after six in the morning.
8572
8573 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8574 HMS form:
8575
8576 @smallexample
8577 @group
8578 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8579 . .
8580
8581 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8582 @end group
8583 @end smallexample
8584
8585 @noindent
8586 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8587 the actual number 3.14159...
8588
8589 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8590 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8591
8592 @noindent
8593 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8594 each.
8595
8596 @smallexample
8597 @group
8598 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8599 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8600 .
8601
8602 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8603
8604 @end group
8605 @end smallexample
8606 @noindent
8607 @smallexample
8608 @group
8609 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8610 .
8611
8612 17 *
8613 @end group
8614 @end smallexample
8615
8616 @noindent
8617 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8618
8619 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8620 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8621
8622 @noindent
8623 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8624
8625 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8626 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8627
8628 @noindent
8629 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8630 to the other?
8631
8632 @smallexample
8633 @group
8634 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8635 . .
8636
8637 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8638 @end group
8639 @end smallexample
8640
8641 @noindent
8642 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8643
8644 @smallexample
8645 @group
8646 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356 ns / ns 1: 0.81356
8647 2: 4.1 ns . .
8648 .
8649
8650 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} / u s
8651 @end group
8652 @end smallexample
8653
8654 @noindent
8655 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8656 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8657 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8658
8659 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8660 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8661
8662 @noindent
8663 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8664 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8665
8666 @smallexample
8667 @group
8668 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8669 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8670 .
8671
8672 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8673 @end group
8674 @end smallexample
8675
8676 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8677 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8678 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8679
8680 @smallexample
8681 @group
8682 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8683 . 1: 2 .
8684 .
8685
8686 u s 2 B
8687 @end group
8688 @end smallexample
8689
8690 @noindent
8691 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8692
8693 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8694 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8695
8696 @noindent
8697 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8698 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8699 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8700 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8701 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8702 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8703 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8704
8705 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8706 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8707
8708 @noindent
8709 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8710 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8711 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8712 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8713 familiar form.
8714
8715 @smallexample
8716 @group
8717 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8718 . .
8719
8720 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8721
8722 @end group
8723 @end smallexample
8724 @noindent
8725 @smallexample
8726 @group
8727 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: (x - 1.19023) (x + 1.19023) x
8728 . .
8729
8730 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8731
8732 @end group
8733 @end smallexample
8734 @noindent
8735 @smallexample
8736 @group
8737 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8738 . .
8739
8740 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8741 @end group
8742 @end smallexample
8743
8744 @noindent
8745 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8746 same as the original polynomial.
8747
8748 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8749 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8750
8751 @smallexample
8752 @group
8753 1: x sin(pi x) 1: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8754 . .
8755
8756 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8757
8758 @end group
8759 @end smallexample
8760 @noindent
8761 @smallexample
8762 @group
8763 1: [y, 1]
8764 2: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8765 .
8766
8767 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8768
8769 @end group
8770 @end smallexample
8771 @noindent
8772 @smallexample
8773 @group
8774 1: [(sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2, (sin(pi) - pi cos(pi)) / pi^2]
8775 .
8776
8777 V M $ @key{RET}
8778
8779 @end group
8780 @end smallexample
8781 @noindent
8782 @smallexample
8783 @group
8784 1: (sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2 + (pi cos(pi) - sin(pi)) / pi^2
8785 .
8786
8787 V R -
8788
8789 @end group
8790 @end smallexample
8791 @noindent
8792 @smallexample
8793 @group
8794 1: (sin(3.14159 y) - 3.14159 y cos(3.14159 y)) / 9.8696 - 0.3183
8795 .
8796
8797 =
8798
8799 @end group
8800 @end smallexample
8801 @noindent
8802 @smallexample
8803 @group
8804 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8805 .
8806
8807 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8808 @end group
8809 @end smallexample
8810
8811 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8812 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8813
8814 @noindent
8815 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8816 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8817 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8818 coefficients. Here's one way:
8819
8820 @smallexample
8821 @group
8822 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8823 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8824 . .
8825
8826 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8827
8828 @end group
8829 @end smallexample
8830 @noindent
8831 @smallexample
8832 @group
8833 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8834 . .
8835
8836 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8837 @end group
8838 @end smallexample
8839
8840 @noindent
8841 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8842 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8843
8844 @smallexample
8845 @group
8846 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8847 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8848 .
8849
8850 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8851
8852 @end group
8853 @end smallexample
8854 @noindent
8855 @smallexample
8856 @group
8857 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8858 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8859 .
8860
8861 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8862 @end group
8863 @end smallexample
8864
8865 @noindent
8866 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8867 same thing.
8868
8869 @smallexample
8870 @group
8871 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8872 . . .
8873
8874 * .1 * 3 /
8875 @end group
8876 @end smallexample
8877
8878 @noindent
8879 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8880
8881 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8882 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8883
8884 @noindent
8885 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8886
8887 @smallexample
8888 @group
8889 ___
8890 2 + V 2
8891 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: --------
8892 . ___
8893 1 + V 2
8894
8895 .
8896
8897 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8898 @end group
8899 @end smallexample
8900
8901 @noindent
8902 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8903
8904 @smallexample
8905 @group
8906 ___ ___
8907 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8908 .
8909
8910 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8911
8912 @end group
8913 @end smallexample
8914 @noindent
8915 @smallexample
8916 @group
8917 ___ ___
8918 1: 2 + V 2 - 2 1: V 2
8919 . .
8920
8921 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c a s
8922 @end group
8923 @end smallexample
8924
8925 @noindent
8926 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8927 second step.)
8928
8929 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8930 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8931 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8932
8933 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8934 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8935
8936 @noindent
8937 Here is the rule set:
8938
8939 @smallexample
8940 @group
8941 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8942 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8943 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8944 @end group
8945 @end smallexample
8946
8947 @noindent
8948 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8949 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8950 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8951 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8952 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8953 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8954 numbers.
8955
8956 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8957 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8958 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8959 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8960 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8961
8962 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8963 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8964 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8965 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8966 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8967 function.
8968
8969 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8970 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8971
8972 @noindent
8973 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8974 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8975 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8976 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8977 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8978 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8979 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8980
8981 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8982 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8983 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8984 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8985 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8986 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8987 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8988 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8989 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8990
8991 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8992 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8993
8994 @noindent
8995 @ignore
8996 @starindex
8997 @end ignore
8998 @tindex seq
8999 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
9000
9001 @smallexample
9002 @group
9003 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
9004 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
9005 @end group
9006 @end smallexample
9007
9008 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
9009 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
9010
9011 @example
9012 seq( 3, 1)
9013 seq(10, 2)
9014 seq( 5, 3)
9015 seq(16, 4)
9016 seq( 8, 5)
9017 seq( 4, 6)
9018 seq( 2, 7)
9019 seq( 1, 8)
9020 @end example
9021
9022 @noindent
9023 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
9024
9025 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
9026
9027 @smallexample
9028 @group
9029 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
9030 seq(1, c) := c,
9031 ... ]
9032 @end group
9033 @end smallexample
9034
9035 @noindent
9036 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
9037 as the result.
9038
9039 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
9040
9041 @smallexample
9042 @group
9043 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
9044 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
9045 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
9046 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
9047 @end group
9048 @end smallexample
9049
9050 @noindent
9051 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
9052
9053 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
9054 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
9055 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
9056 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
9057
9058 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
9059 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
9060 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
9061 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
9062 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
9063
9064 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9065 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
9066
9067 @noindent
9068 @ignore
9069 @starindex
9070 @end ignore
9071 @tindex nterms
9072 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@t{nterms(}@var{x}@t{)}' must
9073 be `@t{nterms(}@var{a}@t{)}' plus `@t{nterms(}@var{b}@t{)}'. If @expr{x}
9074 is not a sum, then `@t{nterms(}@var{x}@t{)}' = 1.
9075
9076 @smallexample
9077 @group
9078 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
9079 nterms(x) := 1 ]
9080 @end group
9081 @end smallexample
9082
9083 @noindent
9084 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
9085 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
9086 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
9087
9088 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9089 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
9090
9091 @noindent
9092 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
9093
9094 @smallexample
9095 @group
9096 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
9097 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
9098 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
9099 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
9100 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
9101 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
9102 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
9103 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
9104 @end group
9105 @end smallexample
9106
9107 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
9108 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
9109 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
9110 say, @code{O}, first.
9111
9112 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
9113 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
9114 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
9115 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
9116 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
9117
9118 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O.
9119 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
9120 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
9121 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
9122
9123 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
9124
9125 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
9126 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
9127 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
9128
9129 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
9130 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
9131 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
9132 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
9133 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
9134
9135 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
9136
9137 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
9138 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
9139 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
9140 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
9141 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
9142 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
9143 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
9144 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
9145 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
9146 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
9147 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
9148
9149 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
9150 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
9151 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
9152 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
9153 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
9154 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
9155 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
9156 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
9157 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
9158 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
9159 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
9160 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
9161 in Lisp.)
9162
9163 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9164 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
9165
9166 @noindent
9167 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
9168 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
9169 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
9170 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
9171 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
9172
9173 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
9174 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
9175
9176 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
9177 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
9178
9179 @noindent
9180 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
9181 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
9182
9183 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
9184 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
9185
9186 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
9187 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
9188 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
9189
9190 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
9191 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
9192
9193 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
9194 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
9195
9196 @noindent
9197 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
9198 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
9199
9200 @noindent
9201 Computing
9202 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
9203 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
9204
9205 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
9206
9207 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
9208
9209 @noindent
9210 Computing the logarithm:
9211
9212 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
9213
9214 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9215
9216 @noindent
9217 Computing the vector of integers:
9218
9219 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9220 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9221 from the stack.)
9222
9223 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9224 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9225 next command.)
9226
9227 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9228
9229 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9230 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9231
9232 @noindent
9233 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9234
9235 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9236 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9237
9238 @smallexample
9239 @group
9240 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9241 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9242 . .
9243
9244 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9245 @end group
9246 @end smallexample
9247
9248 @noindent
9249 This answer is quite accurate.
9250
9251 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9252 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9253
9254 @noindent
9255 Here is the matrix:
9256
9257 @example
9258 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9259 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9260 @end example
9261
9262 @noindent
9263 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9264 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9265
9266 @example
9267 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9268 @end example
9269
9270 @noindent
9271 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9272 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9273 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9274 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9275 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9276 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9277 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9278 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9279
9280 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9281 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9282
9283 @noindent
9284 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9285 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9286 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9287
9288 @smallexample
9289 @group
9290 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9291 . 1: 4
9292 .
9293
9294 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9295 @end group
9296 @end smallexample
9297
9298 @noindent
9299 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9300 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9301 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9302 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9303 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9304 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9305 loop counter exceeds 4.
9306
9307 @smallexample
9308 @group
9309 2: 31 3: 31
9310 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9311 . 1: 4.02724519544
9312 .
9313
9314 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9315 @end group
9316 @end smallexample
9317
9318 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9319 harmonic number is 4.02.
9320
9321 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9322 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9323
9324 @noindent
9325 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9326 the formula
9327 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9328 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9329
9330 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9331 below. You can use @w{@kbd{M-# m}} to load it from there. While you are
9332 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9333 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9334 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9335 just for purposes of illustration.)
9336
9337 @smallexample
9338 @group
9339 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9340 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9341 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9342 .
9343
9344 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9345
9346 @end group
9347 @end smallexample
9348 @noindent
9349 @smallexample
9350 @group
9351 2: 4.5
9352 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9353 .
9354
9355 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9356 @end group
9357 @end smallexample
9358
9359 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9360 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9361 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9362 repetitions are done.)
9363
9364 @smallexample
9365 @group
9366 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9367 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9368 1: 4.5 .
9369 .
9370
9371 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9372 @end group
9373 @end smallexample
9374
9375 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9376 old one to see if we've converged.
9377
9378 @smallexample
9379 @group
9380 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9381 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9382 1: 4.5 .
9383 .
9384
9385 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9386 @end group
9387 @end smallexample
9388
9389 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9390 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9391
9392 @smallexample
9393 @group
9394 2: 5.26345856348
9395 1: 0.499999999997
9396 .
9397
9398 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9399 @end group
9400 @end smallexample
9401
9402 Let's test the new definition again:
9403
9404 @smallexample
9405 @group
9406 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9407 1: 1 .
9408 .
9409
9410 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9411 @end group
9412 @end smallexample
9413
9414 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9415
9416 @example
9417 @group
9418 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9419 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9420 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9421 Z >
9422 Z '
9423 C-x )
9424 @end group
9425 @end example
9426
9427 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9428 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9429 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9430 to see how to use it.
9431
9432 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9433 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9434 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9435 @xref{Root Finding}.
9436
9437 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9438 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9439
9440 @noindent
9441 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9442 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9443 reduce the problem using
9444 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9445 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9446 on to compute
9447 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9448 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9449 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9450 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9451
9452 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9453 below. You can use @w{@kbd{M-# m}} to load it from there. While you are
9454 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9455 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9456 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9457 just for purposes of illustration.)
9458
9459 @smallexample
9460 @group
9461 1: 1. 1: 1.
9462 . .
9463
9464 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9465 @end group
9466 @end smallexample
9467
9468 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9469 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9470
9471 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9472 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9473 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9474 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9475
9476 @smallexample
9477 @group
9478 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9479 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9480 1: 5 .
9481 .
9482
9483 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9484 @end group
9485 @end smallexample
9486
9487 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9488 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9489 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9490 minus the adjustment factor.
9491
9492 @smallexample
9493 @group
9494 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9495 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9496 . .
9497
9498 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9499 @end group
9500 @end smallexample
9501
9502 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9503 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9504 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9505
9506 @smallexample
9507 @group
9508 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9509 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9510 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9511 . . 1: 36.
9512 .
9513
9514 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9515
9516 @end group
9517 @end smallexample
9518 @noindent
9519 @smallexample
9520 @group
9521 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9522 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9523 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9524 . .
9525
9526 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9527 @end group
9528 @end smallexample
9529
9530 This is the value of
9531 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9532 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9533 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9534 a higher precision:
9535
9536 @smallexample
9537 @group
9538 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9539 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9540
9541 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9542 @end group
9543 @end smallexample
9544
9545 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9546
9547 @example
9548 @group
9549 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9550 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9551 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9552 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9553 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9554 2 Z )
9555 Z '
9556 C-x )
9557 @end group
9558 @end example
9559
9560 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9561 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9562
9563 @noindent
9564 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9565 a term like
9566 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9567 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9568 Taking the derivative of a constant
9569 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9570 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9571 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9572
9573 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9574 below. You can use @w{@kbd{M-# m}} to load it from there. While you are
9575 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9576 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9577 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9578 just for purposes of illustration.)
9579
9580 @smallexample
9581 @group
9582 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9583 1: 6 2: 0
9584 . 1: 6
9585 .
9586
9587 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9588 @end group
9589 @end smallexample
9590
9591 @noindent
9592 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9593
9594 @smallexample
9595 @group
9596 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9597 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9598 . 1: 1 .
9599 .
9600
9601 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9602 @end group
9603 @end smallexample
9604
9605 @noindent
9606 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9607 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9608 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9609
9610 @smallexample
9611 @group
9612 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9613 . . .
9614
9615 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9616 @end group
9617 @end smallexample
9618
9619 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9620 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9621
9622 @smallexample
9623 @group
9624 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9625 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9626 . .
9627
9628 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9629
9630 @end group
9631 @end smallexample
9632 @noindent
9633 @smallexample
9634 @group
9635 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9636 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9637 .
9638
9639 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9640 @end group
9641 @end smallexample
9642
9643 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9644
9645 @example
9646 @group
9647 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9648 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9649 a d x @key{RET}
9650 1 Z ) r 1
9651 Z '
9652 C-x )
9653
9654 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9655 @end group
9656 @end example
9657
9658 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9659 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9660
9661 @noindent
9662 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9663 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9664 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9665 sure the stack comes out right.
9666
9667 @smallexample
9668 @group
9669 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9670 1: 2 . 1: 2
9671 . .
9672
9673 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9674 @end group
9675 @end smallexample
9676
9677 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9678 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9679 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9680 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9681
9682 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9683 below. You can use @kbd{M-# m} to load it from there.)
9684
9685 @smallexample
9686 @group
9687 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9688 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9689 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9690 1: 2 .
9691 .
9692
9693 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9694
9695 @end group
9696 @end smallexample
9697 @noindent
9698 @smallexample
9699 @group
9700 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9701 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9702 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9703 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9704 . . .
9705
9706 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9707 @end group
9708 @end smallexample
9709
9710 @noindent
9711 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9712 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9713
9714 @smallexample
9715 @group
9716 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9717 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9718 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9719 . 1: 2 .
9720 .
9721
9722 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9723
9724 @end group
9725 @end smallexample
9726 @noindent
9727 @smallexample
9728 @group
9729 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9730 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9731 . .
9732
9733 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9734 @end group
9735 @end smallexample
9736
9737 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9738 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9739 the right answers.
9740
9741 Here's the full program once again:
9742
9743 @example
9744 @group
9745 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9746 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9747 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9748 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9749 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9750 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9751 Z ]
9752 Z ]
9753 C-x )
9754 @end group
9755 @end example
9756
9757 You can read this definition using @kbd{M-# m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9758 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9759 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9760 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{M-# m} is often
9761 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9762
9763 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9764 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9765
9766 @noindent
9767 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9768 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9769
9770 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9771 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9772
9773 @smallexample
9774 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9775 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9776 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9777 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9778 C-c C-c
9779 @end smallexample
9780
9781 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9782
9783 @smallexample
9784 @group
9785 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9786 1: 2 . .
9787 .
9788
9789 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9790 @end group
9791 @end smallexample
9792
9793 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9794 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9795 the last rule.
9796
9797 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9798 @tex
9799 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9800 @end tex
9801
9802 @c [reference]
9803
9804 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9805 @chapter Introduction
9806
9807 @noindent
9808 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9809 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9810 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9811
9812 @c [when-split]
9813 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9814
9815 @menu
9816 * Basic Commands::
9817 * Help Commands::
9818 * Stack Basics::
9819 * Numeric Entry::
9820 * Algebraic Entry::
9821 * Quick Calculator::
9822 * Keypad Mode::
9823 * Prefix Arguments::
9824 * Undo::
9825 * Error Messages::
9826 * Multiple Calculators::
9827 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9828 @end menu
9829
9830 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9831 @section Basic Commands
9832
9833 @noindent
9834 @pindex calc
9835 @pindex calc-mode
9836 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9837 @cindex Running the Calculator
9838 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9839 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9840 and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9841 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9842 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9843 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9844 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9845 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9846 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9847 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9848 to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9849 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9850
9851 @kindex M-# c
9852 @kindex M-# M-#
9853 @ignore
9854 @mindex @null
9855 @end ignore
9856 @kindex M-# #
9857 In most installations, the @kbd{M-# c} key sequence is a more
9858 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{M-# M-#} and
9859 @kbd{M-# #} are synonyms for @kbd{M-# c} unless you last used Calc
9860 in its Keypad mode.
9861
9862 @kindex x
9863 @kindex M-x
9864 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9865 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9866 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9867 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9868 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9869 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9870 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9871 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9872
9873 @cindex Extensions module
9874 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9875 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{M-# c}, the
9876 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9877 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9878 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9879 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9880 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9881 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9882 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9883 extensions by using the @kbd{M-# L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9884 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9885
9886 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{M-# c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9887 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9888 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9889 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9890 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9891 to auto-load the Calculator.
9892
9893 @kindex M-# b
9894 @pindex full-calc
9895 If you type @kbd{M-# b}, then next time you use @kbd{M-# c} you
9896 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9897 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{M-# c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9898 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9899 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9900 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9901 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9902
9903 @kindex M-# o
9904 @pindex calc-other-window
9905 The @kbd{M-# o} command is like @kbd{M-# c} except that the Calc
9906 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9907 window, @kbd{M-# o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9908 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9909 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9910 @kbd{M-# o} takes care not to do.)
9911
9912 @ignore
9913 @mindex M-# q
9914 @end ignore
9915 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{M-# q} (@code{quick-calc})
9916 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9917 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9918 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9919
9920 @ignore
9921 @mindex M-# k
9922 @end ignore
9923 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9924 @kbd{M-# k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9925 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9926 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9927
9928 @kindex q
9929 @pindex calc-quit
9930 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9931 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9932 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9933 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9934 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9935 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{M-# c} or @kbd{M-# M-#}
9936 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9937 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{M-# M-#} as toggling the
9938 Calculator on and off.
9939
9940 @kindex M-# x
9941 The @kbd{M-# x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9942 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9943 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9944
9945 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9946 @pindex calc-refresh
9947 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9948 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9949 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9950 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9951 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9952
9953 @ignore
9954 @mindex o
9955 @end ignore
9956 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9957 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9958
9959 @kindex <
9960 @kindex >
9961 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9962 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9963 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9964 @cindex Scrolling
9965 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9966 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9967 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9968 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9969 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9970 window whenever it can.)
9971
9972 @kindex @{
9973 @kindex @}
9974 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9975 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9976 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9977 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9978 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9979 height of the Calc window.
9980
9981 @kindex M-# 0
9982 @pindex calc-reset
9983 The @kbd{M-# 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{M-#} followed
9984 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9985 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9986 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9987 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9988 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9989 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9990 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{M-# 0} preserves the contents of
9991 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9992 negative prefix argument, @kbd{M-# 0} preserves the contents of the
9993 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9994
9995 @pindex calc-version
9996 The @kbd{M-x calc-version} command displays the current version number
9997 of Calc and the name of the person who installed it on your system.
9998 (This information is also present in the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer,
9999 and in the output of the @kbd{h h} command.)
10000
10001 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
10002 @section Help Commands
10003
10004 @noindent
10005 @cindex Help commands
10006 @kindex ?
10007 @pindex calc-help
10008 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
10009 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs'
10010 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
10011 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
10012 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
10013 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
10014
10015 @kindex h h
10016 @pindex calc-full-help
10017 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
10018 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
10019 summary of Calc keystrokes.
10020
10021 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
10022 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
10023 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
10024
10025 @kindex h i
10026 @kindex M-# i
10027 @kindex i
10028 @pindex calc-info
10029 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
10030 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
10031 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
10032 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
10033 manual. The @kbd{M-# i} command is another way to read the Calc
10034 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
10035 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
10036 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
10037 different command in a future version of Calc.
10038
10039 @kindex h t
10040 @kindex M-# t
10041 @pindex calc-tutorial
10042 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
10043 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
10044 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
10045 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
10046 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
10047 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
10048 The @kbd{M-# t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
10049 all times).
10050
10051 @kindex h s
10052 @kindex M-# s
10053 @pindex calc-info-summary
10054 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
10055 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{M-# s}
10056 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
10057
10058 @kindex h k
10059 @pindex calc-describe-key
10060 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
10061 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
10062 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
10063 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
10064 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
10065 node indicated by the index.
10066
10067 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
10068 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
10069 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
10070 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
10071
10072 @kindex h c
10073 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
10074 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
10075 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
10076 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
10077 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
10078 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
10079 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
10080 gives the description:
10081
10082 @smallexample
10083 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 @noindent
10087 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
10088 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
10089 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
10090 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
10091 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
10092
10093 @kindex h f
10094 @pindex calc-describe-function
10095 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
10096 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
10097 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
10098 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
10099 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
10100 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
10101 @samp{=>}.
10102
10103 @kindex h v
10104 @pindex calc-describe-variable
10105 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
10106 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
10107 @code{PlotRejects}.
10108
10109 @kindex h b
10110 @pindex describe-bindings
10111 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
10112 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
10113 listed.
10114
10115 @kindex h n
10116 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
10117 the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
10118 @file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
10119 source files.
10120
10121 @kindex h C-c
10122 @kindex h C-d
10123 @kindex h C-w
10124 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
10125 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
10126 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
10127 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
10128
10129 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
10130 @section Stack Basics
10131
10132 @noindent
10133 @cindex Stack basics
10134 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
10135 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
10136 Tutorial}.
10137
10138 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
10139 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
10140 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
10141 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
10142 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
10143 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
10144 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
10145 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
10146
10147 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
10148 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
10149 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
10150 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
10151 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
10152 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
10153
10154 @kindex d l
10155 @pindex calc-line-numbering
10156 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
10157 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
10158 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
10159 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
10160 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
10161
10162 @kindex o
10163 @pindex calc-realign
10164 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
10165 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
10166 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
10167 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
10168
10169 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
10170 two consecutive numbers.
10171 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
10172 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
10173 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
10174 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
10175
10176 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
10177 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
10178 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
10179 commands.
10180
10181 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
10182 @section Numeric Entry
10183
10184 @noindent
10185 @kindex 0-9
10186 @kindex .
10187 @kindex e
10188 @cindex Numeric entry
10189 @cindex Entering numbers
10190 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
10191 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
10192 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
10193 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
10194 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
10195
10196 @cindex Minus signs
10197 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
10198 @kindex _
10199 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
10200 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
10201 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
10202 different keys for these operations, respectively:
10203 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10204 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10205 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10206 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10207 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10208 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10209 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10210
10211 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10212 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10213 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10214 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10215
10216 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10217
10218 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10219 @section Algebraic Entry
10220
10221 @noindent
10222 @kindex '
10223 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10224 @cindex Algebraic notation
10225 @cindex Formulas, entering
10226 Calculations can also be entered in algebraic form. This is accomplished
10227 by typing the apostrophe key, @kbd{'}, followed by the expression in
10228 standard format: @kbd{@key{'} 2+3*4 @key{RET}} computes
10229 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10230 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10231 and pushes that on the stack. If you wish you can
10232 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10233 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10234 clear previous results off the stack.
10235
10236 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10237 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do this
10238 would be to use the full Emacs cursor motion and editing keys, which are
10239 available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10240
10241 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10242 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10243 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10244 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10245
10246 @kindex m a
10247 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10248 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10249 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10250 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10251 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10252 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10253 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10254 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10255 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10256 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10257 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10258
10259 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10260 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10261 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10262 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10263 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10264
10265 @kindex m t
10266 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10267 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10268 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10269 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10270 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10271 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10272 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10273 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10274 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10275 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10276 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10277 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10278 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10279
10280 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10281 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10282 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10283
10284 @kindex $
10285 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10286 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10287 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10288 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10289 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10290 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10291 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10292 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10293 first character in the new formula.
10294
10295 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10296 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10297 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10298 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10299 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10300 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10301 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10302
10303 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10304 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10305 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10306 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10307 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10308 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10309
10310 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10311 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10312 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10313 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10314 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10315 @key{TAB} key.
10316
10317 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10318 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10319 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10320 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10321
10322 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10323 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables the default simplifications
10324 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10325 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10326 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10327 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10328
10329 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10330 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10331
10332 @noindent
10333 @kindex M-# q
10334 @pindex quick-calc
10335 @cindex Quick Calculator
10336 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10337 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{M-# q} (or
10338 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10339 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10340 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10341
10342 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10343 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10344 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10345 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10346 forget what it was, just run @code{M-# q} again and enter
10347 @samp{$} as the formula.
10348
10349 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10350 session, the @kbd{M-# q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10351 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10352 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10353 Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10354 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10355 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10356 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10357
10358 If you use @code{M-# q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10359 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10360
10361 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10362 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10363 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10364 to yank the result into the next @kbd{M-# q} input line as a more
10365 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10366 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{M-# c}.
10367
10368 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10369 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10370 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10371
10372 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10373 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10374 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10375 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10376 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10377 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10378
10379 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10380 the number will also be displayed in hex and octal formats. If the
10381 integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10382 an ASCII character.
10383
10384 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10385 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10386 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10387 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10388 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10389 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10390 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10391
10392 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10393 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10394 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10395 small calculations.
10396
10397 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10398 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10399
10400 @noindent
10401 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10402 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10403 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10404 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10405 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10406
10407 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10408 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10409 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10410 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10411 on the entire stack.
10412
10413 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10414 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10415 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10416 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10417 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10418 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10419 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10420 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10421 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10422 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10423 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10424 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10425 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10426 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10427 argument for some other purpose.
10428
10429 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10430 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10431 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10432 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10433
10434 @kindex ~
10435 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10436 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10437 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10438 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10439 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10440 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10441
10442 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10443 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10444
10445 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10446 @section Undoing Mistakes
10447
10448 @noindent
10449 @kindex U
10450 @kindex C-_
10451 @pindex calc-undo
10452 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10453 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10454 @cindex Errors, undoing
10455 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10456 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10457 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10458 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10459 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10460 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10461 specified number of operations. The undo history is cleared only by the
10462 @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command. (Recall that @kbd{M-# c} is
10463 synonymous with @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this
10464 also clears the undo history.)
10465
10466 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10467 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10468 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10469
10470 @kindex D
10471 @pindex calc-redo
10472 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10473 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10474 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10475 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10476 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10477 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10478 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10479 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10480
10481 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10482 @pindex calc-last-args
10483 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10484 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10485 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10486 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10487 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10488 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10489 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10490 onto the stack.
10491
10492 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10493 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10494
10495 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10496 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10497
10498 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10499
10500 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10501 @section Error Messages
10502
10503 @noindent
10504 @kindex w
10505 @pindex calc-why
10506 @cindex Errors, messages
10507 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10508 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10509 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10510 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10511 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10512 reasons for this to happen.
10513
10514 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10515 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10516 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10517 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10518 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10519 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10520 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10521
10522 @kindex d w
10523 @pindex calc-auto-why
10524 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10525 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10526 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10527 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10528 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10529 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10530
10531 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10532 @section Multiple Calculators
10533
10534 @noindent
10535 @pindex another-calc
10536 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10537 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10538 is similar to @kbd{M-# c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10539 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10540 form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10541 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10542 this would ordinarily never be done.
10543
10544 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10545 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10546 Calculator buffer.
10547
10548 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10549 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10550 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10551 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10552 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10553 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10554
10555 There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10556 Calculator buffers.
10557
10558 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10559 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10560
10561 @noindent
10562 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10563 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10564
10565 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10566 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10567
10568 @menu
10569 * Autoloading Problems::
10570 * Recursion Depth::
10571 * Caches::
10572 * Debugging Calc::
10573 @end menu
10574
10575 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10576 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10577
10578 @noindent
10579 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10580 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10581 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10582 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10583 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10584
10585 @kindex M-# L
10586 @pindex calc-load-everything
10587 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{M-# L}
10588 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10589 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10590 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10591
10592 If you seem to run into this problem no matter what you do, or if
10593 even the @kbd{M-# L} command crashes, Calc may have been improperly
10594 installed. @xref{Installation}, for details of the installation
10595 process.
10596
10597 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10598 @subsection Recursion Depth
10599
10600 @noindent
10601 @kindex M
10602 @kindex I M
10603 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10604 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10605 @cindex Recursion depth
10606 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10607 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10608 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10609 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10610 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10611 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10612 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10613 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10614 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10615 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10616
10617 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10618 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10619 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10620 The default value is 1000.
10621
10622 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10623 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10624
10625 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10626 @subsection Caches
10627
10628 @noindent
10629 @cindex Caches
10630 @cindex Flushing caches
10631 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10632 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10633 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10634 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10635 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10636 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10637 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10638 @cpiover{4} and
10639 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10640 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10641 The visible effect of caching is that
10642 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10643 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10644 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10645 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10646
10647 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10648 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10649 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10650 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10651 The @kbd{M-# 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10652 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10653
10654 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10655 @subsection Debugging Calc
10656
10657 @noindent
10658 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10659 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10660 your own Calc commands.
10661
10662 @kindex Z T
10663 @pindex calc-timing
10664 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10665 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10666 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10667 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10668 accurate only to within one second.
10669
10670 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10671 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10672 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10673 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10674 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10675 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10676 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10677 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10678 to execute the whole macro.
10679
10680 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10681 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10682 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10683 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10684 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10685 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10686 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10687
10688 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10689 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10690 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10691 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10692 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10693 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10694 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10695
10696 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10697 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10698 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10699 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10700 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10701 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10702 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10703 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10704 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10705 will be lost.
10706
10707 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10708 @chapter Data Types
10709
10710 @noindent
10711 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10712 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10713 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10714 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10715
10716 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10717 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10718 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10719 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10720 arbitrarily:@: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10721 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10722 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10723
10724 @menu
10725 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10726 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10727 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10728 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10729 * Infinities::
10730 * Vectors and Matrices::
10731 * Strings::
10732 * HMS Forms::
10733 * Date Forms::
10734 * Modulo Forms::
10735 * Error Forms::
10736 * Interval Forms::
10737 * Incomplete Objects::
10738 * Variables::
10739 * Formulas::
10740 @end menu
10741
10742 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10743 @section Integers
10744
10745 @noindent
10746 @cindex Integers
10747 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10748 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10749 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10750 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10751 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10752 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10753
10754 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10755 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10756 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10757 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10758
10759 @kindex #
10760 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10761 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10762 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10763 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10764 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10765 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10766 number, the current display radix is used.
10767
10768 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10769 @section Fractions
10770
10771 @noindent
10772 @cindex Fractions
10773 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10774 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10775 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10776 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10777 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10778 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10779 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10780
10781 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10782 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10783 display formats.
10784
10785 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10786 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10787 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10788
10789 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10790 @section Floats
10791
10792 @noindent
10793 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10794 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10795 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10796 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10797 range of acceptable values is from
10798 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10799 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10800 (inclusive) to
10801 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10802 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10803 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10804
10805 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10806 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10807 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10808 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10809 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10810 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10811 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10812 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10813 would have overflowed!)
10814
10815 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10816 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10817 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10818 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10819
10820 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10821 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10822 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10823 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10824 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10825 or 0.235.
10826
10827 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10828 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10829 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10830 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10831
10832 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10833 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10834 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10835 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10836 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10837 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10838 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10839 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10840 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10841 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10842 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10843 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10844 way.
10845
10846 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10847 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. The
10848 notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}} is a floating-point
10849 number whose digits are in the specified radix. Note that the @samp{.}
10850 is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point'' than as a decimal
10851 point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is defined as
10852 @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can use
10853 @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific notation.
10854 The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a power
10855 of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above, the
10856 letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10857 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10858 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10859
10860 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10861 @section Complex Numbers
10862
10863 @noindent
10864 @cindex Complex numbers
10865 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10866 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10867 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10868 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10869 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10870 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10871
10872 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10873 @texline `@t{(}@var{r}@t{;}@math{\theta}@t{)}'
10874 @infoline `@t{(}@var{r}@t{;}@var{theta}@t{)}'
10875 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10876 @texline @math{\theta}
10877 @infoline @var{theta}
10878 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10879 @texline @math{\theta}
10880 @infoline @var{theta}
10881 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10882 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10883 in radians.
10884
10885 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10886 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10887
10888 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10889 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10890 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10891 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10892 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10893
10894 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10895 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10896 number.
10897
10898 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10899 @section Infinities
10900
10901 @noindent
10902 @cindex Infinity
10903 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10904 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10905 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10906 @vindex inf
10907 @vindex uinf
10908 @vindex nan
10909 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10910 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10911 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10912 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10913 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10914 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10915 entered using algebraic entry.
10916
10917 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10918 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10919 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10920 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10921 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10922 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10923 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10924 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10925 @texline @math{e^x}
10926 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10927 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10928 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10929 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10930 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10931
10932 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10933 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10934 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10935 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10936 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10937 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10938 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10939 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10940 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10941 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10942 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10943
10944 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10945 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10946 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10947 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10948 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10949 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10950 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10951 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10952 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10953 some cases.
10954
10955 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10956 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10957 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10958 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10959 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10960 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10961 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10962 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10963 notation.
10964
10965 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10966 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10967 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10968 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10969 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10970 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10971 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10972 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10973 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10974 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10975 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10976 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10977 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10978 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10979 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10980 (as described above).
10981
10982 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10983 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10984
10985 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10986 @section Vectors and Matrices
10987
10988 @noindent
10989 @cindex Vectors
10990 @cindex Plain vectors
10991 @cindex Matrices
10992 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10993 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10994 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10995 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10996 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10997
10998 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10999 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
11000 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
11001 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
11002 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
11003 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
11004 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
11005 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
11006 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
11007 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
11008 this case.
11009
11010 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
11011 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
11012 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
11013 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
11014 of its elements.
11015
11016 @ignore
11017 @starindex
11018 @end ignore
11019 @tindex vec
11020 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
11021 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
11022 @texline @math{n\times m}
11023 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
11024 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
11025 from 1 to @samp{n}.
11026
11027 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
11028 @section Strings
11029
11030 @noindent
11031 @kindex "
11032 @cindex Strings
11033 @cindex Character strings
11034 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
11035 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
11036 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
11037 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
11038 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
11039 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
11040
11041 @example
11042 @group
11043 \a 7 \^@@ 0
11044 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
11045 \e 27 \^[ 27
11046 \f 12 \^\\ 28
11047 \n 10 \^] 29
11048 \r 13 \^^ 30
11049 \t 9 \^_ 31
11050 \^? 127
11051 @end group
11052 @end example
11053
11054 @noindent
11055 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
11056 character from its ASCII code.
11057
11058 @kindex d "
11059 @pindex calc-display-strings
11060 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
11061 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
11062 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
11063 instead.
11064
11065 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
11066 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
11067 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
11068 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
11069 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
11070 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
11071
11072 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
11073 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
11074 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
11075
11076 @ignore
11077 @starindex
11078 @end ignore
11079 @tindex string
11080 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
11081 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
11082 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
11083 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
11084 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
11085 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
11086 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
11087 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
11088 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
11089
11090 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
11091 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
11092 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
11093 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
11094
11095 @ignore
11096 @starindex
11097 @end ignore
11098 @tindex bstring
11099 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
11100 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
11101 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
11102 character in the string.
11103
11104 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
11105 @section HMS Forms
11106
11107 @noindent
11108 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
11109 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
11110 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
11111 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
11112 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
11113 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
11114 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
11115 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
11116
11117 @kindex @@
11118 @ignore
11119 @mindex @null
11120 @end ignore
11121 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
11122 @ignore
11123 @mindex @null
11124 @end ignore
11125 @kindex " (HMS forms)
11126 @ignore
11127 @mindex @null
11128 @end ignore
11129 @kindex h (HMS forms)
11130 @ignore
11131 @mindex @null
11132 @end ignore
11133 @kindex o (HMS forms)
11134 @ignore
11135 @mindex @null
11136 @end ignore
11137 @kindex m (HMS forms)
11138 @ignore
11139 @mindex @null
11140 @end ignore
11141 @kindex s (HMS forms)
11142 The default format for HMS values is
11143 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
11144 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
11145 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
11146 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
11147 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
11148 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
11149 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
11150 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
11151 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
11152 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
11153 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
11154 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
11155
11156 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
11157 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
11158 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
11159 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
11160
11161 @pindex calc-time
11162 @cindex Time of day
11163 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
11164 the stack as an HMS form.
11165
11166 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
11167 @section Date Forms
11168
11169 @noindent
11170 @cindex Date forms
11171 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
11172 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
11173 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
11174 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
11175 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
11176 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
11177 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
11178
11179 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
11180 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
11181 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
11182 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
11183 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
11184
11185 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
11186 of days since midnight on the morning of January 1 of the year 1 AD.
11187 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
11188 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
11189 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991>}
11190 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
11191 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
11192 time can be stored without roundoff error.
11193
11194 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
11195 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11196 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11197 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11198 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11199 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11200 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11201 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11202 never an issue for them.
11203
11204 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11205 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11206 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11207
11208 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11209 year numbers represent years BC. Calc uses a combination of the
11210 Gregorian and Julian calendars, following the history of Great
11211 Britain and the British colonies. This is the same calendar that
11212 is used by the @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations.
11213
11214 @cindex Julian calendar
11215 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11216 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11217 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the gradual
11218 drift caused by the lack of leap years in the calendar used
11219 until that time. The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in
11220 all years divisible by four. After some initial confusion, the
11221 calendar was adopted around the year we call 8 AD. Some centuries
11222 later it became apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was
11223 itself not quite right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the
11224 Gregorian calendar, which added the new rule that years divisible
11225 by 100, but not by 400, were not to be considered leap years
11226 despite being divisible by four. Many countries delayed adoption
11227 of the Gregorian calendar because of religious differences;
11228 in Britain it was put off until the year 1752, by which time
11229 the Julian calendar had fallen eleven days behind the true
11230 seasons. So the switch to the Gregorian calendar in early
11231 September 1752 introduced a discontinuity: The day after
11232 Sep 2, 1752 is Sep 14, 1752. Calc follows this convention.
11233 To take another example, Russia waited until 1918 before
11234 adopting the new calendar, and thus needed to remove thirteen
11235 days (between Feb 1, 1918 and Feb 14, 1918). This means that
11236 Calc's reckoning will be inconsistent with Russian history between
11237 1752 and 1918, and similarly for various other countries.
11238
11239 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second'' as
11240 well, but Calc does not take these minor effects into account.
11241 (If it did, it would have to report a non-integer number of days
11242 between, say, @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11243 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11244
11245 Calc uses the Julian calendar for all dates before the year 1752,
11246 including dates BC when the Julian calendar technically had not
11247 yet been invented. Thus the claim that day number @mathit{-10000} is
11248 called ``August 16, 28 BC'' should be taken with a grain of salt.
11249
11250 Please note that there is no ``year 0''; the day before
11251 @samp{<Sat Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Fri Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11252 days 0 and @mathit{-1} respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme.
11253
11254 @cindex Julian day counting
11255 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also
11256 called ``Julian.'' It was invented in 1583 by Joseph Justus
11257 Scaliger, who named it in honor of his father Julius Caesar
11258 Scaliger. For obscure reasons he chose to start his day
11259 numbering on Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon, which in Calc's scheme
11260 is @mathit{-1721423.5} (recall that Calc starts at midnight instead
11261 of noon). Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by
11262 unpacking a date form into a Julian day number, simply add
11263 1721423.5. The Julian code for @samp{6:00am Jan 9, 1991}
11264 is 2448265.75. The built-in @kbd{t J} command performs
11265 this conversion for you.
11266
11267 @cindex Unix time format
11268 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11269 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11270 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11271 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11272 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11273 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11274 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11275 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11276 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11277 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11278 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11279 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11280 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11281 conversions.
11282
11283 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11284 @section Modulo Forms
11285
11286 @noindent
11287 @cindex Modulo forms
11288 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11289 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11290 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11291 `@var{a} @t{mod} @var{M}',
11292 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11293 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11294 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11295 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11296 integers but this is not required.
11297
11298 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11299 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11300 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11301 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11302 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11303 the result always lies in the desired range.
11304
11305 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11306 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11307 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11308 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11309 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11310 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11311 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11312 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11313
11314 @cindex Modulo division
11315 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @t{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @t{mod} @var{M}'
11316 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11317 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11318 `@var{b} @t{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @t{mod} @var{M}'. If
11319 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11320 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11321 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11322 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11323 @w{`@t{(}@var{a} @t{mod} @var{M}@t{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11324 in the sense of reducing
11325 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11326 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11327 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11328 number-theoretical point of view.)
11329
11330 @ignore
11331 @mindex M
11332 @end ignore
11333 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11334 @ignore
11335 @mindex mod
11336 @end ignore
11337 @tindex mod (operator)
11338 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11339 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11340 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11341 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11342 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11343 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11344
11345 You can also use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11346 @xref{Building Vectors}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11347
11348 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11349 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11350 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11351 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11352 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11353 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11354 24 radians!
11355
11356 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11357 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11358 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11359
11360 @ignore
11361 @starindex
11362 @end ignore
11363 @tindex makemod
11364 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11365 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11366
11367 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11368 @section Error Forms
11369
11370 @noindent
11371 @cindex Error forms
11372 @cindex Standard deviations
11373 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11374 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11375 @texline `@var{x} @t{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11376 @infoline `@var{x} @t{+/-} sigma'
11377 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11378 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11379 deviation or ``error''
11380 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11381 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11382 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11383 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11384 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11385 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11386 regular number by the Calculator.
11387
11388 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11389 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11390 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11391 @texline @math{\sin x}
11392 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11393 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11394 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11395 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11396 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11397 @tex
11398 $$ \eqalign{
11399 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11400 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11401 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11402 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11403 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11404 \right| \right)^2
11405 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11406 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11407 } $$
11408 @end tex
11409 Note that this
11410 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11411 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11412 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11413 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11414 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11415 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11416 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11417
11418 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11419 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11420 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11421 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11422 @texline `@t{sin(}@var{x} @t{+/-} @math{\sigma}@t{)}'
11423 @infoline `@t{sin(}@var{x} @t{+/-} @var{sigma}@t{)}'
11424 is
11425 @texline `@math{\sigma} @t{abs(cos(}@var{x}@t{))}'.
11426 @infoline `@var{sigma} @t{abs(cos(}@var{x}@t{))}'.
11427 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11428 @texline @math{\cos x}
11429 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11430 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11431 @texline @math{\sigma};
11432 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11433 this makes sense, since
11434 @texline @math{\sin x}
11435 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11436 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11437 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11438 @texline @math{\cos x}
11439 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11440 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11441 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11442 has relatively little effect on the value of
11443 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11444 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11445 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11446 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11447 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11448 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11449 @texline @math{\sin x}
11450 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11451 would indeed have been negligible.
11452
11453 @ignore
11454 @mindex p
11455 @end ignore
11456 @kindex p (error forms)
11457 @tindex +/-
11458 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11459 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11460 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11461 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-p} to
11462 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11463
11464 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11465 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11466 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11467 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11468 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11469 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11470 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11471 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11472
11473 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11474 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11475
11476 @ignore
11477 @starindex
11478 @end ignore
11479 @tindex sdev
11480 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11481
11482 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11483 @section Interval Forms
11484
11485 @noindent
11486 @cindex Interval forms
11487 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11488 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11489 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11490 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11491 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11492 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11493 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11494 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11495 set of possible values of the input.
11496
11497 @ifinfo
11498 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11499 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11500 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11501 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11502 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11503 terms,
11504 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11505 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11506 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11507 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11508 @end ifinfo
11509 @tex
11510 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11511 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11512 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11513 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11514 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11515 terms,
11516 $$ \eqalign{
11517 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11518 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11519 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11520 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11521 } $$
11522 @end tex
11523
11524 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11525 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11526 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11527 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11528 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11529 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11530 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11531 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11532 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11533 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11534 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11535 the real infinities.
11536
11537 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11538 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11539 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11540 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11541 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11542 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11543 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11544
11545 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11546 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11547 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11548 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11549 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11550 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11551 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11552 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11553 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11554
11555 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11556 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11557 form
11558 @texline `@var{x} @t{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11559 @infoline `@var{x} @t{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11560 means a variable is random, and its value could
11561 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11562 @texline @math{\sigma}
11563 @infoline @var{sigma}
11564 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11565 `@t{[}@var{a} @t{..@:} @var{b}@t{]}' means a
11566 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11567 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11568 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11569 answer.
11570
11571 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11572 HMS forms or date forms.
11573
11574 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11575 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11576
11577 @ignore
11578 @starindex
11579 @end ignore
11580 @tindex intv
11581 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11582 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11583 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11584 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11585
11586 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11587 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11588 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11589 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11590 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11591 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11592 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11593 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11594 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11595 error.
11596
11597 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11598 @section Incomplete Objects
11599
11600 @noindent
11601 @ignore
11602 @mindex [ ]
11603 @end ignore
11604 @kindex [
11605 @ignore
11606 @mindex ( )
11607 @end ignore
11608 @kindex (
11609 @kindex ,
11610 @ignore
11611 @mindex @null
11612 @end ignore
11613 @kindex ]
11614 @ignore
11615 @mindex @null
11616 @end ignore
11617 @kindex )
11618 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11619 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11620 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11621 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11622 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11623 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11624 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11625 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11626 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11627
11628 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11629 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11630 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11631
11632 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11633 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11634 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11635 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11636
11637 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11638 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11639 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11640 from the list.
11641
11642 @kindex ;
11643 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11644 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11645 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11646 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11647
11648 @kindex ..
11649 @pindex calc-dots
11650 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11651 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11652 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11653 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11654 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11655 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11656
11657 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11658 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11659
11660 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11661 @section Variables
11662
11663 @noindent
11664 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11665 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11666 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11667 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11668 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11669 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11670 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11671 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11672 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11673 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11674 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11675 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11676 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11677 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11678 refer to the same variable.)
11679
11680 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11681 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11682 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11683 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11684 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11685 @code{foo}.
11686
11687 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11688 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11689 (@key{'}) key.
11690
11691 @kindex =
11692 @pindex calc-evaluate
11693 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11694 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11695 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11696 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11697 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11698 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11699 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11700 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11701 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11702 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11703 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11704 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11705
11706 @cindex @code{e} variable
11707 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11708 @cindex @code{i} variable
11709 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11710 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11711 @vindex e
11712 @vindex pi
11713 @vindex i
11714 @vindex phi
11715 @vindex gamma
11716 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11717 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11718 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11719 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11720 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11721 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11722
11723 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11724 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11725 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11726 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11727 a value into any of these special variables.
11728
11729 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11730
11731 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11732 @section Formulas
11733
11734 @noindent
11735 @cindex Formulas
11736 @cindex Expressions
11737 @cindex Operators in formulas
11738 @cindex Precedence of operators
11739 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11740 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11741 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11742 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11743 Parentheses may
11744 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11745 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11746 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11747 with their equivalent function names, are:
11748
11749 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11750
11751 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11752
11753 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x})
11754 and prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11755
11756 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11757 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11758
11759 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11760 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11761
11762 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11763
11764 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11765
11766 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11767 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11768
11769 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11770
11771 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11772
11773 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11774 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11775
11776 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11777
11778 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11779
11780 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11781
11782 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11783
11784 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11785
11786 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11787
11788 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11789
11790 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11791
11792 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11793
11794 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11795 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11796 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11797 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11798
11799 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11800 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11801 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11802 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11803 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11804 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11805 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11806 as in @samp{f(x)},
11807 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11808 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11809 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11810 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11811 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11812
11813 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11814 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11815 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11816 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11817 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11818 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11819 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11820 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11821 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11822 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11823 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11824
11825 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11826 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11827 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11828 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11829 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11830 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11831 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11832 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11833 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11834 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11835
11836 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11837 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11838 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11839 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11840
11841 @cindex Function call notation
11842 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11843 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11844 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11845 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11846 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11847 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11848 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11849 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11850 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11851 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11852 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11853
11854 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11855 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11856 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11857 represent the same operation.
11858
11859 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11860 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11861 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{M-# g}
11862 and @w{@kbd{M-# r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11863 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11864 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11865 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11866
11867 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11868 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11869 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11870 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11871
11872 @example
11873 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11874 c + d,
11875 %% last line is coming up:
11876 e + f ]
11877 @end example
11878
11879 @noindent
11880 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11881
11882 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11883 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11884 formats.
11885
11886 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11887
11888 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11889 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11890
11891 @noindent
11892 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11893 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11894 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11895
11896 @menu
11897 * Stack Manipulation::
11898 * Editing Stack Entries::
11899 * Trail Commands::
11900 * Keep Arguments::
11901 @end menu
11902
11903 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11904 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11905
11906 @noindent
11907 @kindex @key{RET}
11908 @kindex @key{SPC}
11909 @pindex calc-enter
11910 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11911 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11912 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11913 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11914 several elements at the top of the stack.
11915 Given a negative argument,
11916 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11917 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11918 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11919 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11920 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11921 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11922 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11923
11924 @kindex @key{LFD}
11925 @pindex calc-over
11926 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11927 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11928 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11929 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11930 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11931 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11932 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11933
11934 @kindex @key{DEL}
11935 @kindex C-d
11936 @pindex calc-pop
11937 @cindex Removing stack entries
11938 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11939 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11940 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11941 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11942 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11943 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11944 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11945 stack is emptied.
11946 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11947 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11948 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11949 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11950 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11951
11952 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11953 @pindex calc-pop-above
11954 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11955 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11956 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11957 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11958 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11959 the third stack element.
11960
11961 @kindex @key{TAB}
11962 @pindex calc-roll-down
11963 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11964 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11965 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11966 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11967 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11968 top-for-bottom.
11969 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11970 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11971 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11972 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11973 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11974
11975 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11976 @pindex calc-roll-up
11977 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11978 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11979 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11980 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11981 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11982 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11983 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11984 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11985
11986 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11987 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11988 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11989 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11990 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11991 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11992 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11993
11994 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11995 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11996 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11997 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @mathit{n}, also
11998 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11999
12000 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
12001 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
12002
12003 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
12004 @section Editing Stack Entries
12005
12006 @noindent
12007 @kindex `
12008 @pindex calc-edit
12009 @pindex calc-edit-finish
12010 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
12011 The backquote, @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary
12012 buffer (@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using
12013 regular Emacs commands. With a numeric prefix argument, it edits the
12014 specified number of stack entries at once. (An argument of zero edits
12015 the entire stack; a negative argument edits one specific stack entry.)
12016
12017 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
12018 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
12019 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
12020 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
12021 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
12022
12023 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
12024 the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
12025 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
12026 then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
12027 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
12028 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
12029 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
12030
12031 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
12032 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
12033 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
12034 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
12035
12036 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
12037 Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
12038 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
12039 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
12040 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
12041 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
12042 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
12043 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
12044 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
12045
12046 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
12047 each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
12048 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
12049 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
12050 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
12051
12052 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
12053 text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
12054 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
12055
12056 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
12057 @section Trail Commands
12058
12059 @noindent
12060 @cindex Trail buffer
12061 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
12062 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
12063
12064 @kindex t d
12065 @pindex calc-trail-display
12066 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
12067 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
12068 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
12069 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
12070 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
12071 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
12072 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
12073 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
12074 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
12075
12076 @kindex t i
12077 @pindex calc-trail-in
12078 @kindex t o
12079 @pindex calc-trail-out
12080 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
12081 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
12082 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
12083 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
12084 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
12085 in the Calculator window.
12086
12087 @cindex Trail pointer
12088 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
12089 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
12090 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
12091 trail pointer in various ways.
12092
12093 @kindex t y
12094 @pindex calc-trail-yank
12095 @cindex Retrieving previous results
12096 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
12097 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
12098 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
12099 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
12100 trail pointer.
12101
12102 @kindex t <
12103 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
12104 @kindex t >
12105 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
12106 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
12107 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
12108 window left or right by one half of its width.
12109
12110 @kindex t n
12111 @pindex calc-trail-next
12112 @kindex t p
12113 @pindex calc-trail-previous
12114 @kindex t f
12115 @pindex calc-trail-forward
12116 @kindex t b
12117 @pindex calc-trail-backward
12118 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
12119 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
12120 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
12121 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
12122 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
12123 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
12124
12125 @kindex t [
12126 @pindex calc-trail-first
12127 @kindex t ]
12128 @pindex calc-trail-last
12129 @kindex t h
12130 @pindex calc-trail-here
12131 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
12132 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
12133 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
12134 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
12135 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
12136
12137 @kindex t s
12138 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
12139 @kindex t r
12140 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
12141 @ifinfo
12142 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12143 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
12144 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12145 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12146 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12147 it was when the search began.
12148 @end ifinfo
12149 @tex
12150 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12151 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12152 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12153 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12154 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12155 it was when the search began.
12156 @end tex
12157
12158 @kindex t m
12159 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12160 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12161 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12162 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12163 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12164 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12165
12166 @kindex t k
12167 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12168 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12169 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12170 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12171 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12172 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12173
12174 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12175 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12176
12177 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12178 @section Keep Arguments
12179
12180 @noindent
12181 @kindex K
12182 @pindex calc-keep-args
12183 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12184 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12185 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12186 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12187 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12188
12189 This works for all commands that take arguments off the stack. As
12190 another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12191 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12192 formula (rather than replacing the original formula).
12193
12194 Note that you could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s},
12195 copying the formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference
12196 is that for a very large formula the time taken to format the
12197 intermediate copy in @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s}
12198 would avoid this extra work.
12199
12200 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12201 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12202 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12203
12204 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12205 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12206 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12207 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12208 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12209 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12210
12211 Keyboard macros may interact surprisingly with the @kbd{K} prefix.
12212 If you have defined a keyboard macro to be, say, @samp{Q +} to add
12213 one number to the square root of another, then typing @kbd{K X} will
12214 execute @kbd{K Q +}, probably not what you expected. The @kbd{K}
12215 prefix will apply to just the first command in the macro rather than
12216 the whole macro.
12217
12218 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12219 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12220 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12221 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12222 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12223 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12224
12225 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12226 @chapter Mode Settings
12227
12228 @noindent
12229 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12230 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12231 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12232
12233 @menu
12234 * General Mode Commands::
12235 * Precision::
12236 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12237 * Calculation Modes::
12238 * Simplification Modes::
12239 * Declarations::
12240 * Display Modes::
12241 * Language Modes::
12242 * Modes Variable::
12243 * Calc Mode Line::
12244 @end menu
12245
12246 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12247 @section General Mode Commands
12248
12249 @noindent
12250 @kindex m m
12251 @pindex calc-save-modes
12252 @cindex Continuous memory
12253 @cindex Saving mode settings
12254 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12255 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12256 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12257 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12258 @file{~/.calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command.
12259 This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time it starts up.
12260 The modes saved in the file include everything controlled by the @kbd{m}
12261 and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current precision and binary word size,
12262 whether or not the trail is displayed, the current height of the Calc
12263 window, and more. The current interface (used when you type @kbd{M-#
12264 M-#}) is also saved. If there were already saved mode settings in the
12265 file, they are replaced. Otherwise, the new mode information is
12266 appended to the end of the file.
12267
12268 @kindex m R
12269 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12270 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12271 record the new mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12272 time a mode setting changes. If Embedded mode is enabled, other
12273 options are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.
12274
12275 @kindex m F
12276 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12277 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12278 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12279 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12280 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12281 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12282 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12283 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12284 file name is @file{~/.calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12285 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12286 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Installation}.
12287
12288 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12289 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12290 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12291 to reread. You can give
12292 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12293 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12294 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12295 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12296 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12297 modes present in the file you were using before.
12298
12299 @kindex m x
12300 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12301 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12302 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12303 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12304 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12305 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12306 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12307 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{M-# L}.
12308
12309 @kindex m S
12310 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12311 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12312 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12313 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12314 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12315 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12316 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12317 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12318 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12319 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12320 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12321 shifted-prefix mode.
12322
12323 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12324 @section Precision
12325
12326 @noindent
12327 @kindex p
12328 @pindex calc-precision
12329 @cindex Precision of calculations
12330 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12331 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12332 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12333 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12334 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12335
12336 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12337 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12338
12339 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12340 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12341 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12342 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12343 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12344 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12345 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12346 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12347 existing value to a new precision.
12348
12349 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12350 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12351 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12352 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12353 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12354 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12355 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12356 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12357 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12358 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12359 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12360 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12361 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12362
12363 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12364 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12365 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12366 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12367 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12368 of the numbers involved.
12369
12370 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12371 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12372 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12373 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12374 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12375 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12376
12377 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12378 issues.
12379
12380 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12381 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12382
12383 @noindent
12384 @kindex I
12385 @pindex calc-inverse
12386 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12387 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12388 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12389 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12390 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12391
12392 @kindex H
12393 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12394 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12395 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12396 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12397 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12398 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12399 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12400
12401 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12402 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12403 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12404 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12405
12406 The Inverse and Hyperbolic flags apply only to the next Calculator
12407 command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They are also
12408 cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits you
12409 type after @kbd{I} or @kbd{H} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as prefix
12410 arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The same
12411 is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means to
12412 subtract and keep arguments).
12413
12414 The third Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12415 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12416
12417 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12418 @section Calculation Modes
12419
12420 @noindent
12421 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12422 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12423 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12424 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12425
12426 @menu
12427 * Angular Modes::
12428 * Polar Mode::
12429 * Fraction Mode::
12430 * Infinite Mode::
12431 * Symbolic Mode::
12432 * Matrix Mode::
12433 * Automatic Recomputation::
12434 * Working Message::
12435 @end menu
12436
12437 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12438 @subsection Angular Modes
12439
12440 @noindent
12441 @cindex Angular mode
12442 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12443 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12444 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12445 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12446 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12447 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12448
12449 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12450 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12451 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12452 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12453 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12454 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12455 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12456
12457 @kindex m r
12458 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12459 @kindex m d
12460 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12461 @kindex m h
12462 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12463 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12464 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12465 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12466 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12467
12468 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12469 @subsection Polar Mode
12470
12471 @noindent
12472 @cindex Polar mode
12473 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12474 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12475 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12476 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12477 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12478
12479 @kindex m p
12480 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12481 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12482 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12483 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12484
12485 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12486 @subsection Fraction Mode
12487
12488 @noindent
12489 @cindex Fraction mode
12490 @cindex Division of integers
12491 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12492 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12493 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12494 to multiply fractions instead: @kbd{6 @key{RET} 1:4 *} produces @expr{3:2}
12495 even though @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12496
12497 @kindex m f
12498 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12499 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12500 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12501 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12502 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12503 Float mode.
12504
12505 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12506 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12507 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12508
12509 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12510 @subsection Infinite Mode
12511
12512 @noindent
12513 @cindex Infinite mode
12514 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12515 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12516 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12517 results.
12518
12519 @kindex m i
12520 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12521 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12522 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12523 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12524 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12525 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12526 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12527
12528 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12529 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12530 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12531 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12532 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12533 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12534 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12535 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12536
12537 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12538 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12539 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12540 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12541 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12542 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12543 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12544 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12545 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12546 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12547 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12548
12549 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12550 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12551
12552 @noindent
12553 @cindex Symbolic mode
12554 @cindex Inexact results
12555 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12556 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12557 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12558 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12559 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12560
12561 @kindex m s
12562 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12563 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12564 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12565 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12566 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12567
12568 @kindex N
12569 @pindex calc-eval-num
12570 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12571 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12572 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12573 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12574 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12575 of the command.
12576
12577 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12578 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12579 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12580 variables.)
12581
12582 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12583 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12584
12585 @noindent
12586 @cindex Matrix mode
12587 @cindex Scalar mode
12588 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12589 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12590 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12591 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12592
12593 @kindex m v
12594 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12595 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12596 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12597 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12598 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12599 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12600 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12601 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12602 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12603 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12604 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12605 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12606 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12607 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12608 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12609 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12610 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12611 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12612 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12613
12614 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12615 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12616 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12617 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12618 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12619 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12620 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12621
12622 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12623
12624 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12625 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12626 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12627 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12628 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix.
12629
12630 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12631 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12632 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12633 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12634 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12635 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12636
12637 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12638 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12639 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12640 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12641 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12642 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12643 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12644
12645 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12646 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12647 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12648 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12649 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12650 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12651
12652 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12653 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12654
12655 @noindent
12656 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12657 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12658 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12659 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12660
12661 @kindex m C
12662 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12663 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12664 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12665 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12666 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12667 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12668 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12669 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12670 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12671
12672 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12673 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{M-# u}}.
12674 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12675
12676 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12677 @subsection Working Messages
12678
12679 @noindent
12680 @cindex Performance
12681 @cindex Working messages
12682 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12683 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12684 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12685 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12686 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12687 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12688 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12689
12690 @kindex m w
12691 @pindex calc-working
12692 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12693 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12694 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12695 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12696 the current mode.
12697
12698 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12699 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12700 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12701 to turn the messages off.
12702
12703 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12704 @section Simplification Modes
12705
12706 @noindent
12707 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12708 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12709 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12710 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12711 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12712 are done by default but can be turned off when necessary.
12713
12714 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12715 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12716 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12717 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12718
12719 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12720 followed by a shifted letter.
12721
12722 @kindex m O
12723 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12724 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12725 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12726 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12727 in this mode.
12728
12729 @kindex m N
12730 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12731 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12732 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12733 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12734 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12735 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12736 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12737 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12738 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12739 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12740 elements are constant.
12741
12742 @kindex m D
12743 @pindex calc-default-simplify-mode
12744 The @kbd{m D} (@code{calc-default-simplify-mode}) command restores the
12745 default simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12746 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12747 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12748 @texline @t{deriv}@expr{(x^2,x)}
12749 @infoline @expr{@t{deriv}(x^2, x)}
12750 to @expr{2 x}.
12751
12752 @kindex m B
12753 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12754 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the default
12755 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12756 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12757 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12758 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12759 results (after the default simplifications) are left alone.
12760
12761 @kindex m A
12762 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12763 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does algebraic
12764 simplification; it applies all the default simplifications, and also
12765 the more powerful (and slower) simplifications made by @kbd{a s}
12766 (@code{calc-simplify}). @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12767
12768 @kindex m E
12769 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12770 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended''
12771 algebraic simplification, as by the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended})
12772 command. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12773
12774 @kindex m U
12775 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12776 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12777 simplification; it applies the command @kbd{u s}
12778 (@code{calc-simplify-units}), which in turn
12779 is a superset of @kbd{a s}. In this mode, variable names which
12780 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12781 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12782
12783 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12784 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12785 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12786 perform higher types of simplifications on demand. @xref{Algebraic
12787 Definitions}, for another sample use of No-Simplification mode.
12788
12789 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12790 @section Declarations
12791
12792 @noindent
12793 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12794 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12795 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12796 take the fully general situation into account.
12797
12798 @menu
12799 * Declaration Basics::
12800 * Kinds of Declarations::
12801 * Functions for Declarations::
12802 @end menu
12803
12804 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12805 @subsection Declaration Basics
12806
12807 @noindent
12808 @kindex s d
12809 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12810 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12811 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12812 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12813 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12814 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12815 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12816 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12817
12818 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12819 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12820 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12821 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12822 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12823 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12824 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12825 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12826
12827 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12828 @vindex Decls
12829 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12830 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12831 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12832 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12833 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12834 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12835 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12836 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12837 permanently if you wish.
12838
12839 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12840 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12841 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12842 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12843 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12844
12845 For example, the declaration matrix
12846
12847 @smallexample
12848 @group
12849 [ [ foo, real ]
12850 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12851 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12852 @end group
12853 @end smallexample
12854
12855 @noindent
12856 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12857 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12858 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12859
12860 @vindex All
12861 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12862 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12863 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12864 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12865 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12866 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12867 response to the variable-name prompt.
12868
12869 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12870 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12871
12872 @noindent
12873 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12874 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12875 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12876 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12877 for the variable.
12878
12879 @smallexample
12880 @group
12881 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12882 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12883 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12884 @end group
12885 @end smallexample
12886
12887 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12888 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12889 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12890 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12891 nearly equivalent (see below).
12892
12893 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12894 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12895 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12896 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12897
12898 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12899 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12900 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12901 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12902 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12903 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12904
12905 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12906 stored in a variable:
12907
12908 @table @code
12909 @item int
12910 Integers.
12911 @item numint
12912 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12913 @item frac
12914 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12915 @item rat
12916 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12917 @item float
12918 Floating-point numbers.
12919 @item real
12920 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12921 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12922 reals here.)
12923 @item pos
12924 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12925 @item nonneg
12926 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12927 @item number
12928 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12929 @end table
12930
12931 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12932 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12933 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12934 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12935 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12936 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12937 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12938 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12939 of the formula.
12940
12941 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12942 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12943 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12944 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12945 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12946 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12947
12948 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12949 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12950 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12951 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12952 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12953
12954 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12955 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12956 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12957 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12958 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12959 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12960
12961 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12962 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12963 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12964 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12965 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12966 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12967 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12968 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12969 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12970 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12971
12972 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12973 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12974
12975 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12976 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12977 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12978 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12979 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12980 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12981 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12982
12983 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12984 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12985 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12986 type symbol.
12987
12988 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12989 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12990 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12991 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12992 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12993
12994 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12995 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12996 shown above).
12997
12998 Another command that makes use of declarations is @kbd{a s}, when
12999 simplifying equations and inequalities. It will cancel @code{x}
13000 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
13001 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
13002 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
13003 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
13004 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
13005 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
13006 including cancelling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
13007 not known to be nonzero.
13008
13009 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
13010
13011 @table @code
13012 @item scalar
13013 The value is not a vector.
13014 @item vector
13015 The value is a vector.
13016 @item matrix
13017 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
13018 @end table
13019
13020 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
13021 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
13022 is a matrix of integers.
13023
13024 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
13025 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
13026 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
13027 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
13028 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
13029 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
13030 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
13031 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
13032 declarations.)
13033
13034 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
13035 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
13036 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
13037
13038 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
13039 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
13040
13041 @table @code
13042 @item const
13043 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
13044 @end table
13045
13046 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
13047 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
13048 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
13049 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
13050 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
13051 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
13052 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
13053 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
13054 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
13055 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
13056
13057 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
13058 @subsection Functions for Declarations
13059
13060 @noindent
13061 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
13062 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
13063 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
13064 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
13065 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
13066 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
13067 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
13068 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
13069 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
13070
13071 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
13072 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
13073 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
13074 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
13075 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
13076
13077 @ignore
13078 @starindex
13079 @end ignore
13080 @tindex dint
13081 @ignore
13082 @starindex
13083 @end ignore
13084 @tindex dnumint
13085 @ignore
13086 @starindex
13087 @end ignore
13088 @tindex dnatnum
13089 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
13090 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
13091 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
13092 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
13093 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
13094 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
13095 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
13096 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
13097
13098 @ignore
13099 @starindex
13100 @end ignore
13101 @tindex drat
13102 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
13103 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
13104 and error forms do not.
13105
13106 @ignore
13107 @starindex
13108 @end ignore
13109 @tindex dreal
13110 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
13111 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
13112
13113 @ignore
13114 @starindex
13115 @end ignore
13116 @tindex dimag
13117 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
13118 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
13119
13120 @ignore
13121 @starindex
13122 @end ignore
13123 @tindex dpos
13124 @ignore
13125 @starindex
13126 @end ignore
13127 @tindex dneg
13128 @ignore
13129 @starindex
13130 @end ignore
13131 @tindex dnonneg
13132 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
13133 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
13134 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
13135 equal to zero. Note that the @kbd{a s} command can simplify an
13136 expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}, and that
13137 @kbd{a s} is effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules,
13138 so the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
13139 are rarely necessary.
13140
13141 @ignore
13142 @starindex
13143 @end ignore
13144 @tindex dnonzero
13145 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13146 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13147 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13148 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13149 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13150 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13151 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13152
13153 @ignore
13154 @starindex
13155 @end ignore
13156 @tindex deven
13157 @ignore
13158 @starindex
13159 @end ignore
13160 @tindex dodd
13161 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13162 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13163 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13164 The @kbd{a s} command uses this to simplify a test of the form
13165 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13166
13167 @ignore
13168 @starindex
13169 @end ignore
13170 @tindex drange
13171 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13172 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13173 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13174 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13175 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13176 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13177 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13178 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13179 remains unevaluated.
13180
13181 @ignore
13182 @starindex
13183 @end ignore
13184 @tindex dscalar
13185 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13186 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13187 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13188 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13189 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13190 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13191 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13192 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13193 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13194 information to tell.
13195
13196 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13197 @section Display Modes
13198
13199 @noindent
13200 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13201 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13202 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13203 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13204 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13205 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13206
13207 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13208 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13209 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13210 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13211 reflect the latest mode settings.
13212
13213 @kindex d @key{RET}
13214 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13215 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13216 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13217 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13218 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13219 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13220 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13221 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13222
13223 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13224 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13225 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13226 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13227
13228 @menu
13229 * Radix Modes::
13230 * Grouping Digits::
13231 * Float Formats::
13232 * Complex Formats::
13233 * Fraction Formats::
13234 * HMS Formats::
13235 * Date Formats::
13236 * Truncating the Stack::
13237 * Justification::
13238 * Labels::
13239 @end menu
13240
13241 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13242 @subsection Radix Modes
13243
13244 @noindent
13245 @cindex Radix display
13246 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13247 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13248 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13249 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13250 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13251 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13252 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13253
13254 @kindex d 2
13255 @kindex d 8
13256 @kindex d 6
13257 @kindex d 0
13258 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13259 @cindex Octal integers
13260 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13261 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13262 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13263 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13264 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13265 as decimal.
13266
13267 @kindex d r
13268 @pindex calc-radix
13269 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13270 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13271 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13272
13273 @kindex d z
13274 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13275 @cindex Leading zeros
13276 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13277 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13278 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13279 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13280 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13281 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13282 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13283 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13284 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13285 entirety.)
13286
13287 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13288 @subsection Grouping Digits
13289
13290 @noindent
13291 @kindex d g
13292 @pindex calc-group-digits
13293 @cindex Grouping digits
13294 @cindex Digit grouping
13295 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13296 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13297 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13298 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13299 separated by commas.
13300
13301 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13302 With a numerix prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13303 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13304 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13305 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13306 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13307 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13308
13309 @kindex d ,
13310 @pindex calc-group-char
13311 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13312 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13313 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13314 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13315 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13316 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13317 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13318
13319 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13320 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{M-# y} and @kbd{M-# g}.
13321 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13322 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13323 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13324
13325 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13326 @subsection Float Formats
13327
13328 @noindent
13329 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13330 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13331 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13332 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13333 formats for floats.
13334
13335 @kindex d n
13336 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13337 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13338 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13339 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13340 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13341 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13342 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13343 current precision is 12.)
13344
13345 @kindex d f
13346 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13347 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13348 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13349 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13350 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13351 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13352 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13353 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13354
13355 @kindex d s
13356 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13357 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13358 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13359 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13360 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13361 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13362 The default is to display all significant digits.
13363
13364 @kindex d e
13365 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13366 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13367 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13368 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13369 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13370 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13371 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13372
13373 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13374 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13375 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13376 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13377 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13378 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13379 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13380 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{M-# y} which operate on the
13381 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13382
13383 @kindex d .
13384 @pindex calc-point-char
13385 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13386 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13387 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13388 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13389 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13390
13391 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13392 @subsection Complex Formats
13393
13394 @noindent
13395 @kindex d c
13396 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13397 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13398 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13399 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13400 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13401
13402 @kindex d i
13403 @pindex calc-i-notation
13404 @kindex d j
13405 @pindex calc-j-notation
13406 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13407 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13408 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13409 in some disciplines.
13410
13411 @cindex @code{i} variable
13412 @vindex i
13413 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13414 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13415 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13416 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13417 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13418 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13419 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13420 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13421
13422 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13423 @subsection Fraction Formats
13424
13425 @noindent
13426 @kindex d o
13427 @pindex calc-over-notation
13428 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13429 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13430 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13431 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13432 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13433 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13434 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13435 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13436
13437 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13438 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13439 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13440 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13441 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13442
13443 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13444 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13445 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13446 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13447 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13448 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13449 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13450 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13451 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13452 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13453 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13454
13455 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13456 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13457 never affects floats.
13458
13459 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13460 @subsection HMS Formats
13461
13462 @noindent
13463 @kindex d h
13464 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13465 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13466 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13467 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13468 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13469 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13470 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13471 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13472
13473 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13474 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13475 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13476 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13477 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13478 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13479 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13480 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13481 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13482 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13483 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13484 entry.
13485
13486 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13487 @subsection Date Formats
13488
13489 @noindent
13490 @kindex d d
13491 @pindex calc-date-notation
13492 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13493 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13494 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13495 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13496 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13497 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13498 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13499 pure dates.
13500
13501 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13502 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13503 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13504 reestablished.
13505
13506 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13507 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13508 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13509
13510 @menu
13511 * Date Formatting Codes::
13512 * Free-Form Dates::
13513 * Standard Date Formats::
13514 @end menu
13515
13516 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13517 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13518
13519 @noindent
13520 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13521 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13522 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13523 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13524 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13525 below.
13526
13527 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13528 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13529 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13530 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13531 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13532 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13533 since Jan 1, 1 AD. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13534 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13535
13536 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13537
13538 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13539 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13540 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13541 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13542 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13543
13544 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13545
13546 @table @asis
13547 @item Y
13548 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13549 @item YY
13550 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13551 @item BY
13552 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13553 @item YYY
13554 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13555 @item YYYY
13556 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13557 @item aa
13558 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13559 @item AA
13560 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13561 @item aaa
13562 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13563 @item AAA
13564 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13565 @item aaaa
13566 Year: ``a.d.'' or blank.
13567 @item AAAA
13568 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13569 @item bb
13570 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13571 @item BB
13572 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13573 @item bbb
13574 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13575 @item BBB
13576 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13577 @item bbbb
13578 Year: ``b.c.'' or blank.
13579 @item BBBB
13580 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13581 @item M
13582 Month: ``8'' for August.
13583 @item MM
13584 Month: ``08'' for August.
13585 @item BM
13586 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13587 @item MMM
13588 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13589 @item Mmm
13590 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13591 @item mmm
13592 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13593 @item MMMM
13594 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13595 @item Mmmm
13596 Month: ``August'' for August.
13597 @item D
13598 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13599 @item DD
13600 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13601 @item BD
13602 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13603 @item W
13604 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13605 @item WWW
13606 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13607 @item Www
13608 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13609 @item www
13610 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13611 @item WWWW
13612 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13613 @item Wwww
13614 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13615 @item d
13616 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13617 @item ddd
13618 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13619 @item bdd
13620 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13621 @item h
13622 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13623 @item hh
13624 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13625 @item bh
13626 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13627 @item H
13628 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13629 @item HH
13630 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13631 @item BH
13632 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13633 @item p
13634 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13635 @item P
13636 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13637 @item pp
13638 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13639 @item PP
13640 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13641 @item pppp
13642 AM/PM: ``a.m.'' or ``p.m.''.
13643 @item PPPP
13644 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13645 @item m
13646 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13647 @item mm
13648 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13649 @item bm
13650 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13651 @item s
13652 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13653 @item ss
13654 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13655 @item bs
13656 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13657 @item SS
13658 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13659 @item BS
13660 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13661 @item N
13662 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13663 @item n
13664 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13665 @item J
13666 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13667 @item j
13668 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13669 @item U
13670 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13671 @item X
13672 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13673 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13674 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13675 required for algebraic entry.
13676 @end table
13677
13678 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13679 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13680
13681 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13682 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13683 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13684 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13685 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13686
13687 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13688 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13689 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13690 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13691 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13692
13693 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13694 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13695 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13696
13697 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13698 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13699
13700 @noindent
13701 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13702 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13703 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13704 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13705 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13706
13707 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13708 while interpreting dates.
13709
13710 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13711 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13712 the date.
13713
13714 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13715 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13716 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13717 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13718 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13719 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13720 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13721 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13722 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13723 recognized with no number attached.
13724
13725 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13726 format.
13727
13728 To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13729 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13730 be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13731 are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13732 abbreviations.
13733
13734 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13735 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13736 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13737 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13738 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13739 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13740 current year is taken from the system clock.
13741
13742 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13743 words, then the input is rejected.
13744
13745 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13746 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13747 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13748 date components when the date was formatted.
13749
13750 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13751 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13752 minus sign on the year value.
13753
13754 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13755 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13756
13757 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13758 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13759
13760 @noindent
13761 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13762 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13763 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13764 to select the other formats.
13765
13766 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13767 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13768 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13769 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13770 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13771 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13772
13773 @table @asis
13774 @item 0
13775 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13776 @item 1
13777 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13778 @item 2
13779 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13780 @item 3
13781 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13782 @item 4
13783 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13784 @item 5
13785 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13786 @item 6
13787 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13788 @item 7
13789 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13790 @item 8
13791 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13792 @item 9
13793 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13794 @end table
13795
13796 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13797 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13798
13799 @noindent
13800 @kindex d t
13801 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13802 @cindex Truncating the stack
13803 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13804 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13805 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13806 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13807 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13808 operations. This is similar to the Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except
13809 that the values below the @samp{.} are @emph{visible}, just temporarily
13810 frozen. This feature allows you to keep several independent calculations
13811 running at once in different parts of the stack, or to apply a certain
13812 command to an element buried deep in the stack.
13813
13814 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13815 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13816 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13817 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13818 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13819 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13820 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13821
13822 @kindex d [
13823 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13824 @kindex d ]
13825 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13826 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13827 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13828 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13829
13830 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13831 @subsection Justification
13832
13833 @noindent
13834 @kindex d <
13835 @pindex calc-left-justify
13836 @kindex d =
13837 @pindex calc-center-justify
13838 @kindex d >
13839 @pindex calc-right-justify
13840 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13841 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13842 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13843 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13844 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13845 window.
13846
13847 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13848 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13849 text.
13850
13851 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13852 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13853 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13854
13855 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13856 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13857 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13858 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13859 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13860 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13861 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13862 mode.
13863
13864 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13865 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13866 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13867 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13868 line is indented to the origin.
13869
13870 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13871 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13872 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13873 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13874 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13875 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13876
13877 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13878 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13879 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13880 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13881 line width or Calc window width is used.
13882
13883 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13884 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13885 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13886 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13887 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13888 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13889 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13890
13891 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13892 @subsection Labels
13893
13894 @noindent
13895 @kindex d @{
13896 @pindex calc-left-label
13897 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13898 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13899 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13900 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13901 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13902 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13903 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13904
13905 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13906
13907 @kindex d @}
13908 @pindex calc-right-label
13909 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13910 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13911 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13912 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13913 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13914 justified to the line width.
13915
13916 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13917 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13918 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13919 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13920 left or right as you prefer.
13921
13922 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13923 @section Language Modes
13924
13925 @noindent
13926 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13927 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13928 other common language such as Pascal or @TeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13929 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13930 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13931 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13932
13933 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13934 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13935 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13936 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13937
13938 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13939 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13940 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13941 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u M-# g} to grab the formula
13942 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13943 to the first variable, and @kbd{M-# y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13944 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13945 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13946
13947 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13948 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13949 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13950 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13951 multiplication) which would not have been legal for a C program.
13952
13953 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a @TeX{}
13954 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13955 formula from the program in C mode, switch to @TeX{} mode, and yank the
13956 formula into the document in @TeX{} math-mode format.
13957
13958 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13959 shifted letter key.
13960
13961 @menu
13962 * Normal Language Modes::
13963 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13964 * TeX Language Mode::
13965 * Eqn Language Mode::
13966 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13967 * Maple Language Mode::
13968 * Compositions::
13969 * Syntax Tables::
13970 @end menu
13971
13972 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13973 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13974
13975 @noindent
13976 @kindex d N
13977 @pindex calc-normal-language
13978 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13979 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13980 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13981 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13982 keyboard.
13983
13984 @kindex d O
13985 @pindex calc-flat-language
13986 @cindex Matrix display
13987 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13988 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13989 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13990 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13991
13992 @kindex d b
13993 @pindex calc-line-breaking
13994 @cindex Line breaking
13995 @cindex Breaking up long lines
13996 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13997 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13998 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13999 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
14000 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
14001 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
14002 long lines.
14003
14004 @kindex d B
14005 @pindex calc-big-language
14006 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
14007 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
14008 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
14009
14010 @example
14011 ____________
14012 | a + 1 2
14013 | ----- + c
14014 \| b
14015 @end example
14016
14017 @noindent
14018 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
14019
14020 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
14021 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
14022 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
14023 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
14024 notation.
14025
14026 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
14027
14028 @example
14029 3
14030 - -
14031 4
14032 @end example
14033
14034 @noindent
14035 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
14036 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
14037 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
14038 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
14039 typical use.
14040
14041 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
14042 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
14043 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
14044 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
14045 in Big mode.
14046
14047 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
14048 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
14049 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
14050 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
14051 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
14052
14053 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
14054 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
14055 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
14056 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
14057
14058 @kindex d U
14059 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
14060 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
14061 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
14062 shown above would be displayed:
14063
14064 @example
14065 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
14066 @end example
14067
14068 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
14069 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
14070 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
14071 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
14072 parentheses).
14073
14074 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX Language Mode, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
14075 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
14076
14077 @noindent
14078 @kindex d C
14079 @pindex calc-c-language
14080 @cindex C language
14081 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
14082 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
14083 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
14084 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
14085 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
14086 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
14087 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
14088
14089 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
14090 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
14091 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
14092 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
14093 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
14094 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
14095 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
14096
14097 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
14098 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
14099 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
14100 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
14101 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
14102 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
14103 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
14104 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
14105
14106 @kindex d P
14107 @pindex calc-pascal-language
14108 @cindex Pascal language
14109 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14110 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14111 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14112 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14113 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14114 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
14115 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14116 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14117 of handling these in Pascal.
14118
14119 @kindex d F
14120 @pindex calc-fortran-language
14121 @cindex FORTRAN language
14122 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14123 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14124 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14125 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14126 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14127 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14128 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
14129 Also, if the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14130 @code{vector} or @code{matrix} then @samp{a(i)} will be parsed as a
14131 subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't matter, though;
14132 if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and Calc interprets
14133 it as a function call, you'll never know the difference unless you
14134 switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an actual
14135 vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
14136 function!).
14137
14138 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14139 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14140 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14141
14142 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14143 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14144 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14145 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14146 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14147 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14148
14149 @node TeX Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14150 @subsection @TeX{} Language Mode
14151
14152 @noindent
14153 @kindex d T
14154 @pindex calc-tex-language
14155 @cindex TeX language
14156 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14157 of ``math mode'' in the @TeX{} typesetting language, by Donald Knuth.
14158 Formulas are entered
14159 and displayed in @TeX{} notation, as in @samp{\sin\left( a \over b \right)}.
14160 Math formulas are usually enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{}; these
14161 should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc, the @samp{$} sign
14162 has the same meaning it always does in algebraic formulas (a reference to
14163 an existing entry on the stack).
14164
14165 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14166 quotients are written using @code{\over};
14167 binomial coefficients are written with @code{\choose}.
14168 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and
14169 error forms are written with @code{\pm}.
14170 Absolute values are written as in @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and
14171 ceiling functions are written with @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc.
14172 The words @code{\left} and @code{\right} are ignored when reading
14173 formulas in @TeX{} mode. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written
14174 as @code{\infty}; when read, @code{\infty} always translates to
14175 @code{inf}.
14176
14177 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14178 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{} has
14179 special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces instead of
14180 parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly braces and
14181 parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the document is
14182 formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the printed result is
14183 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14184 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14185 but
14186 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14187 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14188
14189 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} are simply
14190 written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in italic letters
14191 in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} with a positive numeric
14192 prefix argument, names of more than one character will instead be written
14193 @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}}. The @samp{\hbox@{ @}} notation is ignored
14194 during reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function
14195 names are written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin
14196 with @code{\} during reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that
14197 in this mode, long variable names are still written with @code{\hbox}.
14198 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar}
14199 in any @TeX{} mode.)
14200
14201 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14202 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14203 @code{\bmatrix}. The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14204 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14205 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14206 format; you may need to edit this afterwards to change @code{\matrix}
14207 to @code{\pmatrix} or @code{\\} to @code{\cr}.
14208
14209 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14210 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14211 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14212 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14213 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14214 in Calc, @TeX{}, and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14215
14216 @iftex
14217 @begingroup
14218 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14219 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14220 @end iftex
14221 @ignore
14222 @starindex
14223 @end ignore
14224 @tindex acute
14225 @ignore
14226 @starindex
14227 @end ignore
14228 @tindex bar
14229 @ignore
14230 @starindex
14231 @end ignore
14232 @tindex breve
14233 @ignore
14234 @starindex
14235 @end ignore
14236 @tindex check
14237 @ignore
14238 @starindex
14239 @end ignore
14240 @tindex dot
14241 @ignore
14242 @starindex
14243 @end ignore
14244 @tindex dotdot
14245 @ignore
14246 @starindex
14247 @end ignore
14248 @tindex dyad
14249 @ignore
14250 @starindex
14251 @end ignore
14252 @tindex grave
14253 @ignore
14254 @starindex
14255 @end ignore
14256 @tindex hat
14257 @ignore
14258 @starindex
14259 @end ignore
14260 @tindex Prime
14261 @ignore
14262 @starindex
14263 @end ignore
14264 @tindex tilde
14265 @ignore
14266 @starindex
14267 @end ignore
14268 @tindex under
14269 @ignore
14270 @starindex
14271 @end ignore
14272 @tindex Vec
14273 @iftex
14274 @endgroup
14275 @end iftex
14276 @example
14277 Calc TeX eqn
14278 ---- --- ---
14279 acute \acute
14280 bar \bar bar
14281 breve \breve
14282 check \check
14283 dot \dot dot
14284 dotdot \ddot dotdot
14285 dyad dyad
14286 grave \grave
14287 hat \hat hat
14288 Prime prime
14289 tilde \tilde tilde
14290 under \underline under
14291 Vec \vec vec
14292 @end example
14293
14294 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14295 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14296 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14297 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14298 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14299 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14300 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14301 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14302
14303 @example
14304 \def\evalto@{@}
14305 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14306 @end example
14307
14308 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14309 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14310 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14311 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14312 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14313 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14314
14315 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14316 reading is:
14317
14318 @example
14319 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14320 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14321 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14322 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14323 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14324 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14325 \evalto
14326 @end example
14327
14328 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} formula
14329 into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and font information.
14330
14331 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14332 the same as @samp{*}.
14333
14334 @ifinfo
14335 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14336 end of this section.
14337 @end ifinfo
14338 @iftex
14339 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14340
14341 @example
14342 @group
14343 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14344 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14345 @end group
14346 @end example
14347 @tex
14348 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14349 @end tex
14350 @sp 1
14351
14352 @example
14353 @group
14354 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14355 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14356 @end group
14357 @end example
14358 @tex
14359 \turnoffactive
14360 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14361 @end tex
14362 @sp 1
14363
14364 @example
14365 @group
14366 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14367 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14368 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14369 @end group
14370 @end example
14371 @tex
14372 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14373 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14374 @end tex
14375 @sp 1
14376
14377 @example
14378 @group
14379 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14380 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14381 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14382 @end group
14383 @end example
14384 @tex
14385 \turnoffactive
14386 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14387 @end tex
14388 @sp 2
14389
14390 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14391 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14392 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14393
14394 @example
14395 @group
14396 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14397 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14398 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14399 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14400 @end group
14401 @end example
14402 @tex
14403 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14404 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14405 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14406 @end tex
14407 @sp 2
14408
14409 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14410
14411 @example
14412 @group
14413 2 + 3 => 5
14414 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14415 @end group
14416 @end example
14417 @tex
14418 \turnoffactive
14419 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14420 $$ 5 $$
14421 @end tex
14422 @sp 2
14423
14424 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14425
14426 @example
14427 @group
14428 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14429 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14430 @end group
14431 @end example
14432 @tex
14433 \turnoffactive
14434 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14435 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14436 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14437 @end tex
14438 @sp 2
14439
14440 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14441
14442 @example
14443 @group
14444 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14445 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14446 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14447 @end group
14448 @end example
14449 @tex
14450 \turnoffactive
14451 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14452 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14453 @end tex
14454 @sp 2
14455 @end iftex
14456
14457 @node Eqn Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, TeX Language Mode, Language Modes
14458 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14459
14460 @noindent
14461 @kindex d E
14462 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14463 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14464 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14465 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14466 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14467
14468 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14469 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14470 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14471 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14472 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14473 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14474
14475 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14476 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14477 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14478 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14479 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14480 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14481 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14482
14483 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14484 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14485 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14486 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14487 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14488 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14489 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14490 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14491 names, too.)
14492
14493 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14494 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14495 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14496 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14497 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14498
14499 As in @TeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14500 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14501 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14502 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14503
14504 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14505 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14506 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14507 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14508 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14509 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14510 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14511
14512 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14513 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally. @xref{TeX Language
14514 Mode}, for a table of these accent functions. The @code{prime} accent
14515 is treated specially if it occurs on a variable or function name:
14516 @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is stored internally as
14517 @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the derivative of @samp{f(2 x)}
14518 with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode
14519 will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14520
14521 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14522 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14523 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX Language Mode}, for a discussion
14524 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14525 recognized for these operators during reading.
14526
14527 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14528 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14529 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14530 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14531 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14532
14533 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14534 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14535
14536 @noindent
14537 @kindex d M
14538 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14539 @cindex Mathematica language
14540 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14541 conventions of Mathematica, a powerful and popular mathematical tool
14542 from Wolfram Research, Inc. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14543 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14544 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14545 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14546 Mathematica mode.
14547
14548 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14549 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14550 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14551 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14552 Mathematica mode.
14553 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14554 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14555 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14556
14557 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14558 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14559
14560 @noindent
14561 @kindex d W
14562 @pindex calc-maple-language
14563 @cindex Maple language
14564 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14565 conventions of Maple, another mathematical tool from the University
14566 of Waterloo.
14567
14568 Maple's language is much like C. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14569 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14570 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14571 denote powers.
14572
14573 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14574 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14575 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14576 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14577 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14578 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14579
14580 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14581 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]}, and
14582 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot
14583 see the difference between an open and a closed interval while in
14584 Maple display mode.
14585
14586 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14587 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14588 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14589 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14590
14591 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14592 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14593 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14594
14595 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14596 @subsection Compositions
14597
14598 @noindent
14599 @cindex Compositions
14600 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14601 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14602 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14603 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14604 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14605
14606 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14607 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14608 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14609 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14610 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14611 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14612 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14613 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14614
14615 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14616 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14617 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14618 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14619 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14620 the language modes.
14621
14622 @menu
14623 * Composition Basics::
14624 * Horizontal Compositions::
14625 * Vertical Compositions::
14626 * Other Compositions::
14627 * Information about Compositions::
14628 * User-Defined Compositions::
14629 @end menu
14630
14631 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14632 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14633
14634 @noindent
14635 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14636 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14637 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14638 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14639 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14640 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14641 For example, in the Big mode formula
14642
14643 @example
14644 @group
14645 2
14646 a + b
14647 17 + ------
14648 c
14649 @end group
14650 @end example
14651
14652 @noindent
14653 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14654 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14655 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14656
14657 @tex
14658 \bigskip
14659 @end tex
14660
14661 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14662 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14663 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14664 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14665 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14666
14667 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14668 following precedences:
14669
14670 @example
14671 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14672 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14673 - 1000 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14674 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14675 mod 400
14676 +/- 300
14677 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14678 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14679 ^ 200
14680 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14681 / % \ 190
14682 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14683 | 170
14684 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14685 && 110
14686 || 100
14687 ? : 90
14688 !!! 85
14689 &&& 80
14690 ||| 75
14691 := 50
14692 :: 45
14693 => 40
14694 @end example
14695
14696 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14697 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14698 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14699 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14700 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14701 normally never get additional parentheses).
14702
14703 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14704 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14705 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14706 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14707 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14708 with one-higher precedence.
14709
14710 @ignore
14711 @starindex
14712 @end ignore
14713 @tindex cprec
14714 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14715 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14716 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14717 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14718 precedence than multiplication).
14719
14720 @tex
14721 \bigskip
14722 @end tex
14723
14724 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14725 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14726 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14727 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14728 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14729 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14730 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14731 view them.
14732
14733 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14734 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14735 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14736 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14737 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14738 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14739 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14740 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14741 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14742
14743 @example
14744 @group
14745 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14746 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14747 @end group
14748 @end example
14749
14750 @noindent
14751 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14752 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14753 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14754 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14755 itself been too large to fit.
14756
14757 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14758 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14759 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14760 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14761 end of the string.
14762
14763 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14764 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14765 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14766 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14767 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14768 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14769 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14770 object.
14771
14772 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14773 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14774
14775 @noindent
14776 @ignore
14777 @starindex
14778 @end ignore
14779 @tindex choriz
14780 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14781 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14782 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14783
14784 @example
14785 @group
14786 a b
14787 17---d
14788 c
14789 @end group
14790 @end example
14791
14792 @noindent
14793 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14794 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14795 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14796 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14797 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14798 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14799
14800 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14801 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14802 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14803 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14804 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14805 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14806
14807 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14808 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14809 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14810 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14811 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14812
14813 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14814 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14815
14816 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14817 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14818
14819 @noindent
14820 @ignore
14821 @starindex
14822 @end ignore
14823 @tindex cvert
14824 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14825 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14826 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14827 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14828 formats in Big mode as
14829
14830 @example
14831 @group
14832 f( a , 2 )
14833 bb a + 1
14834 ccc 2
14835 b
14836 @end group
14837 @end example
14838
14839 @ignore
14840 @starindex
14841 @end ignore
14842 @tindex cbase
14843 There are several special composition functions that work only as
14844 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14845 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14846 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14847 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14848 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14849
14850 @example
14851 @group
14852 2
14853 a + 1
14854 a 2
14855 f(bb , b )
14856 ccc
14857 @end group
14858 @end example
14859
14860 @ignore
14861 @starindex
14862 @end ignore
14863 @tindex ctbase
14864 @ignore
14865 @starindex
14866 @end ignore
14867 @tindex cbbase
14868 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14869 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14870 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14871 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14872 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14873
14874 @example
14875 @group
14876 a
14877 a -
14878 - + a + b
14879 b -
14880 b
14881 @end group
14882 @end example
14883
14884 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14885 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14886 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14887 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14888 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14889 item.
14890
14891 @ignore
14892 @starindex
14893 @end ignore
14894 @tindex crule
14895 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
14896 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
14897 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
14898 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
14899 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
14900 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
14901 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
14902
14903 @example
14904 @group
14905 a + 1
14906 =====
14907 2
14908 b
14909 @end group
14910 @end example
14911
14912 @ignore
14913 @starindex
14914 @end ignore
14915 @tindex clvert
14916 @ignore
14917 @starindex
14918 @end ignore
14919 @tindex crvert
14920 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
14921 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
14922 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
14923 gives:
14924
14925 @example
14926 @group
14927 a + a
14928 bb bb
14929 ccc ccc
14930 @end group
14931 @end example
14932
14933 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
14934 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
14935 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
14936
14937 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
14938 @subsubsection Other Compositions
14939
14940 @noindent
14941 @ignore
14942 @starindex
14943 @end ignore
14944 @tindex csup
14945 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
14946 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
14947 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
14948 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
14949 bottom line is one above the baseline.
14950
14951 @ignore
14952 @starindex
14953 @end ignore
14954 @tindex csub
14955 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
14956 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
14957 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
14958 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
14959 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
14960
14961 @ignore
14962 @starindex
14963 @end ignore
14964 @tindex cflat
14965 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
14966 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
14967 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
14968 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
14969 to improve its readability.
14970
14971 @ignore
14972 @starindex
14973 @end ignore
14974 @tindex cspace
14975 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
14976 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
14977 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
14978 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
14979 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
14980 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
14981 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
14982
14983 @example
14984 @group
14985 2 2 2 2
14986 a a a a
14987 @end group
14988 @end example
14989
14990 @noindent
14991 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
14992
14993 @ignore
14994 @starindex
14995 @end ignore
14996 @tindex cvspace
14997 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
14998 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
14999 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15000 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15001 height if used in a vertical composition.
15002
15003 @ignore
15004 @starindex
15005 @end ignore
15006 @tindex ctspace
15007 @ignore
15008 @starindex
15009 @end ignore
15010 @tindex cbspace
15011 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15012 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15013 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15014 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15015 displays as:
15016
15017 @example
15018 @group
15019 a
15020 -
15021 a b
15022 - a a
15023 b + - + -
15024 a b b
15025 - a
15026 b -
15027 b
15028 @end group
15029 @end example
15030
15031 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15032 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15033
15034 @noindent
15035 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15036 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15037 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15038
15039 @ignore
15040 @starindex
15041 @end ignore
15042 @tindex cwidth
15043 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15044 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15045 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15046 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15047 the composition functions described in this section.
15048
15049 @ignore
15050 @starindex
15051 @end ignore
15052 @tindex cheight
15053 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15054 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15055
15056 @ignore
15057 @starindex
15058 @end ignore
15059 @tindex cascent
15060 @ignore
15061 @starindex
15062 @end ignore
15063 @tindex cdescent
15064 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15065 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15066 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15067 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15068 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15069 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15070 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15071 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15072
15073 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15074 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15075
15076 @noindent
15077 @kindex Z C
15078 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15079 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15080 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15081 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15082 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15083 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15084 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15085 replaced.
15086
15087 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15088 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15089 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15090 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15091 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15092 affect the display at all.
15093
15094 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15095 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15096 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15097 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15098 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15099 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15100 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15101 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15102 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15103 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15104
15105 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15106 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15107 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15108
15109 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15110 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15111
15112 @example
15113 @group
15114 n
15115 ( )
15116 m
15117 @end group
15118 @end example
15119
15120 @noindent
15121 You might prefer the notation,
15122
15123 @example
15124 @group
15125 C
15126 n m
15127 @end group
15128 @end example
15129
15130 @noindent
15131 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15132 then put the formula
15133
15134 @smallexample
15135 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15136 @end smallexample
15137
15138 @noindent
15139 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15140 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15141 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15142 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15143 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15144 as an algebraic entry.
15145
15146 @example
15147 @group
15148 C + C
15149 a b 7 3
15150 @end group
15151 @end example
15152
15153 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15154 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15155 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15156 instead of parentheses.
15157
15158 @smallexample
15159 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15160 @end smallexample
15161
15162 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15163 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15164
15165 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15166 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15167 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15168 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15169 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15170 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15171 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15172 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15173 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15174 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15175 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15176 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15177
15178 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15179 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15180 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15181 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15182 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15183 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15184 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15185 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15186 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15187 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15188 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15189 symbolic form.
15190
15191 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15192 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15193 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15194 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15195 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15196 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15197 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15198 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15199 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15200
15201 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15202 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15203
15204 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15205 @subsection Syntax Tables
15206
15207 @noindent
15208 @cindex Syntax tables
15209 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15210 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15211 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15212 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15213
15214 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15215 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15216
15217 @kindex Z S
15218 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15219 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15220 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15221 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15222 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15223 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15224 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15225 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15226
15227 @menu
15228 * Syntax Table Basics::
15229 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15230 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15231 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15232 @end menu
15233
15234 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15235 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15236
15237 @noindent
15238 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15239 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15240 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15241 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15242 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15243 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15244 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15245 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15246 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15247 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15248
15249 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15250 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15251 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15252 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15253 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15254 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15255 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15256 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15257 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15258 completely different.)
15259
15260 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15261 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15262 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15263
15264 @example
15265 foo ( ) := 2+3
15266 @end example
15267
15268 @noindent
15269 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15270 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15271 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15272 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15273 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15274 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15275 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15276 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15277 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15278 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15279 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15280 calls would no longer recognize it!
15281
15282 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15283 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15284 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15285
15286 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15287 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15288 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15289 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15290 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15291 and postfix operator, respectively:
15292
15293 @example
15294 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15295 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15296 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15297 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15298 @end example
15299
15300 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15301 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15302
15303 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15304 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15305 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15306 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15307 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15308 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15309 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15310 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15311 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15312 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15313 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15314 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15315
15316 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15317 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15318 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15319 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15320 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15321 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15322 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15323 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15324
15325 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15326 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15327 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15328 rule,
15329
15330 @example
15331 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15332 @end example
15333
15334 @noindent
15335 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15336 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15337 define these operators quite easily:
15338
15339 @example
15340 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15341 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15342 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15343 @end example
15344
15345 @noindent
15346 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15347 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15348 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15349 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15350
15351 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15352 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15353
15354 @example
15355 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15356 @end example
15357
15358 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15359 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15360 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15361 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15362 backslashes in tokens.)
15363
15364 @example
15365 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15366 @end example
15367
15368 @noindent
15369 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15370
15371 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15372 it is not legal to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15373 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15374 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15375 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15376 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15377 respectively).
15378
15379 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15380 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15381
15382 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15383 @subsubsection Precedence
15384
15385 @noindent
15386 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15387 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15388
15389 @example
15390 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15391 @end example
15392
15393 @noindent
15394 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15395 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15396 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15397 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15398 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15399 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15400
15401 @example
15402 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15403 @end example
15404
15405 @noindent
15406 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15407 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15408 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15409 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15410 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15411 can create a right-associative operator.
15412
15413 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15414 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15415 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15416
15417 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15418 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15419
15420 @noindent
15421 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15422 write
15423
15424 @example
15425 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15426 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15427 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15428 @end example
15429
15430 @noindent
15431 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15432 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15433 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15434
15435 @example
15436 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15437 @end example
15438
15439 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15440 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15441 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15442 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15443 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15444 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15445 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15446 several expressions separated by commas.
15447
15448 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15449 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15450 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15451 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15452 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15453 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15454
15455 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15456 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15457 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15458 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15459 always be an empty vector.
15460
15461 @example
15462 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15463 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15464 @end example
15465
15466 @noindent
15467 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15468 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15469 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15470 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15471 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15472
15473 @example
15474 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15475 @end example
15476
15477 @noindent
15478 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15479 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15480
15481 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15482 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15483 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15484
15485 @example
15486 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15487 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15488 @end example
15489
15490 @noindent
15491 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15492 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15493 empty vector is produced.
15494
15495 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15496 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15497 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15498 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15499 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15500 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15501 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15502 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15503 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15504 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15505 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15506 as optional.
15507
15508 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15509 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15510
15511 @example
15512 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15513 @end example
15514
15515 @noindent
15516 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15517 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15518 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15519 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15520 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15521 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15522 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15523
15524 @example
15525 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15526 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15527 @end example
15528
15529 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15530 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15531 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15532 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15533 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15534 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15535 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15536
15537 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15538 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15539
15540 @noindent
15541 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15542 example, the rules
15543
15544 @example
15545 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15546 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15547 @end example
15548
15549 @noindent
15550 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15551 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15552 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15553 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15554 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15555 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15556
15557 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15558 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15559 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15560 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15561 as if by the @w{@kbd{a s}} algebra command (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15562 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15563 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15564 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15565 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15566 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15567 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15568
15569 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15570 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15571 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15572 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15573 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15574 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15575
15576 @example
15577 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15578 @end example
15579
15580 @noindent
15581 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15582 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15583 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15584 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15585
15586 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15587 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15588 rules.
15589
15590 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15591 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15592 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15593 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15594 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15595 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15596
15597 @example
15598 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15599 @end example
15600
15601 @noindent
15602 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15603 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15604 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15605 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15606 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15607 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15608 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15609 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15610
15611 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15612 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15613
15614 @noindent
15615 @kindex m g
15616 @pindex calc-get-modes
15617 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15618 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15619 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15620 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15621 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15622 on the current mode settings.
15623
15624 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15625 @vindex Modes
15626 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15627 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15628 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15629 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15630 command will continue to work, however.)
15631
15632 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15633 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15634 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15635 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15636
15637 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15638
15639 @enumerate
15640 @item
15641 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15642
15643 @item
15644 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15645
15646 @item
15647 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15648 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15649
15650 @item
15651 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15652
15653 @item
15654 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15655 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15656 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15657 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15658 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15659 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15660 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15661 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15662 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15663 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15664
15665 @item
15666 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15667 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15668
15669 @item
15670 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15671
15672 @item
15673 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15674
15675 @item
15676 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15677 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15678
15679 @item
15680 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15681 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, or @var{N} for
15682 @texline @math{N\times N}
15683 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15684 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15685
15686 @item
15687 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15688 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15689 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15690
15691 @item
15692 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15693 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15694 @end enumerate
15695
15696 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15697 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15698 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15699 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15700 keyboard macro.)
15701
15702 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15703 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15704
15705 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15706 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15707 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15708 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15709 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15710 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15711
15712 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15713 @section The Calc Mode Line
15714
15715 @noindent
15716 @cindex Mode line indicators
15717 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15718 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15719 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15720
15721 The basic mode line format is:
15722
15723 @example
15724 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15725 @end example
15726
15727 The @samp{%%} is the Emacs symbol for ``read-only''; it shows that
15728 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15729 as if it were text.
15730
15731 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15732 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15733 that are in effect.
15734
15735 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15736 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15737 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15738
15739 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15740 on the mode line:
15741
15742 @table @code
15743 @item Alg
15744 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15745
15746 @item Alg[(
15747 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15748
15749 @item Alg*
15750 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15751
15752 @item Symb
15753 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15754
15755 @item Matrix
15756 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15757
15758 @item Matrix@var{n}
15759 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}).
15760
15761 @item Scalar
15762 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15763
15764 @item Polar
15765 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15766
15767 @item Frac
15768 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15769
15770 @item Inf
15771 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15772
15773 @item +Inf
15774 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15775
15776 @item NoSimp
15777 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15778
15779 @item NumSimp
15780 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15781
15782 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15783 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15784
15785 @item AlgSimp
15786 Algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m A}).
15787
15788 @item ExtSimp
15789 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15790
15791 @item UnitSimp
15792 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15793
15794 @item Bin
15795 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15796
15797 @item Oct
15798 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15799
15800 @item Hex
15801 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15802
15803 @item Radix@var{n}
15804 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15805
15806 @item Zero
15807 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15808
15809 @item Big
15810 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15811
15812 @item Flat
15813 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15814
15815 @item Unform
15816 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15817
15818 @item C
15819 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15820
15821 @item Pascal
15822 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15823
15824 @item Fortran
15825 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15826
15827 @item TeX
15828 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX Language Mode}).
15829
15830 @item Eqn
15831 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15832
15833 @item Math
15834 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15835
15836 @item Maple
15837 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15838
15839 @item Norm@var{n}
15840 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15841
15842 @item Fix@var{n}
15843 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15844
15845 @item Sci
15846 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15847
15848 @item Sci@var{n}
15849 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15850
15851 @item Eng
15852 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15853
15854 @item Eng@var{n}
15855 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15856
15857 @item Left@var{n}
15858 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15859
15860 @item Right
15861 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15862
15863 @item Right@var{n}
15864 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15865
15866 @item Center
15867 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15868
15869 @item Center@var{n}
15870 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15871
15872 @item Wid@var{n}
15873 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15874
15875 @item Wide
15876 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15877
15878 @item Break
15879 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15880
15881 @item Save
15882 Record modes in @file{~/.calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
15883
15884 @item Local
15885 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15886
15887 @item LocEdit
15888 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15889
15890 @item LocPerm
15891 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15892
15893 @item Global
15894 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15895
15896 @item Manual
15897 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
15898 Recomputation}).
15899
15900 @item Graph
15901 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
15902
15903 @item Sel
15904 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15905
15906 @item Dirty
15907 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
15908
15909 @item Inv
15910 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
15911
15912 @item Hyp
15913 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
15914
15915 @item Keep
15916 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
15917
15918 @item Narrow
15919 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
15920 @end table
15921
15922 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
15923 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
15924
15925 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
15926 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
15927
15928 @noindent
15929 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
15930 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
15931 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
15932 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
15933 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
15934 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
15935 is illegal) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
15936
15937 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
15938 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
15939 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
15940
15941 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
15942 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
15943 interpret a prefix argument.
15944
15945 @menu
15946 * Basic Arithmetic::
15947 * Integer Truncation::
15948 * Complex Number Functions::
15949 * Conversions::
15950 * Date Arithmetic::
15951 * Financial Functions::
15952 * Binary Functions::
15953 @end menu
15954
15955 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
15956 @section Basic Arithmetic
15957
15958 @noindent
15959 @kindex +
15960 @pindex calc-plus
15961 @ignore
15962 @mindex @null
15963 @end ignore
15964 @tindex +
15965 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
15966 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
15967 onto the stack.
15968
15969 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
15970 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
15971 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
15972 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
15973 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
15974 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
15975 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
15976 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
15977 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
15978 to every element of a vector.
15979
15980 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
15981 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
15982 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
15983 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
15984 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
15985
15986 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
15987 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
15988 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
15989 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
15990 and then the two HMS forms are added.
15991
15992 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
15993 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
15994 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
15995 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
15996 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
15997 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
15998 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
15999 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16000
16001 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16002 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16003 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16004 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16005 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16006 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16007 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16008 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16009
16010 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16011 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16012 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16013 the two values.
16014
16015 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16016 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16017 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16018 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16019
16020 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16021 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16022 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16023 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16024
16025 @kindex -
16026 @pindex calc-minus
16027 @ignore
16028 @mindex @null
16029 @end ignore
16030 @tindex -
16031 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16032 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16033 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16034 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16035
16036 @kindex *
16037 @pindex calc-times
16038 @ignore
16039 @mindex @null
16040 @end ignore
16041 @tindex *
16042 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16043 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16044 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16045 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16046 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16047 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16048 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16049 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16050 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16051
16052 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16053 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16054 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16055 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16056 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16057 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16058 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16059 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16060
16061 @kindex /
16062 @pindex calc-divide
16063 @ignore
16064 @mindex @null
16065 @end ignore
16066 @tindex /
16067 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers. When
16068 dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the computation
16069 performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This also occurs
16070 if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the effect is
16071 to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}. If @expr{B}
16072 is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a plain vector
16073 (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the equation
16074 @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}. Otherwise,
16075 if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of @emph{columns}
16076 as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If you wish a vector
16077 @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be solved as @expr{X A = B},
16078 make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1 v p} first. To force a
16079 left-handed solution with a square matrix @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and
16080 @expr{B} before dividing, then transpose the result.
16081
16082 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16083 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16084 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16085 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16086 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16087 interval.
16088
16089 @kindex ^
16090 @pindex calc-power
16091 @ignore
16092 @mindex @null
16093 @end ignore
16094 @tindex ^
16095 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16096 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16097 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16098 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16099 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16100 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16101
16102 @kindex I ^
16103 @tindex nroot
16104 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16105 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16106 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16107
16108 @kindex \
16109 @pindex calc-idiv
16110 @tindex idiv
16111 @ignore
16112 @mindex @null
16113 @end ignore
16114 @tindex \
16115 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16116 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16117 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16118 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16119 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16120 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16121
16122 @kindex %
16123 @pindex calc-mod
16124 @ignore
16125 @mindex @null
16126 @end ignore
16127 @tindex %
16128 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16129 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16130 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16131 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16132 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16133 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16134 must be positive real number.
16135
16136 @kindex :
16137 @pindex calc-fdiv
16138 @tindex fdiv
16139 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) command [@code{fdiv} function in a formula]
16140 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16141 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16142 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16143 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16144 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16145 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16146 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16147
16148 @kindex n
16149 @pindex calc-change-sign
16150 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16151 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16152 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16153
16154 @kindex A
16155 @pindex calc-abs
16156 @tindex abs
16157 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16158 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16159 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16160 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16161 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16162 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16163 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16164 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16165 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16166
16167 @kindex f A
16168 @pindex calc-abssqr
16169 @tindex abssqr
16170 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16171 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16172
16173 @kindex f s
16174 @pindex calc-sign
16175 @tindex sign
16176 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16177 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16178 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16179 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16180 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16181
16182 @kindex &
16183 @pindex calc-inv
16184 @tindex inv
16185 @cindex Reciprocal
16186 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16187 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16188 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16189
16190 @kindex Q
16191 @pindex calc-sqrt
16192 @tindex sqrt
16193 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16194 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16195 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16196
16197 @kindex f h
16198 @pindex calc-hypot
16199 @tindex hypot
16200 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16201 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16202 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16203 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16204 magnitudes are used.
16205
16206 @kindex f Q
16207 @pindex calc-isqrt
16208 @tindex isqrt
16209 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16210 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16211 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16212 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16213 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16214 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16215 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16216
16217 @kindex f n
16218 @kindex f x
16219 @pindex calc-min
16220 @tindex min
16221 @pindex calc-max
16222 @tindex max
16223 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16224 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16225 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16226 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16227 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16228 all the arguments.)
16229
16230 @kindex f M
16231 @kindex f X
16232 @pindex calc-mant-part
16233 @tindex mant
16234 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16235 @tindex xpon
16236 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16237 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16238 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16239 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16240 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16241 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16242 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16243 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16244 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16245 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16246 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16247 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16248 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16249
16250 @kindex f S
16251 @pindex calc-scale-float
16252 @tindex scf
16253 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16254 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16255 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16256 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16257 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16258
16259 @kindex f [
16260 @kindex f ]
16261 @pindex calc-decrement
16262 @pindex calc-increment
16263 @tindex decr
16264 @tindex incr
16265 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16266 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16267 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16268 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16269 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16270 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16271 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16272 @samp{0.0} produces
16273 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16274 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16275 where @expr{p} is the current
16276 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16277 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16278
16279 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16280 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16281 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16282 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16283 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16284 way floating-point numbers work.
16285
16286 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16287 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16288
16289 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16290 @section Integer Truncation
16291
16292 @noindent
16293 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16294 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16295 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16296 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16297 to integer form.
16298
16299 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16300 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16301
16302 @cindex Integer part of a number
16303 @kindex F
16304 @pindex calc-floor
16305 @tindex floor
16306 @tindex ffloor
16307 @ignore
16308 @mindex @null
16309 @end ignore
16310 @kindex H F
16311 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16312 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16313 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16314 @mathit{-4}.
16315
16316 @kindex I F
16317 @pindex calc-ceiling
16318 @tindex ceil
16319 @tindex fceil
16320 @ignore
16321 @mindex @null
16322 @end ignore
16323 @kindex H I F
16324 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16325 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16326 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16327
16328 @kindex R
16329 @pindex calc-round
16330 @tindex round
16331 @tindex fround
16332 @ignore
16333 @mindex @null
16334 @end ignore
16335 @kindex H R
16336 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16337 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16338 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16339 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16340 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16341
16342 @kindex I R
16343 @pindex calc-trunc
16344 @tindex trunc
16345 @tindex ftrunc
16346 @ignore
16347 @mindex @null
16348 @end ignore
16349 @kindex H I R
16350 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16351 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16352 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16353 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16354
16355 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16356 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16357 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16358 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16359 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16360 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16361
16362 @ignore
16363 @starindex
16364 @end ignore
16365 @tindex rounde
16366 @ignore
16367 @starindex
16368 @end ignore
16369 @tindex roundu
16370 @ignore
16371 @starindex
16372 @end ignore
16373 @tindex frounde
16374 @ignore
16375 @starindex
16376 @end ignore
16377 @tindex froundu
16378 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16379 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16380 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16381 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16382 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16383 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16384 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16385 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16386 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16387 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16388 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16389 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16390 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16391 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16392 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16393
16394 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16395 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16396 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16397 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16398 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16399 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16400 no second argument at all.
16401
16402 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16403 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16404 added to `@t{floor(}@var{n}@t{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16405 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16406
16407 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16408 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16409 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16410 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16411
16412 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16413 @section Complex Number Functions
16414
16415 @noindent
16416 @kindex J
16417 @pindex calc-conj
16418 @tindex conj
16419 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16420 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16421 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16422 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16423 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16424
16425 @kindex G
16426 @pindex calc-argument
16427 @tindex arg
16428 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16429 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16430 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16431 @texline `@t{(}@var{r}@t{;}@math{\theta}@t{)}'.
16432 @infoline `@t{(}@var{r}@t{;}@var{theta}@t{)}'.
16433 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16434 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16435 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16436
16437 @pindex calc-imaginary
16438 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16439 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16440 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16441 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16442
16443 @kindex f r
16444 @pindex calc-re
16445 @tindex re
16446 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16447 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16448 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16449 the value part.)
16450
16451 @kindex f i
16452 @pindex calc-im
16453 @tindex im
16454 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16455 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16456 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16457
16458 @ignore
16459 @mindex v p
16460 @end ignore
16461 @kindex v p (complex)
16462 @pindex calc-pack
16463 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16464 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16465 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16466 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16467 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16468
16469 @ignore
16470 @mindex v u
16471 @end ignore
16472 @kindex v u (complex)
16473 @pindex calc-unpack
16474 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16475 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16476 into its separate components.
16477
16478 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16479 @section Conversions
16480
16481 @noindent
16482 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16483 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16484
16485 @kindex c f
16486 @pindex calc-float
16487 @tindex pfloat
16488 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16489 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16490 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16491 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16492 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16493 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16494 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16495 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16496 format may lose information.
16497
16498 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16499 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16500 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16501 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16502 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16503 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16504
16505 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16506 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16507 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16508 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16509
16510 @kindex H c f
16511 @tindex float
16512 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16513 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16514 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16515 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16516
16517 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16518 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16519 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16520 that appear right now.
16521
16522 @kindex c F
16523 @pindex calc-fraction
16524 @tindex pfrac
16525 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16526 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16527 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16528 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16529 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16530 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16531 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16532 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16533 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16534 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16535 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16536
16537 @kindex H c F
16538 @tindex frac
16539 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16540 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16541 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16542
16543 @kindex c d
16544 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16545 @tindex deg
16546 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16547 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16548 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16549 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16550
16551 @kindex c r
16552 @pindex calc-to-radians
16553 @tindex rad
16554 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16555 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16556
16557 @kindex c h
16558 @pindex calc-to-hms
16559 @tindex hms
16560 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16561 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16562 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16563 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16564 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16565
16566 @pindex calc-from-hms
16567 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16568 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16569
16570 @kindex c p
16571 @kindex I c p
16572 @pindex calc-polar
16573 @tindex polar
16574 @tindex rect
16575 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16576 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16577 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16578 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16579 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16580 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16581 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16582 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16583
16584 @kindex c c
16585 @pindex calc-clean
16586 @tindex pclean
16587 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16588 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16589 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16590 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16591 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16592 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16593 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16594 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16595 number (i.e., pervasively).
16596
16597 If the simplification mode is set below the default level, it is raised
16598 to the default level for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c}
16599 applies the default simplifications even if their automatic application
16600 is disabled. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16601
16602 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16603 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16604 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16605 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16606 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16607
16608 @kindex c 0-9
16609 @pindex calc-clean-num
16610 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16611 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16612 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16613 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16614
16615 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16616 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16617 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16618 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16619 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16620 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16621 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16622
16623 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16624 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16625 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16626 does not clip small numbers.)
16627
16628 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16629 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16630 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16631 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16632 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16633 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16634
16635 @kindex H c 0-9
16636 @kindex H c c
16637 @tindex clean
16638 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16639 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16640
16641 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16642 @section Date Arithmetic
16643
16644 @noindent
16645 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16646 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16647 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16648 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16649 letters.
16650
16651 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16652 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16653 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16654 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16655 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16656 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16657
16658 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16659 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16660 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16661
16662 @menu
16663 * Date Conversions::
16664 * Date Functions::
16665 * Time Zones::
16666 * Business Days::
16667 @end menu
16668
16669 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16670 @subsection Date Conversions
16671
16672 @noindent
16673 @kindex t D
16674 @pindex calc-date
16675 @tindex date
16676 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16677 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD. The
16678 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16679 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16680 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16681
16682 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16683 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16684 of the following ways:
16685
16686 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16687 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16688 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16689 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16690 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16691 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16692 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16693 month will be used.
16694
16695 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16696 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16697 real-time clock.
16698
16699 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16700 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16701
16702 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16703 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16704 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16705 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16706 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16707 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16708
16709 @kindex t J
16710 @pindex calc-julian
16711 @tindex julian
16712 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16713 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16714 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16715 since noon on Jan 1, 4713 BC. A pure date is converted to an integer
16716 Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form is
16717 converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16718 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16719 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16720 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16721 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16722 are never time-zone adjusted.
16723
16724 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16725 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16726 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16727 current or specified time zone.
16728
16729 @kindex t U
16730 @pindex calc-unix-time
16731 @tindex unixtime
16732 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16733 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16734 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16735 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16736 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16737 precisions, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16738 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16739 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16740 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16741 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16742 suppress the adjustment if so.
16743
16744 @kindex t C
16745 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16746 @tindex tzconv
16747 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16748 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16749 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16750 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16751 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16752 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16753 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16754 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16755 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16756
16757 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16758 @subsection Date Functions
16759
16760 @noindent
16761 @kindex t N
16762 @pindex calc-now
16763 @tindex now
16764 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16765 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16766 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16767 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16768
16769 @kindex t P
16770 @pindex calc-date-part
16771 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16772 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16773 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16774 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16775
16776 @tindex year
16777 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16778 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16779 following functions will also accept a real number for an
16780 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16781 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
16782 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16783
16784 @tindex month
16785 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16786 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16787
16788 @tindex day
16789 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16790 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16791
16792 @tindex hour
16793 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16794 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16795 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16796 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16797 HMS forms as input.
16798
16799 @tindex minute
16800 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16801 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16802
16803 @tindex second
16804 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16805 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16806 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16807 precisions, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16808
16809 @tindex weekday
16810 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16811 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16812 to 6 (Saturday).
16813
16814 @tindex yearday
16815 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16816 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16817 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16818
16819 @tindex time
16820 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16821 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16822 for a pure date form.
16823
16824 @kindex t M
16825 @pindex calc-new-month
16826 @tindex newmonth
16827 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16828 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16829 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16830 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16831 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16832 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16833 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16834 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16835
16836 @kindex t Y
16837 @pindex calc-new-year
16838 @tindex newyear
16839 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16840 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16841 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16842 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16843 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16844 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16845 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16846 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16847 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16848
16849 @kindex t W
16850 @pindex calc-new-week
16851 @tindex newweek
16852 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16853 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16854 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16855 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16856 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16857 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16858
16859 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16860 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
16861 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
16862 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
16863 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
16864 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
16865 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
16866 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
16867 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
16868 the time to midnight; hint:@: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
16869 of the @code{weekday} function?).
16870
16871 @ignore
16872 @starindex
16873 @end ignore
16874 @tindex pwday
16875 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
16876 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
16877 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
16878 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
16879 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
16880 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
16881 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
16882 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
16883 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
16884 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
16885 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
16886
16887 @kindex t I
16888 @pindex calc-inc-month
16889 @tindex incmonth
16890 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
16891 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
16892 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
16893 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
16894 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
16895 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
16896 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
16897 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
16898 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
16899 in this case).
16900
16901 @ignore
16902 @starindex
16903 @end ignore
16904 @tindex incyear
16905 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
16906 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
16907 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
16908 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
16909 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
16910 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
16911 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
16912 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
16913
16914 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
16915 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
16916 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
16917
16918 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
16919 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
16920
16921 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
16922 @subsection Business Days
16923
16924 @noindent
16925 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
16926 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
16927 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
16928 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
16929 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
16930 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
16931
16932 @kindex t +
16933 @kindex t -
16934 @tindex badd
16935 @tindex bsub
16936 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
16937 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
16938 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
16939 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
16940 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
16941 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
16942 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
16943 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
16944 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
16945 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
16946 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
16947 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
16948 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
16949 case the result is the number of business days between the two
16950 dates.
16951
16952 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
16953 @vindex Holidays
16954 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
16955 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
16956 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
16957 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
16958 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
16959 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
16960 be any of the following kinds of objects:
16961
16962 @itemize @bullet
16963 @item
16964 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
16965 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
16966
16967 @item
16968 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
16969 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
16970
16971 @item
16972 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
16973 considered to be a holiday.
16974
16975 @item
16976 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
16977 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
16978 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
16979 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
16980 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
16981 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
16982 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
16983 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
16984 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
16985
16986 @item
16987 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
16988 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
16989
16990 @item
16991 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
16992 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
16993 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
16994 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
16995 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
16996 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
16997 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
16998 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
16999 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17000 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17001
17002 @item
17003 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17004 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17005 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17006 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17007 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17008 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17009 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17010 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17011 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17012 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17013 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17014 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17015 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17016 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17017 @end itemize
17018
17019 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17020 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17021 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17022
17023 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17024 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17025 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17026 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17027 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17028 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17029
17030 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17031 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17032 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17033 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17034 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17035 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17036 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17037 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17038
17039 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17040 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17041 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17042 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17043 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17044 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17045 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17046 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17047 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17048 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17049 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17050 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17051 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17052 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17053 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17054
17055 @ignore
17056 @starindex
17057 @end ignore
17058 @tindex holiday
17059 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17060 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17061 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17062 business day.
17063
17064 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17065 @subsection Time Zones
17066
17067 @noindent
17068 @cindex Time zones
17069 @cindex Daylight savings time
17070 Time zones and daylight savings time are a complicated business.
17071 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17072 compute the correct time zone and daylight savings adjustment to use,
17073 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17074 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17075 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17076 can't determine the right correction to use.
17077
17078 Adjustments for time zones and daylight savings time are done by
17079 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17080 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17081 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-savings
17082 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17083 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17084 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight savings time:
17085 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17086 evaluates to @samp{29.95834} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17087 because one hour was lost when daylight savings commenced on
17088 April 7, 1991.
17089
17090 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17091 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17092 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17093 days between two dates without taking daylight savings into account.
17094
17095 @pindex calc-time-zone
17096 @ignore
17097 @starindex
17098 @end ignore
17099 @tindex tzone
17100 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17101 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17102 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17103 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17104 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17105 Daylight Savings time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17106 the normal difference.
17107
17108 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17109 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17110 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17111 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17112 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17113 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17114 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17115 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17116 (for Pacific standard and daylight savings times, respectively).
17117
17118 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17119 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17120 another for daylight savings time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17121 in which the daylight savings adjustment is computed from context.
17122
17123 @smallexample
17124 @group
17125 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17126 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17127
17128 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17129 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17130
17131 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17132 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17133 @end group
17134 @end smallexample
17135
17136 @vindex math-tzone-names
17137 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17138 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17139 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17140 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17141 Pacific Time look like this:
17142
17143 @smallexample
17144 @group
17145 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17146 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight savings adjustment.
17147 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17148 @end group
17149 @end smallexample
17150
17151 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17152 @vindex TimeZone
17153 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} obtains an
17154 argument from the Calc variable @code{TimeZone} if a value has been
17155 stored for that variable. If not, Calc runs the Unix @samp{date}
17156 command and looks for one of the above time zone names in the output;
17157 if this does not succeed, @samp{tzone()} leaves itself unevaluated.
17158 The time zone name in the @samp{date} output may be followed by a signed
17159 adjustment, e.g., @samp{GMT+5} or @samp{GMT+0500} which specifies a
17160 number of hours and minutes to be added to the base time zone.
17161 Calc stores the time zone it finds into @code{TimeZone} to speed
17162 later calls to @samp{tzone()}.
17163
17164 The special time zone name @code{local} is equivalent to no argument,
17165 i.e., it uses the local time zone as obtained from the @code{date}
17166 command.
17167
17168 If the time zone name found is one of the standard or daylight
17169 savings zone names from the above table, and Calc's internal
17170 daylight savings algorithm says that time and zone are consistent
17171 (e.g., @code{PDT} accompanies a date that Calc's algorithm would also
17172 consider to be daylight savings, or @code{PST} accompanies a date
17173 that Calc would consider to be standard time), then Calc substitutes
17174 the corresponding generalized time zone (like @code{PGT}).
17175
17176 If your system does not have a suitable @samp{date} command, you
17177 may wish to put a @samp{(setq var-TimeZone ...)} in your Emacs
17178 initialization file to set the time zone. (Since you are interacting
17179 with the variable @code{TimeZone} directly from Emacs Lisp, the
17180 @code{var-} prefix needs to be present.) The easiest way to do
17181 this is to edit the @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T}
17182 command, then use the @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable})
17183 command to save the value of @code{TimeZone} permanently.
17184
17185 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17186 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}. If the current
17187 time zone is a generalized time zone, e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc
17188 examines the date being converted to tell whether to use standard
17189 or daylight savings time. But if the current time zone is explicit,
17190 e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is used exactly
17191 and Calc's daylight savings algorithm is not consulted.
17192
17193 Some places don't follow the usual rules for daylight savings time.
17194 The state of Arizona, for example, does not observe daylight savings
17195 time. If you run Calc during the winter season in Arizona, the
17196 Unix @code{date} command will report @code{MST} time zone, which
17197 Calc will change to @code{MGT}. If you then convert a time that
17198 lies in the summer months, Calc will apply an incorrect daylight
17199 savings time adjustment. To avoid this, set your @code{TimeZone}
17200 variable explicitly to @code{MST} to force the use of standard,
17201 non-daylight-savings time.
17202
17203 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17204 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17205 By default Calc always considers daylight savings time to begin at
17206 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of April, and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the
17207 last Sunday of October. This is the rule that has been in effect
17208 in North America since 1987. If you are in a country that uses
17209 different rules for computing daylight savings time, you have two
17210 choices: Write your own daylight savings hook, or control time
17211 zones explicitly by setting the @code{TimeZone} variable and/or
17212 always giving a time-zone argument for the conversion functions.
17213
17214 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17215 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight savings
17216 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17217 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17218 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17219
17220 The daylight savings hook function is called with four arguments:
17221 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17222 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17223 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17224 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17225 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17226 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17227
17228 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17229 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17230 daylight savings computations. This is an internal version of
17231 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17232 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17233 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17234 and the weekday number (0-6).
17235
17236 The default daylight savings hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17237 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17238 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17239 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17240 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17241 daylight savings hook:
17242
17243 @smallexample
17244 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17245 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17246 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17247 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17248 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17249 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17250 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17251 (t -1))))
17252 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17253 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17254 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17255 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17256 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17257 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17258 (t 0))))
17259 (t 0))
17260 )
17261 @end smallexample
17262
17263 @noindent
17264 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17265 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17266 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17267 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17268 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17269
17270 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17271 beginning of daylight savings time; converting a date/time form that
17272 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17273 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight savings time, the
17274 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17275 form that falls in in this hour results in a time value for the first
17276 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour later).
17277
17278 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17279 daylight savings adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17280
17281 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17282 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17283 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17284 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17285 daylight savings computation is applied to it as it appears.
17286 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17287 daylight-savings version of @var{zone} before being given to
17288 the daylight savings hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17289 that the daylight-savings computation is always done in
17290 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17291 is typically represented in.
17292
17293 @ignore
17294 @starindex
17295 @end ignore
17296 @tindex dsadj
17297 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17298 daylight savings adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17299 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17300 daylight savings time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17301 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17302 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17303 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17304
17305 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, for the address of Calc's author, if you
17306 should wish to contribute your improved versions of
17307 @code{math-tzone-names} and @code{math-daylight-savings-hook}
17308 to the Calc distribution.
17309
17310 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17311 @section Financial Functions
17312
17313 @noindent
17314 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17315 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17316 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17317
17318 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17319 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17320 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17321 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17322
17323 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17324 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17325 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17326 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17327
17328 @menu
17329 * Percentages::
17330 * Future Value::
17331 * Present Value::
17332 * Related Financial Functions::
17333 * Depreciation Functions::
17334 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17335 @end menu
17336
17337 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17338 @subsection Percentages
17339
17340 @kindex M-%
17341 @pindex calc-percent
17342 @tindex %
17343 @tindex percent
17344 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17345 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17346 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17347 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17348
17349 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17350 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17351 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17352 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17353 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17354 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17355 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17356 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17357
17358 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17359 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17360 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17361 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17362 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17363 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17364
17365 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17366 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17367 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17368 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17369
17370 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17371 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17372 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17373
17374 @kindex c %
17375 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17376 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17377 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17378 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17379 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17380 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17381 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17382 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17383
17384 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17385 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17386 @samp{25%}.
17387
17388 @kindex b %
17389 @pindex calc-percent-change
17390 @tindex relch
17391 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17392 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17393 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17394 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17395 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17396 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17397 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17398 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17399 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17400 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17401
17402 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17403 @subsection Future Value
17404
17405 @noindent
17406 @kindex b F
17407 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17408 @tindex fv
17409 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17410 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17411 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17412 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17413 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17414 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17415 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17416 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17417 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17418 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17419
17420 @kindex I b F
17421 @tindex fvb
17422 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17423 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17424 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17425 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17426 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17427 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17428 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17429 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17430 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17431
17432 @kindex H b F
17433 @tindex fvl
17434 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17435 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17436 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17437 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17438
17439 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17440 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17441 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17442 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17443 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17444
17445 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17446 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17447 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17448 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17449 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17450 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17451 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17452 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17453 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17454 by @code{fvb} directly.
17455
17456 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17457 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17458 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17459 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17460 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17461 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17462 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17463
17464 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17465 @subsection Present Value
17466
17467 @noindent
17468 @kindex b P
17469 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17470 @tindex pv
17471 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17472 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17473 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17474 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17475 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17476 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17477 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17478 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17479 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17480 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17481 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17482 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17483 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17484
17485 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17486 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17487 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17488 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17489 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17490 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17491 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17492 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17493 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17494
17495 @kindex I b P
17496 @tindex pvb
17497 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17498 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17499 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17500 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17501 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17502 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17503
17504 @kindex H b P
17505 @tindex pvl
17506 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17507 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17508 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17509 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17510 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17511 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17512 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17513
17514 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17515 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17516 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17517
17518 @kindex b N
17519 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17520 @tindex npv
17521 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17522 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17523 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17524 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17525 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17526 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17527 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17528
17529 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17530 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17531 not all the same!
17532
17533 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17534 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17535 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17536 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17537 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17538 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17539 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17540 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17541
17542 @kindex I b N
17543 @tindex npvb
17544 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17545 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17546 rather than at the end.
17547
17548 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17549 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17550
17551 @noindent
17552 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17553 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17554
17555 @kindex b M
17556 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17557 @tindex pmt
17558 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17559 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17560 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17561 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17562 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17563
17564 @kindex I b M
17565 @tindex pmtb
17566 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17567 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17568 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17569 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17570
17571 @kindex H b M
17572 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17573 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17574
17575 @kindex b #
17576 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17577 @tindex nper
17578 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17579 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17580 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17581 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17582 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17583 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17584 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17585
17586 @kindex I b #
17587 @tindex nperb
17588 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17589 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17590 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17591 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17592
17593 @kindex H b #
17594 @tindex nperl
17595 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17596 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17597 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17598 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17599 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17600
17601 @kindex b T
17602 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17603 @tindex rate
17604 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17605 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17606 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17607 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17608 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17609
17610 @kindex I b T
17611 @kindex H b T
17612 @tindex rateb
17613 @tindex ratel
17614 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17615 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17616 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17617 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17618 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17619 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17620 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17621
17622 @kindex b I
17623 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17624 @tindex irr
17625 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17626 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17627 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17628 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17629 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17630
17631 @kindex I b I
17632 @tindex irrb
17633 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17634 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17635
17636 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17637 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17638
17639 @noindent
17640 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17641 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17642 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17643 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17644 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17645 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17646
17647 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17648 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17649
17650 @kindex b S
17651 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17652 @tindex sln
17653 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17654 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17655 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17656 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17657 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17658 per year.
17659
17660 @kindex b Y
17661 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17662 @tindex syd
17663 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17664 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17665 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17666 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17667 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17668 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17669 return zero.
17670
17671 @kindex b D
17672 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17673 @tindex ddb
17674 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17675 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17676 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17677
17678 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17679 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17680 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17681
17682 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17683 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17684 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17685 the three depreciation methods:
17686
17687 @example
17688 @group
17689 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17690 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17691 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17692 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17693 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17694 @end group
17695 @end example
17696
17697 @noindent
17698 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17699 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17700 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17701 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17702
17703 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17704 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17705 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17706
17707 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17708 @subsection Definitions
17709
17710 @noindent
17711 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17712 Calc's financial functions.
17713
17714 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17715 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17716 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17717 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17718 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17719 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17720
17721 @ifinfo
17722 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17723 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17724 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17725
17726 @example
17727 n
17728 (1 + rate) - 1
17729 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17730 rate
17731
17732 n
17733 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17734 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17735 rate
17736
17737 n
17738 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17739
17740 -n
17741 1 - (1 + rate)
17742 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17743 rate
17744
17745 -n
17746 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17747 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17748 rate
17749
17750 -n
17751 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17752
17753 -1 -2 -3
17754 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17755
17756 -1 -2
17757 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17758
17759 -n
17760 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17761 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17762 -n
17763 1 - (1 + rate)
17764
17765 -n
17766 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17767 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17768 -n
17769 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17770
17771 amt * rate
17772 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17773 pmt
17774
17775 amt * rate
17776 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17777 pmt * (1 + rate)
17778
17779 amt
17780 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17781 pmt
17782
17783 1/n
17784 pmt
17785 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17786 1/n
17787 amt
17788
17789 cost - salv
17790 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17791 life
17792
17793 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17794 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17795 life * (life + 1) / 2
17796
17797 book * 2
17798 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17799 life
17800 @end example
17801 @end ifinfo
17802 @tex
17803 \turnoffactive
17804 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17805 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17806 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17807 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17808 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17809 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17810 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17811 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17812 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17813 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17814 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17815 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17816 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17817 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17818 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17819 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17820 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17821 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17822 @end tex
17823
17824 @noindent
17825 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17826
17827 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17828 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17829 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17830 all sorts of inputs.
17831
17832 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17833 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17834 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17835
17836 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17837 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17838 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17839 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17840 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17841 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17842
17843 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17844 for @samp{rate}.
17845
17846 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17847 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17848 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17849
17850 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17851 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17852 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17853
17854 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17855 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17856 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17857 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17858 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17859 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17860 period.
17861
17862 The Calc financial function names were borrowed mostly from Microsoft
17863 Excel and Borland's Quattro. The @code{ratel} function corresponds to
17864 @samp{@@CGR} in Borland's Reflex. The @code{nper} and @code{nperl}
17865 functions correspond to @samp{@@TERM} and @samp{@@CTERM} in Quattro,
17866 respectively. Beware that the Calc functions may take their arguments
17867 in a different order than the corresponding functions in your favorite
17868 spreadsheet.
17869
17870 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17871 @section Binary Number Functions
17872
17873 @noindent
17874 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17875 the @kbd{b} prefix.
17876
17877 @cindex Binary numbers
17878 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17879 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17880 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17881 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17882 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17883
17884 @cindex Word size for binary operations
17885 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17886 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17887 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17888 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
17889 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
17890
17891 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce 2's complement
17892 integers from
17893 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
17894 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
17895 to
17896 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
17897 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
17898 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
17899 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
17900
17901 @kindex b c
17902 @pindex calc-clip
17903 @tindex clip
17904 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
17905 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
17906 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
17907 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
17908 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
17909 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
17910 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
17911 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
17912 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
17913
17914 @kindex b w
17915 @pindex calc-word-size
17916 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
17917 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
17918 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
17919 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
17920 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
17921 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
17922 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
17923
17924 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
17925 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
17926 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
17927 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
17928 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
17929 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
17930 integer-valued floats.
17931
17932 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
17933 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
17934 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
17935 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
17936
17937 @kindex b a
17938 @pindex calc-and
17939 @tindex and
17940 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
17941 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
17942 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
17943 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
17944 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
17945
17946 @kindex b o
17947 @pindex calc-or
17948 @tindex or
17949 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
17950 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
17951 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
17952
17953 @kindex b x
17954 @pindex calc-xor
17955 @tindex xor
17956 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
17957 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
17958 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
17959
17960 @kindex b d
17961 @pindex calc-diff
17962 @tindex diff
17963 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
17964 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
17965 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
17966
17967 @kindex b n
17968 @pindex calc-not
17969 @tindex not
17970 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
17971 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
17972
17973 @kindex b l
17974 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
17975 @tindex lsh
17976 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
17977 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
17978 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
17979 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
17980 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
17981 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
17982
17983 @kindex H b l
17984 @kindex H b r
17985 @ignore
17986 @mindex @idots
17987 @end ignore
17988 @kindex H b L
17989 @ignore
17990 @mindex @null
17991 @end ignore
17992 @kindex H b R
17993 @ignore
17994 @mindex @null
17995 @end ignore
17996 @kindex H b t
17997 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
17998 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
17999 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18000 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18001 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18002
18003 @kindex b r
18004 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18005 @tindex rsh
18006 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18007 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18008 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18009
18010 @kindex b L
18011 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18012 @tindex ash
18013 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18014 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18015 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18016 is performed as described below.
18017
18018 @kindex b R
18019 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18020 @tindex rash
18021 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18022 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18023 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18024 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18025 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18026 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18027 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18028 performs a standard left shift.
18029
18030 @kindex b t
18031 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18032 @tindex rot
18033 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18034 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18035 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18036 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18037 or right.
18038
18039 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18040 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18041 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18042 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18043 bits in a binary integer.
18044
18045 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18046 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18047 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18048 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18049 into a binary integer.
18050
18051 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18052 @chapter Scientific Functions
18053
18054 @noindent
18055 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18056 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18057 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18058 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18059
18060 @kindex P
18061 @pindex calc-pi
18062 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18063 @vindex pi
18064 @kindex H P
18065 @cindex @code{e} variable
18066 @vindex e
18067 @kindex I P
18068 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18069 @vindex gamma
18070 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18071 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18072 @kindex H I P
18073 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18074 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18075 @cindex Golden ratio
18076 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18077 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18078 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18079 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18080 @texline @math{\gamma}
18081 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18082 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18083 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18084 @texline @math{\phi}
18085 @infoline @expr{phi}
18086 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18087 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18088 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18089 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18090 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18091
18092 @ignore
18093 @mindex Q
18094 @end ignore
18095 @ignore
18096 @mindex I Q
18097 @end ignore
18098 @kindex I Q
18099 @tindex sqr
18100 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18101 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18102 computes the square of the argument.
18103
18104 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18105 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18106 interpret a prefix argument.
18107
18108 @menu
18109 * Logarithmic Functions::
18110 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18111 * Advanced Math Functions::
18112 * Branch Cuts::
18113 * Random Numbers::
18114 * Combinatorial Functions::
18115 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18116 @end menu
18117
18118 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18119 @section Logarithmic Functions
18120
18121 @noindent
18122 @kindex L
18123 @pindex calc-ln
18124 @tindex ln
18125 @ignore
18126 @mindex @null
18127 @end ignore
18128 @kindex I E
18129 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18130 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18131 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18132 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18133
18134 @kindex E
18135 @pindex calc-exp
18136 @tindex exp
18137 @ignore
18138 @mindex @null
18139 @end ignore
18140 @kindex I L
18141 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18142 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18143 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18144 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18145
18146 @kindex H L
18147 @kindex H E
18148 @pindex calc-log10
18149 @tindex log10
18150 @tindex exp10
18151 @ignore
18152 @mindex @null
18153 @end ignore
18154 @kindex H I L
18155 @ignore
18156 @mindex @null
18157 @end ignore
18158 @kindex H I E
18159 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18160 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18161 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18162 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18163 by
18164 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18165 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18166
18167 @kindex B
18168 @kindex I B
18169 @pindex calc-log
18170 @tindex log
18171 @tindex alog
18172 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18173 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18174 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18175 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18176 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18177 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18178 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18179 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18180
18181 @kindex f I
18182 @pindex calc-ilog
18183 @tindex ilog
18184 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18185 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18186 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18187 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18188 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18189 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18190 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18191
18192 @kindex f E
18193 @pindex calc-expm1
18194 @tindex expm1
18195 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18196 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18197 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18198 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18199 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18200 @texline @math{e^x}
18201 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18202 is close to one.
18203
18204 @kindex f L
18205 @pindex calc-lnp1
18206 @tindex lnp1
18207 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18208 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18209 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18210 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18211
18212 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18213 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18214
18215 @noindent
18216 @kindex S
18217 @pindex calc-sin
18218 @tindex sin
18219 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18220 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18221 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18222 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18223 on complex numbers.
18224
18225 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18226 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18227 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18228 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18229 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18230
18231 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18232 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18233 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command recognizes many such
18234 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18235 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18236 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18237 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18238 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18239 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18240 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18241
18242 The @kbd{a s} command knows all angles which are integer multiples of
18243 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18244 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18245 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18246
18247 @kindex I S
18248 @pindex calc-arcsin
18249 @tindex arcsin
18250 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18251 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18252 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18253 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18254
18255 @kindex H S
18256 @pindex calc-sinh
18257 @tindex sinh
18258 @kindex H I S
18259 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18260 @tindex arcsinh
18261 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18262 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18263 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18264 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18265
18266 @kindex C
18267 @pindex calc-cos
18268 @tindex cos
18269 @ignore
18270 @mindex @idots
18271 @end ignore
18272 @kindex I C
18273 @pindex calc-arccos
18274 @ignore
18275 @mindex @null
18276 @end ignore
18277 @tindex arccos
18278 @ignore
18279 @mindex @null
18280 @end ignore
18281 @kindex H C
18282 @pindex calc-cosh
18283 @ignore
18284 @mindex @null
18285 @end ignore
18286 @tindex cosh
18287 @ignore
18288 @mindex @null
18289 @end ignore
18290 @kindex H I C
18291 @pindex calc-arccosh
18292 @ignore
18293 @mindex @null
18294 @end ignore
18295 @tindex arccosh
18296 @ignore
18297 @mindex @null
18298 @end ignore
18299 @kindex T
18300 @pindex calc-tan
18301 @ignore
18302 @mindex @null
18303 @end ignore
18304 @tindex tan
18305 @ignore
18306 @mindex @null
18307 @end ignore
18308 @kindex I T
18309 @pindex calc-arctan
18310 @ignore
18311 @mindex @null
18312 @end ignore
18313 @tindex arctan
18314 @ignore
18315 @mindex @null
18316 @end ignore
18317 @kindex H T
18318 @pindex calc-tanh
18319 @ignore
18320 @mindex @null
18321 @end ignore
18322 @tindex tanh
18323 @ignore
18324 @mindex @null
18325 @end ignore
18326 @kindex H I T
18327 @pindex calc-arctanh
18328 @ignore
18329 @mindex @null
18330 @end ignore
18331 @tindex arctanh
18332 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18333 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18334 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18335 variants of these functions.
18336
18337 @kindex f T
18338 @pindex calc-arctan2
18339 @tindex arctan2
18340 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18341 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18342 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18343 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18344 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18345 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18346 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18347 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18348 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18349 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18350
18351 @pindex calc-sincos
18352 @ignore
18353 @starindex
18354 @end ignore
18355 @tindex sincos
18356 @ignore
18357 @starindex
18358 @end ignore
18359 @ignore
18360 @mindex arc@idots
18361 @end ignore
18362 @tindex arcsincos
18363 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18364 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18365 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18366 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18367 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18368 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18369
18370 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18371 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18372
18373 @noindent
18374 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18375 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18376 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18377 will work to arbitrarily large precisions. They can not at present
18378 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18379
18380 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18381 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18382 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18383 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18384 slow for some values of the arguments.
18385
18386 @kindex f g
18387 @pindex calc-gamma
18388 @tindex gamma
18389 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18390 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18391 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18392 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18393 integral:
18394 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18395 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18396 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18397
18398 @kindex f G
18399 @tindex gammaP
18400 @ignore
18401 @mindex @idots
18402 @end ignore
18403 @kindex I f G
18404 @ignore
18405 @mindex @null
18406 @end ignore
18407 @kindex H f G
18408 @ignore
18409 @mindex @null
18410 @end ignore
18411 @kindex H I f G
18412 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18413 @ignore
18414 @mindex @null
18415 @end ignore
18416 @tindex gammaQ
18417 @ignore
18418 @mindex @null
18419 @end ignore
18420 @tindex gammag
18421 @ignore
18422 @mindex @null
18423 @end ignore
18424 @tindex gammaG
18425 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18426 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18427 the integral,
18428 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18429 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18430 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18431 definition of the normal gamma function).
18432
18433 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18434 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18435 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18436 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18437 @expr{x} to infinity.
18438
18439 @ifinfo
18440 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18441 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18442 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18443 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18444 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18445 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18446 @end ifinfo
18447 @tex
18448 \turnoffactive
18449 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18450 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18451 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18452 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18453 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18454 @end tex
18455
18456 @kindex f b
18457 @pindex calc-beta
18458 @tindex beta
18459 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18460 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18461 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18462 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18463 or by
18464 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18465 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18466
18467 @kindex f B
18468 @kindex H f B
18469 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18470 @tindex betaI
18471 @tindex betaB
18472 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18473 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18474 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18475 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18476 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18477 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18478
18479 @kindex f e
18480 @kindex I f e
18481 @pindex calc-erf
18482 @tindex erf
18483 @tindex erfc
18484 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18485 error function
18486 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18487 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18488 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18489 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18490 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18491 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18492
18493 @kindex f j
18494 @kindex f y
18495 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18496 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18497 @tindex besJ
18498 @tindex besY
18499 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18500 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18501 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18502 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18503 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18504 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18505 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18506 Use with care!
18507
18508 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18509 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18510
18511 @noindent
18512 @cindex Branch cuts
18513 @cindex Principal values
18514 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18515 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18516 This section describes the values
18517 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18518 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18519 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18520 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18521 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18522
18523 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18524 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Versions of
18525 Calc starting with 2.00 follow the second edition.
18526
18527 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18528 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18529 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18530 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18531 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18532 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18533
18534 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18535 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18536 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18537 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18538
18539 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18540 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18541 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18542 in the right half of the complex plane.
18543
18544 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18545 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18546 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18547 negative real axis.
18548
18549 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18550 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18551 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18552 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18553 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18557 ----------------------------------------
18558 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18559 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18560 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18561 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18562 @end smallexample
18563
18564 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18565 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18566 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18567 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18568 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18569 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18570
18571 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18572 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18573
18574 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18575 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18576 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18577
18578 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18579 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18580 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18581
18582 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18583 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18584 above @expr{i}.
18585
18586 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18587 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18588 real axis less than 1.
18589
18590 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18591 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18592
18593 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18594 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18595 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18596
18597 @smallexample
18598 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18599 -------------------------------------------------------
18600 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18601 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18602 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18603 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18604 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18605 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18606 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18607 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18608 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18609 @end smallexample
18610
18611 @smallexample
18612 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18613 -----------------------------------------------------
18614 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18615 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18616 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18617 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18618 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18619 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18620 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18621 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18622 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18623 @end smallexample
18624
18625 @smallexample
18626 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18627 -----------------------------------------------------
18628 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18629 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18630 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18631 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18632 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18633 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18634 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18635 @end smallexample
18636
18637 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18638 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18639 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18640
18641 @smallexample
18642 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18643 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18644 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18645 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18646 @end smallexample
18647
18648 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18649 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18650 are not rigorously specified at present.
18651
18652 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18653 @section Random Numbers
18654
18655 @noindent
18656 @kindex k r
18657 @pindex calc-random
18658 @tindex random
18659 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18660 random numbers of various sorts.
18661
18662 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18663 integer @expr{N} in the range
18664 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18665 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18666 Each of the @expr{M} values appears with equal probability.
18667
18668 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18669 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18670 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18671 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18672 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18673 the result is a random integer in the range
18674 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18675 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18676
18677 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18678 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18679 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18680 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18681 or
18682 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18683 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18684 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18685
18686 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18687 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18688 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18689 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18690
18691 If @expr{M} is an error form
18692 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18693 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18694 where @var{m} and
18695 @texline @math{\sigma}
18696 @infoline @var{s}
18697 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18698 @var{m} and standard deviation
18699 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18700 @var{s}.
18701
18702 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18703 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18704 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18705 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18706 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18707 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18708 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18709 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18710 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18711 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18712 extremely small.)
18713
18714 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18715 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18716
18717 @vindex RandSeed
18718 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18719 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18720 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18721 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18722 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18723 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18724 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18725 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18726 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18727 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18728 of random numbers as before.
18729
18730 @pindex calc-rrandom
18731 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18732 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18733
18734 @kindex k a
18735 @pindex calc-random-again
18736 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18737 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18738 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18739 that value of @expr{M}.
18740
18741 @kindex k h
18742 @pindex calc-shuffle
18743 @tindex shuffle
18744 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18745 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18746 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18747 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18748 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18749 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18750 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18751
18752 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18753 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18754 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18755 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18756 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18757 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18758 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18759 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18760 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18761 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18762 each make it into the result vector.)
18763
18764 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18765 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18766 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18767 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18768 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18769 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18770 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18771
18772 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18773 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18774 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18775 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18776 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18777
18778 @menu
18779 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18780 @end menu
18781
18782 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18783 @subsection Random Number Generator
18784
18785 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18786 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18787 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18788 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18789 characterization.
18790
18791 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs' built-in
18792 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18793 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18794 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18795
18796 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18797 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18798 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18799
18800 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18801 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18802 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18803 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18804 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18805 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18806 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18807 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18808
18809 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18810 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18811 computing
18812 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18813 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18814 This method expands the seed
18815 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18816 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18817 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18818 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18819 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18820 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18821 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18822 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18823 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18824 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18825 to reseed the generator with that number.
18826
18827 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18828 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18829 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18830 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18831 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18832 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18833 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18834 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18835 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18836 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18837 damage its randomness.
18838
18839 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18840 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18841 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18842 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18843 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18844 value.
18845
18846 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18847 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18848 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18849 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18850 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18851 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18852 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18853 numbers on the order of
18854 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
18855 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
18856 or
18857 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
18858 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
18859 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18860 correspond to small integers times
18861 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18862 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18863
18864 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18865 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18866 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18867 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18868 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18869 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18870 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18871 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18872 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18873 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18874
18875 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
18876 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C. This method
18877 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
18878 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
18879
18880 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
18881 @section Combinatorial Functions
18882
18883 @noindent
18884 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
18885 @kbd{k} key prefix.
18886
18887 @kindex k g
18888 @pindex calc-gcd
18889 @tindex gcd
18890 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
18891 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
18892 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
18893 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
18894 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
18895 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
18896 the operation is left in symbolic form.
18897
18898 @kindex k l
18899 @pindex calc-lcm
18900 @tindex lcm
18901 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
18902 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
18903 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
18904 numbers.
18905
18906 @kindex k E
18907 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
18908 @tindex egcd
18909 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
18910 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
18911 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
18912 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
18913 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
18914
18915 @kindex !
18916 @pindex calc-factorial
18917 @tindex fact
18918 @ignore
18919 @mindex @null
18920 @end ignore
18921 @tindex !
18922 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
18923 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
18924 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
18925 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
18926 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
18927 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
18928 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
18929 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
18930 the commands in this section.
18931
18932 @kindex k d
18933 @pindex calc-double-factorial
18934 @tindex dfact
18935 @ignore
18936 @mindex @null
18937 @end ignore
18938 @tindex !!
18939 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
18940 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
18941 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
18942 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
18943 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
18944 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
18945 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
18946
18947 @kindex k c
18948 @pindex calc-choose
18949 @tindex choose
18950 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
18951 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
18952 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
18953 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
18954 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
18955 real numbers by
18956 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
18957 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
18958
18959 @kindex H k c
18960 @pindex calc-perm
18961 @tindex perm
18962 @ifinfo
18963 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
18964 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
18965 @end ifinfo
18966 @tex
18967 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
18968 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
18969 @end tex
18970
18971 @kindex k b
18972 @kindex H k b
18973 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
18974 @tindex bern
18975 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
18976 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
18977 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
18978 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
18979 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
18980 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
18981 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
18982
18983 @kindex k e
18984 @kindex H k e
18985 @pindex calc-euler-number
18986 @tindex euler
18987 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
18988 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
18989 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
18990 functions.
18991
18992 @kindex k s
18993 @kindex H k s
18994 @pindex calc-stirling-number
18995 @tindex stir1
18996 @tindex stir2
18997 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
18998 computes a Stirling number of the first
18999 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19000 @infoline kind,
19001 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19002 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19003 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19004 @infoline kind.
19005 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19006 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19007 non-empty sets, respectively.
19008
19009 @kindex k p
19010 @pindex calc-prime-test
19011 @cindex Primes
19012 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19013 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19014 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19015 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19016 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19017 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19018 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19019 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19020 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19021 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19022 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19023 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19024 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19025
19026 @ignore
19027 @starindex
19028 @end ignore
19029 @tindex prime
19030 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19031 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19032 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19033 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19034 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19035 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19036
19037 @kindex k f
19038 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19039 @tindex prfac
19040 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19041 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19042 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19043 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19044 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19045 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19046 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19047 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19048 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19049
19050 @kindex k n
19051 @pindex calc-next-prime
19052 @ignore
19053 @mindex nextpr@idots
19054 @end ignore
19055 @tindex nextprime
19056 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19057 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19058 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19059 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19060 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19061 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19062 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19063 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19064 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19065 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19066 prime.
19067
19068 @kindex I k n
19069 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19070 @ignore
19071 @mindex prevpr@idots
19072 @end ignore
19073 @tindex prevprime
19074 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19075 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19076
19077 @kindex k t
19078 @pindex calc-totient
19079 @tindex totient
19080 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19081 Euler ``totient''
19082 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19083 @infoline function,
19084 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19085 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19086
19087 @kindex k m
19088 @pindex calc-moebius
19089 @tindex moebius
19090 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19091 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19092 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19093 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19094 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19095 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19096 the result is zero.
19097
19098 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19099 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19100
19101 @noindent
19102 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19103 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19104 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19105 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19106 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19107 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19108 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19109 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19110
19111 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19112 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19113 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19114 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19115 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19116 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19117
19118 @kindex k B
19119 @kindex I k B
19120 @pindex calc-utpb
19121 @tindex utpb
19122 @tindex ltpb
19123 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19124 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19125 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19126 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19127 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19128 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19129 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19130
19131 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19132 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19133 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19134 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19135 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19136 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19137 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19138 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19139 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19140 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19141 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19142
19143 @kindex k C
19144 @pindex calc-utpc
19145 @tindex utpc
19146 @ignore
19147 @mindex @idots
19148 @end ignore
19149 @kindex I k C
19150 @ignore
19151 @mindex @null
19152 @end ignore
19153 @tindex ltpc
19154 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19155 @texline @math{\nu}
19156 @infoline @expr{v}
19157 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19158 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19159
19160 @kindex k F
19161 @pindex calc-utpf
19162 @tindex utpf
19163 @ignore
19164 @mindex @idots
19165 @end ignore
19166 @kindex I k F
19167 @ignore
19168 @mindex @null
19169 @end ignore
19170 @tindex ltpf
19171 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19172 various statistical tests. The parameters
19173 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19174 @infoline @expr{v1}
19175 and
19176 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19177 @infoline @expr{v2}
19178 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19179 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19180
19181 @kindex k N
19182 @pindex calc-utpn
19183 @tindex utpn
19184 @ignore
19185 @mindex @idots
19186 @end ignore
19187 @kindex I k N
19188 @ignore
19189 @mindex @null
19190 @end ignore
19191 @tindex ltpn
19192 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19193 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19194 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19195 @infoline @expr{s}.
19196 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19197 would exceed @expr{x}.
19198
19199 @kindex k P
19200 @pindex calc-utpp
19201 @tindex utpp
19202 @ignore
19203 @mindex @idots
19204 @end ignore
19205 @kindex I k P
19206 @ignore
19207 @mindex @null
19208 @end ignore
19209 @tindex ltpp
19210 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19211 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19212 Poisson random events will occur.
19213
19214 @kindex k T
19215 @pindex calc-ltpt
19216 @tindex utpt
19217 @ignore
19218 @mindex @idots
19219 @end ignore
19220 @kindex I k T
19221 @ignore
19222 @mindex @null
19223 @end ignore
19224 @tindex ltpt
19225 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19226 with
19227 @texline @math{\nu}
19228 @infoline @expr{v}
19229 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19230 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19231 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19232 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19233 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19234 where
19235 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19236 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19237 and
19238 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19239 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19240 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19241 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19242
19243 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19244 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19245 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19246 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19247 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19248
19249 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19250 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19251
19252 @noindent
19253 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19254 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19255 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19256 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19257 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19258
19259 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19260 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19261 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19262 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19263 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19264
19265 @menu
19266 * Packing and Unpacking::
19267 * Building Vectors::
19268 * Extracting Elements::
19269 * Manipulating Vectors::
19270 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19271 * Set Operations::
19272 * Statistical Operations::
19273 * Reducing and Mapping::
19274 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19275 @end menu
19276
19277 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19278 @section Packing and Unpacking
19279
19280 @noindent
19281 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19282 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19283 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19284 vectors.
19285
19286 @kindex v p
19287 @pindex calc-pack
19288 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19289 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19290 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19291 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19292 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19293 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19294 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19295 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19296
19297 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19298 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19299 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19300 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19301
19302 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19303
19304 @table @cite
19305 @item -1
19306 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19307 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19308 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19309 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19310 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19311 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19312 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19313 components are not suitable.)
19314
19315 @item -2
19316 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19317 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19318 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19319 mode.
19320
19321 @item -3
19322 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19323 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19324 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19325 number.
19326
19327 @item -4
19328 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19329 may be real numbers or formulas.
19330
19331 @item -5
19332 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19333 must be real numbers.
19334
19335 @item -6
19336 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19337 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19338
19339 @item -7
19340 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19341
19342 @item -8
19343 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19344
19345 @item -9
19346 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19347
19348 @item -10
19349 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19350
19351 @item -11
19352 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19353 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19354 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19355 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19356
19357 @item -12
19358 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19359 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19360 is desired.
19361
19362 @item -13
19363 A real number is converted into a date form.
19364
19365 @item -14
19366 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19367
19368 @item -15
19369 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19370 @end table
19371
19372 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19373 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19374 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19375 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19376 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19377 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19378 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19379 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19380 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19381 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19382
19383 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19384 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19385 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19386 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19387 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19388
19389 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19390 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19391 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19392 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19393 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19394
19395 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19396 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19397 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19398 @texline @math{2\times3}
19399 @infoline 2x3
19400 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19401 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19402 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19403
19404 @ignore
19405 @starindex
19406 @end ignore
19407 @tindex pack
19408 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19409 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19410 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19411 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19412 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19413 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19414 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is illegal, or if the
19415 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19416 by the mode.
19417
19418 @kindex v u
19419 @pindex calc-unpack
19420 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19421 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19422 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19423 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19424 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19425 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19426
19427 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19428 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19429 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19430 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19431 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19432 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19433 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19434
19435 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19436 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19437 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19438 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19439 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19440 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19441 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19442 is not a composite object.
19443
19444 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19445 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19446 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19447 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19448 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19449 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19450 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19451 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19452
19453 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19454 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19455 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19456 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19457 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19458 original object.
19459
19460 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19461 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19462 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19463 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19464
19465 @ignore
19466 @starindex
19467 @end ignore
19468 @tindex unpack
19469 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19470 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19471 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19472 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19473 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19474 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19475
19476 @ignore
19477 @starindex
19478 @end ignore
19479 @tindex unpackt
19480 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19481 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19482 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19483 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19484 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19485 The identity for re-building the original object is
19486 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19487 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19488 name and a vector of arguments.)
19489
19490 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19491 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19492 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19493 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19494
19495 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19496 @section Building Vectors
19497
19498 @noindent
19499 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19500 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19501
19502 @kindex |
19503 @pindex calc-concat
19504 @ignore
19505 @mindex @null
19506 @end ignore
19507 @tindex |
19508 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19509 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19510 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19511 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19512 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19513 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19514
19515 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19516 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19517 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19518 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19519 one-row matrix.
19520
19521 @kindex H |
19522 @tindex append
19523 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19524 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19525 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19526 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19527 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19528
19529 @kindex I |
19530 @kindex H I |
19531 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19532 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19533 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19534
19535 @kindex v d
19536 @pindex calc-diag
19537 @tindex diag
19538 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19539 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19540 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19541 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19542 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19543 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19544 the prefix argument is required.
19545
19546 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19547 @texline @math{3\times3}
19548 @infoline 3x3
19549 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19550 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19551 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19552
19553 @kindex v i
19554 @pindex calc-ident
19555 @tindex idn
19556 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19557 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19558 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19559 this command prompts for one.
19560
19561 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19562 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19563 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19564 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19565 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19566 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19567 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19568 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19569 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19570 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19571 dimensions.
19572
19573 @kindex v x
19574 @pindex calc-index
19575 @tindex index
19576 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19577 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19578 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19579 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19580 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19581
19582 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19583 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19584 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19585 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19586 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19587 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19588 of numbers or formulas.
19589
19590 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19591 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19592 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19593 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19594 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19595 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19596
19597 @kindex v b
19598 @pindex calc-build-vector
19599 @tindex cvec
19600 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19601 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19602 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19603 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19604 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19605 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19606
19607 @kindex v h
19608 @kindex I v h
19609 @pindex calc-head
19610 @pindex calc-tail
19611 @tindex head
19612 @tindex tail
19613 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19614 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19615 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19616 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19617
19618 @kindex v k
19619 @pindex calc-cons
19620 @tindex cons
19621 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19622 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19623 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19624 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19625 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19626
19627 @kindex H v h
19628 @tindex rhead
19629 @ignore
19630 @mindex @idots
19631 @end ignore
19632 @kindex H I v h
19633 @ignore
19634 @mindex @null
19635 @end ignore
19636 @kindex H v k
19637 @ignore
19638 @mindex @null
19639 @end ignore
19640 @tindex rtail
19641 @ignore
19642 @mindex @null
19643 @end ignore
19644 @tindex rcons
19645 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19646 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19647 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19648 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19649 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19650 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19651 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19652
19653 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19654 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19655
19656 @noindent
19657 @kindex v r
19658 @pindex calc-mrow
19659 @tindex mrow
19660 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19661 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19662 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19663 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19664 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19665 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19666
19667 @cindex Permutations, applying
19668 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19669 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19670 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19671 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19672 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19673 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19674
19675 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19676 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19677 submatrix is returned.
19678
19679 @cindex Subscript notation
19680 @kindex a _
19681 @pindex calc-subscript
19682 @tindex subscr
19683 @tindex _
19684 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19685 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19686 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19687 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19688 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19689 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19690 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19691 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19692 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19693 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19694
19695 @tindex mrrow
19696 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19697 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19698 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19699 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19700 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19701
19702 @tindex getdiag
19703 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19704 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19705 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19706
19707 @kindex v c
19708 @pindex calc-mcol
19709 @tindex mcol
19710 @tindex mrcol
19711 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19712 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19713 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19714 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19715 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19716 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19717
19718 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19719 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19720 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19721 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19722 of matrix @expr{m}.
19723
19724 @kindex v s
19725 @pindex calc-subvector
19726 @tindex subvec
19727 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19728 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19729 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19730 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19731 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19732 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19733 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19734 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19735
19736 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19737 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19738 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19739 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19740 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19741 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19742 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19743
19744 @kindex I v s
19745 @tindex rsubvec
19746 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19747 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19748 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19749 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19750 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19751
19752 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19753 vectors one element at a time.
19754
19755 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19756 @section Manipulating Vectors
19757
19758 @noindent
19759 @kindex v l
19760 @pindex calc-vlength
19761 @tindex vlen
19762 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19763 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19764 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19765 command.
19766
19767 @kindex H v l
19768 @tindex mdims
19769 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19770 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19771 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19772 its argument is a
19773 @texline @math{2\times3}
19774 @infoline 2x3
19775 matrix.
19776
19777 @kindex v f
19778 @pindex calc-vector-find
19779 @tindex find
19780 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19781 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19782 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19783 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19784 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19785 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19786
19787 @kindex v a
19788 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
19789 @tindex arrange
19790 @cindex Arranging a matrix
19791 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
19792 @cindex Flattening a matrix
19793 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19794 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19795 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19796 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19797 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19798 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19799 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19800 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19801 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19802 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19803 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19804 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19805 @texline @math{1\times4}
19806 @infoline 1x4
19807 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19808 @texline @math{4\times1}
19809 @infoline 4x1
19810 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19811 @texline @math{2\times2}
19812 @infoline 2x2
19813 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19814 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19815 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19816
19817 @cindex Sorting data
19818 @kindex V S
19819 @kindex I V S
19820 @pindex calc-sort
19821 @tindex sort
19822 @tindex rsort
19823 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19824 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19825 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19826 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19827 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19828 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19829 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19830 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19831 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19832 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19833 alphabetical order by this command.
19834
19835 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19836
19837 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
19838 @cindex Inverse of permutation
19839 @cindex Index tables
19840 @cindex Rank tables
19841 @kindex V G
19842 @kindex I V G
19843 @pindex calc-grade
19844 @tindex grade
19845 @tindex rgrade
19846 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19847 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19848 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19849 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19850 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19851 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
19852 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
19853 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
19854 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
19855 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
19856 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
19857 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
19858 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
19859
19860 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
19861 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
19862 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
19863 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
19864 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
19865 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
19866 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
19867 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
19868 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
19869 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
19870 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
19871
19872 @cindex Histograms
19873 @kindex V H
19874 @pindex calc-histogram
19875 @ignore
19876 @mindex histo@idots
19877 @end ignore
19878 @tindex histogram
19879 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
19880 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
19881 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
19882 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
19883 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
19884 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
19885 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
19886 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
19887 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
19888 input vector.)
19889
19890 @kindex H V H
19891 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
19892 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
19893 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
19894 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
19895 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
19896 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
19897
19898 @kindex v t
19899 @pindex calc-transpose
19900 @tindex trn
19901 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
19902 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
19903 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
19904 a one-column matrix.
19905
19906 @kindex v v
19907 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
19908 @tindex rev
19909 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{vec}] command reverses
19910 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
19911 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
19912 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
19913 a matrix.)
19914
19915 @kindex v m
19916 @pindex calc-mask-vector
19917 @tindex vmask
19918 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
19919 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
19920 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
19921 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
19922 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
19923 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
19924 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
19925 @xref{Logical Operations}.
19926
19927 @kindex v e
19928 @pindex calc-expand-vector
19929 @tindex vexp
19930 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
19931 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
19932 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
19933 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
19934 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
19935 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
19936 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
19937 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
19938 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
19939
19940 @kindex H v e
19941 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
19942 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
19943 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
19944 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
19945 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
19946 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
19947 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
19948 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
19949 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
19950
19951 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
19952 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
19953 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
19954 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
19955 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
19956 masking using vectors.
19957
19958 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
19959 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
19960
19961 @noindent
19962 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
19963 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
19964 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
19965 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
19966 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19967
19968 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
19969 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
19970 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
19971 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
19972
19973 @kindex V J
19974 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
19975 @tindex ctrn
19976 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
19977 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
19978
19979 @ignore
19980 @mindex A
19981 @end ignore
19982 @kindex A (vectors)
19983 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
19984 @ignore
19985 @mindex abs
19986 @end ignore
19987 @tindex abs (vectors)
19988 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
19989 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
19990 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
19991 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
19992 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
19993 from that point to the origin.
19994
19995 @kindex v n
19996 @pindex calc-rnorm
19997 @tindex rnorm
19998 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes
19999 the row norm, or infinity-norm, of a vector or matrix. For a plain
20000 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements.
20001 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums,
20002 i.e., of the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the
20003 various rows.
20004
20005 @kindex V N
20006 @pindex calc-cnorm
20007 @tindex cnorm
20008 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20009 the column norm, or one-norm, of a vector or matrix. For a plain
20010 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20011 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20012 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20013 not provided.
20014
20015 @kindex V C
20016 @pindex calc-cross
20017 @tindex cross
20018 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20019 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20020 exactly three elements.
20021
20022 @ignore
20023 @mindex &
20024 @end ignore
20025 @kindex & (matrices)
20026 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20027 @ignore
20028 @mindex inv
20029 @end ignore
20030 @tindex inv (matrices)
20031 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20032 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20033 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20034 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20035 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20036 quickly in the future.
20037
20038 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20039 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20040 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20041 by a matrix.
20042
20043 @kindex V D
20044 @pindex calc-mdet
20045 @tindex det
20046 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20047 determinant of a square matrix.
20048
20049 @kindex V L
20050 @pindex calc-mlud
20051 @tindex lud
20052 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20053 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20054 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20055 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20056 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20057 and the third is upper-triangular.
20058
20059 @kindex V T
20060 @pindex calc-mtrace
20061 @tindex tr
20062 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20063 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20064 elements of the matrix.
20065
20066 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20067 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20068
20069 @noindent
20070 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20071 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20072 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20073 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20074 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20075 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20076 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20077 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20078 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20079 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20080 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20081 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20082 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20083
20084 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20085 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20086 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20087 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20088 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20089 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20090
20091 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20092 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20093 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20094 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20095
20096 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20097 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20098 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20099
20100 @kindex V +
20101 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20102 @tindex rdup
20103 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20104 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20105 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20106 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20107 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20108 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20109 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20110 them.
20111
20112 @kindex V V
20113 @pindex calc-set-union
20114 @tindex vunion
20115 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20116 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20117 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20118 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20119 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20120
20121 @kindex V ^
20122 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20123 @tindex vint
20124 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20125 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20126 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20127 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20128 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20129 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20130 notation for set
20131 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20132 @infoline union
20133 and
20134 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20135 @infoline intersection.
20136
20137 @kindex V -
20138 @pindex calc-set-difference
20139 @tindex vdiff
20140 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20141 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20142 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20143 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20144 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20145 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20146 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20147 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20148 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20149 enough to express in a few intervals).
20150
20151 @kindex V X
20152 @pindex calc-set-xor
20153 @tindex vxor
20154 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20155 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20156 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20157 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20158 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20159
20160 @kindex V ~
20161 @pindex calc-set-complement
20162 @tindex vcompl
20163 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20164 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20165 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20166 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20167 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20168
20169 @kindex V F
20170 @pindex calc-set-floor
20171 @tindex vfloor
20172 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20173 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20174 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20175 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20176 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20177 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20178 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20179 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20180
20181 @kindex V E
20182 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20183 @tindex venum
20184 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20185 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20186 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20187 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20188 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20189
20190 @kindex V :
20191 @pindex calc-set-span
20192 @tindex vspan
20193 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20194 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20195 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20196 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20197 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20198
20199 @kindex V #
20200 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20201 @tindex vcard
20202 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20203 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20204 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20205 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20206
20207 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20208 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20209 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20210 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20211 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20212 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20213 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20214 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20215 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20216 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20217 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20218 convenient to you.
20219
20220 @kindex b p
20221 @kindex b u
20222 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20223 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20224 @tindex vpack
20225 @tindex vunpack
20226 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20227 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20228 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20229 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20230 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20231 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20232 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20233 (binary) prefix key.
20234
20235 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20236 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20237 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20238 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20239 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20240 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20241 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20242 representation
20243 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20244 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20245
20246 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20247 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20248
20249 @noindent
20250 @cindex Statistical functions
20251 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20252 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20253 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20254 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20255 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20256 Vetterling.
20257
20258 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20259 a shifted letter or other character.
20260
20261 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20262 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20263
20264 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20265 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20266
20267 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20268 probability distribution functions.
20269
20270 @menu
20271 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20272 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20273 @end menu
20274
20275 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20276 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20277
20278 @noindent
20279 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20280 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20281 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20282 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20283 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20284 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20285 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20286
20287 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20288 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20289 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20290 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20291
20292 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20293 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20294 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20295 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20296 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20297 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20298 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20299
20300 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20301 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20302 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20303 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20304 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20305 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20306 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20307 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20308 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20309 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20310
20311 @kindex u #
20312 @pindex calc-vector-count
20313 @tindex vcount
20314 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20315 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20316 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20317 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20318 simply computes the length of the vector.
20319
20320 @kindex u +
20321 @kindex u *
20322 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20323 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20324 @tindex vsum
20325 @tindex vprod
20326 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20327 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20328 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20329 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20330 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20331 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20332 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20333
20334 @kindex u X
20335 @kindex u N
20336 @pindex calc-vector-max
20337 @pindex calc-vector-min
20338 @tindex vmax
20339 @tindex vmin
20340 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20341 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20342 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20343 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20344 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20345 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20346 plus or minus infinity.
20347
20348 @kindex u M
20349 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20350 @tindex vmean
20351 @cindex Mean of data values
20352 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20353 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20354 If the inputs are error forms
20355 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20356 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20357 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20358 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20359 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20360 @tex
20361 \turnoffactive
20362 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20363 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20364 @end tex
20365 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20366 values divided by the count of the values.
20367
20368 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20369 error
20370 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20371 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20372 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20373 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20374 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20375 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20376 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20377 weight is completely negligible.)
20378
20379 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20380 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @t{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20381 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20382 and maximum values of the interval.
20383
20384 @kindex I u M
20385 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20386 @tindex vmeane
20387 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20388 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20389 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20390 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20391 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20392 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20393 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20394 @tex
20395 \turnoffactive
20396 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20397 @end tex
20398 If the inputs are plain
20399 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20400 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20401 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20402 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20403 deviation.)
20404 @tex
20405 \turnoffactive
20406 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20407 @end tex
20408
20409 @kindex H u M
20410 @pindex calc-vector-median
20411 @tindex vmedian
20412 @cindex Median of data values
20413 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20414 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20415 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20416 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20417 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20418 The median function is different from the other functions in
20419 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20420 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20421 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20422 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20423 ignored.
20424
20425 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20426 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20427 the same as the mean.
20428
20429 @kindex H I u M
20430 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20431 @tindex vhmean
20432 @cindex Harmonic mean
20433 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20434 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20435 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20436 of the values.
20437 @tex
20438 \turnoffactive
20439 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20440 @end tex
20441
20442 @kindex u G
20443 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20444 @tindex vgmean
20445 @cindex Geometric mean
20446 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20447 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20448 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20449 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20450 of the data values.
20451 @tex
20452 \turnoffactive
20453 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20454 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20455 @end tex
20456
20457 @kindex H u G
20458 @tindex agmean
20459 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20460 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20461 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20462 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20463 @tex
20464 \turnoffactive
20465 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20466 @end tex
20467
20468 @cindex Root-mean-square
20469 Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20470 for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20471
20472 @kindex u S
20473 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20474 @tindex vsdev
20475 @cindex Standard deviation
20476 @cindex Sample statistics
20477 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20478 computes the standard
20479 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20480 @infoline deviation
20481 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20482 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20483 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20484 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20485 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20486 @tex
20487 \turnoffactive
20488 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20489 @end tex
20490
20491 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20492 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20493 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20494 limits, divided by
20495 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20496 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20497 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20498 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20499
20500 @kindex I u S
20501 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20502 @tindex vpsdev
20503 @cindex Population statistics
20504 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20505 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20506 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20507 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20508 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20509 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20510 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20511 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20512 only an estimate of the true mean.
20513 @tex
20514 \turnoffactive
20515 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20516 @end tex
20517
20518 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20519 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20520 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20521
20522 @kindex H u S
20523 @kindex H I u S
20524 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20525 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20526 @tindex vvar
20527 @tindex vpvar
20528 @cindex Variance of data values
20529 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20530 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20531 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20532 is the
20533 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20534 @infoline square
20535 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20536 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20537 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20538
20539 @ignore
20540 @starindex
20541 @end ignore
20542 @tindex vflat
20543 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20544 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20545 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20546 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20547
20548 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20549 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20550
20551 @noindent
20552 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20553 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20554 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20555 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20556 the stack, which must be an
20557 @texline @math{N\times2}
20558 @infoline Nx2
20559 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20560 of actual vectors and matrices.
20561
20562 @kindex u C
20563 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20564 @tindex vcov
20565 @cindex Covariance
20566 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20567 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20568 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20569 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20570 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20571 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20572 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20573 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20574 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20575 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20576 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20577 input errors.
20578 @tex
20579 \turnoffactive
20580 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20581 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20582 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20583 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20584 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20585 $$
20586 @end tex
20587
20588 @kindex I u C
20589 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20590 @tindex vpcov
20591 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20592 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20593 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20594 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20595
20596 @kindex H u C
20597 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20598 @tindex vcorr
20599 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20600 @cindex Linear correlation
20601 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20602 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20603 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20604 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20605 between sample or population statistics here.)
20606 @tex
20607 \turnoffactive
20608 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20609 @end tex
20610
20611 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20612 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20613
20614 @noindent
20615 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20616 elements of vectors.
20617
20618 @kindex V A
20619 @pindex calc-apply
20620 @tindex apply
20621 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20622 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20623 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20624 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20625 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20626 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20627 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20628
20629 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20630 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20631
20632 @menu
20633 * Specifying Operators::
20634 * Mapping::
20635 * Reducing::
20636 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20637 * Generalized Products::
20638 @end menu
20639
20640 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20641 @subsection Specifying Operators
20642
20643 @noindent
20644 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20645 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20646 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20647 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20648 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20649 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20650 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20651 element as its argument.)
20652
20653 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20654 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20655 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20656 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20657 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20658 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20659 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20660 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20661 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20662 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20663 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20664 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20665 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20666 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20667 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20668
20669 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20670 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20671 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20672 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20673 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20674 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20675 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20676 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20677 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20678 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20679
20680 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20681 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20682 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20683 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20684 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20685 entry interacts with the stack.)
20686
20687 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20688 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20689 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20690 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20691 prompted for an argument list.
20692
20693 @cindex Nameless functions
20694 @cindex Generic functions
20695 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20696 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20697 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20698 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20699 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20700 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20701 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20702 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20703 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20704 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20705 can get it back later if you wish.
20706
20707 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20708 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20709 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20710 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20711 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20712
20713 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20714 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20715 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20716 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20717 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20718 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20719 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20720
20721 @cindex Lambda expressions
20722 @ignore
20723 @starindex
20724 @end ignore
20725 @tindex lambda
20726 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20727 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20728 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20729 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20730 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20731 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20732 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20733
20734 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20735 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20736 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20737 called.)
20738
20739 @tindex add
20740 @tindex sub
20741 @ignore
20742 @mindex @idots
20743 @end ignore
20744 @tindex mul
20745 @ignore
20746 @mindex @null
20747 @end ignore
20748 @tindex div
20749 @ignore
20750 @mindex @null
20751 @end ignore
20752 @tindex pow
20753 @ignore
20754 @mindex @null
20755 @end ignore
20756 @tindex neg
20757 @ignore
20758 @mindex @null
20759 @end ignore
20760 @tindex mod
20761 @ignore
20762 @mindex @null
20763 @end ignore
20764 @tindex vconcat
20765 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20766 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20767 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20768 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20769 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20770 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20771 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20772 @code{vconcat}.
20773
20774 @ignore
20775 @starindex
20776 @end ignore
20777 @tindex call
20778 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20779 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20780 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20781 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20782 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20783 as @samp{x + 2y}).
20784
20785 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20786 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20787 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20788 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20789 about it.)
20790
20791 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20792 @subsection Mapping
20793
20794 @noindent
20795 @kindex V M
20796 @pindex calc-map
20797 @tindex map
20798 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20799 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20800 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20801 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20802 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20803 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20804 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20805 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20806 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20807 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20808 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20809 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20810
20811 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20812 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20813 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20814 produce another
20815 @texline @math{3\times2}
20816 @infoline 3x2
20817 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
20818
20819 @tindex mapr
20820 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
20821 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
20822 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
20823 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
20824 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
20825 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
20826 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
20827 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
20828 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
20829
20830 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
20831 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
20832 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
20833 their individual elements.
20834
20835 @tindex mapc
20836 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
20837 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
20838 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
20839 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
20840 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
20841 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
20842
20843 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
20844 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
20845 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
20846 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
20847
20848 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
20849 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
20850 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
20851 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
20852 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
20853 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
20854
20855 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
20856 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
20857 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
20858 column.
20859
20860 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
20861 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
20862 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
20863 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
20864 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
20865 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
20866 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
20867 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
20868 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
20869 mapped over the elements of each row.)
20870
20871 @tindex mapa
20872 @tindex mapd
20873 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
20874 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
20875 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
20876 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
20877 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
20878 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
20879 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
20880 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
20881
20882 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
20883 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
20884 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
20885 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
20886
20887 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20888 @subsection Reducing
20889
20890 @noindent
20891 @kindex V R
20892 @pindex calc-reduce
20893 @tindex reduce
20894 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
20895 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
20896 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
20897 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
20898 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
20899 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
20900 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
20901 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
20902
20903 @kindex I V R
20904 @tindex rreduce
20905 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
20906 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
20907 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
20908 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
20909 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
20910 in power series expansions.
20911
20912 @kindex V U
20913 @tindex accum
20914 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
20915 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
20916 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
20917 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
20918 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
20919 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
20920
20921 @kindex I V U
20922 @tindex raccum
20923 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
20924 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
20925 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
20926
20927 @tindex reducea
20928 @tindex rreducea
20929 @tindex reduced
20930 @tindex rreduced
20931 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
20932 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
20933 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
20934 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
20935 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
20936 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
20937 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
20938 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
20939 b + e, c + f]}.
20940
20941 @tindex reducer
20942 @tindex rreducer
20943 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
20944 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
20945 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
20946 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
20947 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
20948 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
20949 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
20950
20951 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
20952 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
20953
20954 @tindex reducec
20955 @tindex rreducec
20956 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
20957 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
20958
20959 The commands @kbd{M-# :} and @kbd{M-# _} are equivalent to typing
20960 @kbd{M-# r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
20961 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
20962 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
20963
20964 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
20965 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
20966
20967 @noindent
20968 @kindex H V R
20969 @tindex nest
20970 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
20971 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
20972 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
20973 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
20974 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
20975 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
20976 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
20977
20978 @kindex H V U
20979 @tindex anest
20980 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
20981 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
20982 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
20983 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
20984 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
20985
20986 @kindex H I V R
20987 @tindex fixp
20988 @cindex Fixed points
20989 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
20990 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
20991 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
20992 no longer changes.
20993
20994 @kindex H I V U
20995 @tindex afixp
20996 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
20997 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
20998 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
20999 by @code{fixp}.
21000
21001 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21002 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21003 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21004 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21005 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21006 to converge to 0.739085.)
21007
21008 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21009 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21010 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21011 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21012 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21013 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21014 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21015
21016 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21017 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21018 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21019 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21020 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21021 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21022 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21023 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21024
21025 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21026 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21027 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21028 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21029 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21030 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21031 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21032 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21033 exactly equal.)
21034
21035 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21036 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21037 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21038 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21039
21040 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21041 @subsection Generalized Products
21042
21043 @kindex V O
21044 @pindex calc-outer-product
21045 @tindex outer
21046 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21047 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21048 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21049 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21050 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21051 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21052 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21053
21054 @kindex V I
21055 @pindex calc-inner-product
21056 @tindex inner
21057 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21058 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21059 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21060 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21061 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21062 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21063 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21064 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21065 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21066 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21067 generalized dot product.
21068
21069 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21070 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21071 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21072 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21073 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21074
21075 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21076 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21077
21078 @noindent
21079 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21080 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21081 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21082 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21083 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21084 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21085
21086 @kindex V <
21087 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21088 @kindex V =
21089 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21090 @kindex V >
21091 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21092 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21093 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21094 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21095 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21096
21097 @kindex V [
21098 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21099 @kindex V @{
21100 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21101 @kindex V (
21102 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21103 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21104 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21105 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21106 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21107 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21108 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21109 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21110 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21111 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21112 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21113
21114 @kindex V ]
21115 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21116 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21117 ``big'' style display of matrices. It prompts for a string of code
21118 letters; currently implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables
21119 brackets on each row of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer
21120 brackets in opposite corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which
21121 enables commas or semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last.
21122 The default format is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format
21123 was fixed at @samp{ROC}.) Here are some example matrices:
21124
21125 @example
21126 @group
21127 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21128 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21129 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21130
21131 RO ROC
21132
21133 @end group
21134 @end example
21135 @noindent
21136 @example
21137 @group
21138 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21139 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21140 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21141
21142 O OC
21143
21144 @end group
21145 @end example
21146 @noindent
21147 @example
21148 @group
21149 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21150 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21151 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21152
21153 R @r{blank}
21154 @end group
21155 @end example
21156
21157 @noindent
21158 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21159 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21160 the others are useful for display only.
21161
21162 @kindex V ,
21163 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21164 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21165 off in vector and matrix display.
21166
21167 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21168 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21169 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21170 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21171 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21172 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21173 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21174 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21175 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21176
21177 @kindex V .
21178 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21179 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21180 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21181 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21182 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21183 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21184 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21185 improve Calc's display speed.
21186
21187 @kindex t .
21188 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21189 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21190 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21191 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21192 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21193 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21194 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21195 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21196 that involve the trail.
21197
21198 @kindex V /
21199 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21200 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21201 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21202 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21203 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21204 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21205 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21206
21207 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21208 @chapter Algebra
21209
21210 @noindent
21211 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21212 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21213 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21214 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21215 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21216 is discussed.
21217
21218 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21219 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21220 for anything else'') prefix.
21221
21222 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21223 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21224
21225 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21226 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21227 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21228 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21229 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21230 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21231 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21232
21233 @menu
21234 * Selecting Subformulas::
21235 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21236 * Simplifying Formulas::
21237 * Polynomials::
21238 * Calculus::
21239 * Solving Equations::
21240 * Numerical Solutions::
21241 * Curve Fitting::
21242 * Summations::
21243 * Logical Operations::
21244 * Rewrite Rules::
21245 @end menu
21246
21247 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21248 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21249
21250 @noindent
21251 @cindex Selections
21252 @cindex Sub-formulas
21253 @cindex Parts of formulas
21254 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21255 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21256 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21257 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21258 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21259 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21260
21261 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21262 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21263 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21264
21265 @menu
21266 * Making Selections::
21267 * Changing Selections::
21268 * Displaying Selections::
21269 * Operating on Selections::
21270 * Rearranging with Selections::
21271 @end menu
21272
21273 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21274 @subsection Making Selections
21275
21276 @noindent
21277 @kindex j s
21278 @pindex calc-select-here
21279 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21280 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21281 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21282 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21283 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21284 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21285 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21286
21287 @smallexample
21288 @group
21289 3 ___
21290 (a + b) + V c
21291 1: ---------------
21292 2 x + 1
21293 @end group
21294 @end smallexample
21295
21296 @noindent
21297 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21298 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21299 to
21300
21301 @smallexample
21302 @group
21303 . ...
21304 .. . b. . . .
21305 1* ...............
21306 . . . .
21307 @end group
21308 @end smallexample
21309
21310 @noindent
21311 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21312 to a dot. The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21313 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21314 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21315 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21316 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21317
21318 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21319 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21320
21321 @smallexample
21322 @group
21323 . ...
21324 (a + b) . . .
21325 1* ...............
21326 . . . .
21327 @end group
21328 @end smallexample
21329
21330 @noindent
21331 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21332 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21333 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21334 would have had the same effect.
21335
21336 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21337 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21338 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21339 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21340
21341 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21342 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21343 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21344 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21345 and so on.
21346
21347 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21348 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21349
21350 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21351 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21352 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21353 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21354 cursor on any stack entry.
21355
21356 @kindex j a
21357 @pindex calc-select-additional
21358 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21359 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21360 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21361 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21362 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21363 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21364
21365 @kindex j o
21366 @pindex calc-select-once
21367 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21368 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21369 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21370 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21371 by the cursor.
21372
21373 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21374 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21375 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21376 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21377
21378 @kindex j S
21379 @kindex j O
21380 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21381 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21382 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21383 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21384 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21385 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21386 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21387 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21388 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21389 commands.
21390
21391 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21392 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21393 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21394 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21395 entire four-term sum.
21396
21397 @kindex j b
21398 @pindex calc-break-selections
21399 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21400 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21401 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}
21402 and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain obscure reasons, Calc
21403 treats multiplication as right-associative.) Once you have enabled
21404 @kbd{j b} mode, selecting with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would
21405 only select the @samp{a + b - c} portion, which makes sense when the
21406 deep structure of the sum is considered. There is no way to select
21407 the @samp{b - c + d} portion; although this might initially look
21408 like just as legitimate a sub-formula as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep
21409 structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d U} command can be used
21410 to view the deep structure of any formula (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21411
21412 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21413 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21414 you get.
21415
21416 @kindex j u
21417 @pindex calc-unselect
21418 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21419 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21420 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21421 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21422 position.
21423
21424 @kindex j c
21425 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21426 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21427 stack elements.
21428
21429 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21430 @subsection Changing Selections
21431
21432 @noindent
21433 @kindex j m
21434 @pindex calc-select-more
21435 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21436 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21437 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21438
21439 @smallexample
21440 @group
21441 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21442 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21443 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21444 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21445 @end group
21446 @end smallexample
21447
21448 @noindent
21449 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21450 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21451 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21452
21453 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21454 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21455 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21456 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21457 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21458
21459 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21460 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21461 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21462 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21463
21464 @kindex j l
21465 @pindex calc-select-less
21466 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21467 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21468 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21469 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21470 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21471
21472 @kindex j 1-9
21473 @pindex calc-select-part
21474 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21475 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21476 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21477 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21478 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21479 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21480 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21481 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21482
21483 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21484 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21485 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21486 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21487 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21488
21489 @kindex j n
21490 @kindex j p
21491 @pindex calc-select-next
21492 @pindex calc-select-previous
21493 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21494 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21495 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21496 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21497 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21498 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21499 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21500 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21501 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21502 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21503
21504 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21505 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21506 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21507
21508 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21509 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21510 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21511 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21512 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21513 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21514 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21515 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21516 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21517
21518 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21519 @subsection Displaying Selections
21520
21521 @noindent
21522 @kindex j d
21523 @pindex calc-show-selections
21524 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21525 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21526 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21527 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21528 by @samp{#} signs:
21529
21530 @smallexample
21531 @group
21532 3 ... # ___
21533 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21534 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21535 . . . . 2 x + 1
21536 @end group
21537 @end smallexample
21538
21539 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21540 @subsection Operating on Selections
21541
21542 @noindent
21543 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21544 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21545 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21546 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21547 given stack element.)
21548
21549 @kindex j e
21550 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21551 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21552 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21553 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21554 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21555 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21556 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21557
21558 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21559 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21560 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21561 element.
21562
21563 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21564 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21565 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21566 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21567 portion to the top of the stack.
21568
21569 @smallexample
21570 @group
21571 3 ... ... ___
21572 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21573 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21574 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21575
21576 3 3
21577 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21578 @end group
21579 @end smallexample
21580
21581 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21582 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21583 the complete, edited formula.
21584
21585 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21586 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21587
21588 @kindex j '
21589 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21590 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21591 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21592 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21593 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21594 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21595 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21596 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21597 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21598 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21599
21600 @kindex j `
21601 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21602 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21603 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21604 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21605 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21606
21607 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21608 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21609 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21610 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21611
21612 @smallexample
21613 @group
21614 ###
21615 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21616 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21617 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21618 @end group
21619 @end smallexample
21620
21621 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21622 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21623 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21624 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21625 and resimplifies.
21626
21627 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21628 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21629 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21630
21631 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21632 @pindex calc-del-selection
21633 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21634 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21635 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21636 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21637 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21638
21639 @kindex j @key{RET}
21640 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21641 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21642 command.)
21643
21644 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21645 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21646 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21647 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21648
21649 @smallexample
21650 @group
21651 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21652 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21653 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21654 V 4 - 2 x
21655 @end group
21656 @end smallexample
21657
21658 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21659 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21660 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21661 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21662 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21663 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21664 the command will abort with an error message.
21665
21666 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21667 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21668 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21669 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21670
21671 @smallexample
21672 @group
21673 .. . .. .
21674 1* .......... 1* ...........
21675 ......... ..........
21676 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21677 @end group
21678 @end smallexample
21679
21680 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21681 normally have cancelled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21682 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21683 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21684 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21685 to be simplified.
21686
21687 @smallexample
21688 @group
21689 17 y 17 y
21690 1: ----------- 1: ----------
21691 __________ _________
21692 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21693 @end group
21694 @end smallexample
21695
21696 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21697 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21698
21699 @noindent
21700 @kindex j R
21701 @pindex calc-commute-right
21702 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21703 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21704 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21705 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21706
21707 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21708 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21709 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21710 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21711
21712 @smallexample
21713 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21714 @end smallexample
21715
21716 @noindent
21717 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21718 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21719 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21720 mathematical meaning of the formula.
21721
21722 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21723 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21724 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21725 course be drastically changed.
21726
21727 @smallexample
21728 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21729
21730 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21731 @end smallexample
21732
21733 @kindex j L
21734 @pindex calc-commute-left
21735 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21736 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21737
21738 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21739 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21740 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21741 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21742 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21743
21744 @kindex j D
21745 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
21746 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21747 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21748 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21749 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21750 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21751 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21752 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21753 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21754
21755 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21756 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21757 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21758 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21759 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21760 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21761
21762 @vindex DistribRules
21763 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21764 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21765 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21766 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21767 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21768 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21769 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21770
21771 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21772 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21773 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21774 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
21775
21776 @kindex j M
21777 @pindex calc-sel-merge
21778 @vindex MergeRules
21779 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
21780 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
21781 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
21782 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
21783 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
21784 the relevant rules.
21785
21786 @kindex j C
21787 @pindex calc-sel-commute
21788 @vindex CommuteRules
21789 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
21790 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
21791 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
21792 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
21793 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
21794 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
21795 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
21796 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
21797 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
21798
21799 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
21800 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
21801 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
21802 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
21803 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
21804 manipulations described in this section.
21805
21806 @kindex j N
21807 @pindex calc-sel-negate
21808 @vindex NegateRules
21809 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
21810 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
21811 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
21812 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
21813 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
21814 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
21815 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
21816 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
21817
21818 @kindex j &
21819 @pindex calc-sel-invert
21820 @vindex InvertRules
21821 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
21822 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
21823 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
21824 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
21825
21826 @kindex j E
21827 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
21828 @vindex JumpRules
21829 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
21830 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
21831 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
21832 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
21833 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
21834 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
21835
21836 @kindex j I
21837 @kindex H j I
21838 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
21839 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
21840 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
21841 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
21842 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
21843 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
21844 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
21845 as well as equations.
21846
21847 @kindex j *
21848 @kindex j /
21849 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
21850 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
21851 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
21852 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
21853 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It simplifies each
21854 side with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) before re-forming the
21855 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
21856 providing any numeric prefix argument. There is also a @kbd{j /}
21857 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
21858 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
21859
21860 As a special feature, if the numerator of the quotient is 1, then
21861 the denominator is expanded at the top level using the distributive
21862 law (i.e., using the @kbd{C-u -1 a x} command). Suppose the
21863 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, and you wish
21864 to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying both
21865 sides by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
21866 change the result @samp{(sqrt(a) - 1) / (sqrt(a) - 1) (sqrt(a) + 1)}
21867 right back to the original form by cancellation; Calc expands the
21868 denominator to @samp{sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1} to prevent
21869 this. (You would now want to use an @kbd{a x} command to expand
21870 the rest of the way, whereupon the denominator would cancel out to
21871 the desired form, @samp{a - 1}.) When the numerator is not 1, this
21872 initial expansion is not necessary because Calc's default
21873 simplifications will not notice the potential cancellation.
21874
21875 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
21876 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
21877 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
21878 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
21879 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
21880 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
21881 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
21882 message.
21883
21884 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
21885 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
21886 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
21887 back by the formula.
21888
21889 @kindex j +
21890 @kindex j -
21891 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
21892 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
21893 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
21894 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
21895 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
21896 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
21897 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
21898 results.
21899
21900 @kindex j U
21901 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
21902 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
21903 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
21904 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
21905 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
21906 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
21907 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
21908
21909 @kindex j v
21910 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
21911 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
21912 normal default simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
21913 These are the simplifications that are normally done automatically
21914 on all results, but which may have been partially inhibited by
21915 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
21916 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
21917 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
21918
21919 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
21920 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command to the selected
21921 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
21922 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
21923 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
21924 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
21925 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
21926 sub-formula.
21927
21928 @kindex j "
21929 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
21930 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
21931 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
21932
21933 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
21934 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
21935
21936 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
21937 @section Algebraic Manipulation
21938
21939 @noindent
21940 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
21941 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
21942 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
21943 formula).
21944
21945 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
21946 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
21947 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
21948 from the second-to-top stack level.
21949
21950 @kindex a v
21951 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
21952 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
21953 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
21954 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
21955 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
21956 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
21957 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
21958
21959 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
21960 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
21961 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
21962
21963 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
21964 as if in Algebraic Simplification mode. This is equivalent to typing
21965 @kbd{a s}; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}. If you give a numeric prefix
21966 of 3 or more, it uses Extended Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
21967
21968 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
21969 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
21970 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
21971 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
21972 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
21973 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
21974 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
21975 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
21976 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
21977
21978 @tindex evalv
21979 @tindex evalvn
21980 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
21981 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
21982 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
21983 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
21984 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
21985 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
21986 it as a temporary different working precision.)
21987
21988 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
21989 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
21990 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
21991 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
21992 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
21993 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
21994 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
21995 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
21996 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
21997 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
21998 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
21999 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22000
22001 @kindex a "
22002 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22003 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22004 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22005 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22006 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22007 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22008 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22009 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22010 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22011 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22012 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22013 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22014 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22015 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22016 top-level function call.
22017
22018 @kindex a M
22019 @pindex calc-map-equation
22020 @tindex mapeq
22021 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22022 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22023 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22024 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22025 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22026 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22027 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22028 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22029 respective sides of a new equation.
22030
22031 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22032 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22033 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22034 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22035 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22036 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22037 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22038 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22039 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the @kbd{a s} command can
22040 then simplify to get @samp{2 < b}.
22041
22042 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22043 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22044 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22045 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22046 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22047
22048 @kindex H a M
22049 @tindex mapeqp
22050 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22051 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22052 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22053 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22054 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22055
22056 @kindex I a M
22057 @tindex mapeqr
22058 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22059 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22060 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22061 working with small positive angles.
22062
22063 @kindex a b
22064 @pindex calc-substitute
22065 @tindex subst
22066 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22067 all occurrences
22068 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22069 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22070 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22071 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22072 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22073 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22074 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22075 doing substitutions.
22076
22077 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22078 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22079 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22080 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22081 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22082 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22083 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22084
22085 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22086 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22087 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22088 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22089 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22090 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22091 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22092 these limitations.
22093
22094 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22095 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22096 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22097 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22098 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22099
22100 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22101 @section Simplifying Formulas
22102
22103 @noindent
22104 @kindex a s
22105 @pindex calc-simplify
22106 @tindex simplify
22107 The @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command applies
22108 various algebraic rules to simplify a formula. This includes rules which
22109 are not part of the default simplifications because they may be too slow
22110 to apply all the time, or may not be desirable all of the time. For
22111 example, non-adjacent terms of sums are combined, as in @samp{a + b + 2 a}
22112 to @samp{b + 3 a}, and some formulas like @samp{sin(arcsin(x))} are
22113 simplified to @samp{x}.
22114
22115 The sections below describe all the various kinds of algebraic
22116 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22117 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22118 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22119 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22120 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22121 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22122 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22123
22124 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22125 simplification occurs automatically. Normally only the ``default
22126 simplifications'' occur.
22127
22128 @menu
22129 * Default Simplifications::
22130 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22131 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22132 * Simplification of Units::
22133 @end menu
22134
22135 @node Default Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22136 @subsection Default Simplifications
22137
22138 @noindent
22139 @cindex Default simplifications
22140 This section describes the ``default simplifications,'' those which are
22141 normally applied to all results. For example, if you enter the variable
22142 @expr{x} on the stack twice and push @kbd{+}, Calc's default
22143 simplifications automatically change @expr{x + x} to @expr{2 x}.
22144
22145 The @kbd{m O} command turns off the default simplifications, so that
22146 @expr{x + x} will remain in this form unless you give an explicit
22147 ``simplify'' command like @kbd{=} or @kbd{a v}. @xref{Algebraic
22148 Manipulation}. The @kbd{m D} command turns the default simplifications
22149 back on.
22150
22151 The most basic default simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22152 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@t{sqrt}(9)}
22153 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22154 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@t{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22155 range (@expr{@t{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@t{tan}(3,5)}),
22156 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@t{f}(5)}), or if
22157 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22158 (@expr{@t{sqrt}(2)}).
22159
22160 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22161 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@t{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22162 simplified to @expr{@t{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22163 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22164 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22165 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22166 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22167 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22168
22169 Most commands apply the default simplifications to all arguments they
22170 take from the stack, perform a particular operation, then simplify
22171 the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the common special
22172 case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}],
22173 the arguments are simply popped from the stack and collected into a
22174 suitable function call, which is then simplified (the arguments being
22175 simplified first as part of the process, as described above).
22176
22177 The default simplifications are too numerous to describe completely
22178 here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22179 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22180 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22181 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22182
22183 @tex
22184 \bigskip
22185 @end tex
22186
22187 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22188 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22189 will also be applied before any built-in default simplifications.
22190 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22191
22192 @tex
22193 \bigskip
22194 @end tex
22195
22196 And now, on with the default simplifications:
22197
22198 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22199 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22200 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22201 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22202 a right-associative form for products, @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}.
22203 Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are rearranged to
22204 left-associative form, though this rarely matters since Calc's
22205 algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of
22206 sums and products as much as possible. Sums and products in
22207 their proper associative form will be written without parentheses
22208 in the examples below.
22209
22210 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22211 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22212 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22213 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22214 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22215 Calc assumes you have put the terms into the order you want
22216 and generally leaves that order alone, with the consequence
22217 that formulas like the above will only be simplified if you
22218 explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command. @xref{Algebraic
22219 Simplifications}.
22220
22221 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22222 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22223 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22224 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22225 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22226 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22227 negative-looking.
22228
22229 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22230 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22231 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22232 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22233 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22234 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22235 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22236 simplifications.)
22237
22238 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22239 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22240 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22241 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22242 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22243 using the distributive law.
22244
22245 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22246 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22247 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22248 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22249 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22250 square of the number of terms; Calc relegates potentially slow
22251 operations like this to commands that have to be invoked
22252 explicitly, like @kbd{a s}.
22253
22254 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22255 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22256 to @expr{-a}.
22257
22258 @tex
22259 \bigskip
22260 @end tex
22261
22262 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22263 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22264 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22265 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22266 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22267 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22268
22269 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22270 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22271 numbers.
22272
22273 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22274 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22275
22276 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22277 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22278 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22279 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22280 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22281
22282 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22283 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22284 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22285 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22286 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22287 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@t{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22288 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22289 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22290 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22291 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22292
22293 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22294 power is changed to use division:
22295 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22296 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22297 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22298 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22299 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22300
22301 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22302 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22303
22304 @tex
22305 \bigskip
22306 @end tex
22307
22308 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22309 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22310 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22311 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22312 respectively.
22313
22314 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22315 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22316 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22317
22318 The expression
22319 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22320 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22321 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22322 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22323 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22324 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22325 for any power @expr{c}.
22326
22327 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22328 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22329 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22330 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22331 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22332
22333 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22334 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22335 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22336 described for multiplication.
22337
22338 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22339 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22340 is cancelled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22341 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22342 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22343
22344 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22345 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22346 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22347
22348 @tex
22349 \bigskip
22350 @end tex
22351
22352 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22353 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22354 unless @expr{x} is a negative number or complex number, in which
22355 case the result is an infinity or an unsimplified formula according
22356 to the current infinite mode. Note that @expr{0^0} is an
22357 indeterminate form, as evidenced by the fact that the simplifications
22358 for @expr{x^0} and @expr{0^x} conflict when @expr{x=0}.
22359
22360 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22361 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22362 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22363 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22364 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22365 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22366 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22367 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22368 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22369 (In other words,
22370 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22371 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22372 is safe to simplify, but
22373 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22374 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22375 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22376 variables satisfy these requirements.
22377
22378 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@t{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22379 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22380 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22381 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22382
22383 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22384 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22385 simplified to @expr{@t{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22386
22387 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22388 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22389 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22390
22391 Square roots @expr{@t{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22392 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22393 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22394 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22395
22396 Also, note that
22397 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22398 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22399 is changed to
22400 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22401 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22402 but @expr{1 / @t{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22403
22404 @tex
22405 \bigskip
22406 @end tex
22407
22408 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22409 following rules: @expr{@t{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22410 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22411 @expr{@t{idn}(a) + @t{idn}(b)} to @expr{@t{idn}(a + b)};
22412 @expr{-@t{idn}(a)} to @expr{@t{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @t{idn}(b)} to
22413 @expr{@t{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22414 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@t{idn}(a) @t{idn}(b)} to
22415 @expr{@t{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22416 @code{idn}; and @expr{@t{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@t{idn}(a^n)} where
22417 @expr{n} is an integer.
22418
22419 @tex
22420 \bigskip
22421 @end tex
22422
22423 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22424 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22425 @expr{@t{floor}(@t{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@t{round}(x)}.
22426 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22427 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22428 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22429
22430 The expression @expr{@t{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@t{abs}(x)}.
22431 The expression @expr{@t{abs}(@t{abs}(x))} changes to
22432 @expr{@t{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@t{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22433 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22434 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22435
22436 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22437 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22438 @expr{@t{arg}(@t{i})} and @expr{@t{arg}(-@t{i})} just for convenience.
22439
22440 The expression @expr{@t{conj}(@t{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22441 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22442 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22443 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22444 @expr{@t{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22445 @expr{@t{conj}(a) - @t{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22446 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22447
22448 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22449 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22450 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The @kbd{a s} command
22451 described in the next section does provide some simplifications for
22452 these functions, though.
22453
22454 One important simplification that does occur is that
22455 @expr{@t{ln}(@t{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@t{ln}(@t{e}^x)} is
22456 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22457 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22458 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22459
22460 Among the logical functions, @t{(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22461 @t{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22462 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22463 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22464 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22465 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22466
22467 Most other Calc functions have few if any default simplifications
22468 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22469 suitable numbers.
22470
22471 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Default Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22472 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22473
22474 @noindent
22475 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22476 The @kbd{a s} command makes simplifications that may be too slow to
22477 do all the time, or that may not be desirable all of the time.
22478 If you find these simplifications are worthwhile, you can type
22479 @kbd{m A} to have Calc apply them automatically.
22480
22481 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22482 the @kbd{a s} command. Note that these occur in addition to the
22483 default simplifications; even if the default simplifications have
22484 been turned off by an @kbd{m O} command, @kbd{a s} will turn them
22485 back on temporarily while it simplifies the formula.
22486
22487 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22488 to be applied by @kbd{a s}. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22489 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22490 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22491 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22492 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22493 the original expression, the process repeats with the default
22494 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22495 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22496
22497 @tex
22498 \bigskip
22499 @end tex
22500
22501 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22502 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22503 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22504 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22505 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22506
22507 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22508 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22509 adjacent terms, but @kbd{a s} compares all pairs of terms including
22510 non-adjacent ones.
22511
22512 @tex
22513 \bigskip
22514 @end tex
22515
22516 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22517 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22518 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the default
22519 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22520 but @kbd{a s} will; it first rewrites the sum to @expr{x y + x y},
22521 and then the default simplifications are able to recognize a sum
22522 of identical terms.
22523
22524 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22525 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22526 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22527 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22528
22529 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22530 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22531 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22532
22533 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22534 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22535 use for adjacent terms of products.
22536
22537 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22538 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22539 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22540 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22541 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22542 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22543 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22544
22545 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22546 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22547 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22548 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22549 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22550
22551 @tex
22552 \bigskip
22553 @end tex
22554
22555 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22556 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22557 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22558 cancel @expr{x^2} from both sides to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22559 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22560 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22561 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is cancelled out;
22562 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22563
22564 Non-constant common factors are not found even by @kbd{a s}. To
22565 cancel the factor @expr{a} in @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first
22566 use @kbd{j M} on the product @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to
22567 @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be simplified successfully.
22568
22569 @tex
22570 \bigskip
22571 @end tex
22572
22573 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22574 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22575 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22576 will no longer occur. This is done by @kbd{a s} instead of by default
22577 in case someone (unwisely) uses the name @code{i} for a variable
22578 unrelated to complex numbers; it would be unfortunate if Calc
22579 quietly and automatically changed this formula for reasons the
22580 user might not have been thinking of.
22581
22582 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22583 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22584 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22585 pulled out so that @expr{@t{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22586 @texline @math{2\,\t{sqrt}(2)}.
22587 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22588 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22589 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22590 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22591
22592 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22593 numerator: @expr{1 / @t{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@t{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22594 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22595 @expr{@t{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@t{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22596
22597 @tex
22598 \bigskip
22599 @end tex
22600
22601 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22602 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22603 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22604 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22605 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22606
22607 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22608 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22609 cancelled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22610 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22611 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22612 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22613 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22614
22615 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22616 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22617 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22618 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22619 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22620 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22621 declared to be an integer.
22622
22623 @tex
22624 \bigskip
22625 @end tex
22626
22627 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. First,
22628 @expr{@t{sin}(@t{arcsin}(x))} is simplified to @expr{x}, and
22629 similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}. If the argument to
22630 @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22631 @expr{-@t{sin}(x),}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22632 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22633 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22634
22635 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22636 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@t{sin}(@t{arccos}(x))}
22637 to @expr{@t{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22638
22639 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22640 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22641 hyperbolic functions.
22642
22643 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22644 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22645 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22646 @expr{@t{arcsin}(@t{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22647 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22648 @texline @math{2 \pi}
22649 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
22650 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@t{arcsinh}(@t{sinh}(x))} is
22651 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22652
22653 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22654 are that @expr{@t{exp}(@t{ln}(x))},
22655 @texline @t{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22656 @infoline @expr{e^@t{ln}(x)},
22657 and
22658 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22659 @infoline @expr{10^@t{log10}(x)}
22660 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@t{ln}(@t{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22661 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22662 @expr{@t{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@t{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22663 is a suitable multiple of
22664 @texline @math{\pi i}
22665 @infoline @expr{pi i}
22666 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22667 @expr{@t{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22668 @expr{@t{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22669 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22670 negative imaginary.
22671
22672 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22673 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22674 function.
22675
22676 @tex
22677 \bigskip
22678 @end tex
22679
22680 Equations and inequalities are simplified by cancelling factors
22681 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22682 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is cancelled.
22683 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22684 cancelled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22685 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22686 are cancelled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22687 sign is known.
22688
22689 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
22690 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22691 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22692 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22693 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22694 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22695 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22696
22697 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22698 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22699
22700 @noindent
22701 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
22702 @cindex Extended simplification
22703 @kindex a e
22704 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
22705 @ignore
22706 @mindex esimpl@idots
22707 @end ignore
22708 @tindex esimplify
22709 The @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22710 is like @kbd{a s}
22711 except that it applies some additional simplifications which are not
22712 ``safe'' in all cases. Use this only if you know the values in your
22713 formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these simplifications
22714 are valid. The symbolic integrator uses @kbd{a e};
22715 one effect of this is that the integrator's results must be used with
22716 caution. Where an integral table will often attach conditions like
22717 ``for positive @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic
22718 integration programs) will simply produce an unqualified result.
22719
22720 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22721 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22722 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22723 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22724 to any specific part of a formula.
22725
22726 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22727 the @kbd{a e} command. These are applied in addition to
22728 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22729 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22730
22731 Following is a complete list of ``unsafe'' simplifications performed
22732 by @kbd{a e}.
22733
22734 @tex
22735 \bigskip
22736 @end tex
22737
22738 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
22739 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified
22740 by @kbd{a e}. For example, @expr{@t{arcsin}(@t{sin}(x))} changes
22741 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@t{arcsin}(@t{cos}(x))} and
22742 @expr{@t{arccos}(@t{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@t{pi}/2 - x}.
22743 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
22744 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
22745 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
22746 functions always produce.
22747
22748 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
22749 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
22750 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
22751 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
22752 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
22753 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
22754 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
22755 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
22756 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
22757
22758 Similarly, @expr{@t{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@t{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
22759 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
22760 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
22761 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
22762
22763 Forms like @expr{@t{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
22764 @expr{@t{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
22765 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
22766
22767 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
22768 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
22769 @expr{@t{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
22770 @expr{a b @t{sqrt}(a+b)}.
22771
22772 The simplifications of @expr{@t{ln}(@t{exp}(x))},
22773 @expr{@t{ln}(@t{e}^x)}, and @expr{@t{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
22774 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
22775 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
22776
22777 Common factors are cancelled from products on both sides of an
22778 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
22779 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never cancelled from
22780 inequalities: Even @kbd{a e} is not bold enough to reduce
22781 @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
22782 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
22783 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
22784 both sides of an inequality.
22785
22786 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22787 @subsection Simplification of Units
22788
22789 @noindent
22790 The simplifications described in this section are applied by the
22791 @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command. These are in addition
22792 to the regular @kbd{a s} (but not @kbd{a e}) simplifications described
22793 earlier. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
22794
22795 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22796 the @kbd{u s} command. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
22797 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
22798
22799 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
22800 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
22801
22802 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
22803 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
22804 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
22805 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
22806 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
22807 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
22808
22809 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
22810 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
22811 leading unit are modified accordingly.
22812
22813 When cancelling and combining units in products and quotients,
22814 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
22815 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
22816 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
22817 are not combined in this way.
22818
22819 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
22820 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
22821 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
22822
22823 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
22824 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
22825 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
22826 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
22827 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
22828
22829 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
22830 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
22831 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
22832
22833 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
22834 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
22835 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
22836 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22837 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22838 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
22839 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
22840 real.)
22841
22842 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
22843 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
22844 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
22845 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
22846 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
22847 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
22848 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
22849 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
22850 replaced by approximately
22851 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
22852 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
22853 which is then changed to
22854 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
22855 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
22856 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
22857
22858 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
22859 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
22860 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
22861 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
22862 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
22863 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
22864
22865 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
22866 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
22867 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
22868 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
22869
22870 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
22871 @section Polynomials
22872
22873 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
22874 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
22875 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
22876 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
22877 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
22878 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
22879 involving the base variable.
22880
22881 @kindex a f
22882 @pindex calc-factor
22883 @tindex factor
22884 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
22885 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
22886 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
22887 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
22888 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
22889
22890 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
22891 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
22892 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
22893 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
22894 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
22895 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
22896 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
22897 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
22898 rewrite mechanism.
22899
22900 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
22901 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
22902 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
22903 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
22904 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
22905 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
22906 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
22907 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
22908 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
22909 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
22910 version of Calc.)
22911
22912 @vindex FactorRules
22913 @ignore
22914 @starindex
22915 @end ignore
22916 @tindex thecoefs
22917 @ignore
22918 @starindex
22919 @end ignore
22920 @ignore
22921 @mindex @idots
22922 @end ignore
22923 @tindex thefactors
22924 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
22925 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
22926 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
22927 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
22928 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
22929 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
22930 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
22931 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
22932 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
22933 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
22934 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
22935 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
22936 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
22937 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
22938 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
22939 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
22940 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
22941 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
22942
22943 @kindex H a f
22944 @tindex factors
22945 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
22946 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
22947 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
22948 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
22949 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
22950 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
22951 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
22952 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
22953 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
22954 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
22955 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
22956
22957 @kindex a c
22958 @pindex calc-collect
22959 @tindex collect
22960 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
22961 formula as a
22962 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
22963 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
22964 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
22965 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
22966 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
22967 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
22968 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
22969 not be expanded.
22970
22971 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
22972 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
22973 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
22974 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
22975 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
22976
22977 @kindex a x
22978 @pindex calc-expand
22979 @tindex expand
22980 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
22981 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
22982 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
22983 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
22984 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
22985 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
22986
22987 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
22988 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
22989 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
22990 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
22991 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
22992 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
22993 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
22994 do not do.)
22995
22996 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
22997 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
22998 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
22999 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23000 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23001 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23002 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23003 the way in one step.
23004
23005 @kindex a a
23006 @pindex calc-apart
23007 @tindex apart
23008 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23009 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23010 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23011 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23012 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23013 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23014 chooses the base variable automatically.
23015
23016 @kindex a n
23017 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23018 @tindex nrat
23019 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23020 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23021 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23022 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23023 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23024 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23025
23026 @kindex a \
23027 @pindex calc-poly-div
23028 @tindex pdiv
23029 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23030 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23031 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23032 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23033 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23034 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23035 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23036 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23037 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23038
23039 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23040 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23041 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23042 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23043 above.
23044
23045 @kindex a %
23046 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23047 @tindex prem
23048 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23049 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23050 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23051 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23052 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23053 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23054
23055 @kindex a /
23056 @kindex H a /
23057 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23058 @tindex pdivrem
23059 @tindex pdivide
23060 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23061 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23062 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23063 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23064 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23065 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23066
23067 @kindex a g
23068 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23069 @tindex pgcd
23070 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23071 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23072 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23073 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23074 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23075 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23076 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23077 leaving a remainder.)
23078
23079 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23080 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23081 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23082 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23083 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23084 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23085 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23086
23087 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23088 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23089 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23090
23091 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23092 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23093
23094 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23095 @section Calculus
23096
23097 @noindent
23098 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23099 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23100 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23101 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23102 readable way.
23103
23104 @menu
23105 * Differentiation::
23106 * Integration::
23107 * Customizing the Integrator::
23108 * Numerical Integration::
23109 * Taylor Series::
23110 @end menu
23111
23112 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23113 @subsection Differentiation
23114
23115 @noindent
23116 @kindex a d
23117 @kindex H a d
23118 @pindex calc-derivative
23119 @tindex deriv
23120 @tindex tderiv
23121 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23122 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23123 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23124 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23125 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23126 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23127 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23128 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23129 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23130 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23131 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23132
23133 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23134 @var{n}th derivative.
23135
23136 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23137 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23138 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23139 answer!
23140
23141 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23142 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23143 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23144 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23145 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23146
23147 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23148 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23149 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23150 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23151 derivative of @code{f}.
23152
23153 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23154 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23155 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23156 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23157 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23158 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23159 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23160 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23161
23162 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23163 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23164 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23165 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23166 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23167 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23168 argument once).
23169
23170 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23171 @subsection Integration
23172
23173 @noindent
23174 @kindex a i
23175 @pindex calc-integral
23176 @tindex integ
23177 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23178 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23179 respect to a variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to work for
23180 all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several large
23181 classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational function
23182 (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable. (Rational functions
23183 don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23184 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23185 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23186 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23187 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23188 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23189 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23190 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23191
23192 @ifinfo
23193 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23194 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23195 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23196 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23197 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23198 @end ifinfo
23199 @tex
23200 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23201 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23202 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23203 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23204 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23205 @end tex
23206
23207 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23208 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23209 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23210 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23211 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23212 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23213 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23214 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23215 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23216 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23217 Calc's solution for
23218 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23219 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23220 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23221 constant factor of
23222 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23223 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23224 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23225
23226 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23227 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23228 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23229 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23230 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23231
23232 @vindex IntegLimit
23233 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23234 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23235 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23236 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23237 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23238 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23239 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23240 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23241 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23242 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23243 by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23244 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23245
23246 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23247 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23248 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23249 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23250 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23251
23252 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23253 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23254
23255 @noindent
23256 @vindex IntegRules
23257 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23258 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23259 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23260 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23261 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23262 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23263 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23264 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23265 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23266 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23267 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23268 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23269 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23270 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23271 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23272 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23273
23274 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23275 @ignore
23276 @starindex
23277 @end ignore
23278 @tindex Ei
23279 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23280 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23281 integral'' function
23282 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23283 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23284 was invented to describe it.
23285 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23286 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23287 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23288 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23289 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23290 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23291 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23292 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23293 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23294
23295 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23296 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23297 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23298 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23299 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23300 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23301 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23302 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23303 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still legal
23304 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23305 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23306 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23307 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23308
23309 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23310 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23311 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23312 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23313 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23314 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23315 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23316 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23317 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23318 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23319 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23320 it need not be.
23321
23322 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23323 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23324 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23325 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23326 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23327 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23328 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23329 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23330 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23331 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23332 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23333 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23334 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23335 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23336
23337 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23338 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23339 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23340 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23341 forever!)
23342
23343 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23344 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23345 every time the integrator uses @kbd{a s} to simplify an intermediate
23346 result. For example, putting the rule @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into
23347 @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to convert the @code{twice}
23348 function into a form it knows whenever integration is attempted.
23349
23350 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23351 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23352 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23353 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23354 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23355 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23356 do this.)
23357
23358 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23359 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23360 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23361 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23362 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23363 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23364 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23365 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23366 (It also does an @kbd{a s}, without @code{IntegSimpRules}, after that
23367 to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23368 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23369 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23370 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23371 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23372 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23373 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23374 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23375 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23376
23377 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23378 @subsection Numerical Integration
23379
23380 @noindent
23381 @kindex a I
23382 @pindex calc-num-integral
23383 @tindex ninteg
23384 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23385 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23386 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23387 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23388 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23389 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23390
23391 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23392 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23393 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23394 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23395 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23396 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23397 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23398 determine the value of the integral.
23399
23400 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23401 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23402 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23403 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23404 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23405 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23406
23407 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23408 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23409 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23410 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23411 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23412 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23413 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23414
23415 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23416 @subsection Taylor Series
23417
23418 @noindent
23419 @kindex a t
23420 @pindex calc-taylor
23421 @tindex taylor
23422 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23423 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23424 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23425 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23426 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23427 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23428 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23429 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23430 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23431
23432 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23433 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23434 Taylor series.
23435
23436 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23437 @section Solving Equations
23438
23439 @noindent
23440 @kindex a S
23441 @pindex calc-solve-for
23442 @tindex solve
23443 @cindex Equations, solving
23444 @cindex Solving equations
23445 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23446 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23447 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23448 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23449 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23450 form @expr{X = 0}.
23451
23452 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23453 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23454 be; for example, solving
23455 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23456 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23457 for @expr{b} is impossible
23458 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23459 produce the result
23460 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23461 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23462 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23463 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23464 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23465 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23466 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23467 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23468
23469 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23470 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23471 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23472 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23473
23474 @menu
23475 * Multiple Solutions::
23476 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23477 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23478 @end menu
23479
23480 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23481 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23482
23483 @noindent
23484 @kindex H a S
23485 @tindex fsolve
23486 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23487 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23488 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23489 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23490 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23491 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23492 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23493 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23494 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23495 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23496 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23497 of these variables.
23498
23499 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23500 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23501 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23502 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23503 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23504 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23505 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23506 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23507
23508 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23509 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23510 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23511 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23512 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23513 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23514 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23515 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23516
23517 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23518 @vindex GenCount
23519 @ignore
23520 @starindex
23521 @end ignore
23522 @tindex an
23523 @ignore
23524 @starindex
23525 @end ignore
23526 @tindex as
23527 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23528 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23529 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23530 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23531 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23532 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23533 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23534 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23535 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23536 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23537 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23538 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23539 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23540 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23541
23542 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23543 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23544
23545 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23546 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23547 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23548
23549 @kindex I a S
23550 @kindex H I a S
23551 @tindex finv
23552 @tindex ffinv
23553 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23554 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23555 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23556 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23557 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23558 fully general inverse, as described above.
23559
23560 @kindex a P
23561 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23562 @tindex roots
23563 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23564 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23565 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23566 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23567 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23568 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23569 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23570 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23571 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23572 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23573 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23574 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23575 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23576
23577 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23578 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23579 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23580 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23581 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23582 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23583 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23584 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23585 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23586 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23587 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23588 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23589 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23590 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23591 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23592 are all numbers (real or complex).
23593
23594 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23595 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23596
23597 @noindent
23598 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23599 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23600 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23601 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23602 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23603 at the prompt.)
23604
23605 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23606 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23607 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23608 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23609 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23610 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23611 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23612 command.
23613
23614 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23615 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23616 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23617 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23618 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23619 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23620 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23621 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23622 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23623 nonlinear systems.
23624
23625 @ignore
23626 @starindex
23627 @end ignore
23628 @tindex elim
23629 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23630 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23631 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23632 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23633 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23634 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23635 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23636 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23637 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23638 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23639 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23640 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23641
23642 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23643 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23644 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23645 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23646 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23647 by one.
23648
23649 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23650 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23651 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23652 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23653 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23654 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23655 variables you requested.)
23656
23657 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23658 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23659 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23660
23661 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23662 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23663
23664 @noindent
23665 @ignore
23666 @starindex
23667 @end ignore
23668 @tindex poly
23669 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23670 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23671 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23672 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23673 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23674 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23675 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23676 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23677 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23678 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23679 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23680 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23681
23682 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23683 @cindex Degree of polynomial
23684 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23685 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23686 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23687 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23688 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23689
23690 @ignore
23691 @starindex
23692 @end ignore
23693 @tindex gpoly
23694 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23695 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23696 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23697 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23698 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23699 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23700 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23701 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23702 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23703 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23704 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23705 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23706 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23707 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23708 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23709 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23710 is considered trivial.
23711
23712 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23713 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23714
23715 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23716 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23717 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23718 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23719 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23720
23721 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23722 discover:
23723
23724 @smallexample
23725 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23726 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23727 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23728 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23729 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23730 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23731 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23732 @end smallexample
23733
23734 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
23735 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
23736 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
23737 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
23738 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
23739 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
23740 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
23741 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
23742
23743 @ignore
23744 @starindex
23745 @end ignore
23746 @tindex pdeg
23747 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
23748 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
23749 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
23750 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
23751 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
23752 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
23753 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
23754 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
23755 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
23756 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
23757 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
23758 (minus infinity).
23759
23760 @ignore
23761 @starindex
23762 @end ignore
23763 @tindex plead
23764 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
23765 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
23766 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
23767 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
23768 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
23769
23770 @ignore
23771 @starindex
23772 @end ignore
23773 @tindex pcont
23774 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
23775 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
23776 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
23777 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
23778 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
23779 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
23780 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
23781 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
23782 coefficient.
23783
23784 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
23785 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
23786 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
23787 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
23788 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
23789 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
23790 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
23791 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
23792 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
23793 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
23794
23795 @ignore
23796 @starindex
23797 @end ignore
23798 @tindex pprim
23799 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
23800 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
23801 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
23802 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
23803 terms.
23804
23805 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
23806 @section Numerical Solutions
23807
23808 @noindent
23809 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
23810 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
23811 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
23812 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
23813 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
23814
23815 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
23816 on numerical data.)
23817
23818 @menu
23819 * Root Finding::
23820 * Minimization::
23821 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
23822 @end menu
23823
23824 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
23825 @subsection Root Finding
23826
23827 @noindent
23828 @kindex a R
23829 @pindex calc-find-root
23830 @tindex root
23831 @cindex Newton's method
23832 @cindex Roots of equations
23833 @cindex Numerical root-finding
23834 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
23835 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
23836 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
23837 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
23838
23839 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
23840 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
23841 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
23842 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
23843 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
23844 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
23845 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
23846 this command.
23847
23848 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
23849 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
23850 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
23851 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
23852 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
23853 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
23854 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
23855 the equation yourself.)
23856
23857 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
23858 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
23859
23860 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
23861 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
23862 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
23863 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
23864 to real numbers inside that interval.
23865
23866 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
23867 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
23868 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
23869 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
23870 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
23871 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
23872 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
23873
23874 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
23875 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
23876 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
23877 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
23878 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
23879 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
23880
23881 @kindex H a R
23882 @tindex wroot
23883 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
23884 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
23885 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
23886 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
23887 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
23888
23889 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
23890 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
23891 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
23892 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
23893 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
23894
23895 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
23896 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
23897 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
23898 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
23899
23900 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
23901 @subsection Minimization
23902
23903 @noindent
23904 @kindex a N
23905 @kindex H a N
23906 @kindex a X
23907 @kindex H a X
23908 @pindex calc-find-minimum
23909 @pindex calc-find-maximum
23910 @tindex minimize
23911 @tindex maximize
23912 @cindex Minimization, numerical
23913 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
23914 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
23915 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
23916 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
23917 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
23918 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
23919 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
23920 with the minimum value itself.
23921
23922 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
23923 have more than one minimum; some, like
23924 @texline @math{x \sin x},
23925 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
23926 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
23927 ``global'' minimum of
23928 @texline @math{x \sin x}
23929 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
23930 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
23931 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
23932 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
23933 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
23934
23935 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
23936 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
23937 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
23938 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
23939 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
23940 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
23941 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
23942 any, that happens to lie in that range.
23943
23944 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
23945 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
23946 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
23947 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
23948 answer.
23949
23950 @ignore
23951 @mindex wmin@idots
23952 @end ignore
23953 @tindex wminimize
23954 @ignore
23955 @mindex wmax@idots
23956 @end ignore
23957 @tindex wmaximize
23958 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
23959 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
23960 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
23961
23962 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
23963 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
23964 negative of the formula you supply.
23965
23966 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
23967 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
23968 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
23969 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
23970 be minimized over the reals.
23971
23972 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
23973 @subsection Systems of Equations
23974
23975 @noindent
23976 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
23977 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
23978 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
23979 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
23980 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
23981 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
23982 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
23983 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
23984 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
23985 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
23986 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
23987 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
23988 no effect when solving a system of equations.
23989
23990 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
23991 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
23992 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
23993 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
23994 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
23995 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
23996 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
23997
23998 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
23999 @section Curve Fitting
24000
24001 @noindent
24002 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24003 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24004 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24005 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24006 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24007 possible fit.
24008
24009 @menu
24010 * Linear Fits::
24011 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24012 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24013 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24014 * Curve Fitting Details::
24015 * Interpolation::
24016 @end menu
24017
24018 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24019 @subsection Linear Fits
24020
24021 @noindent
24022 @kindex a F
24023 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24024 @tindex fit
24025 @cindex Linear regression
24026 @cindex Least-squares fits
24027 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24028 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24029 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24030 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24031 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24032 fit for the data.
24033
24034 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24035 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24036 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24037 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24038 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24039 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24040 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24041 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24042
24043 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24044 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24045 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24046 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24047
24048 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24049 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24050 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24051 @texline @math{2\times N}
24052 @infoline 2xN
24053 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24054 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24055 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24056 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24057
24058 If you happen to have an
24059 @texline @math{N\times2}
24060 @infoline Nx2
24061 matrix instead of a
24062 @texline @math{2\times N}
24063 @infoline 2xN
24064 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24065
24066 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24067 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24068
24069 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24070 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24071 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24072 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24073 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24074 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24075 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24076
24077 For example, suppose the data matrix
24078
24079 @ifinfo
24080 @example
24081 @group
24082 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24083 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24084 @end group
24085 @end example
24086 @end ifinfo
24087 @tex
24088 \turnoffactive
24089 \turnoffactive
24090 \beforedisplay
24091 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24092 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24093 $$
24094 \afterdisplay
24095 @end tex
24096
24097 @noindent
24098 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24099 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24100 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3 + 2 x}
24101 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24102 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24103 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24104 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24105 formula.
24106
24107 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24108 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24109 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24110 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24111 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24112 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24113
24114 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24115 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24116 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24117 the equations that go into the trail.
24118
24119 @tex
24120 \bigskip
24121 @end tex
24122
24123 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24124 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24125 The result is:
24126
24127 @example
24128 2.6 + 2.2 x
24129 @end example
24130
24131 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24132 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24133
24134 @example
24135 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24136 @end example
24137
24138 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24139 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24140 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24141 error measure
24142
24143 @ifinfo
24144 @example
24145 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24146 @end example
24147 @end ifinfo
24148 @tex
24149 \turnoffactive
24150 \beforedisplay
24151 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24152 \afterdisplay
24153 @end tex
24154
24155 @noindent
24156 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24157 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24158 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24159 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24160 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24161 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24162 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24163 for which the error
24164 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24165 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24166 is as small as possible.
24167
24168 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24169 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24170
24171 @tex
24172 \bigskip
24173 @end tex
24174
24175 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24176 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24177 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24178 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24179 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24180
24181 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24182 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24183 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24184 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24185 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24186
24187 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24188 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24189
24190 @noindent
24191 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24192 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24193 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24194 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24195 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24196
24197 @example
24198 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24199 @end example
24200
24201 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24202 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24203 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24204 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24205 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24206 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24207 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24208 won't help.)
24209
24210 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24211 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24212 line slightly to improve the fit.
24213
24214 @example
24215 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24216 @end example
24217
24218 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24219 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24220 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24221 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24222 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24223
24224 @example
24225 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24226 @end example
24227
24228 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24229 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24230 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24231 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24232 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24233 results.
24234
24235 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24236 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24237 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24238 automatically.
24239
24240 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24241 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24242 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24243 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24244 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24245 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24246
24247 @tex
24248 \bigskip
24249 @end tex
24250
24251 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24252 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24253 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24254 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24255 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24256
24257 Given the data matrix,
24258
24259 @example
24260 @group
24261 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24262 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24263 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24264 @end group
24265 @end example
24266
24267 @noindent
24268 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24269 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24270 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24271
24272 @example
24273 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24274 @end example
24275
24276 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24277 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24278
24279 @tex
24280 \bigskip
24281 @end tex
24282
24283 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24284 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24285 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24286 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24287 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24288 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24289 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24290
24291 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24292 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24293 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24294 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24295 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24296
24297 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24298 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24299
24300 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24301 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24302
24303 @noindent
24304 @kindex H a F
24305 @tindex efit
24306 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24307 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24308 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24309 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24310
24311 @example
24312 3. + 2. x
24313 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24314 @end example
24315
24316 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24317 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24318 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24319
24320 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24321 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24322 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24323 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24324 row contains error forms
24325 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @t{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24326 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @t{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24327 then the
24328 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24329 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24330 statistic is now,
24331
24332 @ifinfo
24333 @example
24334 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24335 @end example
24336 @end ifinfo
24337 @tex
24338 \turnoffactive
24339 \beforedisplay
24340 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24341 \afterdisplay
24342 @end tex
24343
24344 @noindent
24345 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24346 the fitting operation.
24347
24348 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24349 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24350 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24351 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24352 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24353 used for the data point.
24354
24355 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24356 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24357 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24358 estimates.
24359
24360 If the input contains error forms but all the
24361 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24362 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24363 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24364 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24365 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24366 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24367 is simply scaled uniformly by
24368 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24369 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24370 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24371 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24372 @kbd{H a F}.
24373
24374 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24375 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24376 interpreted.
24377
24378 @tex
24379 \bigskip
24380 @end tex
24381
24382 @kindex I a F
24383 @tindex xfit
24384 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24385 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24386
24387 @enumerate
24388 @item
24389 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24390 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24391 produced.
24392
24393 @item
24394 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24395 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24396 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24397 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24398 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24399
24400 @item
24401 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24402 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24403 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24404 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24405 are the variances
24406 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24407 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24408 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24409 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24410 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24411 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24412 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24413 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24414 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24415 are defined as
24416 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24417 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24418
24419 @item
24420 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24421 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24422 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24423 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24424
24425 @item
24426 The value of
24427 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24428 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24429 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24430 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24431 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24432 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24433 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24434 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24435
24436 @item
24437 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24438 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24439 function using
24440 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24441 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24442 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24443 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24444 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24445 particular,
24446 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24447 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24448 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24449 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24450 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24451
24452 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24453 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24454 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24455 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24456 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24457 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24458 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24459 over to use for a confidence test.
24460 @end enumerate
24461
24462 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24463 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24464
24465 @noindent
24466 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24467 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24468 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24469
24470 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24471
24472 @table @kbd
24473 @item 1
24474 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24475 @item 2-9
24476 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24477 @item e
24478 Exponential. @mathit{a} @t{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @t{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24479 @item E
24480 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @t{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @t{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24481 @item x
24482 Exponential (alternate notation). @t{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24483 @item X
24484 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @t{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24485 @item l
24486 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @t{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @t{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24487 @item L
24488 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @t{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @t{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24489 @item ^
24490 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24491 @item p
24492 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24493 @item q
24494 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24495 @item g
24496 Gaussian.
24497 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24498 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24499 @end table
24500
24501 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24502 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24503 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24504 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24505 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24506
24507 All models except Gaussian and polynomials can generalize as shown to any
24508 number of independent variables. Also, all the built-in models have an
24509 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24510 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24511 before the model key.
24512
24513 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24514 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24515 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24516 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24517 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24518 matches the problem.
24519
24520 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24521 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24522 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24523 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24524 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24525 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24526
24527 @tex
24528 \bigskip
24529 @end tex
24530
24531 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24532 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24533 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24534 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24535
24536 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24537 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24538 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24539 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24540 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24541 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24542 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24543 model.
24544
24545 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24546 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24547 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24548 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24549 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24550 and thus does not need a name.
24551
24552 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24553 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24554 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24555 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24556 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24557 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24558 variables.
24559
24560 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24561 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24562 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24563 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24564 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24565 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24566 in the model formula will become parameters.
24567
24568 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24569 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24570 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24571 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24572 a linear model.
24573
24574 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24575 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24576 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24577 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24578 which are parameters.
24579
24580 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24581 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24582 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24583 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24584 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24585 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24586
24587 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24588 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24589
24590 @tex
24591 \bigskip
24592 @end tex
24593
24594 @vindex Model1
24595 @vindex Model2
24596 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24597 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24598 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24599 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24600 accept for a model on the stack.
24601
24602 @tex
24603 \bigskip
24604 @end tex
24605
24606 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24607 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24608 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24609 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24610 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24611 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24612 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24613 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24614 @texline @math{3\times360}
24615 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24616 degrees.
24617 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24618 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24619 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24620 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24621 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24622 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24623 even approximately.
24624
24625 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24626 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24627 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24628 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24629 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24630 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24631 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24632
24633 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24634 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
24635
24636 @noindent
24637 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24638 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24639 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24640 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24641 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24642
24643 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24644 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24645 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24646 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24647
24648 For other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24649 to try to put the problem into the form
24650
24651 @smallexample
24652 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24653 @end smallexample
24654
24655 @noindent
24656 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24657 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24658 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24659 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24660 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24661
24662 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24663 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24664 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24665 can be rewritten as follows:
24666
24667 @example
24668 y = a x^b
24669 y = a exp(b ln(x))
24670 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24671 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24672 @end example
24673
24674 @noindent
24675 which matches the desired form with
24676 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24677 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24678 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24679 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24680 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24681 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24682 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24683 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24684 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24685 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24686 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24687 and @expr{b = B}.
24688
24689 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24690 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24691
24692 @example
24693 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24694 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24695 @end example
24696
24697 @noindent
24698 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24699 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24700 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24701 @expr{H = x^2}.
24702
24703 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24704 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24705 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24706
24707 An example of a model that cannot be put into general linear
24708 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24709 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24710 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24711 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
24712 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
24713 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
24714 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
24715 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
24716 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
24717 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
24718 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
24719
24720 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
24721 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
24722 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
24723
24724 @tex
24725 \bigskip
24726 @end tex
24727
24728 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
24729 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
24730 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
24731 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24732 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24733 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
24734 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
24735 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
24736 command can do the same thing by brute force.
24737
24738 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
24739 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
24740 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
24741 to be minimized would be the value of
24742 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24743 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24744 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
24745
24746 @smallexample
24747 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
24748 @end smallexample
24749
24750 @noindent
24751 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
24752 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
24753 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
24754 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
24755 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
24756 were used by itself to solve the problem).
24757
24758 @tex
24759 \bigskip
24760 @end tex
24761
24762 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
24763 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
24764 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
24765 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
24766 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
24767 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
24768 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
24769 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
24770 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
24771 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
24772 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
24773 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
24774 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
24775 and so on.
24776
24777 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
24778 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
24779 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
24780 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
24781 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
24782 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
24783 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
24784 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
24785 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
24786
24787 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
24788 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
24789 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
24790 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
24791 nontrivial filter functions.
24792
24793 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
24794 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
24795 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
24796 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
24797 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
24798 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
24799 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
24800 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
24801 form. The error part of that result is used for
24802 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24803 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24804 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
24805 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
24806 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
24807 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
24808 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
24809 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
24810 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
24811 arithmetic with no error forms.
24812
24813 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
24814 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
24815 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
24816 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
24817 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
24818 @texline @math{\sigma}
24819 @infoline @expr{sigma}
24820 for the data point with no further ado.)
24821
24822 @tex
24823 \bigskip
24824 @end tex
24825
24826 @vindex FitRules
24827 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
24828 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
24829 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
24830 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
24831 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
24832 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
24833 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
24834
24835 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
24836
24837 @ignore
24838 @starindex
24839 @end ignore
24840 @tindex fitvar
24841 @ignore
24842 @starindex
24843 @end ignore
24844 @ignore
24845 @mindex @idots
24846 @end ignore
24847 @tindex fitparam
24848 @ignore
24849 @starindex
24850 @end ignore
24851 @ignore
24852 @mindex @null
24853 @end ignore
24854 @tindex fitmodel
24855 @ignore
24856 @starindex
24857 @end ignore
24858 @ignore
24859 @mindex @null
24860 @end ignore
24861 @tindex fitsystem
24862 @ignore
24863 @starindex
24864 @end ignore
24865 @ignore
24866 @mindex @null
24867 @end ignore
24868 @tindex fitdummy
24869 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
24870 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
24871 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
24872 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
24873 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
24874 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
24875 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
24876 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
24877 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
24878
24879 @smallexample
24880 @group
24881 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
24882 @end group
24883 @end smallexample
24884
24885 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
24886 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
24887 changes are possible.)
24888
24889 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
24890 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
24891
24892 @example
24893 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
24894 @end example
24895
24896 @noindent
24897 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
24898 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
24899 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
24900 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
24901 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
24902 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
24903 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
24904
24905 The power law model eventually boils down to
24906
24907 @smallexample
24908 @group
24909 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
24910 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
24911 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
24912 @end group
24913 @end smallexample
24914
24915 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
24916 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
24917 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
24918 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
24919 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
24920 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
24921 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
24922 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
24923 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
24924 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
24925 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
24926 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
24927 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
24928
24929 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
24930 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
24931 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
24932 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
24933 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
24934 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
24935 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
24936 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
24937 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
24938 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
24939 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
24940 raw parameters, for now.)
24941
24942 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
24943 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
24944 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
24945 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
24946 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
24947 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
24948 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
24949 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
24950 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
24951 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
24952 raw parameters needed.
24953
24954 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
24955 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
24956 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
24957 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
24958 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
24959 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
24960 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
24961 least-squares solver wants to see.
24962
24963 @ignore
24964 @starindex
24965 @end ignore
24966 @ignore
24967 @mindex hasfit@idots
24968 @end ignore
24969 @tindex hasfitparams
24970 @ignore
24971 @starindex
24972 @end ignore
24973 @ignore
24974 @mindex @null
24975 @end ignore
24976 @tindex hasfitvars
24977 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
24978 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
24979 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
24980 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
24981 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
24982 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
24983 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
24984 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
24985 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
24986
24987 @tex
24988 \bigskip
24989 @end tex
24990
24991 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
24992 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
24993 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
24994 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
24995 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
24996 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
24997 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
24998 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
24999 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25000 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25001
25002 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25003 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25004 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25005 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25006 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25007
25008 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25009 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25010 and variables, as discussed previously.
25011
25012 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25013 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25014 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25015 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25016
25017 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25018 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25019
25020 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25021 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25022
25023 @kindex a p
25024 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25025 @tindex polint
25026 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25027 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25028 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25029 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25030 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25031 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25032 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25033 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25034 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25035
25036 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25037 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25038 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25039 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25040 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25041 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25042
25043 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25044 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25045
25046 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25047 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25048 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25049 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25050 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25051 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25052
25053 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25054 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25055
25056 @kindex H a p
25057 @tindex ratint
25058 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25059 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25060 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25061 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25062 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25063 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25064
25065 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25066 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25067 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25068 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25069 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25070 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25071
25072 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25073 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25074 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25075 capabilities to fit.)
25076
25077 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25078 @section Summations
25079
25080 @noindent
25081 @cindex Summation of a series
25082 @kindex a +
25083 @pindex calc-summation
25084 @tindex sum
25085 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25086 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25087 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25088 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25089 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25090 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25091 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25092 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25093 produces the result 55.
25094 @tex
25095 \turnoffactive
25096 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25097 @end tex
25098
25099 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25100 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25101 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25102 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25103 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25104 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25105 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25106 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25107 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25108
25109 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25110 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25111 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25112 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25113 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25114 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25115 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25116 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25117 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25118
25119 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25120 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25121 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25122 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25123 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25124 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25125 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25126 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25127 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25128 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25129
25130 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25131 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25132 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25133 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25134 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25135 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25136
25137 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25138 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25139 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25140 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25141 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25142 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25143 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25144 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25145
25146 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25147 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25148 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25149 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25150 legal subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25151 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25152
25153 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25154 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25155 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25156 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25157 after simplification as if by @kbd{a s}, evaluate to an integer.
25158
25159 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25160 not come out to an integer, the sum is illegal and will be left
25161 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25162 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25163 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25164 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25165 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25166 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25167
25168 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25169 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25170 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25171 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25172 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25173 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25174 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25175
25176 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25177 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25178 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25179 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25180 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25181 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25182 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25183 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25184 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25185 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25186 closed form.
25187
25188 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25189 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25190 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25191 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25192 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25193 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25194 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25195 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25196 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25197 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25198 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25199 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25200 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25201 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25202
25203 @cindex Alternating sums
25204 @kindex a -
25205 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25206 @tindex asum
25207 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25208 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25209 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25210 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25211 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25212 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25213 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25214 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25215 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25216 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25217 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25218 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25219
25220 @cindex Product of a sequence
25221 @kindex a *
25222 @pindex calc-product
25223 @tindex prod
25224 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25225 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25226 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25227 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25228 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25229
25230 @kindex a T
25231 @pindex calc-tabulate
25232 @tindex table
25233 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25234 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25235 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25236 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25237 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25238
25239 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25240 @section Logical Operations
25241
25242 @noindent
25243 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25244 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25245 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25246 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25247 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25248 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25249 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25250 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25251 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25252 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25253 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25254 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25255 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25256 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25257
25258 @kindex a =
25259 @pindex calc-equal-to
25260 @tindex eq
25261 @tindex =
25262 @tindex ==
25263 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25264 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25265 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25266 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25267 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25268 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25269 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25270 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25271 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25272
25273 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25274 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25275 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25276 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25277 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25278 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25279 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25280 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25281 zero if not.
25282
25283 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25284 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25285 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25286 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25287 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25288 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25289 variables).
25290
25291 @kindex a #
25292 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25293 @tindex neq
25294 @tindex !=
25295 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25296 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25297 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25298 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25299 distinct numbers.
25300
25301 @kindex a <
25302 @tindex lt
25303 @ignore
25304 @mindex @idots
25305 @end ignore
25306 @kindex a >
25307 @ignore
25308 @mindex @null
25309 @end ignore
25310 @kindex a [
25311 @ignore
25312 @mindex @null
25313 @end ignore
25314 @kindex a ]
25315 @pindex calc-less-than
25316 @pindex calc-greater-than
25317 @pindex calc-less-equal
25318 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25319 @ignore
25320 @mindex @null
25321 @end ignore
25322 @tindex gt
25323 @ignore
25324 @mindex @null
25325 @end ignore
25326 @tindex leq
25327 @ignore
25328 @mindex @null
25329 @end ignore
25330 @tindex geq
25331 @ignore
25332 @mindex @null
25333 @end ignore
25334 @tindex <
25335 @ignore
25336 @mindex @null
25337 @end ignore
25338 @tindex >
25339 @ignore
25340 @mindex @null
25341 @end ignore
25342 @tindex <=
25343 @ignore
25344 @mindex @null
25345 @end ignore
25346 @tindex >=
25347 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25348 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25349 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25350 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25351 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25352
25353 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25354 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25355 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25356 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25357 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25358 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25359 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25360 involve both equalities and inequalities, are not allowed.
25361
25362 @kindex a .
25363 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25364 @tindex rmeq
25365 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25366 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25367 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25368 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25369 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25370 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25371 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25372 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25373 the righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25374 taking the lefthand side.
25375
25376 @kindex a &
25377 @pindex calc-logical-and
25378 @tindex land
25379 @tindex &&
25380 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25381 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25382 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25383 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25384 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25385
25386 @kindex a |
25387 @pindex calc-logical-or
25388 @tindex lor
25389 @tindex ||
25390 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25391 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25392 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25393 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25394 zero.
25395
25396 @kindex a !
25397 @pindex calc-logical-not
25398 @tindex lnot
25399 @tindex !
25400 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25401 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25402 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25403 number.
25404
25405 @kindex a :
25406 @pindex calc-logical-if
25407 @tindex if
25408 @ignore
25409 @mindex ? :
25410 @end ignore
25411 @tindex ?
25412 @ignore
25413 @mindex @null
25414 @end ignore
25415 @tindex :
25416 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25417 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25418 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25419 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25420 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25421 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25422 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25423 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25424 @code{condition}.
25425
25426 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25427 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25428 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25429 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25430
25431 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25432 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25433 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25434 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25435 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25436 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25437 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25438
25439 @kindex a @{
25440 @pindex calc-in-set
25441 @tindex in
25442 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25443 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25444 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25445 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25446 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25447 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25448 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25449 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25450 of this sort.
25451
25452 @ignore
25453 @starindex
25454 @end ignore
25455 @tindex typeof
25456 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25457 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25458 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25459
25460 @example
25461 1 Integer
25462 2 Fraction
25463 3 Floating-point number
25464 4 HMS form
25465 5 Rectangular complex number
25466 6 Polar complex number
25467 7 Error form
25468 8 Interval form
25469 9 Modulo form
25470 10 Date-only form
25471 11 Date/time form
25472 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25473 100 Variable
25474 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25475 102 Matrix
25476 @end example
25477
25478 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25479 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25480
25481 @ignore
25482 @starindex
25483 @end ignore
25484 @tindex integer
25485 @ignore
25486 @starindex
25487 @end ignore
25488 @tindex real
25489 @ignore
25490 @starindex
25491 @end ignore
25492 @tindex constant
25493 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25494 The @samp{real(a)} function
25495 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25496 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25497 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25498 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25499 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25500 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25501 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25502
25503 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25504 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25505 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25506 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25507 literally an integer constant.
25508
25509 @ignore
25510 @starindex
25511 @end ignore
25512 @tindex refers
25513 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25514 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25515 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25516 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25517 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25518 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25519
25520 @ignore
25521 @starindex
25522 @end ignore
25523 @tindex negative
25524 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25525 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25526 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25527 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25528 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25529 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25530 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25531 as a rewrite rule condition).
25532
25533 @ignore
25534 @starindex
25535 @end ignore
25536 @tindex variable
25537 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25538 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25539 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25540 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25541
25542 @ignore
25543 @starindex
25544 @end ignore
25545 @tindex nonvar
25546 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25547 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25548 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25549 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25550 often good enough.
25551
25552 @ignore
25553 @starindex
25554 @end ignore
25555 @tindex lin
25556 @ignore
25557 @starindex
25558 @end ignore
25559 @tindex linnt
25560 @ignore
25561 @starindex
25562 @end ignore
25563 @tindex islin
25564 @ignore
25565 @starindex
25566 @end ignore
25567 @tindex islinnt
25568 @cindex Linearity testing
25569 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25570 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25571 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25572 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25573 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25574 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25575 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25576 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25577 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25578 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25579 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25580 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25581 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25582 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25583 returns true.
25584
25585 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25586 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25587 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25588 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25589 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25590 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25591 linear in @expr{x}).
25592
25593 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25594 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25595 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25596 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25597 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25598 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25599 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25600 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25601 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25602 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25603
25604 @ignore
25605 @starindex
25606 @end ignore
25607 @tindex istrue
25608 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25609 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25610 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25611 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25612 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25613 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25614 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25615 in symbolic form.)
25616
25617 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25618 @section Rewrite Rules
25619
25620 @noindent
25621 @cindex Rewrite rules
25622 @cindex Transformations
25623 @cindex Pattern matching
25624 @kindex a r
25625 @pindex calc-rewrite
25626 @tindex rewrite
25627 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25628 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25629 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25630 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25631 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25632 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25633 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25634 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25635 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25636
25637 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25638 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25639 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25640 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25641 Calc formulas.
25642
25643 @menu
25644 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
25645 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
25646 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25647 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25648 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25649 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25650 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25651 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25652 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25653 * Matching Commands::
25654 * Automatic Rewrites::
25655 * Debugging Rewrites::
25656 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25657 @end menu
25658
25659 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25660 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25661
25662 @noindent
25663 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25664 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25665 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25666 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25667 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25668 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25669 assignments in special ways.
25670
25671 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25672 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25673 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25674 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25675 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25676
25677 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25678 rules.
25679
25680 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25681 in several ways:
25682
25683 @enumerate
25684 @item
25685 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25686 @item
25687 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25688 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25689 @item
25690 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25691 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25692 @item
25693 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25694 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25695 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25696 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25697 @item
25698 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25699 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25700 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25701 @end enumerate
25702
25703 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25704 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25705 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25706
25707 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25708 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25709 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25710 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25711 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25712 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
25713
25714 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
25715 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
25716 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
25717 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
25718 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
25719 reason to store your rules in a variable.
25720
25721 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
25722 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
25723 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
25724
25725 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25726 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
25727
25728 @noindent
25729 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
25730 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
25731 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
25732 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
25733 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
25734 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
25735 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
25736 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
25737 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
25738 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
25739 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
25740
25741 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
25742 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
25743 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
25744 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
25745 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
25746
25747 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
25748 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
25749 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
25750 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
25751 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
25752
25753 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
25754 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
25755 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
25756 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
25757
25758 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
25759 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
25760 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
25761 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
25762 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
25763
25764 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
25765 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
25766 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
25767 change at a time.
25768
25769 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25770 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
25771
25772 @noindent
25773 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
25774 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
25775 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
25776 is present in the
25777 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
25778 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
25779 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
25780 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
25781 with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}). If the result is a nonzero
25782 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
25783 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
25784 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
25785 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
25786 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
25787
25788 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
25789 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
25790 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
25791 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
25792 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
25793 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
25794 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
25795 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
25796 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
25797
25798 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
25799 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
25800 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
25801 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
25802 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
25803 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
25804 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
25805 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
25806 the condition.
25807
25808 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
25809 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
25810 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
25811
25812 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
25813 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
25814
25815 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
25816 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
25817 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
25818 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
25819 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
25820 matched.
25821
25822 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
25823 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
25824 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
25825 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
25826 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
25827 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
25828 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
25829 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
25830 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
25831
25832 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
25833 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
25834 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
25835 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
25836 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
25837 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
25838 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
25839 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
25840 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
25841
25842 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
25843 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
25844 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
25845 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
25846 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
25847 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
25848 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
25849 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
25850 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
25851
25852 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25853 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
25854
25855 @noindent
25856 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
25857 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
25858 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
25859 account:
25860
25861 @smallexample
25862 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
25863 @end smallexample
25864
25865 For example, the rewrite rule:
25866
25867 @example
25868 a x + b x := (a + b) x
25869 @end example
25870
25871 @noindent
25872 will match formulas of the form,
25873
25874 @example
25875 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
25876 @end example
25877
25878 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
25879 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
25880
25881 @example
25882 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
25883 @end example
25884
25885 @noindent
25886 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
25887
25888 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
25889 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
25890 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
25891
25892 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
25893 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
25894 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
25895 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
25896 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
25897 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
25898 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
25899 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
25900
25901 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
25902 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
25903 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
25904 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
25905 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
25906 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
25907 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
25908 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
25909 from occurring.
25910
25911 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
25912 the rule
25913
25914 @example
25915 f(-x) := -f(x)
25916 @end example
25917
25918 @noindent
25919 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
25920 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
25921 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
25922 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
25923 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
25924 condition is:
25925
25926 @example
25927 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
25928 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
25929 @end example
25930
25931 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
25932 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
25933
25934 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
25935 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
25936 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
25937 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
25938
25939 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
25940 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
25941 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
25942 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
25943 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
25944 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
25945 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
25946 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
25947 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
25948 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
25949
25950 Even more subtle is the rule set
25951
25952 @example
25953 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
25954 @end example
25955
25956 @noindent
25957 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
25958 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
25959 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
25960 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
25961 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
25962 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
25963 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
25964 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
25965 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
25966 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
25967 rule will have to be added.
25968
25969 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
25970 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
25971 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
25972 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
25973 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
25974
25975 @example
25976 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
25977 @end example
25978
25979 @noindent
25980 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
25981 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
25982 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
25983 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
25984 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
25985 conjugate of a real number.)
25986
25987 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
25988
25989 @example
25990 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
25991 @end example
25992
25993 @noindent
25994 will match the formula
25995
25996 @example
25997 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
25998 @end example
25999
26000 @noindent
26001 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26002 formulas like
26003
26004 @example
26005 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26006 @end example
26007
26008 @noindent
26009 producing, respectively,
26010
26011 @example
26012 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26013 @end example
26014
26015 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26016 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26017
26018 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26019 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26020 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26021 with @samp{a = -1}.
26022
26023 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26024
26025 @example
26026 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26027 @end example
26028
26029 @noindent
26030 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26031
26032 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26033 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26034 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26035 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26036 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26037 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26038 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26039 for a multiplication, not a division.
26040
26041 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26042 by 1,
26043
26044 @example
26045 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26046 @end example
26047
26048 @noindent
26049 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26050 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26051
26052 @example
26053 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26054 @end example
26055
26056 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26057 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26058
26059 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26060
26061 @example
26062 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26063 @end example
26064
26065 @noindent
26066 into the form
26067
26068 @example
26069 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26070 @end example
26071
26072 @noindent
26073 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26074 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26075 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26076 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26077 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26078
26079 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26080 following rule,
26081
26082 @example
26083 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26084 @end example
26085
26086 @noindent
26087 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26088 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26089 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26090 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26091 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26092 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26093 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26094
26095 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26096 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26097 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26098
26099 @example
26100 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26101 @end example
26102
26103 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26104 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26105 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26106 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26107 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26108 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26109 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26110 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26111
26112 @smallexample
26113 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26114 max min re im conj arg
26115 @end smallexample
26116
26117 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26118 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26119 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26120 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26121 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26122 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26123 For example,
26124
26125 @example
26126 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26127 @end example
26128
26129 @noindent
26130 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26131 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26132 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26133 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26134 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26135 further and use
26136
26137 @example
26138 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26139 @end example
26140
26141 @noindent
26142 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26143
26144 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26145 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26146 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26147
26148 @example
26149 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26150 @end example
26151
26152 @noindent
26153 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26154
26155 @example
26156 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26157 @end example
26158
26159 @noindent
26160 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26161 effect!
26162
26163 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26164 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26165 in the rule
26166
26167 @example
26168 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26169 @end example
26170
26171 @noindent
26172 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26173 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26174 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26175 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26176 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26177 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26178 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26179 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26180 marker on the righthand side:
26181
26182 @example
26183 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26184 @end example
26185
26186 @noindent
26187 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26188 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26189 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26190
26191 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26192 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26193
26194 @noindent
26195 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26196 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26197 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26198 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26199
26200 @ignore
26201 @starindex
26202 @end ignore
26203 @tindex import
26204 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26205 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26206 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26207 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26208 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26209 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26210 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26211 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26212 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26213 @texline @math{v_1},
26214 @infoline @expr{v1},
26215 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26216 @texline @math{x_1}
26217 @infoline @expr{x1}
26218 and so on. (If
26219 @texline @math{v_1}
26220 @infoline @expr{v1}
26221 is used as a function name, then
26222 @texline @math{x_1}
26223 @infoline @expr{x1}
26224 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26225 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26226 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26227 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26228 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26229
26230 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26231
26232 @table @samp
26233 @item quote(x)
26234 @ignore
26235 @starindex
26236 @end ignore
26237 @tindex quote
26238 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26239 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26240 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26241 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26242 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26243 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26244 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26245 as a result in this case.)
26246
26247 @item plain(x)
26248 @ignore
26249 @starindex
26250 @end ignore
26251 @tindex plain
26252 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26253 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26254 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26255 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26256 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26257 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26258 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26259 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26260
26261 @item opt(x,def)
26262 @ignore
26263 @starindex
26264 @end ignore
26265 @tindex opt
26266 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26267 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26268 the argument or element is optional.
26269 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26270 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26271 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26272 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26273 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26274 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26275
26276 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26277 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26278 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26279 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26280 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26281 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26282 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26283 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26284 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26285
26286 @item condition(x,c)
26287 @ignore
26288 @starindex
26289 @end ignore
26290 @tindex condition
26291 @tindex ::
26292 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26293 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26294
26295 @item pand(x,y)
26296 @ignore
26297 @starindex
26298 @end ignore
26299 @tindex pand
26300 @tindex &&&
26301 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26302 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26303 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26304
26305 @item por(x,y)
26306 @ignore
26307 @starindex
26308 @end ignore
26309 @tindex por
26310 @tindex |||
26311 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26312 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26313
26314 @item pnot(x)
26315 @ignore
26316 @starindex
26317 @end ignore
26318 @tindex pnot
26319 @tindex !!!
26320 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26321 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26322
26323 @item cons(h,t)
26324 @ignore
26325 @mindex cons
26326 @end ignore
26327 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26328 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26329 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26330 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26331 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26332 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26333 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26334
26335 @item rcons(t,h)
26336 @ignore
26337 @mindex rcons
26338 @end ignore
26339 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26340 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26341 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26342 to @expr{t}.
26343
26344 @item apply(f,args)
26345 @ignore
26346 @mindex apply
26347 @end ignore
26348 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26349 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26350 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26351 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26352 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26353 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26354 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26355 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26356 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26357 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26358 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26359 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26360 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26361 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26362 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26363
26364 @example
26365 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26366 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26367 @end example
26368
26369 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26370 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26371 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26372 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26373 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26374 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26375 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26376
26377 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26378 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26379 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26380
26381 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26382 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26383 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26384 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26385 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26386 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26387 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26388 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26389 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26390 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26391
26392 @item select(x)
26393 @ignore
26394 @starindex
26395 @end ignore
26396 @tindex select
26397 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26398 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26399 @end table
26400
26401 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26402
26403 @table @samp
26404 @item quote(x)
26405 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26406 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26407 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26408 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26409 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26410 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26411 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26412 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26413 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26414 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26415
26416 @item plain(x)
26417 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26418 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26419 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26420 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26421 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26422 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26423 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26424
26425 @item cons(h,t)
26426 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26427 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26428 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26429 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26430 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26431 have been turned off.
26432
26433 @item rcons(t,h)
26434 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26435 the vector @expr{t}.
26436
26437 @item apply(f,args)
26438 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26439 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26440 is also a regular Calc function.
26441
26442 @item eval(x)
26443 @ignore
26444 @starindex
26445 @end ignore
26446 @tindex eval
26447 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26448 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26449 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26450 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26451 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26452 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26453 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26454
26455 @item evalsimp(x)
26456 @ignore
26457 @starindex
26458 @end ignore
26459 @tindex evalsimp
26460 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26461 way, then algebraically simplified as if by the @kbd{a s} command.
26462
26463 @item evalextsimp(x)
26464 @ignore
26465 @starindex
26466 @end ignore
26467 @tindex evalextsimp
26468 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26469 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26470
26471 @item select(x)
26472 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26473 @end table
26474
26475 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26476
26477 @table @samp
26478 @item let(v := x)
26479 @ignore
26480 @starindex
26481 @end ignore
26482 @tindex let
26483 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26484 The @kbd{a s} command's simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26485 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26486 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26487 of simplification. The
26488 result of @expr{x} is then bound to the meta-variable @expr{v}. As
26489 usual, if this meta-variable has already been matched to something
26490 else the two values must be equal; if the meta-variable is new then
26491 it is bound to the result of the expression. This variable can then
26492 appear in later conditions, and on the righthand side of the rule.
26493 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26494 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26495 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26496 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26497 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26498 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26499
26500 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26501 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26502 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26503 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26504
26505 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26506 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26507 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26508 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26509 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26510 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26511 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26512 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26513 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26514 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26515 be bound to @code{ia}.
26516
26517 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26518 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26519 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26520 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26521 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26522 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26523 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26524 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26525 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26526 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26527
26528 @ignore
26529 @starindex
26530 @end ignore
26531 @tindex ierf
26532 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26533 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26534 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26535 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26536 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26537 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26538
26539 @example
26540 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26541 @end example
26542
26543 @item matches(v,p)
26544 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26545 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26546 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26547 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26548 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26549 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26550 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26551 rule.
26552
26553 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26554 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26555 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26556
26557 @item remember
26558 @vindex remember
26559 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26560 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26561 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26562 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26563 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26564 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26565 contains any variables.
26566
26567 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26568 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26569 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26570 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26571 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26572 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26573
26574 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26575 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26576 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26577 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26578 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26579 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26580 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26581
26582 @item remember(c)
26583 @ignore
26584 @starindex
26585 @end ignore
26586 @tindex remember
26587 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26588 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26589 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26590 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26591 @end table
26592
26593 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26594 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26595
26596 @noindent
26597 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26598 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26599 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26600 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26601 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26602
26603 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26604 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26605 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26606
26607 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26608 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26609 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26610 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26611
26612 @example
26613 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26614 @end example
26615
26616 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26617
26618 @example
26619 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26620 @end example
26621
26622 @ignore
26623 @starindex
26624 @end ignore
26625 @tindex ends
26626 Here's another interesting example:
26627
26628 @example
26629 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26630 @end example
26631
26632 @noindent
26633 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26634 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26635 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26636
26637 @example
26638 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26639 @end example
26640
26641 @noindent
26642 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26643 one-element vector.
26644
26645 @tex
26646 \bigskip
26647 @end tex
26648
26649 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26650 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26651 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26652
26653 @ignore
26654 @starindex
26655 @end ignore
26656 @tindex curve
26657 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26658
26659 @example
26660 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26661 @end example
26662
26663 @noindent
26664 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26665
26666 Here is a larger example:
26667
26668 @example
26669 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26670 @end example
26671
26672 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26673 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26674 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26675
26676 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26677 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26678
26679 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26680 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26681 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26682 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26683 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26684 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26685 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26686 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26687
26688 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26689 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26690 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26691 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26692
26693 @example
26694 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26695 @end example
26696
26697 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26698 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26699
26700 @tex
26701 \bigskip
26702 @end tex
26703
26704 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26705 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26706 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26707
26708 For example,
26709
26710 @example
26711 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26712 @end example
26713
26714 @noindent
26715 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
26716 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
26717 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
26718
26719 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
26720 then an equivalent rule would be:
26721
26722 @example
26723 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
26724 @end example
26725
26726 @noindent
26727 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
26728 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
26729 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
26730 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
26731 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
26732 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
26733 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
26734
26735 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
26736 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
26737
26738 @example
26739 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
26740 @end example
26741
26742 @noindent
26743 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
26744 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
26745
26746 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
26747 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
26748 matched last. Thus
26749
26750 @example
26751 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
26752 @end example
26753
26754 @noindent
26755 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
26756 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
26757 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
26758 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
26759 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
26760 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
26761
26762 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26763 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
26764
26765 @noindent
26766 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
26767 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
26768 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
26769 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
26770 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
26771 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
26772 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
26773 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
26774
26775 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
26776 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
26777 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
26778 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
26779 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
26780 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
26781 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
26782 anywhere in the formula.
26783
26784 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
26785 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
26786 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
26787 side actually comes out to something different than the original
26788 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
26789 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
26790 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
26791 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
26792 forms.
26793
26794 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
26795 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
26796 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
26797 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
26798 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
26799
26800 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
26801 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
26802 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
26803 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
26804
26805 @ignore
26806 @starindex
26807 @end ignore
26808 @ignore
26809 @mindex iter@idots
26810 @end ignore
26811 @tindex iterations
26812 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
26813 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
26814 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
26815 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
26816 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
26817 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
26818 rule set.
26819
26820 @example
26821 [ iterations(1),
26822 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
26823 @end example
26824
26825 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
26826 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
26827 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
26828 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
26829 that was matched.
26830
26831 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
26832
26833 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
26834 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
26835 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
26836
26837 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
26838 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
26839 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
26840 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
26841 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
26842 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
26843 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
26844 are omitted, 100 is used.
26845
26846 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26847 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
26848
26849 @noindent
26850 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
26851 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
26852 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
26853 phases occur during the rewriting process.
26854
26855 @ignore
26856 @starindex
26857 @end ignore
26858 @tindex phase
26859 @vindex all
26860 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
26861 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
26862 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
26863 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
26864 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
26865 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
26866
26867 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
26868 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
26869 ascending order. For example, the rule set
26870
26871 @example
26872 @group
26873 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
26874 phase(1),
26875 f1(x) := g1(x),
26876 phase(2),
26877 f2(x) := g2(x),
26878 phase(3),
26879 f3(x) := g3(x),
26880 phase(1,2),
26881 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
26882 @end group
26883 @end example
26884
26885 @noindent
26886 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
26887 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
26888 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
26889 and @code{f3}.
26890
26891 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
26892 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
26893 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
26894 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
26895 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
26896 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
26897 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
26898 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
26899 100 by default, is reached.)
26900
26901 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
26902 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
26903 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
26904 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
26905 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
26906 in the formula.
26907
26908 @ignore
26909 @starindex
26910 @end ignore
26911 @tindex schedule
26912 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
26913 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
26914 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
26915 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
26916 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
26917 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
26918 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
26919 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
26920 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
26921 moving on to phase 3.
26922
26923 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
26924 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
26925 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
26926 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
26927 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
26928 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
26929 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
26930 touches.
26931
26932 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
26933 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
26934 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
26935 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
26936 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
26937 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
26938 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
26939
26940 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
26941 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
26942 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
26943 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
26944 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
26945 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
26946
26947 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
26948 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
26949 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
26950 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
26951 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
26952 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
26953 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
26954 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
26955 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
26956 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
26957 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
26958
26959 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
26960 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
26961 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
26962 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
26963 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
26964 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
26965 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
26966
26967 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26968 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
26969
26970 @noindent
26971 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
26972 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
26973 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
26974 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
26975 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
26976
26977 @kindex j r
26978 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
26979 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
26980 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
26981 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
26982 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
26983 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
26984 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
26985 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
26986 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
26987
26988 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
26989 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
26990 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
26991 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
26992 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
26993 the selected sub-formula should appear.
26994
26995 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
26996 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
26997 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
26998 formula will be unselected.
26999
27000 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27001 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27002 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27003 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27004 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27005 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27006 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27007 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27008
27009 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27010 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27011 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27012 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27013
27014 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27015 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27016 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27017 at stack level 1.)
27018
27019 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27020 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27021 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27022 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27023 target and the rewrite rules).
27024
27025 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27026 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27027 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27028 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27029 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27030 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27031
27032 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27033 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27034 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27035 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27036 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27037 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27038 both with and without selections.
27039
27040 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27041 @subsection Matching Commands
27042
27043 @noindent
27044 @kindex a m
27045 @pindex calc-match
27046 @tindex match
27047 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27048 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27049 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27050 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27051 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27052 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27053 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27054 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27055 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27056 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27057 of the patterns.
27058
27059 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27060 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27061
27062 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27063
27064 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27065 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27066 all the positive vector elements.
27067
27068 @kindex I a m
27069 @tindex matchnot
27070 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27071 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27072
27073 @ignore
27074 @starindex
27075 @end ignore
27076 @tindex matches
27077 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27078 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27079 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27080 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27081
27082 @ignore
27083 @starindex
27084 @end ignore
27085 @tindex vmatches
27086 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27087 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27088 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27089 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27090 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27091
27092 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27093 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27094
27095 @noindent
27096 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27097 @vindex EvalRules
27098 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27099 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27100 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27101 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27102 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27103
27104 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27105 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27106 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27107 set would be,
27108
27109 @smallexample
27110 @group
27111 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27112 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27113 @end group
27114 @end smallexample
27115
27116 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27117 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27118 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27119 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27120 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27121 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27122 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27123
27124 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27125 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27126 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27127 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27128 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27129 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27130 applies rules from the top down.
27131
27132 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27133 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27134
27135 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27136 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27137 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27138 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27139 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27140 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27141 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27142 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27143 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27144 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27145 or ran too long'' message.
27146
27147 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27148 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27149 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27150 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27151 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27152 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27153 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27154 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27155 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27156 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27157 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27158 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27159 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27160
27161 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27162 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27163 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27164 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27165 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27166 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27167 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27168 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27169 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27170 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27171 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27172 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27173 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27174
27175 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27176 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27177 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27178 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27179
27180 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27181 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27182 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27183 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27184 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27185 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27186 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27187 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27188
27189 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27190 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27191 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27192 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27193 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27194 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27195 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27196 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27197 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27198 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27199 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27200 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27201 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27202 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27203
27204 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27205 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27206 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27207 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27208 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27209 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27210 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27211 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27212 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27213 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27214 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27215 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27216 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27217
27218 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27219 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27220
27221 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27222 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27223 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27224 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27225 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27226 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27227 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27228
27229 @smallexample
27230 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27231 @end smallexample
27232
27233 @noindent
27234 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27235 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27236 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27237 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27238
27239 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27240 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27241 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27242 but only when @kbd{a s} is used to simplify the formula. The variable
27243 @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose. The @kbd{a s} command
27244 will apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as
27245 well as all of its built-in simplifications.
27246
27247 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27248 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27249 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of @kbd{a s}.
27250 It then applies its own built-in simplifications throughout the
27251 formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with applying the
27252 default simplifications) until no further changes are possible.
27253
27254 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27255 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27256 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27257 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27258 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27259 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27260 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27261 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27262 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27263
27264 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27265 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27266
27267 @noindent
27268 If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27269 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27270 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27271 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27272 noted.
27273
27274 Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27275 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27276
27277 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27278 @samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27279 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27280 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27281 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27282 be needlessly slow.
27283
27284 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27285 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27286
27287 @noindent
27288 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27289 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27290 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27291 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27292 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27293 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27294 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27295
27296 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27297 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27298 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27299 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27300 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27301 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27302 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27303
27304 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27305 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27306 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27307 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27308 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27309 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27310 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27311 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27312
27313 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27314 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27315 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27316 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27317 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27318 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27319 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27320 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27321 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27322 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27323
27324 @cindex Quaternions
27325 The following rule set, contributed by
27326 @texline Fran\c cois
27327 @infoline Francois
27328 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27329 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27330 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27331 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27332 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27333 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27334 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27335 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27336 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27337 @key{RET}}.
27338
27339 @smallexample
27340 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27341 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27342 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27343 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27344 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27345 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27346 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27347 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27348 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27349 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27350 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27351 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27352 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27353 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27354 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27355 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27356 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27357 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27358 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27359 @end smallexample
27360
27361 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27362 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27363 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27364 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27365 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27366 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27367 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27368
27369 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27370 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27371 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27372 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27373 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27374 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27375
27376 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27377 @chapter Operating on Units
27378
27379 @noindent
27380 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27381 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27382 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27383 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27384 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27385
27386 @menu
27387 * Basic Operations on Units::
27388 * The Units Table::
27389 * Predefined Units::
27390 * User-Defined Units::
27391 @end menu
27392
27393 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27394 @section Basic Operations on Units
27395
27396 @noindent
27397 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27398 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27399 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27400 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27401 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27402 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27403 formula.
27404
27405 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27406 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27407 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27408 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27409 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27410 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27411
27412 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27413 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27414 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27415 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27416 representation of one millimeter.
27417
27418 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27419 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27420 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27421
27422 @kindex u s
27423 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27424 @ignore
27425 @mindex usimpl@idots
27426 @end ignore
27427 @tindex usimplify
27428 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27429 simplifies a units
27430 expression. It uses @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) to simplify the
27431 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27432 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27433 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27434 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27435 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27436 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27437 automatically at all times.
27438
27439 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27440 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27441 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27442 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27443 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27444 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27445 applied to units expressions, in which case
27446 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27447 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27448 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27449
27450 @kindex u c
27451 @pindex calc-convert-units
27452 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27453 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27454 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27455 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If the units you request are inconsistent with
27456 the original units, the number will be converted into your units
27457 times whatever ``remainder'' units are left over. For example,
27458 converting @samp{55 mph} into acres produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}.
27459 (Recall that multiplication binds more strongly than division in Calc
27460 formulas, so the units here are acres per meter-second.) Remainder
27461 units are expressed in terms of ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and
27462 @samp{s}, regardless of the input units.
27463
27464 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27465 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27466 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27467 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27468 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27469 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27470 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27471 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27472
27473 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27474 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27475 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27476 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27477 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27478 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27479
27480 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27481 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27482 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27483 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27484 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27485 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27486 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27487
27488 @cindex Composite units
27489 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27490 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27491 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27492 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27493 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27494 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27495 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27496 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27497 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27498 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27499 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27500 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27501 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27502
27503 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27504 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27505 to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27506 give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
27507 any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}} converts the number
27508 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27509
27510 @kindex u b
27511 @pindex calc-base-units
27512 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27513 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27514 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27515 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27516
27517 The @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u b} commands treat temperature units (like
27518 @samp{degC} and @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example,
27519 @kbd{u c} converts @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10
27520 degrees Celsius corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit.
27521
27522 @kindex u t
27523 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27524 @cindex Temperature conversion
27525 The @kbd{u t} (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command converts
27526 absolute temperatures. The value on the stack must be a simple units
27527 expression with units of temperature only. This command would convert
27528 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the equivalent temperature on the
27529 Fahrenheit scale.
27530
27531 @kindex u r
27532 @pindex calc-remove-units
27533 @kindex u x
27534 @pindex calc-extract-units
27535 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27536 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27537 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27538 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27539 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27540 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27541
27542 @kindex u a
27543 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27544 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27545 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27546 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27547 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27548 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27549 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27550 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27551 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27552 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27553
27554 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27555 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27556 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27557 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27558 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27559 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27560 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27561 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27562 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27563 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27564 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27565 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27566 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27567 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27568 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27569 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27570
27571 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27572 @section The Units Table
27573
27574 @noindent
27575 @kindex u v
27576 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27577 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27578 in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27579 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27580 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27581 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27582 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27583 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27584 and steradians.
27585
27586 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27587 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27588 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27589 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27590 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27591 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27592
27593 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27594 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27595 argument to @kbd{u v}.
27596
27597 @kindex u V
27598 @pindex calc-view-units-table
27599 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27600 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27601 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27602 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{M-# c}
27603 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27604 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27605 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27606
27607 @kindex u g
27608 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27609 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27610 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27611 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27612 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27613 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27614 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27615 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27616 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27617 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27618
27619 @kindex u e
27620 @pindex calc-explain-units
27621 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27622 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27623 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27624 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27625 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27626 column of the Units Table.
27627
27628 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27629 @section Predefined Units
27630
27631 @noindent
27632 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27633 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27634 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27635 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27636 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27637 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27638 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27639 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27640
27641 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27642 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27643 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27644 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27645 of the various temperature scales.
27646
27647 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27648 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27649
27650 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27651 @tex
27652 for \AA ngstroms.
27653 @end tex
27654 @ifinfo
27655 for Angstroms.
27656 @end ifinfo
27657
27658 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27659 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. There is
27660 also @code{tpt}, which stands for a printer's point as defined by the
27661 @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 tpt = 1 in}.
27662
27663 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
27664 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
27665 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
27666 preferable to @code{e}.
27667
27668 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
27669 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
27670 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
27671
27672 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
27673 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
27674
27675 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
27676 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
27677
27678 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
27679 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
27680 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
27681 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
27682 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
27683 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
27684 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
27685 units.
27686
27687 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{fsc} (the fine structure constant,
27688 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
27689 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
27690 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
27691 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
27692 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
27693 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
27694 really is unitless.)
27695
27696 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
27697
27698 @node User-Defined Units, , Predefined Units, Units
27699 @section User-Defined Units
27700
27701 @noindent
27702 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
27703 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
27704
27705 @kindex u 0-9
27706 @pindex calc-quick-units
27707 @vindex Units
27708 @cindex @code{Units} variable
27709 @cindex Quick units
27710 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
27711 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
27712 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
27713 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
27714 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
27715 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
27716 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
27717 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
27718 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
27719 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
27720 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
27721 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
27722
27723 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
27724 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
27725 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
27726 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
27727 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
27728 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27729
27730 @kindex u d
27731 @pindex calc-define-unit
27732 @cindex User-defined units
27733 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
27734 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
27735 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
27736 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
27737 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
27738 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
27739 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
27740 appear in the Units Table.
27741
27742 @kindex u u
27743 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
27744 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
27745 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
27746 however.
27747
27748 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
27749 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
27750 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
27751 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
27752 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
27753
27754 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
27755 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
27756 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
27757 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
27758 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
27759 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
27760 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
27761 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
27762 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
27763
27764 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
27765 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
27766
27767 @kindex u p
27768 @pindex calc-permanent-units
27769 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
27770 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
27771 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
27772 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so that the
27773 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
27774 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
27775 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
27776 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
27777
27778 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
27779 @chapter Storing and Recalling
27780
27781 @noindent
27782 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
27783 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
27784 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
27785 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
27786
27787 @menu
27788 * Storing Variables::
27789 * Recalling Variables::
27790 * Operations on Variables::
27791 * Let Command::
27792 * Evaluates-To Operator::
27793 @end menu
27794
27795 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
27796 @section Storing Variables
27797
27798 @noindent
27799 @kindex s s
27800 @pindex calc-store
27801 @cindex Storing variables
27802 @cindex Quick variables
27803 @vindex q0
27804 @vindex q9
27805 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
27806 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
27807 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
27808 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
27809 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
27810
27811 @kindex s t
27812 @pindex calc-store-into
27813 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
27814 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
27815 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
27816
27817 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
27818 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
27819 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
27820 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
27821 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
27822 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
27823 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
27824 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
27825
27826 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
27827 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
27828 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
27829 righthand sides simultaneously.
27830
27831 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
27832 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
27833 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
27834 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
27835 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
27836 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
27837
27838 @kindex s 0-9
27839 @kindex t 0-9
27840 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
27841 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
27842 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
27843 for trail and time/date commands.)
27844
27845 @kindex s +
27846 @kindex s -
27847 @ignore
27848 @mindex @idots
27849 @end ignore
27850 @kindex s *
27851 @ignore
27852 @mindex @null
27853 @end ignore
27854 @kindex s /
27855 @ignore
27856 @mindex @null
27857 @end ignore
27858 @kindex s ^
27859 @ignore
27860 @mindex @null
27861 @end ignore
27862 @kindex s |
27863 @ignore
27864 @mindex @null
27865 @end ignore
27866 @kindex s n
27867 @ignore
27868 @mindex @null
27869 @end ignore
27870 @kindex s &
27871 @ignore
27872 @mindex @null
27873 @end ignore
27874 @kindex s [
27875 @ignore
27876 @mindex @null
27877 @end ignore
27878 @kindex s ]
27879 @pindex calc-store-plus
27880 @pindex calc-store-minus
27881 @pindex calc-store-times
27882 @pindex calc-store-div
27883 @pindex calc-store-power
27884 @pindex calc-store-concat
27885 @pindex calc-store-neg
27886 @pindex calc-store-inv
27887 @pindex calc-store-decr
27888 @pindex calc-store-incr
27889 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
27890 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
27891 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
27892 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
27893 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
27894 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
27895
27896 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
27897 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
27898 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
27899 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
27900 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
27901 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
27902 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
27903 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
27904 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
27905 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
27906 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
27907 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
27908 forwards and backwards:
27909
27910 @example
27911 @group
27912 s + v := v + a v := a + v
27913 s - v := v - a v := a - v
27914 s * v := v * a v := a * v
27915 s / v := v / a v := a / v
27916 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
27917 s | v := v | a v := a | v
27918 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
27919 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
27920 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
27921 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
27922 @end group
27923 @end example
27924
27925 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
27926 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
27927 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
27928 minus-two minus the variable.
27929
27930 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
27931 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
27932 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
27933
27934 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
27935 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
27936 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
27937 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
27938 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
27939 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
27940 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
27941
27942 @kindex s m
27943 @pindex calc-store-map
27944 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
27945 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
27946 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
27947 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
27948 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
27949 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
27950 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
27951 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
27952 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
27953 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
27954 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
27955
27956 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
27957 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
27958 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
27959 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
27960 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
27961 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
27962 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
27963
27964 @kindex s x
27965 @pindex calc-store-exchange
27966 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
27967 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
27968 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
27969
27970 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
27971 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
27972 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
27973
27974 @kindex s u
27975 @pindex calc-unstore
27976 @cindex Void variables
27977 @cindex Un-storing variables
27978 Until you store something in them, variables are ``void,'' that is, they
27979 contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula they
27980 will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
27981 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
27982 void state.
27983
27984 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
27985 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
27986 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
27987 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
27988 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
27989 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
27990 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
27991 normally void).
27992
27993 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored
27994 in it, but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{}
27995 at the current precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and
27996 @code{phi} evaluate according to the current precision or polar mode.
27997 If you recall a value from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic
27998 property will be lost.
27999
28000 @kindex s c
28001 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28002 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28003 value of one variable to another. It differs from a simple @kbd{s r}
28004 followed by an @kbd{s t} in two important ways. First, the value never
28005 goes on the stack and thus is never rounded, evaluated, or simplified
28006 in any way; it is not even rounded down to the current precision.
28007 Second, the ``magic'' contents of a variable like @code{e} can
28008 be copied into another variable with this command, perhaps because
28009 you need to unstore @code{e} right now but you wish to put it
28010 back when you're done. The @kbd{s c} command is the only way to
28011 manipulate these magic values intact.
28012
28013 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28014 @section Recalling Variables
28015
28016 @noindent
28017 @kindex s r
28018 @pindex calc-recall
28019 @cindex Recalling variables
28020 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28021 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28022 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28023 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28024 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28025
28026 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28027 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28028 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28029 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28030 latter will produce an error message.
28031
28032 @kindex r 0-9
28033 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28034 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}. (The @kbd{r} prefix is otherwise unused
28035 in the current version of Calc.)
28036
28037 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28038 @section Other Operations on Variables
28039
28040 @noindent
28041 @kindex s e
28042 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28043 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28044 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28045 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28046 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28047 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28048 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28049 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28050 description of editing.
28051
28052 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28053 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28054 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28055 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28056 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28057 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28058 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28059 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28060 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28061 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28062
28063 @kindex s A
28064 @kindex s D
28065 @ignore
28066 @mindex @idots
28067 @end ignore
28068 @kindex s E
28069 @ignore
28070 @mindex @null
28071 @end ignore
28072 @kindex s F
28073 @ignore
28074 @mindex @null
28075 @end ignore
28076 @kindex s G
28077 @ignore
28078 @mindex @null
28079 @end ignore
28080 @kindex s H
28081 @ignore
28082 @mindex @null
28083 @end ignore
28084 @kindex s I
28085 @ignore
28086 @mindex @null
28087 @end ignore
28088 @kindex s L
28089 @ignore
28090 @mindex @null
28091 @end ignore
28092 @kindex s P
28093 @ignore
28094 @mindex @null
28095 @end ignore
28096 @kindex s R
28097 @ignore
28098 @mindex @null
28099 @end ignore
28100 @kindex s T
28101 @ignore
28102 @mindex @null
28103 @end ignore
28104 @kindex s U
28105 @ignore
28106 @mindex @null
28107 @end ignore
28108 @kindex s X
28109 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28110 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28111 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28112 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28113 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28114 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28115 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28116 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28117 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28118 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28119 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28120 @pindex calc-store-Units
28121 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28122 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28123 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28124
28125 @table @kbd
28126 @item s A
28127 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28128 @item s D
28129 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28130 @item s E
28131 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Default Simplifications}.
28132 @item s F
28133 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28134 @item s G
28135 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28136 @item s H
28137 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28138 @item s I
28139 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28140 @item s L
28141 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28142 @item s P
28143 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28144 @item s R
28145 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28146 @item s T
28147 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28148 @item s U
28149 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28150 @item s X
28151 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28152 @end table
28153
28154 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28155 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28156
28157 @kindex s p
28158 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28159 @cindex Storing variables
28160 @cindex Permanent variables
28161 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28162 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28163 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28164 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so
28165 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28166 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28167 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28168 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28169 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28170
28171 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28172 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28173 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28174 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28175 and @code{PlotRejects};
28176 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28177 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28178 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28179 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28180
28181 @kindex s i
28182 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28183 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28184 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28185 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28186 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28187 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28188 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28189 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28190 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28191 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28192 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28193
28194 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28195 @section The Let Command
28196
28197 @noindent
28198 @kindex s l
28199 @pindex calc-let
28200 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28201 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28202 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28203 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28204 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28205 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28206
28207 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28208 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28209 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28210 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28211 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28212 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28213 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28214 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28215 by these commands.
28216
28217 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28218 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28219 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28220
28221 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28222 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28223 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28224
28225 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28226 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28227 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28228 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28229 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28230 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28231
28232 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28233 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
28234
28235 @noindent
28236 @tindex evalto
28237 @tindex =>
28238 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
28239 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
28240 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28241 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28242 other language modes like Pascal and @TeX{}.) This is a binary
28243 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28244 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28245
28246 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28247 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28248 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28249 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28250 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28251 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28252
28253 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28254 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28255 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28256
28257 @kindex s =
28258 @pindex calc-evalto
28259 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28260 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28261 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28262 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28263 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28264
28265 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28266 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28267 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28268 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28269 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28270 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28271 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28272 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28273 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28274 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28275 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28276 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28277 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28278 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28279 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28280
28281 @kindex m C
28282 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
28283 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28284 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28285 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28286 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28287 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28288 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28289 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28290
28291 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28292 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28293 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28294 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28295 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28296 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28297 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
28298
28299 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28300 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28301 formula @samp{x + y + x} is not handled by Calc's default
28302 simplifications, but the @kbd{a s} command will reduce it to
28303 the simpler form @samp{y + 2 x}. You can also type @kbd{m A}
28304 to enable an Algebraic Simplification mode in which the
28305 equivalent of @kbd{a s} is used on all of Calc's results.
28306 If you enter @samp{x + y + x =>} normally, the result will
28307 be @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x}. If you change to
28308 Algebraic Simplification mode, the result will be
28309 @samp{x + y + x => y + 2 x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a s}
28310 once will have no effect on @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x},
28311 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28312 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28313 affected by commands like @kbd{a s}.
28314
28315 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28316 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28317 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28318 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28319 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28320 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28321 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28322 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28323 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28324 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28325
28326 @smallexample
28327 @group
28328 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
28329 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28330 . . .
28331
28332 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28333 @end group
28334 @end smallexample
28335
28336 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28337 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28338 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28339 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28340 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
28341 side effects.
28342
28343 @kindex s :
28344 @pindex calc-assign
28345 @tindex assign
28346 @tindex :=
28347 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
28348 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
28349 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
28350 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
28351 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
28352 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
28353 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
28354 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
28355 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
28356
28357 @xref{TeX Language Mode}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
28358 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
28359 treatment to @samp{=>}.
28360
28361 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
28362 @chapter Graphics
28363
28364 @noindent
28365 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
28366 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or 3.0 to do graphics. These commands will only work
28367 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
28368 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
28369 However, it is free software and can be obtained from the Free
28370 Software Foundation's machine @samp{prep.ai.mit.edu}.)
28371
28372 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
28373 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
28374 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable
28375 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some Lisp
28376 variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
28377 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are
28378 using the X window system, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
28379 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 and you are not using X,
28380 Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display graphs using simple character
28381 graphics that will work on any terminal.
28382
28383 @menu
28384 * Basic Graphics::
28385 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
28386 * Managing Curves::
28387 * Graphics Options::
28388 * Devices::
28389 @end menu
28390
28391 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
28392 @section Basic Graphics
28393
28394 @noindent
28395 @kindex g f
28396 @pindex calc-graph-fast
28397 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
28398 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
28399 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
28400 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
28401 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
28402 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
28403 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
28404 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
28405 to indicate the points themselves.
28406
28407 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
28408 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
28409 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
28410
28411 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
28412 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
28413 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
28414
28415 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
28416 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
28417 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
28418 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
28419 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
28420 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
28421 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
28422 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
28423 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
28424
28425 @ignore
28426 @starindex
28427 @end ignore
28428 @tindex xy
28429 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
28430 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
28431 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
28432 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
28433 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
28434 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
28435 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
28436 will be a circle.
28437
28438 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
28439 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
28440 variables.
28441
28442 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
28443 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
28444 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). If either the ``x''
28445 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
28446 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
28447 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
28448
28449 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
28450 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
28451
28452 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
28453 @vindex PlotRejects
28454 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
28455 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
28456 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
28457 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
28458 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
28459 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
28460 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
28461 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
28462 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
28463 @code{PlotRejects}.
28464
28465 @kindex g c
28466 @pindex calc-graph-clear
28467 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
28468 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
28469 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
28470 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
28471 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
28472 window if there is one.
28473
28474 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
28475 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
28476
28477 @kindex g F
28478 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
28479 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
28480 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
28481 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
28482
28483 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
28484 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
28485 are several options for these values.
28486
28487 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
28488 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
28489 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
28490 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
28491 result is a surface plot where
28492 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
28493 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
28494 is the height of the point
28495 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
28496 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
28497 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
28498 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT 3.0 documentation for a
28499 description of the @samp{set view} command.
28500
28501 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
28502 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
28503
28504 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
28505 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
28506 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
28507 of values from the input vectors.
28508
28509 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
28510 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
28511 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
28512 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
28513 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
28514 3D surface.
28515
28516 @ignore
28517 @starindex
28518 @end ignore
28519 @tindex xyz
28520 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
28521 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
28522 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
28523 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
28524 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
28525 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
28526 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
28527 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
28528 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
28529 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
28530 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
28531 vectors with more than 5 elements.
28532
28533 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
28534 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
28535 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
28536 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
28537 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
28538
28539 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
28540 variables containing the relevant data.
28541
28542 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
28543 @section Managing Curves
28544
28545 @noindent
28546 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
28547 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
28548 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
28549 by using these commands directly.
28550
28551 @kindex g a
28552 @pindex calc-graph-add
28553 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
28554 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
28555 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
28556 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
28557 on the same axes.
28558
28559 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
28560 will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
28561 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
28562 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
28563 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
28564 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
28565 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
28566 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
28567 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
28568 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
28569 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
28570 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
28571 the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28572
28573 @vindex PlotData1
28574 @vindex PlotData2
28575 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
28576 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
28577 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
28578 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
28579 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
28580 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
28581 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
28582 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
28583
28584 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
28585 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
28586 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
28587 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
28588 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
28589 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
28590
28591 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
28592 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
28593 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
28594
28595 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
28596 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
28597 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
28598 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
28599 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
28600 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
28601
28602 For example, to plot
28603 @texline @math{\sin n x}
28604 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
28605 for integers @expr{n}
28606 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
28607 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
28608 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
28609 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
28610 command.
28611
28612 @kindex g A
28613 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
28614 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
28615 to the graph. It is not legal to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
28616 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
28617 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
28618 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
28619 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
28620 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
28621 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
28622 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
28623 command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28624
28625 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
28626 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
28627 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
28628 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
28629 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
28630 check for this.)
28631
28632 @kindex g d
28633 @pindex calc-graph-delete
28634 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
28635 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
28636 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
28637 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
28638
28639 @kindex g H
28640 @pindex calc-graph-hide
28641 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
28642 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
28643 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
28644 point styles will be retained.
28645
28646 @kindex g j
28647 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
28648 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
28649 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
28650 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
28651 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
28652 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
28653 affect the last curve in the list.
28654
28655 @kindex g p
28656 @pindex calc-graph-plot
28657 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
28658 the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
28659 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
28660 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
28661 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
28662 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
28663 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
28664 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
28665 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
28666
28667 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
28668 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
28669 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
28670 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
28671 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
28672 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
28673 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
28674
28675 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
28676 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
28677 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
28678 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
28679 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
28680 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
28681 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
28682
28683 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
28684 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
28685 the current graph is three-dimensional.
28686
28687 @kindex g P
28688 @pindex calc-graph-print
28689 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
28690 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
28691 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
28692 or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
28693 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
28694 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
28695 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
28696 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
28697 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
28698 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
28699 always plot to the printer.
28700
28701 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
28702 @section Graphics Options
28703
28704 @noindent
28705 @kindex g g
28706 @pindex calc-graph-grid
28707 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
28708 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
28709 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
28710 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
28711 changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
28712 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
28713
28714 @kindex g b
28715 @pindex calc-graph-border
28716 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
28717 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
28718 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
28719
28720 @kindex g k
28721 @pindex calc-graph-key
28722 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
28723 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
28724 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
28725 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
28726 curves on the same graph.
28727
28728 @kindex g N
28729 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
28730 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
28731 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
28732 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
28733 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
28734 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
28735 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
28736 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
28737 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
28738 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
28739 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
28740 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
28741 will be computed for the surface.
28742
28743 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
28744 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
28745 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
28746 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
28747 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
28748 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
28749 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
28750 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
28751 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
28752
28753 @kindex g h
28754 @pindex calc-graph-header
28755 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
28756 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
28757 The default title is blank (no title).
28758
28759 @kindex g n
28760 @pindex calc-graph-name
28761 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
28762 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
28763 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
28764 list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
28765 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
28766 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
28767 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
28768 not used.
28769
28770 @kindex g t
28771 @kindex g T
28772 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
28773 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
28774 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
28775 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
28776 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
28777 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
28778 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
28779 but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
28780 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
28781
28782 @kindex g r
28783 @kindex g R
28784 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
28785 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
28786 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
28787 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
28788 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
28789 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
28790 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
28791 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
28792 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
28793 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
28794 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
28795
28796 @kindex g l
28797 @kindex g L
28798 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
28799 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
28800 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
28801 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
28802 be logarithmic instead of linear.
28803
28804 @kindex g C-l
28805 @kindex g C-r
28806 @kindex g C-t
28807 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
28808 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
28809 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
28810 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
28811 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
28812 for the ``z'' axis.
28813
28814 @kindex g z
28815 @kindex g Z
28816 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
28817 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
28818 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
28819 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
28820 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
28821 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
28822 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
28823 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
28824 not available for 3D plots.
28825
28826 @kindex g s
28827 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
28828 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
28829 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
28830 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
28831 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
28832 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
28833 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
28834 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
28835 available for any device.
28836
28837 @kindex g S
28838 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
28839 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
28840 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
28841 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
28842 tiny dots.
28843
28844 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
28845 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
28846 @vindex LineStyles
28847 @vindex PointStyles
28848 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
28849 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
28850 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
28851 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
28852 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
28853 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
28854 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
28855 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
28856 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
28857 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
28858
28859 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
28860 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
28861 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
28862 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
28863 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
28864
28865 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
28866 @section Graphical Devices
28867
28868 @noindent
28869 @kindex g D
28870 @pindex calc-graph-device
28871 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
28872 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
28873 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
28874 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
28875 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
28876
28877 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
28878 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
28879 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
28880 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
28881 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
28882 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
28883 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), or otherwise @code{dumb} under
28884 GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0.
28885 This is the initial default value.
28886
28887 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
28888 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
28889 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
28890 to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
28891 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
28892 dumb terminals will be
28893 @texline @math{80\times24}
28894 @infoline 80x24
28895 characters. The graph is displayed in
28896 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
28897 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
28898 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
28899
28900 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
28901 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
28902 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
28903 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
28904 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
28905 graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
28906 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
28907 of the four directions.
28908
28909 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
28910 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
28911 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
28912 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
28913 plot on any text-only printer.
28914
28915 @kindex g O
28916 @pindex calc-graph-output
28917 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of
28918 the output file used by GNUPLOT. For some devices, notably @code{x11},
28919 there is no output file and this information is not used. Many other
28920 ``devices'' are really file formats like @code{postscript}; in these
28921 cases the output in the desired format goes into the file you name
28922 with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write
28923 to its standard output stream, i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}.
28924 This is the default setting.
28925
28926 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
28927 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
28928 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
28929 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
28930 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
28931 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
28932 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
28933 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
28934 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
28935
28936 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
28937 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
28938 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
28939 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
28940 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
28941 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
28942
28943 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
28944 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
28945 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
28946 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
28947 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
28948 of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28949
28950 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
28951 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
28952 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
28953 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
28954 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
28955 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
28956 If you are installing Calc you may wish to configure the default and
28957 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
28958 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
28959 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
28960 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
28961 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
28962
28963 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
28964 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
28965 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
28966 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
28967 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
28968 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
28969 to display or print the output.
28970
28971 @kindex g x
28972 @pindex calc-graph-display
28973 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
28974 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
28975 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
28976 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
28977
28978 @kindex g X
28979 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
28980 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
28981 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
28982 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
28983 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
28984 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
28985 window in the upper-left corner of the screen.
28986
28987 The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
28988 session with GNUPLOT. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
28989 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
28990 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
28991 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
28992 something has gone wrong.
28993
28994 @kindex g C
28995 @pindex calc-graph-command
28996 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
28997 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
28998 GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
28999 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29000 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29001
29002 @kindex g v
29003 @kindex g V
29004 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29005 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29006 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29007 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29008 and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29009 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29010 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29011 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29012 buffer is hidden again.
29013
29014 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29015 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29016 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29017 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29018 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29019 you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29020 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29021 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29022 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29023 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29024 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29025 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29026 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29027 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29028 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29029 with @kbd{g p}.
29030
29031 @kindex g q
29032 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29033 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29034 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29035 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29036 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29037 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29038 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29039
29040 @kindex g K
29041 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29042 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29043 except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29044 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29045 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29046
29047 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29048 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29049
29050 @noindent
29051 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29052 other Emacs editing buffers.
29053
29054 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29055 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29056
29057 @menu
29058 * Killing From Stack::
29059 * Yanking Into Stack::
29060 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29061 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29062 * X Cut and Paste::
29063 @end menu
29064
29065 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29066 @section Killing from the Stack
29067
29068 @noindent
29069 @kindex C-k
29070 @pindex calc-kill
29071 @kindex M-k
29072 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29073 @kindex C-w
29074 @pindex calc-kill-region
29075 @kindex M-w
29076 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29077 @cindex Kill ring
29078 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the
29079 ``kill ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y}
29080 command. Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which
29081 kills one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point,
29082 and @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29083 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too. Also,
29084 @kbd{M-k} has been provided to complete the set; it puts the current line
29085 into the kill ring without deleting anything.
29086
29087 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29088 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below the
29089 bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack. Otherwise,
29090 they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. Calc's kill
29091 commands always operate on whole stack entries. (They act the same as their
29092 standard Emacs cousins except they ``round up'' the specified region to
29093 encompass full lines.) The text is copied into the kill ring exactly as
29094 it appears on the screen, including line numbers if they are enabled.
29095
29096 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29097 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29098 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29099 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29100 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29101 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29102 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29103 newline.
29104
29105 @node Yanking Into Stack, Grabbing From Buffers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29106 @section Yanking into the Stack
29107
29108 @noindent
29109 @kindex C-y
29110 @pindex calc-yank
29111 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29112 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29113 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29114 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29115 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29116 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29117 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29118 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29119 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29120 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29121 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29122 difference.)
29123
29124 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29125 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29126
29127 @noindent
29128 @kindex M-# g
29129 @pindex calc-grab-region
29130 The @kbd{M-# g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29131 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29132 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29133 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29134 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29135 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29136 If the @kbd{M-# g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29137 @kbd{M-# c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29138
29139 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29140 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29141 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 M-# g} grabs from point
29142 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29143 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29144 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29145 delete given that prefix argument.
29146
29147 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29148 line.
29149
29150 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29151 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29152 @kbd{M-# g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29153 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u M-# g} on the same region
29154 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29155 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29156 vector of one element by plain @kbd{M-# g} because the interpretation
29157 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29158
29159 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29160 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29161
29162 @kindex M-# r
29163 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29164 The @kbd{M-# r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29165 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29166 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29167 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29168 whose contents are parsed.
29169
29170 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29171 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29172 only if every row contains the same number of values.
29173
29174 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29175 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29176 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29177 is ignored.
29178
29179 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29180 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29181 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29182 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29183 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29184 @kbd{M-# r} command.
29185
29186 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29187 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29188 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u M-# r} will be a
29189 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29190 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{M-# r}} will interpret this as
29191 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29192 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u M-# r} will interpret this row
29193 as @samp{[2*a]}.
29194
29195 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29196 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29197 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29198 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29199 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29200
29201 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29202 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29203 @texline @math{1\times1}
29204 @infoline 1x1
29205 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29206
29207 @kindex M-# :
29208 @kindex M-# _
29209 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29210 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29211 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29212 The @kbd{M-# :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29213 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29214 typing @kbd{M-# r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29215 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29216 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29217 in the input data. The @kbd{M-# _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29218 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29219
29220 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{M-# :} and @kbd{M-# _} are also
29221 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29222 the stack. In a @kbd{M-# r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29223 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29224 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29225
29226 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29227 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29228 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{M-# :}. Since there
29229 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29230 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29231 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29232
29233 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29234 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29235 Use @kbd{M-# r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29236 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29237 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29238 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29239 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29240
29241 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29242 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
29243
29244 @noindent
29245 @kindex y
29246 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29247 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29248 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29249 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29250 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29251 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29252 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29253 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29254 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29255
29256 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29257 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29258 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29259 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29260 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29261 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29262 latter strips off the trailing newline.
29263
29264 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29265 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29266 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29267 @kbd{M-# g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29268 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29269 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29270 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29271 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
29272 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
29273 @kbd{M-# g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{M-# r}).
29274
29275 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
29276 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
29277 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
29278 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
29279 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
29280 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
29281 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
29282 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
29283 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
29284 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
29285 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
29286 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
29287 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
29288 to overwriting one complete number with another.
29289
29290 @kindex M-# y
29291 The @kbd{M-# y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
29292 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
29293 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
29294
29295 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
29296 @section X Cut and Paste
29297
29298 @noindent
29299 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
29300 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
29301 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
29302
29303 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
29304 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
29305 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
29306 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
29307 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
29308 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
29309 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
29310 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
29311 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
29312 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
29313 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
29314
29315 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
29316 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
29317 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
29318 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
29319 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
29320 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
29321 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
29322 in the Calc window.
29323
29324 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Introduction
29325 @chapter Keypad Mode
29326
29327 @noindent
29328 @kindex M-# k
29329 @pindex calc-keypad
29330 The @kbd{M-# k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
29331 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
29332 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
29333 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
29334 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
29335 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
29336 calculations with the mouse.
29337
29338 @pindex full-calc-keypad
29339 If you have used @kbd{M-# b} first, @kbd{M-# k} instead invokes
29340 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
29341 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
29342 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
29343 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
29344
29345 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
29346 the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
29347 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
29348 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
29349
29350 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
29351 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
29352 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
29353
29354 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
29355 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
29356 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
29357 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
29358 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
29359 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
29360 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
29361 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
29362
29363 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
29364 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
29365 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
29366 original buffer.
29367
29368 @menu
29369 * Keypad Main Menu::
29370 * Keypad Functions Menu::
29371 * Keypad Binary Menu::
29372 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
29373 * Keypad Modes Menu::
29374 @end menu
29375
29376 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
29377 @section Main Menu
29378
29379 @smallexample
29380 @group
29381 |----+-----Calc 2.00-----+----1
29382 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
29383 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29384 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
29385 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29386 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
29387 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29388 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
29389 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
29390 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
29391 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29392 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
29393 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29394 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
29395 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29396 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
29397 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
29398 @end group
29399 @end smallexample
29400
29401 @noindent
29402 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
29403 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
29404 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
29405 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
29406
29407 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
29408 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
29409 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
29410 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
29411 or any other function key.
29412
29413 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
29414 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
29415 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
29416 stack.
29417
29418 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
29419 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
29420 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
29421 below and in the following sections.
29422
29423 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
29424 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
29425
29426 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
29427 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
29428 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
29429
29430 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
29431 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
29432 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
29433 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
29434
29435 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
29436 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
29437 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
29438 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
29439 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
29440
29441 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
29442 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
29443 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
29444 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
29445
29446 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
29447 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
29448 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
29449 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
29450
29451 @table @kbd
29452 @item INV +/-
29453 is the same as @key{1/x}.
29454 @item INV +
29455 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
29456 @item INV -
29457 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
29458 @item INV *
29459 is the same as @key{y^x}.
29460 @item INV /
29461 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
29462 @item HYP/INV 1
29463 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
29464 @item HYP/INV 2
29465 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
29466 @item HYP/INV 3
29467 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
29468 @item INV/HYP 4
29469 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
29470 @item INV/HYP 5
29471 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
29472 @item INV 6
29473 is the same as @key{ABS}.
29474 @item INV 7
29475 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
29476 @item INV 8
29477 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
29478 @item INV 9
29479 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
29480 @item INV 0
29481 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
29482 @item INV .
29483 is the same as @key{PREC}.
29484 @item INV ENTER
29485 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
29486 @item HYP ENTER
29487 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
29488 @item INV HYP ENTER
29489 is the same as @key{OVER}.
29490 @item HYP +/-
29491 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
29492 @item HYP EEX
29493 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
29494 @item INV EEX
29495 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
29496 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
29497 by the two limits of the interval.
29498 @end table
29499
29500 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{M-# k} or @kbd{M-# M-#}
29501 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
29502 hitting @kbd{M-# c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
29503 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
29504 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
29505 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
29506
29507 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
29508 @section Functions Menu
29509
29510 @smallexample
29511 @group
29512 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
29513 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
29514 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29515 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
29516 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29517 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
29518 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29519 @end group
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522 @noindent
29523 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
29524 prefix keys.
29525
29526 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
29527 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
29528
29529 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
29530 extracts the imaginary part.
29531
29532 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
29533 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
29534 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
29535 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
29536 same limit as last time.
29537
29538 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
29539
29540 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
29541 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29542 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29543
29544 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
29545 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
29546
29547 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
29548 finds the previous prime.
29549
29550 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
29551 @section Binary Menu
29552
29553 @smallexample
29554 @group
29555 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
29556 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
29557 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29558 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
29559 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29560 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
29561 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29562 @end group
29563 @end smallexample
29564
29565 @noindent
29566 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
29567 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
29568 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
29569
29570 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
29571 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
29572
29573 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
29574 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
29575 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
29576 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
29577
29578 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
29579 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
29580 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
29581 The initial word size is 32 bits.
29582
29583 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
29584 @section Vectors Menu
29585
29586 @smallexample
29587 @group
29588 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
29589 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
29590 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29591 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
29592 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29593 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
29594 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29595 @end group
29596 @end smallexample
29597
29598 @noindent
29599 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
29600
29601 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
29602 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
29603 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
29604 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
29605 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
29606 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
29607 rows into a matrix.
29608
29609 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
29610 components separately.
29611
29612 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
29613 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
29614 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
29615 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
29616 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
29617
29618 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
29619 identity matrix.
29620
29621 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
29622
29623 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
29624
29625 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
29626 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
29627
29628 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
29629 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
29630 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
29631 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
29632
29633 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
29634 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
29635 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
29636
29637 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
29638 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
29639 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
29640
29641 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
29642 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
29643 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
29644 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
29645 all the elements of a vector.
29646
29647 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
29648 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
29649 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
29650 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
29651 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
29652 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
29653 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
29654 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
29655 the formula @samp{x^y}.
29656
29657 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
29658 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
29659 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
29660 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
29661 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
29662 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
29663 @expr{t}, respectively.
29664
29665 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
29666 @section Modes Menu
29667
29668 @smallexample
29669 @group
29670 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
29671 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
29672 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29673 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
29674 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29675 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
29676 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29677 @end group
29678 @end smallexample
29679
29680 @noindent
29681 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
29682
29683 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
29684 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
29685 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
29686 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
29687 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
29688
29689 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
29690 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
29691 well as to the left.
29692
29693 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
29694 for trigonometric functions.
29695
29696 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
29697 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
29698 fractional or floating-point results.
29699
29700 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
29701 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
29702
29703 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
29704 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
29705 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
29706
29707 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
29708 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
29709
29710 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
29711 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
29712 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
29713 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
29714
29715 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
29716 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
29717 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
29718 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
29719 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
29720
29721 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
29722 @chapter Embedded Mode
29723
29724 @noindent
29725 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
29726 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
29727 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
29728 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
29729
29730 @menu
29731 * Basic Embedded Mode::
29732 * More About Embedded Mode::
29733 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
29734 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
29735 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
29736 @end menu
29737
29738 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
29739 @section Basic Embedded Mode
29740
29741 @noindent
29742 @kindex M-# e
29743 @pindex calc-embedded
29744 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
29745 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{M-# e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
29746 Note that @kbd{M-# e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
29747 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
29748 are visiting your own files.
29749
29750 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
29751 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
29752 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
29753 understands are:
29754
29755 @enumerate
29756 @item
29757 The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
29758 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
29759 @item
29760 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end};
29761 @item
29762 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
29763 @item
29764 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
29765 @item
29766 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
29767 @end enumerate
29768
29769 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
29770 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
29771 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
29772
29773 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
29774 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and moves
29775 forward or backward (respectively) by that many lines to find the
29776 other end. Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
29777
29778 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region
29779 (delimited by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters.
29780
29781 @kindex M-# w
29782 @pindex calc-embedded-word
29783 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc scans for the first
29784 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a
29785 digit, sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e})
29786 forward and backward to delimit the formula. @kbd{M-# w}
29787 (@code{calc-embedded-word}) is equivalent to @kbd{C-u M-# e}.
29788
29789 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
29790 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
29791 It's best if the current Calc language mode is correct for the
29792 formula, but Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
29793 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
29794 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
29795 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
29796 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
29797 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
29798 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
29799 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
29800 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
29801
29802 If you press @kbd{M-# e} or @kbd{M-# w} to activate an embedded
29803 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
29804 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
29805 an algebraic entry.
29806
29807 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
29808 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
29809 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
29810 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
29811 not affected by Embedded mode.
29812
29813 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
29814 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
29815 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
29816 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{M-# o} if you
29817 find you need to see the entire stack.
29818
29819 For example, typing @kbd{M-# e} while somewhere in the formula
29820 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
29821 inequality:
29822
29823 @example
29824 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
29825 @end example
29826
29827 @noindent
29828 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
29829 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
29830 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
29831 to match Calc's usual display style:
29832
29833 @example
29834 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
29835 @end example
29836
29837 @noindent
29838 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
29839 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
29840 Embedded mode.
29841
29842 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
29843 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
29844 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
29845 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
29846 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
29847 needs to be commuted.
29848
29849 @example
29850 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
29851 @end example
29852
29853 The @kbd{M-# o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
29854 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
29855 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
29856 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
29857
29858 @example
29859 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
29860 @end example
29861
29862 @noindent
29863 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
29864 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
29865 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
29866 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
29867 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
29868 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
29869 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{M-# o}).
29870
29871 Typing @kbd{M-# e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
29872 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
29873 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
29874 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
29875 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
29876 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
29877 Embedded mode is concerned.
29878
29879 If you press @kbd{M-# e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
29880 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
29881 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
29882 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
29883 press @kbd{M-# e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
29884 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
29885 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
29886 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
29887 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
29888 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
29889
29890 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
29891 @section More About Embedded Mode
29892
29893 @noindent
29894 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
29895 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
29896 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
29897 written. If the formula contains any @TeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
29898 it is parsed (i.e., read) in @TeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
29899 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
29900 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
29901
29902 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
29903 to what it finds. Even though it can read a @TeX{} formula when
29904 not in @TeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
29905 whatever language mode is in effect. You must then type @kbd{d T}
29906 to switch Calc permanently into @TeX{} mode if that is what you
29907 desire.
29908
29909 @tex
29910 \bigskip
29911 @end tex
29912
29913 @kindex d p
29914 @pindex calc-show-plain
29915 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
29916 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
29917 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
29918 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
29919 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
29920 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
29921 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
29922 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
29923 version.
29924
29925 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
29926 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
29927 character begins a comment in @TeX{}, so if your formula is
29928 embedded in a @TeX{} document its plain version will be
29929 invisible in the final printed copy. @xref{Customizing
29930 Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the ``plain'' formula
29931 delimiters, say to something that @dfn{eqn} or some other
29932 formatter will treat as a comment.
29933
29934 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
29935 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
29936 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
29937 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
29938 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
29939 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
29940 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
29941 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
29942
29943 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
29944 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
29945 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
29946 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
29947 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
29948 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
29949
29950 @tex
29951 \bigskip
29952 @end tex
29953
29954 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
29955 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
29956 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
29957 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
29958 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
29959 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
29960 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
29961 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
29962 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
29963 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
29964 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
29965 ``plain'' mode.
29966
29967 @tex
29968 \bigskip
29969 @end tex
29970
29971 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
29972 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
29973 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
29974 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
29975 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
29976
29977 @smallexample
29978 The derivative of
29979
29980 ln(ln(x))
29981
29982 is
29983
29984 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
29985
29986 whose value at x = 2 is
29987
29988 @r{(the value)}
29989
29990 and at x = 3 is
29991
29992 @r{(the value)}
29993 @end smallexample
29994
29995 @kindex M-# d
29996 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
29997 The @kbd{M-# d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
29998 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{M-# d},
29999 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30000 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30001 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30002
30003 For this example, you would start with just
30004
30005 @smallexample
30006 The derivative of
30007
30008 ln(ln(x))
30009 @end smallexample
30010
30011 @noindent
30012 and press @kbd{M-# d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30013 is
30014
30015 @smallexample
30016 The derivative of
30017
30018 ln(ln(x))
30019
30020
30021 ln(ln(x))
30022 @end smallexample
30023
30024 @noindent
30025 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30026 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30027 @kbd{M-# d M-# d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30028 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30029 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30030 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30031
30032 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{M-# e} to exit Embedded
30033 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30034 various formulas and numbers.
30035
30036 @tex
30037 \bigskip
30038 @end tex
30039
30040 @kindex M-# f
30041 @kindex M-# '
30042 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30043 The @kbd{M-# f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30044 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30045 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30046 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30047 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30048 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30049 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{M-# e}. The key sequence
30050 @kbd{M-# '} is equivalent to @kbd{M-# f}.
30051
30052 @kindex M-# n
30053 @kindex M-# p
30054 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30055 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30056 The @kbd{M-# n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{M-# p}
30057 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30058 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30059 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30060 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30061 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30062 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30063 @kbd{M-# n} and @kbd{M-# p} are a useful way to tell which
30064 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30065 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30066 formula, they just move the cursor. (By the way, @kbd{M-# n} is
30067 not as awkward to type as it may seem, because @kbd{M-#} ignores
30068 Shift and Meta on the second keystroke: @kbd{M-# M-N} can be typed
30069 by holding down Shift and Meta and alternately typing two keys.)
30070
30071 @kindex M-# `
30072 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30073 The @kbd{M-# `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30074 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30075 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30076 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30077
30078 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30079 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30080
30081 @noindent
30082 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30083 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30084 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30085 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30086
30087 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30088
30089 @example
30090 foo := 5
30091 @end example
30092
30093 @noindent
30094 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30095 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30096 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30097 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30098 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30099
30100 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30101 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30102 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30103 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30104 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30105
30106 @example
30107 foo + 7 => 12
30108 @end example
30109
30110 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30111
30112 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30113 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30114
30115 @example
30116 foo := 17
30117
30118 foo + 7 => 24
30119 @end example
30120
30121 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30122 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30123 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30124 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30125 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30126
30127 @example
30128 17
30129
30130 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30131 @end example
30132
30133 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30134 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30135 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30136 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30137
30138 @kindex M-# j
30139 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30140 The @kbd{M-# j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30141 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{M-# e},
30142 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30143 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30144 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30145 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30146
30147 @example
30148 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30149 @end example
30150
30151 @noindent
30152 in which case @kbd{M-# j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30153
30154 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30155 mode.
30156
30157 @kindex M-# u
30158 @kindex M-# =
30159 @pindex calc-embedded-update
30160 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30161 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30162 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30163 the change. The @kbd{M-# u} or @kbd{M-# =}
30164 (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula}) command is a convenient way
30165 to do this.
30166
30167 @example
30168 foo := 6
30169
30170 foo + 7 => 13
30171 @end example
30172
30173 Pressing @kbd{M-# u} is much like pressing @kbd{M-# e = M-# e}, that
30174 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30175 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{M-# u} does
30176 not actually use @kbd{M-# e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30177 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{M-# u} and
30178 that formula will not be disturbed.
30179
30180 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{M-# u} updates all active
30181 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30182 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30183 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30184 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30185
30186 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u M-# u} updates only in the
30187 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30188
30189 @kbd{M-# u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30190 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30191 file.
30192
30193 @kindex M-# a
30194 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
30195 The @kbd{M-# a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30196 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30197 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30198 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30199 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30200 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30201 changed.
30202
30203 It is a good idea to type @kbd{M-# a} right after loading a file
30204 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30205 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30206 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30207 a few lines that look like this:
30208
30209 @example
30210 --- Local Variables: ---
30211 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30212 --- End: ---
30213 @end example
30214
30215 @noindent
30216 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30217 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30218 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30219 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30220 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30221 trailing strings.
30222
30223 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30224 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30225 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30226 @kbd{M-# a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30227 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30228 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30229 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30230 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30231 Emacs manual}.
30232
30233 Note that @kbd{M-# a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30234 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 M-# u} after @w{@kbd{M-# a}}.
30235 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30236 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30237 saved.
30238
30239 Normally, @kbd{M-# a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30240 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30241 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{M-# a} first deactivates
30242 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30243 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30244 @kbd{M-# a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30245
30246 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30247 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30248 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30249 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{M-# a}
30250 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30251 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30252 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30253 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30254 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30255 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30256 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{M-# a}, or if you
30257 used @kbd{M-# a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30258 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30259 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30260 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- M-# a}).
30261
30262 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30263 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30264 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30265 following assignment is used.
30266
30267 @example
30268 x => 1
30269
30270 x := 1
30271
30272 x => 1
30273
30274 x := 2
30275
30276 x => 2
30277 @end example
30278
30279 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
30280 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
30281 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
30282 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
30283 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
30284 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
30285
30286 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
30287 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
30288 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
30289 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
30290 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
30291 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
30292 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
30293
30294 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
30295 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
30296 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{M-# u} to update these
30297 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
30298 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
30299 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 M-# u}
30300 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
30301 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
30302 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
30303 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
30304 use @kbd{M-# u} to update the buffer by hand.
30305
30306 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30307 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
30308
30309 @noindent
30310 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
30311 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
30312 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
30313 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
30314 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
30315 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
30316
30317 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
30318 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
30319 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
30320 delimiter of the formula.
30321
30322 @example
30323 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
30324 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30325 @end example
30326
30327 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
30328 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
30329 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
30330 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
30331 the file, or up to a line of the form
30332
30333 @example
30334 % [calc-defaults]
30335 @end example
30336
30337 @noindent
30338 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
30339 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
30340 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
30341
30342 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
30343 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
30344 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
30345 below).
30346
30347 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
30348 square brackets and the text they enclose. You can edit the mode
30349 annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
30350 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
30351 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
30352 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
30353 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
30354 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
30355
30356 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
30357 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
30358 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
30359 one.
30360
30361 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
30362 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
30363 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
30364 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
30365 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
30366 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
30367 sure the value is of a legal type or range; if you write an
30368 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
30369 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
30370
30371 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
30372 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
30373 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
30374 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
30375 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
30376 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
30377
30378 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
30379 that look like this, respectively:
30380
30381 @example
30382 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30383 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
30384 @end example
30385
30386 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
30387 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
30388 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
30389 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
30390 yet, is not relevant here.)
30391
30392 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
30393 of the file:
30394
30395 @example
30396 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
30397 @end example
30398
30399 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
30400 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
30401 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
30402 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
30403 formulas in the file.
30404
30405 Enabling a formula with @kbd{M-# e} causes a fresh scan for local
30406 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
30407 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
30408 a formula with @kbd{M-# u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
30409 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{M-# a}.
30410
30411 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
30412 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
30413 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
30414 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
30415 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
30416 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
30417
30418 @example
30419 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30420 1.23e2
30421
30422 456.
30423 @end example
30424
30425 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{M-# u}
30426 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
30427
30428 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are @code{Save}
30429 (which works even outside of Embedded mode), in which mode settings
30430 are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by the
30431 variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el})
30432 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
30433 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
30434 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
30435 annotations at all.
30436
30437 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
30438 for @code{Save} have no effect.
30439
30440 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30441 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
30442
30443 @noindent
30444 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
30445 variables described here. Use @kbd{M-x set-variable} or
30446 @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly, or
30447 put a suitable @code{setq} statement in your Calc init file (or
30448 @file{~/.emacs}) to set a variable permanently. (Another possibility would
30449 be to use a file-local variable annotation at the end of the
30450 file; @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30451 Emacs manual}.)
30452
30453 While none of these variables will be buffer-local by default, you
30454 can make any of them local to any Embedded mode buffer. (Their
30455 values in the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer are never used.)
30456
30457 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
30458 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
30459 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
30460 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
30461 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
30462 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
30463 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
30464 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
30465 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
30466 in detail.
30467
30468 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
30469 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
30470 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
30471 Lisp program.
30472
30473 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
30474 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
30475 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
30476 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
30477 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
30478 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
30479 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
30480 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
30481
30482 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
30483 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
30484 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
30485 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
30486 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
30487 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
30488
30489 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
30490 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
30491 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
30492 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
30493 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
30494 one or two dollar signs.
30495
30496 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
30497 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
30498 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
30499
30500 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
30501 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
30502 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
30503 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
30504 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
30505 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
30506 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
30507
30508 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
30509 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
30510 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
30511 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
30512 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
30513 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
30514 account for each of these six backslashes!)
30515
30516 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
30517 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
30518 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
30519 regular expression to match the above example would be
30520 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
30521 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
30522 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
30523 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
30524 case).
30525
30526 @vindex calc-embedded-open-word
30527 @vindex calc-embedded-close-word
30528 The @code{calc-embedded-open-word} and @code{calc-embedded-close-word}
30529 variables are similar expressions used when you type @kbd{M-# w}
30530 instead of @kbd{M-# e} to enable Embedded mode.
30531
30532 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
30533 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
30534 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
30535 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
30536 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
30537 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
30538 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space).
30539
30540 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
30541 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
30542 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}. Without
30543 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
30544 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
30545
30546 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
30547 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
30548 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
30549 @kbd{M-# f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
30550 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{M-# f} is
30551 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{M-# f} will skip this
30552 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
30553 the file.
30554
30555 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
30556 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
30557 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
30558 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
30559 @w{@kbd{M-# f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
30560 @kbd{M-# f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
30561 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
30562
30563 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
30564 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
30565 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
30566 The @kbd{M-# a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
30567 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{M-# a} will
30568 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
30569 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
30570 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
30571 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
30572 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which
30573 checks for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning
30574 with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to make Calc
30575 consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the formula's
30576 opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
30577
30578 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
30579 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
30580 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
30581 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
30582 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
30583 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
30584 The default is @code{"% "}.
30585
30586 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
30587 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
30588 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
30589 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}. If you change this, it is a
30590 good idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations
30591 will appear on lines by themselves.
30592
30593 @node Programming, Installation, Embedded Mode, Top
30594 @chapter Programming
30595
30596 @noindent
30597 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
30598 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
30599
30600 @enumerate
30601 @item
30602 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
30603 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
30604 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
30605 as loops and conditionals.
30606
30607 @item
30608 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
30609 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
30610 as an interactive command.
30611
30612 @item
30613 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
30614 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
30615 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
30616 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
30617 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
30618
30619 @item
30620 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
30621 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
30622 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
30623 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
30624 rewrite rules.
30625 @end enumerate
30626
30627 @kindex z
30628 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
30629 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
30630 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
30631 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
30632 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
30633 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
30634 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
30635
30636 @menu
30637 * Creating User Keys::
30638 * Keyboard Macros::
30639 * Invocation Macros::
30640 * Algebraic Definitions::
30641 * Lisp Definitions::
30642 @end menu
30643
30644 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
30645 @section Creating User Keys
30646
30647 @noindent
30648 @kindex Z D
30649 @pindex calc-user-define
30650 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
30651 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
30652 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
30653
30654 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
30655 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
30656 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
30657 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
30658 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
30659 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
30660 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
30661 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
30662
30663 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
30664 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
30665
30666 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
30667 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
30668 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
30669
30670 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
30671 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
30672 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
30673 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
30674 of a letter if you wish.
30675
30676 @kindex Z U
30677 @pindex calc-user-undefine
30678 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
30679 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
30680 key we defined above.
30681
30682 @kindex Z P
30683 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
30684 @cindex Storing user definitions
30685 @cindex Permanent user definitions
30686 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
30687 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
30688 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
30689 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
30690 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
30691 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}.) For example,
30692 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
30693 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
30694 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
30695 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
30696
30697 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
30698 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
30699 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
30700 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
30701 command will save all of these definitions.
30702 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
30703 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
30704 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
30705 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
30706 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
30707 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
30708 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
30709 or key bindings associated with the function.)
30710
30711 @kindex Z E
30712 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
30713 @cindex Editing user definitions
30714 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
30715 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
30716 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
30717 following sections.
30718
30719 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
30720 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
30721
30722 @noindent
30723 @kindex X
30724 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
30725 @cindex Keyboard macros
30726 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
30727 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
30728 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
30729 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
30730 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
30731 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
30732 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
30733 information.
30734
30735 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
30736 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
30737 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
30738 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
30739 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
30740 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
30741 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
30742 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
30743 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
30744 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
30745 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
30746 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
30747 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
30748
30749 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
30750 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
30751 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
30752 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
30753
30754 @menu
30755 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
30756 * Conditionals in Macros::
30757 * Loops in Macros::
30758 * Local Values in Macros::
30759 * Queries in Macros::
30760 @end menu
30761
30762 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
30763 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
30764
30765 @noindent
30766 @kindex Z K
30767 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
30768 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
30769 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
30770 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
30771 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
30772 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
30773 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
30774 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
30775 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
30776 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
30777 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
30778 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
30779 descriptive command name if you wish.
30780
30781 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
30782 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
30783 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
30784 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
30785
30786 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
30787 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
30788
30789 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
30790 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
30791 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
30792 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
30793 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
30794 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
30795 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
30796 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
30797 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
30798 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
30799 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
30800 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
30801 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
30802 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
30803 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
30804
30805 @kindex M-# m
30806 @pindex read-kbd-macro
30807 The @kbd{M-# m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
30808 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
30809 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
30810 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
30811
30812 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
30813 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
30814
30815 @noindent
30816 @kindex Z [
30817 @kindex Z ]
30818 @pindex calc-kbd-if
30819 @pindex calc-kbd-else
30820 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
30821 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
30822 @cindex Conditional structures
30823 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
30824 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
30825 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
30826 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
30827 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
30828 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
30829 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
30830
30831 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
30832 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
30833 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
30834 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
30835 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
30836 command is skipped.
30837
30838 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
30839 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
30840 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
30841 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
30842 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
30843 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
30844
30845 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
30846 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
30847
30848 @kindex Z :
30849 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
30850 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
30851 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
30852 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
30853 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
30854 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
30855 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
30856
30857 @kindex Z |
30858 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
30859 between any number of alternatives. For example,
30860 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
30861 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
30862 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
30863 it will execute @var{part3}.
30864
30865 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
30866 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
30867 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
30868 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
30869 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
30870 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
30871 does not.
30872
30873 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
30874 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
30875 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
30876 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
30877 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
30878 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
30879 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
30880 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
30881 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
30882
30883 @kindex Z C-g
30884 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
30885 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
30886 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
30887
30888 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
30889 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
30890
30891 @noindent
30892 @kindex Z <
30893 @kindex Z >
30894 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
30895 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
30896 @cindex Looping structures
30897 @cindex Iterative structures
30898 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
30899 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
30900 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
30901 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
30902 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
30903 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
30904 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
30905 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
30906 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
30907
30908 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
30909 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
30910 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
30911 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
30912 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
30913 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
30914 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
30915 in a buffer, then use @kbd{M-# m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
30916 macro.
30917
30918 @kindex Z /
30919 @pindex calc-break
30920 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
30921 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
30922 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
30923 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
30924 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
30925 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
30926 in the C language.
30927
30928 @kindex Z (
30929 @kindex Z )
30930 @pindex calc-kbd-for
30931 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
30932 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
30933 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
30934 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
30935 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
30936 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
30937 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
30938 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
30939 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
30940 counter each time until the loop finishes.
30941
30942 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
30943 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
30944 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
30945 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
30946 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
30947 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
30948 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
30949
30950 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
30951 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
30952 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
30953 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
30954 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
30955 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
30956
30957 @kindex Z @{
30958 @kindex Z @}
30959 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
30960 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
30961 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
30962 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
30963 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
30964 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
30965 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
30966 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
30967 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
30968 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
30969 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
30970 this feature.)
30971
30972 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
30973 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
30974 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
30975 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
30976 as easily as in a macro definition.
30977
30978 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
30979 conditional and looping commands.
30980
30981 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
30982 @subsection Local Values in Macros
30983
30984 @noindent
30985 @cindex Local variables
30986 @cindex Restoring saved modes
30987 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
30988 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
30989 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
30990 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
30991 modes.
30992
30993 @kindex Z `
30994 @kindex Z '
30995 @pindex calc-kbd-push
30996 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
30997 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
30998 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
30999 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31000 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31001
31002 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31003 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31004 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31005 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31006 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31007
31008 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31009 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31010 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31011 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31012 in exceptional conditions.
31013
31014 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31015 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31016 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31017 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31018 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31019 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31020 macros were involved.
31021
31022 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31023 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31024 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31025 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31026 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31027 thereof) are also saved.
31028
31029 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31030 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31031 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31032 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31033 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31034
31035 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31036 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31037 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31038 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31039 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31040 outside the construct.
31041
31042 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31043 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31044 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31045
31046 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31047 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31048
31049 @noindent
31050 @kindex Z =
31051 @pindex calc-kbd-report
31052 The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31053 message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31054 to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31055 is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31056 to turn such messages off.
31057
31058 @kindex Z #
31059 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31060 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command displays a prompt message
31061 (which you enter during macro definition), then does an algebraic entry
31062 which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro execution.
31063 This command allows your keyboard macros to accept numbers or formulas
31064 as interactive input. All the normal conventions of algebraic input,
31065 including the use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported.
31066
31067 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31068 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31069 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31070 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31071 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31072 return control to the keyboard macro.
31073
31074 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31075 @section Invocation Macros
31076
31077 @kindex M-# z
31078 @kindex Z I
31079 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31080 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31081 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{M-# z}
31082 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31083 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31084 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31085 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31086 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31087 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31088 @kbd{M-# z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31089
31090 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31091 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31092 by typing @kbd{M-# r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31093 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( M-# r
31094 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31095 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{M-# z}.
31096
31097 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31098 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31099 do not apply. @kbd{M-# z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31100 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31101 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31102
31103 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31104 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31105 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31106
31107 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31108 @section Programming with Formulas
31109
31110 @noindent
31111 @kindex Z F
31112 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31113 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31114 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31115 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31116 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31117 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31118 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31119 non-numeric arguments.
31120
31121 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31122 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31123 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31124 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31125 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31126 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31127 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31128
31129 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31130 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31131 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31132 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31133
31134 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31135 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31136 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31137 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31138 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31139 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31140 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31141 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31142 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31143
31144 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31145 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31146 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31147 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31148 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31149 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31150 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31151 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31152 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31153 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31154 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31155 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
31156
31157 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31158 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31159 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31160 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31161 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31162 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31163 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31164
31165 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31166 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31167 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31168 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31169
31170 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31171 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31172 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31173 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31174 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31175 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31176 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31177 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31178 question.
31179
31180 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31181 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31182 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31183 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31184
31185 @kindex Z G
31186 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
31187 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31188 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31189 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31190 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31191 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31192 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31193 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31194
31195 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31196 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31197 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31198 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31199 @kbd{C-x k} to
31200 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31201 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31202 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31203 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31204
31205 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31206 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31207 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31208
31209 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31210 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31211 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31212 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31213 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31214 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31215 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31216 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31217 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31218
31219 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31220 @section Programming with Lisp
31221
31222 @noindent
31223 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31224 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31225 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31226 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31227 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31228 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31229 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31230 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31231 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31232
31233 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31234 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31235 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31236 to program the Calculator.
31237
31238 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31239 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31240 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31241 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31242 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
31243
31244 @menu
31245 * Defining Functions::
31246 * Defining Simple Commands::
31247 * Defining Stack Commands::
31248 * Argument Qualifiers::
31249 * Example Definitions::
31250
31251 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
31252 * Internals::
31253 @end menu
31254
31255 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
31256 @subsection Defining New Functions
31257
31258 @noindent
31259 @findex defmath
31260 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
31261 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
31262 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
31263 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
31264 example,
31265
31266 @example
31267 (defmath myfact (n)
31268 (if (> n 0)
31269 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31270 1))
31271 @end example
31272
31273 @noindent
31274 This actually expands to the code,
31275
31276 @example
31277 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31278 (if (math-posp n)
31279 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31280 1))
31281 @end example
31282
31283 @noindent
31284 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
31285
31286 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
31287 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
31288 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
31289 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
31290
31291 @smallexample
31292 (defmath myfact (n)
31293 (if (> n 0)
31294 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31295 (if (= n 0)
31296 1
31297 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
31298 @end smallexample
31299
31300 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
31301 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
31302 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
31303 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
31304 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
31305 efficiently as possible.
31306
31307 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
31308 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
31309 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
31310 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
31311 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
31312 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
31313
31314 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
31315 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
31316 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
31317 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
31318 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
31319 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
31320 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
31321
31322 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
31323 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
31324 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
31325 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
31326 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
31327
31328 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
31329
31330 @itemize @bullet
31331 @item
31332 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
31333 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
31334 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
31335 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
31336 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
31337
31338 @item
31339 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
31340 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
31341 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
31342 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
31343 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
31344 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
31345 into one element of a matrix.
31346
31347 @item
31348 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
31349 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
31350 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
31351 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
31352 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
31353 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
31354 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
31355 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
31356 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
31357 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
31358 things, not just two.
31359
31360 @item
31361 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
31362 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
31363 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
31364 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
31365 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
31366
31367 @item
31368 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
31369 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
31370 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
31371 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
31372
31373 @item
31374 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
31375 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
31376 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
31377 inside the body of the function.
31378 @end itemize
31379
31380 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
31381 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
31382 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
31383 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
31384 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
31385
31386 @smallexample
31387 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
31388 (and (numberp x)
31389 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
31390 @end smallexample
31391
31392 expands to
31393
31394 @smallexample
31395 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
31396 (and (math-numberp x)
31397 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
31398 @end smallexample
31399
31400 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
31401 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
31402 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
31403 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
31404 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
31405
31406 @example
31407 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
31408 @end example
31409
31410 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
31411 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
31412 @file{~/.calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
31413 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
31414 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
31415 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
31416 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
31417 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
31418 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
31419 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
31420 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
31421
31422 @example
31423 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
31424 (defmath ... )
31425 (defmath ... )
31426 ))
31427 @end example
31428
31429 @noindent
31430 @vindex calc-define
31431 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
31432 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
31433 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
31434 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
31435 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
31436 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
31437 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
31438 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
31439 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
31440
31441 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
31442 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
31443 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
31444 after Calc itself is loaded.
31445
31446 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
31447 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
31448 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
31449 that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
31450
31451 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
31452 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
31453 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
31454 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
31455 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
31456 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
31457 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
31458 protect against this situation, you can put
31459
31460 @example
31461 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31462 @end example
31463
31464 @findex calc-check-defines
31465 @noindent
31466 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
31467 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
31468 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
31469 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
31470
31471 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
31472 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
31473 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
31474 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
31475
31476 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
31477 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
31478
31479 @noindent
31480 @findex interactive
31481 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
31482 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
31483 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
31484 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
31485 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
31486 the command work in the Calc environment.
31487
31488 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
31489 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
31490
31491 @smallexample
31492 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31493 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
31494 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
31495 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31496 @end smallexample
31497
31498 This expands to the pair of definitions,
31499
31500 @smallexample
31501 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
31502 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31503 (interactive "p")
31504 (calc-wrapper
31505 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
31506
31507 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
31508 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31509 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
31510 @end smallexample
31511
31512 @noindent
31513 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
31514 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
31515 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
31516 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
31517
31518 @findex calc-wrapper
31519 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
31520 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
31521
31522 @smallexample
31523 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
31524 (unwind-protect
31525 (save-excursion
31526 (calc-select-buffer)
31527 @emph{body of function}
31528 @emph{renumber stack}
31529 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
31530 @emph{realign cursor and window}
31531 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
31532 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
31533 @end smallexample
31534
31535 @findex calc-select-buffer
31536 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
31537 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
31538 the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
31539
31540 @findex calc-set-command-flag
31541 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
31542 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
31543 following command flags:
31544
31545 @table @code
31546 @item renum-stack
31547 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
31548 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
31549 @code{calc-push}.
31550
31551 @item clear-message
31552 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
31553 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
31554
31555 @item no-align
31556 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
31557
31558 @item position-point
31559 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
31560 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
31561 this command finishes.
31562
31563 @item keep-flags
31564 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
31565 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
31566
31567 @item do-edit
31568 Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
31569
31570 @item hold-trail
31571 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
31572 there.
31573 @end table
31574
31575 @kindex Y
31576 @kindex Y ?
31577 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
31578 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
31579 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
31580 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
31581 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
31582 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
31583 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
31584 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
31585 future versions of Calc.
31586
31587 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
31588 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
31589 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
31590 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
31591 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
31592 within your package.
31593
31594 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
31595 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
31596 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
31597 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
31598 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
31599 if necessary without having to modify the file.
31600
31601 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
31602 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
31603 decreases the precision.
31604
31605 @smallexample
31606 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
31607 ;;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
31608
31609 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
31610 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
31611
31612 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
31613
31614 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
31615 'increase-precision)
31616 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
31617 'decrease-precision)
31618
31619 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
31620 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
31621 calc-Y-help-msgs))
31622
31623 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31624 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31625 (interactive "p")
31626 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31627
31628 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
31629 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
31630 (interactive "p")
31631 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
31632
31633 )) ; end of calc-define property
31634
31635 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31636 @end smallexample
31637
31638 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
31639 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
31640
31641 @noindent
31642 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
31643 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
31644
31645 @example
31646 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
31647 @end example
31648
31649 @noindent
31650 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
31651 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
31652 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
31653 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
31654 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
31655 parameters is legal.
31656
31657 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
31658 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
31659 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
31660 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
31661 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
31662 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
31663
31664 As an example, the definition
31665
31666 @smallexample
31667 (defmath myfact (n)
31668 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31669 (interactive 1 "fact")
31670 (if (> n 0)
31671 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31672 (and (= n 0) 1)))
31673 @end smallexample
31674
31675 @noindent
31676 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
31677 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
31678
31679 @smallexample
31680 (defun calc-myfact ()
31681 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31682 (interactive)
31683 (calc-slow-wrapper
31684 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
31685 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
31686
31687 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31688 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31689 (if (math-posp n)
31690 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31691 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
31692 @end smallexample
31693
31694 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
31695 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
31696 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
31697 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
31698 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
31699
31700 @findex calc-top-list-n
31701 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
31702 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
31703 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
31704 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
31705
31706 @findex calc-enter-result
31707 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
31708 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
31709 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
31710 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
31711 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
31712 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
31713
31714 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
31715 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
31716 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
31717 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
31718 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
31719
31720 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
31721 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
31722 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
31723
31724 @example
31725 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
31726 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
31727 @var{body})
31728 @end example
31729
31730 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
31731 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
31732 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
31733
31734 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
31735 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
31736 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
31737 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
31738 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
31739
31740 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
31741 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
31742
31743 @noindent
31744 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
31745 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
31746
31747 @example
31748 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
31749 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
31750 &rest @var{param})
31751 @var{body})
31752 @end example
31753
31754 @noindent
31755 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
31756
31757 @example
31758 (@var{qual} @var{param})
31759 @end example
31760
31761 The following qualifiers are recognized:
31762
31763 @table @samp
31764 @item complete
31765 @findex complete
31766 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
31767 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
31768 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
31769 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
31770
31771 @item integer
31772 @findex integer
31773 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
31774 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
31775 formulas are rejected.
31776
31777 @item natnum
31778 @findex natnum
31779 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
31780
31781 @item fixnum
31782 @findex fixnum
31783 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
31784 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
31785 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
31786
31787 @item float
31788 @findex float
31789 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
31790 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
31791 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
31792
31793 @item @var{pred}
31794 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
31795 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
31796
31797 @item not-@var{pred}
31798 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
31799 @end table
31800
31801 For example,
31802
31803 @example
31804 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
31805 &rest (integer d))
31806 @var{body})
31807 @end example
31808
31809 @noindent
31810 expands to
31811
31812 @example
31813 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
31814 (and (math-matrixp b)
31815 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
31816 (or (math-constp b)
31817 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
31818 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
31819 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
31820 @var{body})
31821 @end example
31822
31823 @noindent
31824 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
31825 body of the function.
31826
31827 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
31828 @subsection Example Definitions
31829
31830 @noindent
31831 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
31832 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
31833 @pxref{Internals}.
31834
31835 @menu
31836 * Bit Counting Example::
31837 * Sine Example::
31838 @end menu
31839
31840 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
31841 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
31842
31843 @noindent
31844 @ignore
31845 @starindex
31846 @end ignore
31847 @tindex bcount
31848 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
31849 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
31850 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
31851 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
31852 create an intermediate set.
31853
31854 @smallexample
31855 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
31856 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
31857 (let ((count 0))
31858 (while (> n 0)
31859 (if (oddp n)
31860 (setq count (1+ count)))
31861 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
31862 count))
31863 @end smallexample
31864
31865 @noindent
31866 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
31867 Emacs Lisp function:
31868
31869 @smallexample
31870 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
31871 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
31872 (let ((count 0))
31873 (while (math-posp n)
31874 (if (math-oddp n)
31875 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
31876 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
31877 count))
31878 @end smallexample
31879
31880 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
31881 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
31882 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
31883 involve actual division.
31884
31885 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
31886 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
31887 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
31888 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
31889 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
31890
31891 @smallexample
31892 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
31893 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
31894 (let ((count 0))
31895 (while (not (fixnump n))
31896 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
31897 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
31898 n (car qr))))
31899 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
31900
31901 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
31902 (let ((count 0))
31903 (while (> n 0)
31904 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
31905 n (lsh n -1)))
31906 count))
31907 @end smallexample
31908
31909 @noindent
31910 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
31911 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
31912 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
31913 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
31914 uses.
31915
31916 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
31917 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
31918 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
31919 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
31920 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
31921 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
31922 same thing with a single division by 512.
31923
31924 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
31925 @subsubsection The Sine Function
31926
31927 @noindent
31928 @ignore
31929 @starindex
31930 @end ignore
31931 @tindex mysin
31932 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
31933 well-known Taylor series expansion for
31934 @texline @math{\sin x}:
31935 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
31936
31937 @smallexample
31938 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
31939 (interactive 1 "mysn")
31940 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
31941 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
31942 newsum
31943 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
31944 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
31945 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
31946 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
31947 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
31948 x (* x xnegsqr)
31949 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
31950 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
31951 (break)) ; then we are done.
31952 (setq sum newsum))
31953 sum))
31954 @end smallexample
31955
31956 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
31957 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
31958 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
31959 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
31960 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
31961 by a separate algorithm.
31962
31963 @smallexample
31964 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
31965 (interactive 1 "mysn")
31966 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
31967 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
31968 (cond ((complexp x)
31969 (mysin-complex x))
31970 ((< x 0)
31971 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
31972 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
31973
31974 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
31975 (cond ((>= x 7)
31976 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
31977 ((> x (pi-over-2))
31978 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
31979 ((> x (pi-over-4))
31980 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
31981 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
31982 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
31983 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
31984 @end smallexample
31985
31986 @noindent
31987 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
31988 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
31989 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
31990 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
31991
31992 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
31993 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
31994 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
31995 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
31996 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
31997 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
31998 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
31999 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32000 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32001 that this rule misses.
32002
32003 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32004 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32005 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32006 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32007
32008 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32009 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32010
32011 @noindent
32012 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32013 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32014 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32015 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32016 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32017 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32018 much simpler to use!
32019
32020 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32021 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32022
32023 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32024 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32025 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32026
32027 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32028 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32029 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32030 loaded and initialized for you.
32031
32032 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32033 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32034
32035 @ifinfo
32036 @example
32037
32038 @end example
32039 @end ifinfo
32040 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32041
32042 @noindent
32043 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32044 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32045 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32046 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32047
32048 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32049 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32050 one by one below.
32051
32052 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32053 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32054 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32055 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32056 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32057 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32058
32059 @ifinfo
32060 @example
32061
32062 @end example
32063 @end ifinfo
32064 @subsubsection Error Handling
32065
32066 @noindent
32067 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32068 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32069 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32070 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32071 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32072 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32073
32074 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32075 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32076 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32077 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32078
32079 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32080 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32081 ignored.
32082
32083 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32084 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32085 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32086
32087 @ifinfo
32088 @example
32089
32090 @end example
32091 @end ifinfo
32092 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32093
32094 @noindent
32095 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32096 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32097 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32098 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32099 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32100 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32101
32102 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32103 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32104 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32105
32106 @ifinfo
32107 @example
32108
32109 @end example
32110 @end ifinfo
32111 @subsubsection Default Modes
32112
32113 @noindent
32114 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32115 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32116 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32117 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32118 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32119 mode is used.
32120
32121 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32122 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32123 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32124
32125 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32126 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32127 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32128 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32129 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32130 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32131
32132 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32133 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32134 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32135 of the default of 12.
32136
32137 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32138 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32139 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32140 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32141 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32142
32143 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32144 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32145 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32146 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32147 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32148 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32149
32150 @ifinfo
32151 @example
32152
32153 @end example
32154 @end ifinfo
32155 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
32156
32157 @noindent
32158 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32159 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32160 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32161 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32162 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32163
32164 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32165 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32166 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32167 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32168 structure.
32169
32170 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32171 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32172 an error if that object is not a constant).
32173
32174 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32175 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32176 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32177 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32178 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32179 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32180
32181 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32182 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32183 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32184 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32185
32186 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32187 to format it as a string.
32188
32189 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32190 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32191 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32192
32193 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32194 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32195 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32196
32197 @ifinfo
32198 @example
32199
32200 @end example
32201 @end ifinfo
32202 @subsubsection Predicates
32203
32204 @noindent
32205 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32206 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32207 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32208 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32209
32210 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32211 one value is less than another.
32212
32213 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32214 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32215 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32216 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32217 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32218
32219 @ifinfo
32220 @example
32221
32222 @end example
32223 @end ifinfo
32224 @subsubsection Variable Values
32225
32226 @noindent
32227 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32228 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32229 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32230 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32231 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32232 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32233 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32234
32235 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32236 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32237 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32238 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32239 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32240 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32241
32242 @example
32243 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
32244 @end example
32245
32246 @ifinfo
32247 @example
32248
32249 @end example
32250 @end ifinfo
32251 @subsubsection Stack Access
32252
32253 @noindent
32254 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
32255 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
32256 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
32257 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
32258 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
32259 usual way).
32260
32261 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
32262 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
32263 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
32264 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
32265 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
32266 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
32267 the stack.
32268
32269 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
32270 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
32271 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
32272 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
32273 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
32274
32275 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
32276 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
32277 as a string.
32278
32279 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
32280 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
32281 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
32282 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
32283 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
32284 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
32285
32286 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
32287 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
32288 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
32289
32290 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
32291 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
32292 the stack buffer if necessary.
32293
32294 @ifinfo
32295 @example
32296
32297 @end example
32298 @end ifinfo
32299 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
32300
32301 @noindent
32302 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
32303 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
32304 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
32305 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
32306 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
32307 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
32308 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
32309
32310 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
32311 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
32312 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
32313 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
32314 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
32315
32316 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
32317 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
32318 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
32319
32320 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
32321
32322 @ifinfo
32323 @example
32324
32325 @end example
32326 @end ifinfo
32327 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
32328
32329 @noindent
32330 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
32331 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
32332 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
32333 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
32334 @code{calc-eval}.
32335
32336 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
32337 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
32338 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
32339 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
32340
32341 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
32342 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
32343 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
32344 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
32345 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
32346 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
32347 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
32348 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
32349 your original buffer when it is done.
32350
32351 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
32352 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
32353
32354 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
32355 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
32356
32357 @ifinfo
32358 @example
32359
32360 @end example
32361 @end ifinfo
32362 @subsubsection Example
32363
32364 @noindent
32365 @findex convert-temp
32366 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
32367 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
32368 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
32369 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
32370 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
32371 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
32372 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
32373
32374 @example
32375 (defun convert-temp ()
32376 (interactive)
32377 (save-excursion
32378 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
32379 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
32380 (bot1 (match-end 1))
32381 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
32382 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
32383 (bot2 (match-end 2))
32384 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
32385 (if (equal type "F")
32386 (setq type "C"
32387 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
32388 (setq type "F"
32389 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
32390 (goto-char top2)
32391 (delete-region top2 bot2)
32392 (insert-before-markers type)
32393 (goto-char top1)
32394 (delete-region top1 bot1)
32395 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
32396 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
32397 (insert number))))
32398 @end example
32399
32400 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
32401 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
32402 instead of after it.
32403
32404 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
32405 @subsection Calculator Internals
32406
32407 @noindent
32408 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
32409 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
32410 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
32411 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
32412 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
32413 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
32414 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
32415 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
32416
32417 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
32418 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
32419 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
32420 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
32421 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
32422 in the remaining component files.
32423
32424 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
32425 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
32426 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
32427 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
32428 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
32429 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
32430 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
32431 prove this file will already be loaded.
32432
32433 @menu
32434 * Data Type Formats::
32435 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
32436 * Stack Lisp Functions::
32437 * Predicates::
32438 * Computational Lisp Functions::
32439 * Vector Lisp Functions::
32440 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
32441 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
32442 * Hooks::
32443 @end menu
32444
32445 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
32446 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
32447
32448 @noindent
32449 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
32450 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
32451 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
32452 which is not a Lisp list.
32453
32454 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
32455 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
32456 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
32457 @mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
32458 from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
32459 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
32460 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
32461
32462 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
32463 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
32464 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
32465 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
32466 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
32467 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
32468
32469 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
32470 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
32471 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
32472 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
32473 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
32474 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
32475
32476 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
32477 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
32478 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
32479 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
32480 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
32481 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
32482 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
32483 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
32484 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
32485 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
32486
32487 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
32488 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
32489 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
32490 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
32491 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
32492
32493 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
32494 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
32495 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
32496 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
32497 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
32498 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
32499 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
32500 negative real number.)
32501
32502 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
32503 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
32504 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
32505 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
32506 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
32507
32508 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
32509 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
32510 January 1, 1 AD. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
32511 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
32512
32513 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
32514 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
32515 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
32516
32517 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
32518 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
32519 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
32520 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
32521 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
32522 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
32523
32524 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
32525 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
32526 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
32527 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
32528 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
32529 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
32530 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
32531 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
32532 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
32533 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
32534
32535 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
32536 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
32537 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
32538 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
32539 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
32540 generally unused by Calc data structures.
32541
32542 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
32543 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
32544 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
32545 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
32546 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
32547 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
32548 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
32549 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
32550 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
32551 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
32552 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
32553 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
32554 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
32555 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
32556 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
32557 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
32558 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
32559 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
32560 the variable is used.
32561
32562 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
32563 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
32564 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
32565 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
32566 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
32567 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
32568 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
32569 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
32570 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
32571 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
32572 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
32573 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
32574 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
32575 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
32576 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
32577 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
32578 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
32579 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
32580 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
32581
32582 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
32583 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
32584
32585 @noindent
32586 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
32587 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
32588 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
32589 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
32590
32591 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
32592 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
32593 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
32594 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
32595 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
32596 @end defun
32597
32598 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
32599 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
32600 remove it from that list.
32601 @end defun
32602
32603 @defun calc-record-undo rec
32604 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
32605 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
32606 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
32607 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
32608 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
32609 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
32610 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
32611 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
32612 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
32613 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
32614 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
32615 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
32616 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
32617 @end defun
32618
32619 @defun calc-record-why msg args
32620 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
32621 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
32622 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
32623 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
32624 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
32625 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
32626 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
32627 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
32628 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
32629 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
32630 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
32631 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
32632 @end defun
32633
32634 @defun calc-is-inverse
32635 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
32636 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
32637 @end defun
32638
32639 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
32640 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
32641 @end defun
32642
32643 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
32644 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
32645
32646 @noindent
32647 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
32648 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
32649
32650 @defun calc-push-list vals n
32651 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
32652 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
32653 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
32654 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
32655 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
32656 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
32657 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
32658 is an empty list, nothing happens.
32659
32660 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
32661 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
32662 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
32663 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
32664 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
32665 @end defun
32666
32667 @defun calc-top-list n m
32668 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
32669 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
32670 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
32671 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
32672 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
32673 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
32674 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
32675 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
32676 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
32677 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
32678
32679 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
32680 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
32681 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
32682 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
32683 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
32684 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
32685 ``illegal operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
32686 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
32687 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
32688 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
32689 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
32690 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
32691 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
32692 @end defun
32693
32694 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
32695 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
32696 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
32697 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
32698
32699 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
32700 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
32701 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
32702 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
32703 contain selections.
32704 @end defun
32705
32706 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
32707 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
32708 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
32709 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
32710 will be used.
32711 @end defun
32712
32713 @defun calc-normalize n
32714 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
32715 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
32716 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
32717 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
32718 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
32719 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
32720 @end defun
32721
32722 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
32723 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
32724 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
32725 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
32726 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
32727 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
32728 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
32729 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
32730 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
32731 @code{calc-top-list}.
32732 @end defun
32733
32734 @defun calc-top-n m
32735 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
32736 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
32737 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
32738 @end defun
32739
32740 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
32741 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
32742 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
32743 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
32744 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
32745 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
32746 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
32747
32748 @smallexample
32749 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
32750 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
32751 @end smallexample
32752
32753 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
32754 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
32755 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
32756 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
32757 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
32758 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
32759 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
32760 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
32761 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
32762 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
32763 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
32764 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
32765 are present.
32766 @end defun
32767
32768 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
32769 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
32770 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
32771 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
32772 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
32773 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
32774
32775 @smallexample
32776 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
32777 (interactive "P")
32778 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
32779 @end smallexample
32780 @end defun
32781
32782 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
32783 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
32784 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
32785 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
32786 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
32787 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
32788 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
32789 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
32790 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
32791 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
32792 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
32793 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
32794 top element.
32795 @end defun
32796
32797 @defun calc-stack-size
32798 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
32799 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
32800 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
32801 @end defun
32802
32803 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
32804 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
32805 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
32806 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
32807 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
32808 line number, not the stack entry itself.
32809 @end defun
32810
32811 @defun calc-substack-height n
32812 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
32813 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
32814 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
32815 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
32816 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
32817 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
32818 entries.)
32819 @end defun
32820
32821 @defun calc-refresh
32822 Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
32823 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
32824 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
32825 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
32826 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
32827 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
32828 @end defun
32829
32830 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
32831 @subsubsection Predicates
32832
32833 @noindent
32834 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
32835 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
32836 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
32837 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
32838 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
32839 the full range of Calc data types.
32840
32841 @defun zerop x
32842 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
32843 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
32844 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
32845 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
32846 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
32847 @end defun
32848
32849 @defun negp x
32850 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
32851 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
32852 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
32853 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
32854 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
32855 @end defun
32856
32857 @defun posp x
32858 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
32859 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
32860 @end defun
32861
32862 @defun looks-negp x
32863 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
32864 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
32865 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
32866 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
32867 @end defun
32868
32869 @defun integerp x
32870 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
32871 @end defun
32872
32873 @defun fixnump x
32874 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
32875 @end defun
32876
32877 @defun natnump x
32878 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
32879 @end defun
32880
32881 @defun fixnatnump x
32882 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
32883 @end defun
32884
32885 @defun num-integerp x
32886 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
32887 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
32888 the decimal point.
32889 @end defun
32890
32891 @defun messy-integerp x
32892 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
32893 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
32894 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
32895 @end defun
32896
32897 @defun num-natnump x
32898 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
32899 @end defun
32900
32901 @defun evenp x
32902 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
32903 @end defun
32904
32905 @defun looks-evenp x
32906 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
32907 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
32908 @end defun
32909
32910 @defun oddp x
32911 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
32912 @end defun
32913
32914 @defun ratp x
32915 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
32916 fraction.
32917 @end defun
32918
32919 @defun realp x
32920 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
32921 or floating-point number.
32922 @end defun
32923
32924 @defun anglep x
32925 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
32926 @end defun
32927
32928 @defun floatp x
32929 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
32930 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
32931 is a float.
32932 @end defun
32933
32934 @defun complexp x
32935 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
32936 (but not a real number).
32937 @end defun
32938
32939 @defun rect-complexp x
32940 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
32941 @end defun
32942
32943 @defun polar-complexp x
32944 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
32945 @end defun
32946
32947 @defun numberp x
32948 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
32949 @end defun
32950
32951 @defun scalarp x
32952 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
32953 @end defun
32954
32955 @defun vectorp x
32956 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
32957 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
32958 @end defun
32959
32960 @defun numvecp x
32961 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
32962 @end defun
32963
32964 @defun matrixp x
32965 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
32966 all of the same size.
32967 @end defun
32968
32969 @defun square-matrixp x
32970 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
32971 @end defun
32972
32973 @defun objectp x
32974 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
32975 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
32976 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
32977 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
32978 @end defun
32979
32980 @defun objvecp x
32981 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
32982 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
32983 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
32984 @end defun
32985
32986 @defun primp x
32987 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
32988 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
32989 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
32990 and intervals.
32991 @end defun
32992
32993 @defun constp x
32994 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
32995 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
32996 components are @code{constp}.
32997 @end defun
32998
32999 @defun lessp x y
33000 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33001 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33002 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33003 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33004 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33005 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33006 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33007 @end defun
33008
33009 @defun beforep x y
33010 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33011 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33012 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33013 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33014 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33015 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33016 by @kbd{a s} to put the terms of a product into canonical order:
33017 This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to @samp{2 x y}.
33018 @end defun
33019
33020 @defun equal x y
33021 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33022 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33023 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33024 0 and 0.0 as different.
33025 @end defun
33026
33027 @defun math-equal x y
33028 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33029 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33030 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33031 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33032 @end defun
33033
33034 @defun equal-int x n
33035 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33036 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33037 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33038 whenever possible.
33039 @end defun
33040
33041 @defun nearly-equal x y
33042 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33043 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33044 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33045 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33046 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33047 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33048 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33049 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33050 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33051 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33052 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33053 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33054 @end defun
33055
33056 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33057 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33058 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33059 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33060 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33061 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33062 @var{y} must be real.
33063 @end defun
33064
33065 @defun is-true x
33066 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33067 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33068 or a provably non-zero formula.
33069 @end defun
33070
33071 @defun reject-arg val pred
33072 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33073 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33074 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33075 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33076 @end defun
33077
33078 @defun inexact-value
33079 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33080 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33081 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33082 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33083 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33084 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33085 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33086 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33087 @end defun
33088
33089 @defun overflow
33090 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33091 @end defun
33092
33093 @defun underflow
33094 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33095 @end defun
33096
33097 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33098 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33099
33100 @noindent
33101 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33102 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33103 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33104 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33105 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33106 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33107 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33108
33109 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33110 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33111 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33112 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33113 respectively, instead.
33114
33115 @defun normalize val
33116 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33117 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33118 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33119 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33120 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33121 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33122 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33123 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33124 return 6.
33125
33126 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33127 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33128 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33129 the formula still in symbolic form.
33130
33131 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33132 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33133 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33134 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33135 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33136 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33137 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33138 on the stack.
33139 @end defun
33140
33141 @defun evaluate-expr expr
33142 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33143 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33144 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33145 @end defun
33146
33147 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
33148 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33149 digits. This is a macro which expands to
33150
33151 @smallexample
33152 (math-normalize
33153 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33154 @var{body}))
33155 @end smallexample
33156
33157 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33158 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33159 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33160 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33161 @end defmac
33162
33163 @defun make-frac n d
33164 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33165 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33166 @end defun
33167
33168 @defun make-float mant exp
33169 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33170 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33171 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33172 if @var{exp} is out of range.
33173 @end defun
33174
33175 @defun make-sdev x sigma
33176 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33177 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33178 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33179 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33180 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33181 @end defun
33182
33183 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
33184 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33185 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33186 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33187 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33188 @end defun
33189
33190 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33191 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33192 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33193 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33194 @end defun
33195
33196 @defun make-mod n m
33197 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33198 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33199 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33200 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33201 @end defun
33202
33203 @defun float x
33204 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33205 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33206 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33207 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33208 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33209 @end defun
33210
33211 @defun compare x y
33212 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33213 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
33214 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33215 undefined or cannot be determined.
33216 @end defun
33217
33218 @defun numdigs n
33219 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33220 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33221 considered to have zero digits.
33222 @end defun
33223
33224 @defun scale-int x n
33225 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33226 digits with truncation toward zero.
33227 @end defun
33228
33229 @defun scale-rounding x n
33230 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33231 integer rather than truncating.
33232 @end defun
33233
33234 @defun fixnum n
33235 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33236 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
33237 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33238 @end defun
33239
33240 @defun sqr x
33241 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
33242 @end defun
33243
33244 @defun quotient x y
33245 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
33246 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
33247 direction of rounding is undefined.
33248 @end defun
33249
33250 @defun idiv x y
33251 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
33252 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
33253 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
33254 slower than for @code{quotient}.
33255 @end defun
33256
33257 @defun imod x y
33258 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
33259 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
33260 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
33261 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
33262 @end defun
33263
33264 @defun idivmod x y
33265 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
33266 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
33267 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
33268 @end defun
33269
33270 @defun pow x y
33271 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
33272 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
33273 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
33274 @end defun
33275
33276 @defun abs-approx x
33277 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
33278 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
33279 the absolute values of the components.
33280 @end defun
33281
33282 @findex two-pi
33283 @findex pi-over-2
33284 @findex pi-over-4
33285 @findex pi-over-180
33286 @findex sqrt-two-pi
33287 @findex sqrt-e
33288 @findex e
33289 @findex ln-2
33290 @findex ln-10
33291 @defun pi
33292 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
33293 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
33294 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
33295 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, and @code{ln-10}. Each function
33296 returns a floating-point value in the current precision, and each uses
33297 caching so that all calls after the first are essentially free.
33298 @end defun
33299
33300 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
33301 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
33302 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
33303 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
33304 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
33305 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
33306 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
33307 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
33308 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
33309 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
33310 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
33311 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
33312 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
33313 @end defmac
33314
33315 @findex half-circle
33316 @findex quarter-circle
33317 @defun full-circle symb
33318 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
33319 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
33320 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
33321 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
33322 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
33323 @end defun
33324
33325 @defun power-of-2 n
33326 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
33327 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
33328 particular @var{n} is expensive.
33329 @end defun
33330
33331 @defun integer-log2 n
33332 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
33333 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
33334 return @code{nil}.
33335 @end defun
33336
33337 @defun div-mod a b m
33338 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
33339 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
33340 @end defun
33341
33342 @defun pow-mod a b m
33343 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
33344 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
33345 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
33346 @end defun
33347
33348 @defun isqrt n
33349 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
33350 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
33351 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
33352 @end defun
33353
33354 @defun to-hms a ang
33355 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
33356 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
33357 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
33358 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
33359 @end defun
33360
33361 @defun from-hms a ang
33362 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
33363 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
33364 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
33365 is returned as-is.
33366 @end defun
33367
33368 @defun to-radians a
33369 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
33370 angular mode.
33371 @end defun
33372
33373 @defun from-radians a
33374 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
33375 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
33376 @end defun
33377
33378 @defun to-radians-2 a
33379 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
33380 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
33381 @end defun
33382
33383 @defun from-radians-2 a
33384 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
33385 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
33386 @end defun
33387
33388 @defun random-digit
33389 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
33390 @end defun
33391
33392 @defun random-digits n
33393 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
33394 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
33395 @end defun
33396
33397 @defun random-float
33398 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
33399 @end defun
33400
33401 @defun prime-test n iters
33402 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
33403 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
33404 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
33405 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
33406 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
33407 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
33408 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
33409 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
33410 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
33411 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
33412 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
33413 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
33414 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
33415 @end defun
33416
33417 @defun to-simple-fraction f
33418 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
33419 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
33420 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
33421 fast.
33422 @end defun
33423
33424 @defun to-fraction f tol
33425 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
33426 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
33427 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
33428 @end defun
33429
33430 @defun quarter-integer n
33431 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
33432 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
33433 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
33434 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
33435 returns @code{nil}.
33436 @end defun
33437
33438 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
33439 @subsubsection Vector Functions
33440
33441 @noindent
33442 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
33443 matrices.
33444
33445 @defun math-concat x y
33446 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
33447 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
33448 @end defun
33449
33450 @defun vec-length v
33451 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
33452 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
33453 rows in the matrix.
33454 @end defun
33455
33456 @defun mat-dimens m
33457 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
33458 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
33459 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
33460 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
33461 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
33462 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
33463 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
33464 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
33465 elements.
33466 @end defun
33467
33468 @defun dimension-error
33469 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
33470 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
33471 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
33472 @end defun
33473
33474 @defun build-vector args
33475 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
33476 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
33477 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
33478 @end defun
33479
33480 @defun make-vec obj dims
33481 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
33482 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
33483 filled with 27's.
33484 @end defun
33485
33486 @defun row-matrix v
33487 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
33488 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
33489 leave it alone.
33490 @end defun
33491
33492 @defun col-matrix v
33493 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
33494 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
33495 already a matrix, leave it alone.
33496 @end defun
33497
33498 @defun map-vec f v
33499 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
33500 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
33501 of vector @var{v}.
33502 @end defun
33503
33504 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
33505 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
33506 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
33507 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
33508 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
33509 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
33510 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
33511 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
33512 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
33513 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
33514 @end defun
33515
33516 @defun reduce-vec f v
33517 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
33518 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
33519 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
33520 @end defun
33521
33522 @defun reduce-cols f m
33523 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
33524 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
33525 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
33526 @end defun
33527
33528 @defun mat-row m n
33529 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
33530 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
33531 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
33532 @end defun
33533
33534 @defun mat-col m n
33535 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
33536 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
33537 @end defun
33538
33539 @defun mat-less-row m n
33540 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
33541 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
33542 @end defun
33543
33544 @defun mat-less-col m n
33545 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
33546 @end defun
33547
33548 @defun transpose m
33549 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
33550 @end defun
33551
33552 @defun flatten-vector v
33553 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
33554 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
33555 @end defun
33556
33557 @defun copy-matrix m
33558 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
33559 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
33560 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
33561 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
33562 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
33563 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
33564 @end defun
33565
33566 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
33567 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
33568 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
33569 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
33570 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
33571 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
33572 @var{m}.
33573 @end defun
33574
33575 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
33576 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
33577
33578 @noindent
33579 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
33580 Calculator.
33581
33582 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
33583 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
33584 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
33585 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
33586 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
33587 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
33588 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
33589 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
33590 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
33591 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
33592 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
33593 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
33594 their corresponding sub-formulas.
33595
33596 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
33597 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
33598 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
33599 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
33600 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
33601 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
33602 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
33603 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
33604 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
33605 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
33606 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
33607 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
33608 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
33609 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
33610 @end defun
33611
33612 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
33613 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
33614 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
33615 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
33616 the formula in-place.
33617 @end defun
33618
33619 @defun calc-find-selected-part
33620 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
33621 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
33622 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
33623 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
33624 @end defun
33625
33626 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
33627 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
33628 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
33629 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
33630 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
33631 to reflect the new selection.
33632 @end defun
33633
33634 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
33635 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
33636 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
33637 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
33638 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
33639 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
33640 @end defun
33641
33642 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
33643 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
33644 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
33645 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
33646 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
33647 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
33648 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
33649 This function does not take associativity into account.
33650 @end defun
33651
33652 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
33653 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
33654 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
33655 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
33656 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
33657 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
33658 return the whole expression.
33659 @end defun
33660
33661 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
33662 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
33663 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
33664 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
33665 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
33666 @end defun
33667
33668 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
33669 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
33670 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
33671 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
33672 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
33673 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
33674 function does not take associativity into account.
33675 @end defun
33676
33677 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
33678 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
33679 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
33680 @end defun
33681
33682 @defun simplify expr
33683 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying various algebraic rules.
33684 This is what the @w{@kbd{a s}} (@code{calc-simplify}) command uses. This
33685 always returns a copy of the expression; the structure @var{expr} points
33686 to remains unchanged in memory.
33687
33688 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
33689 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
33690 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
33691 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
33692 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
33693 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
33694 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
33695 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
33696 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
33697 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
33698 needed:@: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
33699 further simplifications were possible.
33700 @end defun
33701
33702 @defun simplify-extended expr
33703 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
33704 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
33705 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
33706 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
33707 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
33708 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
33709 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
33710 before taking any action.
33711 @end defun
33712
33713 @defun simplify-units expr
33714 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
33715 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
33716 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
33717 @end defun
33718
33719 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
33720 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
33721 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
33722 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
33723 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
33724 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
33725 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
33726 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
33727 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
33728 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
33729 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
33730 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
33731 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
33732 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
33733
33734 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
33735 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
33736 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
33737 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
33738 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
33739
33740 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
33741 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
33742 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
33743 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
33744
33745 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
33746 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
33747 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
33748 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
33749 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
33750
33751 @smallexample
33752 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
33753 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
33754 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
33755 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
33756 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
33757 (or math-living-dangerously
33758 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
33759 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
33760 @end smallexample
33761
33762 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
33763 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
33764 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
33765 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
33766 @end defmac
33767
33768 @defun common-constant-factor expr
33769 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
33770 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
33771 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
33772 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
33773 @end defun
33774
33775 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
33776 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
33777 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
33778 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
33779 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
33780 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
33781 square roots:
33782
33783 @smallexample
33784 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
33785 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
33786 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
33787 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
33788 (math-normalize
33789 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
33790 (math-cancel-common-factor
33791 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
33792 @end smallexample
33793 @end defun
33794
33795 @defun frac-gcd a b
33796 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
33797 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
33798 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
33799 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
33800 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
33801 @end defun
33802
33803 @defun map-tree func expr many
33804 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
33805 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
33806 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
33807 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
33808 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
33809 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
33810 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
33811 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
33812 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
33813 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
33814 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
33815 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
33816 @end defun
33817
33818 @defun compile-rewrites rules
33819 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
33820 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
33821 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
33822 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
33823 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
33824 message.
33825 @end defun
33826
33827 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
33828 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
33829 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
33830 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
33831 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
33832 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
33833 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
33834 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
33835 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
33836 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
33837 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
33838 @end defun
33839
33840 @defun rewrite-heads expr
33841 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
33842 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
33843 @end defun
33844
33845 @defun rewrite expr rules many
33846 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
33847 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
33848 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
33849 times.
33850 @end defun
33851
33852 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
33853 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
33854 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
33855 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
33856 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
33857 @end defun
33858
33859 @defun deriv expr var value symb
33860 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
33861 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
33862 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
33863 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
33864 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
33865 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
33866 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of undifferentiable
33867 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
33868 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
33869
33870 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
33871 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
33872 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
33873 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
33874 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
33875 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
33876 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
33877 is defined by
33878
33879 @smallexample
33880 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
33881 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
33882 @end smallexample
33883
33884 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
33885 @smallexample
33886 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
33887 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
33888 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
33889 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
33890 @end smallexample
33891 @end defun
33892
33893 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
33894 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
33895 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
33896 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
33897 @end defun
33898
33899 @defun integ expr var low high
33900 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
33901 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
33902 @end defun
33903
33904 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
33905 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
33906 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
33907 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
33908 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
33909 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
33910 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
33911 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
33912 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
33913 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
33914 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
33915
33916 @smallexample
33917 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
33918 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
33919 (and int
33920 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
33921
33922 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
33923 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
33924 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
33925 @end smallexample
33926
33927 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
33928 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
33929 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
33930 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
33931 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
33932 result.
33933 @end defmac
33934
33935 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
33936 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
33937 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
33938 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
33939 @var{v}.
33940 @end defmac
33941
33942 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
33943 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
33944 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
33945 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
33946 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
33947 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
33948 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
33949 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
33950 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
33951 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
33952 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
33953
33954 @smallexample
33955 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
33956 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
33957 @end smallexample
33958
33959 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
33960 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
33961 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
33962 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
33963 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
33964 @end defun
33965
33966 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
33967 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
33968 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
33969 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
33970 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
33971 @end defun
33972
33973 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
33974 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
33975 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
33976 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
33977 @end defun
33978
33979 @defun expr-contains expr var
33980 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
33981 of @var{expr}.
33982
33983 This function might seem at first to be identical to
33984 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
33985 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
33986 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
33987 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
33988 @code{eq} to each other.
33989 @end defun
33990
33991 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
33992 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
33993 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
33994 @end defun
33995
33996 @defun expr-depends expr var
33997 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
33998 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
33999 in common.
34000 @end defun
34001
34002 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34003 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34004 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34005 @end defun
34006
34007 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34008 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34009 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34010 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34011 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34012 @end defun
34013
34014 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34015 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34016 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34017 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34018 are ignored.
34019 @end defun
34020
34021 @defun expr-weight expr
34022 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34023 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34024 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34025 @end defun
34026
34027 @defun expr-height expr
34028 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34029 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34030 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34031 @end defun
34032
34033 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34034 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34035 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34036 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34037 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34038 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34039 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34040 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34041 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34042 a polynomial of degree 0.
34043 @end defun
34044
34045 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34046 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34047 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34048 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34049 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34050 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34051 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34052 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34053 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34054 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34055 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34056 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34057 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34058 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34059 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34060 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34061 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34062 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34063 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34064 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34065 @end defun
34066
34067 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34068 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34069 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34070 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34071 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34072 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34073 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34074 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34075 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34076 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34077 is found.
34078 @end defun
34079
34080 @defun poly-simplify poly
34081 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34082 clipping off trailing zeros.
34083 @end defun
34084
34085 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34086 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34087 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34088 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34089 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34090 @end defun
34091
34092 @defun poly-mul a b
34093 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34094 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34095 @end defun
34096
34097 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34098 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34099 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34100 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34101 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34102 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34103 @end defun
34104
34105 @defun check-unit-name var
34106 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34107 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34108 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34109 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34110 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34111 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34112 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34113 @end defun
34114
34115 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34116 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34117 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34118 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34119 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34120 @end defun
34121
34122 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34123 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34124 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34125 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34126 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34127 @end defun
34128
34129 @defun to-standard-units expr which
34130 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34131 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34132 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34133 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34134 is an expression to substitute for it.
34135 @end defun
34136
34137 @defun remove-units expr
34138 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34139 This expression is generally normalized before use.
34140 @end defun
34141
34142 @defun extract-units expr
34143 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34144 by ones.
34145 @end defun
34146
34147 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34148 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34149
34150 @noindent
34151 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34152 Calc numbers and formulas.
34153
34154 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34155 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34156 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34157 @end defun
34158
34159 @defun read-number str
34160 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34161 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34162 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34163 @end defun
34164
34165 @defun read-expr str
34166 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34167 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34168 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34169 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34170 a string describing the problem.
34171 @end defun
34172
34173 @defun read-exprs str
34174 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34175 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34176 shown above is returned instead.
34177 @end defun
34178
34179 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34180 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34181 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34182 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34183 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34184 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34185 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34186 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34187 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34188 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34189 @code{calc-normalize} first.
34190
34191 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34192 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34193 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34194 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34195 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34196 that actually appeared in the input.
34197 @end defun
34198
34199 @defun format-number a
34200 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34201 @end defun
34202
34203 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
34204 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34205 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34206 This is a simple format designed
34207 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34208 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34209 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34210 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34211 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34212 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34213 @end defun
34214
34215 @defun format-nice-expr a width
34216 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34217 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34218 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34219 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34220 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34221 @end defun
34222
34223 @defun format-value a width
34224 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34225 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34226 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34227 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34228 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34229 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34230 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34231 window is used.
34232 @end defun
34233
34234 @defun compose-expr a prec
34235 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34236 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34237 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34238 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34239 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
34240 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
34241 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
34242 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
34243 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
34244 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
34245 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
34246 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
34247 normal function-call notation for that language.
34248 @end defun
34249
34250 @defun composition-to-string c w
34251 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
34252 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
34253 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
34254 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
34255 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
34256 @end defun
34257
34258 @defun comp-width c
34259 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
34260 @end defun
34261
34262 @defun comp-height c
34263 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
34264 @end defun
34265
34266 @defun comp-ascent c
34267 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
34268 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
34269 @end defun
34270
34271 @defun comp-descent c
34272 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
34273 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
34274 @end defun
34275
34276 @defun comp-first-char c
34277 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
34278 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
34279 return @code{nil}.
34280 @end defun
34281
34282 @defun comp-last-char c
34283 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
34284 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
34285 @end defun
34286
34287 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34288 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
34289 @comment
34290 @comment @noindent
34291 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
34292
34293 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34294 @subsubsection Hooks
34295
34296 @noindent
34297 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
34298 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
34299 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
34300 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
34301 other customization-related variables are also described here.
34302
34303 @defvar calc-load-hook
34304 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
34305 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
34306 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
34307 @end defvar
34308
34309 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
34310 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
34311 @end defvar
34312
34313 @defvar calc-start-hook
34314 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
34315 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
34316 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
34317 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
34318 @end defvar
34319
34320 @defvar calc-mode-hook
34321 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
34322 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
34323 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
34324 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
34325 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
34326 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
34327 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
34328 been evaluated yet.
34329 @end defvar
34330
34331 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
34332 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
34333 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
34334 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
34335 per Emacs session.
34336 @end defvar
34337
34338 @defvar calc-end-hook
34339 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
34340 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{M-# c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
34341 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
34342 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
34343 @end defvar
34344
34345 @defvar calc-window-hook
34346 If this hook exists, it is called to create the Calc window.
34347 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
34348 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
34349 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
34350 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
34351 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
34352 @end defvar
34353
34354 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
34355 If this hook exists, it is called to create the Calc Trail window.
34356 The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
34357 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook},
34358 this hook must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
34359 @end defvar
34360
34361 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
34362 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
34363 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
34364 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
34365 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
34366 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
34367 @code{calc-edit} command.)
34368 @end defvar
34369
34370 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
34371 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
34372 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
34373 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
34374 message is inserted.
34375 @end defvar
34376
34377 @defvar calc-reset-hook
34378 This hook is called after @kbd{M-# 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
34379 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
34380 @end defvar
34381
34382 @defvar calc-other-modes
34383 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
34384 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
34385 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
34386 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
34387 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
34388 @end defvar
34389
34390 @defvar calc-mode-map
34391 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
34392 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
34393 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
34394 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
34395 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
34396 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
34397 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
34398 extensions are loaded.
34399 @end defvar
34400
34401 @defvar calc-digit-map
34402 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
34403 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
34404 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
34405 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
34406 @end defvar
34407
34408 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
34409 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
34410 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
34411 @end defvar
34412
34413 @defvar calc-store-var-map
34414 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
34415 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
34416 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
34417 @end defvar
34418
34419 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
34420 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
34421 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
34422 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
34423 @end defvar
34424
34425 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
34426 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
34427 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
34428 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
34429 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
34430 non-default variables are written out.
34431 @end defvar
34432
34433 @defvar calc-local-var-list
34434 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
34435 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
34436 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
34437 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
34438 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
34439 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
34440 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
34441 @end defvar
34442
34443 @node Installation, Reporting Bugs, Programming, Top
34444 @appendix Installation
34445
34446 @noindent
34447 As of Calc 2.02g, Calc is integrated with GNU Emacs, and thus requires
34448 no separate installation of its Lisp files and this manual.
34449
34450 @appendixsec The GNUPLOT Program
34451
34452 @noindent
34453 Calc's graphing commands use the GNUPLOT program. If you have GNUPLOT
34454 but you must type some command other than @file{gnuplot} to get it,
34455 you should add a command to set the Lisp variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name}
34456 to the appropriate file name. You may also need to change the variables
34457 @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} in
34458 order to get correct displays and hardcopies, respectively, of your
34459 plots.
34460
34461 @ifinfo
34462 @example
34463
34464 @end example
34465 @end ifinfo
34466 @appendixsec Printed Documentation
34467
34468 @noindent
34469 Because the Calc manual is so large, you should only make a printed
34470 copy if you really need it. To print the manual, you will need the
34471 @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free program by Donald Knuth
34472 at Stanford University) as well as the @file{texindex} program and
34473 @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can be obtained from the FSF
34474 as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
34475
34476 To print the Calc manual in one huge 470 page tome, you will need the
34477 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
34478 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
34479 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
34480 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
34481 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
34482
34483 The result will be a device-independent output file called
34484 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
34485 for your system. On many systems, the command is
34486
34487 @example
34488 lpr -d calc.dvi
34489 @end example
34490
34491 @noindent
34492 or
34493
34494 @example
34495 dvips calc.dvi
34496 @end example
34497
34498 @c the bumpoddpages macro was deleted
34499 @ignore
34500 @cindex Marginal notes, adjusting
34501 Marginal notes for each function and key sequence normally alternate
34502 between the left and right sides of the page, which is correct if the
34503 manual is going to be bound as double-sided pages. Near the top of
34504 the file @file{calc.texi} you will find alternate definitions of
34505 the @code{\bumpoddpages} macro that put the marginal notes always on
34506 the same side, best if you plan to be binding single-sided pages.
34507 @end ignore
34508
34509 @appendixsec Settings File
34510
34511 @noindent
34512 @vindex calc-settings-file
34513 Another variable you might want to set is @code{calc-settings-file},
34514 which holds the file name in which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P}
34515 store ``permanent'' definitions. The default value for this variable
34516 is @code{"~/.calc.el"}. If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user
34517 init file (typically @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable
34518 @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is @code{nil}, then Calc will
34519 automatically load your settings file (if it exists) the first time
34520 Calc is invoked.
34521
34522 @ifinfo
34523 @example
34524
34525 @end example
34526 @end ifinfo
34527 @appendixsec Testing the Installation
34528
34529 @noindent
34530 To test your installation of Calc, start a new Emacs and type @kbd{M-# c}
34531 to make sure the autoloads and key bindings work. Type @kbd{M-# i}
34532 to make sure Calc can find its Info documentation. Press @kbd{q} to
34533 exit the Info system and @kbd{M-# c} to re-enter the Calculator.
34534 Type @kbd{20 S} to compute the sine of 20 degrees; this will test the
34535 autoloading of the extensions modules. The result should be
34536 0.342020143326. Finally, press @kbd{M-# c} again to make sure the
34537 Calculator can exit.
34538
34539 You may also wish to test the GNUPLOT interface; to plot a sine wave,
34540 type @kbd{' [0 ..@: 360], sin(x) @key{RET} g f}. Type @kbd{g q} when you
34541 are done viewing the plot.
34542
34543 Calc is now ready to use. If you wish to go through the Calc Tutorial,
34544 press @kbd{M-# t} to begin.
34545 @example
34546
34547 @end example
34548 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Installation, Top
34549 @appendix Reporting Bugs
34550
34551 @noindent
34552 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
34553
34554 @example
34555 belanger@@truman.edu
34556 @end example
34557
34558 @noindent
34559 (In the following text, ``I'' refers to the original Calc author, Dave
34560 Gillespie).
34561
34562 While I cannot guarantee that I will have time to work on your bug,
34563 I do try to fix bugs quickly whenever I can.
34564
34565 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
34566 CVS tree. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
34567
34568 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
34569 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
34570 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
34571 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
34572 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
34573 regular mailbox.
34574
34575 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, I would
34576 love to hear them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already
34577 top-heavy with features; I really don't see what they're talking
34578 about, so, if you have ideas, send them right in. (I may even have
34579 time to implement them!)
34580
34581 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
34582 future work which I have not had time to do. If any enthusiastic souls
34583 wish to take it upon themselves to work on these, I would be delighted.
34584 Please let me know if you plan to contribute to Calc so I can coordinate
34585 your efforts with mine and those of others. I will do my best to help
34586 you in whatever way I can.
34587
34588 @c [summary]
34589 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
34590 @appendix Calc Summary
34591
34592 @noindent
34593 This section includes a complete list of Calc 2.02 keystroke commands.
34594 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
34595 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
34596 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
34597 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
34598 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
34599 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
34600 command name refer to notes at the end.
34601
34602 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
34603 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
34604 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
34605
34606 @iftex
34607 @begingroup
34608 @tex
34609 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
34610 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
34611 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
34612 \leavevmode%
34613 {\smallfonts
34614 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
34615 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
34616 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
34617 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
34618 \thinspace%
34619 {\tt#5}%
34620 {\sl#6}%
34621 }}%
34622 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
34623 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
34624 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
34625 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
34626 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
34627 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
34628 @end tex
34629 @let@:=@sumsep
34630 @let@r=@sumrow
34631 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
34632 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
34633 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
34634 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
34635 @end iftex
34636 @format
34637 @iftex
34638 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
34639 @let@c@sumbreak
34640 @end iftex
34641 @r{ @: M-# a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
34642 @r{ @: M-# b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
34643 @r{ @: M-# c @: @: @:calc@:}
34644 @r{ @: M-# d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
34645 @r{ @: M-# e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
34646 @r{ @: M-# f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
34647 @r{ @: M-# g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
34648 @r{ @: M-# i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
34649 @r{ @: M-# j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
34650 @r{ @: M-# k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
34651 @r{ @: M-# l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
34652 @r{ @: M-# m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
34653 @r{ @: M-# n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
34654 @r{ @: M-# o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
34655 @r{ @: M-# p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
34656 @r{ @: M-# q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
34657 @r{ @: M-# r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
34658 @r{ @: M-# s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
34659 @r{ @: M-# t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
34660 @r{ @: M-# u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update@:}
34661 @r{ @: M-# w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
34662 @r{ @: M-# x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
34663 @r{ @: M-# y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
34664 @r{ @: M-# z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
34665 @r{ @: M-# : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
34666 @r{ @: M-# _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
34667 @r{ @: M-# ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
34668 @r{ @: M-# 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
34669
34670 @c
34671 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
34672 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
34673 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
34674 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
34675 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@t{#}number}
34676 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
34677 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
34678 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
34679 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
34680
34681 @c
34682 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
34683 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
34684 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
34685
34686 @c
34687 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
34688 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
34689 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
34690 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
34691 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
34692 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
34693 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
34694 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
34695 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
34696 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
34697 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
34698 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
34699 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
34700 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
34701 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
34702 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
34703 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
34704
34705 @c
34706 @r{ ... a@: @key{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
34707 @r{ ... a@: @key{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
34708 @r{... a b@: @key{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
34709 @r{. a b c@: M-@key{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
34710 @r{... a b@: @key{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
34711 @r{ ... a@: @key{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
34712 @r{... a b@: M-@key{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
34713 @r{ @: M-@key{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
34714 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
34715
34716 @c
34717 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
34718 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
34719 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
34720 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
34721 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
34722 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
34723 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
34724
34725 @c
34726 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
34727 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
34728 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
34729 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
34730 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
34731 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
34732 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
34733
34734 @c
34735 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
34736 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
34737 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
34738 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
34739 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
34740 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
34741
34742 @c
34743 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
34744 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
34745 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
34746 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
34747 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
34748 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
34749 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
34750
34751 @c
34752 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
34753 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
34754 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
34755 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
34756 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
34757 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
34758 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
34759 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
34760 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
34761 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
34762 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
34763 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
34764 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
34765 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
34766 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
34767 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
34768 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
34769 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
34770 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
34771 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
34772 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
34773 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
34774 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
34775 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
34776 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
34777 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
34778 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
34779 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
34780 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
34781 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
34782 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
34783 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
34784 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
34785 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
34786 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
34787 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
34788 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
34789 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
34790 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
34791 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
34792 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
34793 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
34794 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
34795 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
34796
34797 @c
34798 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
34799 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
34800 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
34801 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
34802 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
34803 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
34804 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
34805 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
34806 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
34807 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
34808 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
34809 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
34810 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
34811
34812 @c
34813 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
34814 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
34815 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
34816 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
34817
34818 @c
34819 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
34820 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
34821 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
34822 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
34823
34824 @c
34825 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
34826 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
34827 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
34828 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
34829 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
34830 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
34831 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
34832 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
34833 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
34834 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
34835 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
34836 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
34837 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
34838 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
34839 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
34840 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
34841 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
34842 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
34843 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
34844 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
34845
34846 @c
34847 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
34848 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
34849 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
34850 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
34851 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
34852 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
34853 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
34854 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
34855 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
34856 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
34857 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
34858 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
34859 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
34860 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
34861 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
34862 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
34863 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
34864 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
34865 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
34866
34867 @c
34868 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
34869 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
34870 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
34871 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
34872 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
34873 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
34874 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
34875 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
34876 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
34877 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
34878 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
34879 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
34880 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
34881 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
34882 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
34883
34884 @c
34885 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
34886 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
34887 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
34888 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
34889 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
34890 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
34891 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
34892 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
34893 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
34894 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
34895 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
34896 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
34897 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
34898 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
34899 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
34900 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
34901 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
34902 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
34903 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
34904 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
34905 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
34906 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
34907 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
34908
34909 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
34910 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
34911 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
34912 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
34913
34914 @c
34915 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
34916 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
34917 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
34918 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
34919 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
34920 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
34921 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
34922 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
34923 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
34924 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
34925 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
34926
34927 @c
34928 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
34929 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
34930
34931 @c
34932 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
34933
34934 @c
34935 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
34936 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
34937 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
34938 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
34939 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
34940 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
34941 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
34942 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
34943 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
34944 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
34945 @r{ @: d @key{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
34946 @r{ @: d @key{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
34947
34948 @c
34949 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
34950 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
34951 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
34952 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
34953
34954 @c
34955 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
34956 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
34957 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
34958 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
34959 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
34960 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
34961 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
34962 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
34963 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
34964 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
34965 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
34966 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
34967 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
34968 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
34969 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
34970 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
34971 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
34972 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
34973
34974 @c
34975 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
34976 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
34977 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
34978 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
34979 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
34980 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
34981 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
34982 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
34983 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
34984 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
34985 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
34986
34987 @c
34988 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
34989 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
34990
34991 @c
34992 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
34993 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
34994 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
34995 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
34996 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
34997 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
34998 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
34999 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
35000 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
35001 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
35002 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
35003 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
35004
35005 @c
35006 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
35007 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
35008 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
35009 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
35010 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
35011 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
35012 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
35013 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
35014 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
35015 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35016 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
35017 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
35018 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
35019 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35020 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
35021 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
35022 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
35023
35024 @c
35025 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
35026 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
35027 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
35028 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
35029 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
35030 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
35031 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
35032 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
35033 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
35034 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
35035 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
35036 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
35037 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
35038 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
35039 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
35040 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
35041 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
35042 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
35043 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
35044
35045 @c
35046 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
35047 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
35048 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
35049 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
35050 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
35051 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
35052 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
35053 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
35054 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
35055 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
35056 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
35057 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
35058 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
35059 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
35060 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
35061 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
35062
35063 @c
35064 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
35065 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
35066 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
35067
35068 @c
35069 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
35070 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
35071 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
35072 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
35073 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35074 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
35075 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
35076 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35077 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35078 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
35079
35080 @c
35081 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
35082 @r{ @: j @key{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
35083 @r{ @: j @key{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
35084 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
35085 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
35086 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
35087
35088 @c
35089 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
35090 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
35091 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
35092 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
35093 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
35094
35095 @c
35096 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
35097 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
35098 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
35099 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
35100 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
35101 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
35102 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
35103 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
35104 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
35105 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
35106 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
35107 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
35108 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
35109 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
35110
35111 @c
35112 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
35113 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
35114 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
35115 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
35116 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
35117 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
35118 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
35119 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
35120 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
35121 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
35122 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
35123 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
35124
35125 @c
35126 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
35127 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
35128 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
35129 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
35130 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
35131 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
35132 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
35133 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
35134 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
35135 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
35136 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
35137 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
35138 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
35139 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
35140 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
35141 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
35142 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
35143 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
35144 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
35145 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
35146
35147 @c
35148 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
35149 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
35150 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
35151 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
35152 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
35153 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35154 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35155 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
35156 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
35157 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
35158 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
35159 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
35160 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
35161
35162 @c
35163 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
35164 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
35165 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
35166 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
35167 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
35168 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
35169 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
35170 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
35171 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
35172 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
35173 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
35174 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
35175 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
35176 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
35177
35178 @c
35179 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
35180 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
35181 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
35182 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
35183 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
35184 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
35185 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
35186 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
35187 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
35188 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
35189 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
35190
35191 @c
35192 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
35193 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
35194 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
35195 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
35196 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
35197 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
35198 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
35199 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
35200 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
35201 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
35202 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
35203 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
35204 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
35205 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
35206 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
35207 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
35208
35209 @c
35210 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
35211 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
35212 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
35213 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
35214 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
35215 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
35216 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
35217 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
35218 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
35219 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
35220 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
35221 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
35222 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
35223
35224 @c
35225 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
35226 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
35227 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
35228 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
35229 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
35230 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
35231 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
35232 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
35233 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
35234 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @t{:=} b}
35235 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @t{=>}}
35236
35237 @c
35238 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
35239 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
35240 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
35241 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
35242 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
35243
35244 @c
35245 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
35246 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
35247 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
35248 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
35249 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
35250 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
35251 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
35252 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
35253 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
35254 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
35255 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
35256 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
35257 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
35258
35259 @c
35260 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35261 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35262 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
35263 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
35264 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
35265 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
35266 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
35267 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
35268 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
35269 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
35270 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
35271 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
35272 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
35273 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
35274 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
35275 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
35276 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
35277 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
35278 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
35279
35280 @c
35281 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
35282 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
35283
35284 @c
35285 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
35286 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
35287 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
35288 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
35289 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
35290 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
35291 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
35292 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
35293 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
35294 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
35295 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
35296 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
35297 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
35298 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
35299
35300 @c
35301 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
35302 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
35303 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
35304 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
35305 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
35306 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
35307 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
35308 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
35309 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
35310 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
35311 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
35312 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
35313 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
35314 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
35315 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
35316 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
35317
35318 @c
35319 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
35320 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
35321 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
35322
35323 @c
35324 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
35325 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
35326 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
35327 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
35328 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
35329 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
35330 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
35331 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
35332 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
35333 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
35334
35335 @c
35336 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
35337 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
35338 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
35339 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
35340 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
35341 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
35342
35343 @c
35344 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
35345
35346 @c
35347 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
35348 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
35349 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
35350 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
35351 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35352 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
35353 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
35354 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
35355 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
35356 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
35357 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
35358 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
35359 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
35360 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
35361 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
35362 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
35363 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
35364 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
35365 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
35366 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
35367 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
35368 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
35369 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
35370 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
35371 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35372 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
35373 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
35374 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
35375 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
35376 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
35377 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
35378 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
35379
35380 @c
35381 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
35382 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
35383 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
35384 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
35385 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
35386 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
35387 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
35388 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
35389 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
35390 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
35391 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
35392 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
35393 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
35394 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
35395 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
35396 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
35397 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
35398 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
35399 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
35400 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
35401 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
35402 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
35403 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
35404 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
35405 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
35406 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
35407 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
35408 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
35409
35410 @c
35411 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
35412
35413 @c
35414 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
35415
35416 @c
35417 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
35418 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
35419 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
35420 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
35421
35422 @c
35423 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
35424 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
35425 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
35426 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
35427 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
35428 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
35429 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
35430
35431 @c
35432 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
35433
35434 @c
35435 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
35436 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
35437 @r{ a@: Z = @:message @: 28 @:calc-kbd-report@:}
35438 @r{ @: Z # @:prompt @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
35439
35440 @c
35441 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
35442 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
35443 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
35444 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
35445 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
35446 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
35447 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
35448 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
35449 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
35450 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
35451 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
35452
35453 @end format
35454
35455 @noindent
35456 NOTES
35457
35458 @enumerate
35459 @c 1
35460 @item
35461 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35462 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
35463 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
35464 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
35465
35466 @c 2
35467 @item
35468 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35469 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
35470 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
35471
35472 @c 3
35473 @item
35474 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
35475 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
35476 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
35477
35478 @c 4
35479 @item
35480 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
35481
35482 @c 5
35483 @item
35484 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
35485 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
35486
35487 @c 6
35488 @item
35489 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
35490 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
35491
35492 @c 7
35493 @item
35494 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
35495 1=Default, 2=like @kbd{a s}, 3=like @kbd{a e}.
35496
35497 @c 8
35498 @item
35499 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
35500
35501 @c 9
35502 @item
35503 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
35504 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
35505
35506 @c 10
35507 @item
35508 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
35509 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
35510
35511 @c 11
35512 @item
35513 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
35514
35515 @c 12
35516 @item
35517 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
35518 prefix always clears the mode.
35519
35520 @c 13
35521 @item
35522 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
35523
35524 @c 14
35525 @item
35526 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
35527 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
35528 @iftex
35529 {@advance@tableindent10pt
35530 @end iftex
35531 @table @asis
35532 @item Integer
35533 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
35534 @item Float
35535 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
35536 @item 0.0
35537 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
35538 @item Error form
35539 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
35540 @item Interval
35541 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
35542 @item Vector
35543 Random element from the vector.
35544 @end table
35545 @iftex
35546 }
35547 @end iftex
35548
35549 @c 15
35550 @item
35551 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
35552 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
35553
35554 @c 16
35555 @item
35556 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
35557 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
35558
35559 @c 17
35560 @item
35561 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
35562
35563 @c 18
35564 @item
35565 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
35566 the new units.
35567
35568 @c 19
35569 @item
35570 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
35571 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
35572
35573 @c 20
35574 @item
35575 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
35576 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
35577 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
35578 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
35579
35580 @c 21
35581 @item
35582 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
35583 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
35584 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
35585 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
35586
35587 @c 22
35588 @item
35589 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
35590 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
35591 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
35592 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
35593 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
35594 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
35595 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
35596 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
35597 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
35598
35599 @c 23
35600 @item
35601 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
35602 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
35603 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
35604 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
35605 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
35606 or @code{d} for ``down.''
35607
35608 @c 24
35609 @item
35610 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
35611 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
35612 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
35613 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
35614 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
35615 @iftex
35616 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
35617 @end iftex
35618 @table @cite
35619 @item -1
35620 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
35621 @item -2
35622 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
35623 @item -3
35624 (@var{3}) HMS form.
35625 @item -4
35626 (@var{2}) Error form.
35627 @item -5
35628 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
35629 @item -6
35630 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
35631 @item -7
35632 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
35633 @item -8
35634 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
35635 @item -9
35636 (@var{2}) Open interval.
35637 @item -10
35638 (@var{2}) Fraction.
35639 @item -11
35640 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
35641 @item -12
35642 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
35643 @item -13
35644 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
35645 @item -14
35646 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
35647 @item -15
35648 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
35649 @end table
35650 @iftex
35651 }
35652 @end iftex
35653
35654 @c 25
35655 @item
35656 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
35657 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
35658 the input vector.
35659
35660 @c 26
35661 @item
35662 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
35663
35664 @c 27
35665 @item
35666 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
35667
35668 @c 28
35669 @item
35670 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
35671
35672 @c 29
35673 @item
35674 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
35675
35676 @c 30
35677 @item
35678 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
35679 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
35680 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
35681 of the result of the edit.
35682
35683 @c 31
35684 @item
35685 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
35686
35687 @c 32
35688 @item
35689 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
35690
35691 @c 33
35692 @item
35693 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
35694 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
35695
35696 @c 34
35697 @item
35698 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
35699 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
35700 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
35701 backward by that many lines.
35702
35703 @c 35
35704 @item
35705 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
35706 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
35707 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
35708 region between point and mark as a single formula.
35709
35710 @c 36
35711 @item
35712 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
35713 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
35714 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
35715 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
35716
35717 @c 37
35718 @item
35719 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
35720
35721 @c 38
35722 @item
35723 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
35724 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
35725
35726 @c 39
35727 @item
35728 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
35729 @expr{v - v_0}.
35730
35731 @c 40
35732 @item
35733 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
35734 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
35735 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
35736 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
35737 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
35738
35739 @c 41
35740 @item
35741 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
35742
35743 @c 42
35744 @item
35745 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
35746 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
35747
35748 @c 43
35749 @item
35750 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
35751 value for this graph.
35752
35753 @c 44
35754 @item
35755 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
35756
35757 @c 45
35758 @item
35759 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
35760 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
35761 otherwise.
35762
35763 @c 46
35764 @item
35765 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
35766 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
35767 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
35768 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
35769 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
35770 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
35771 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
35772 to evaluate variables.
35773
35774 @c 47
35775 @item
35776 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
35777 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
35778 assigns
35779 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
35780 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
35781
35782 @c 48
35783 @item
35784 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
35785 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
35786 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
35787 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
35788 and a vector from the stack.
35789
35790 @c 49
35791 @item
35792 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
35793 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
35794
35795 @c 50
35796 @item
35797 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
35798 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
35799 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
35800
35801 @c 51
35802 @item
35803 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
35804 default 2D resolution.
35805
35806 @c 52
35807 @item
35808 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
35809 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
35810 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
35811 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
35812 @end enumerate
35813
35814 @iftex
35815 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
35816 @page
35817 @endgroup
35818 @end iftex
35819
35820
35821 @c [end-summary]
35822
35823 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
35824 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
35825
35826 @printindex ky
35827
35828 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
35829 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
35830
35831 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
35832 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
35833 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
35834 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
35835
35836 @printindex pg
35837
35838 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
35839 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
35840
35841 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
35842 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
35843 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
35844 @iftex
35845 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
35846 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
35847 @end iftex
35848
35849 @printindex tp
35850
35851 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
35852 @unnumbered Concept Index
35853
35854 @printindex cp
35855
35856 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
35857 @unnumbered Index of Variables
35858
35859 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
35860 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
35861 corresponding Lisp variable.
35862
35863 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
35864 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
35865
35866 @printindex vr
35867
35868 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
35869 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
35870
35871 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
35872 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
35873 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
35874 @samp{math-}.
35875
35876 @printindex fn
35877
35878 @summarycontents
35879
35880 @c [end]
35881
35882 @contents
35883 @bye
35884
35885
35886 @ignore
35887 arch-tag: 77a71809-fa4d-40be-b2cc-da3e8fb137c0
35888 @end ignore